You are on page 1of 1182

Alcatel-Lucent GSM

Telecom Parameters Dictionary

OMC Document
Reference Guide
Release B10

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

BLANK PAGE BREAK

Status

RELEASED

Short title
All rights reserved. Passing on and copying of this document, use
and communication of its contents not permitted without written
authorization from Alcatel-Lucent.

2 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

Contents

Contents
Preface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
1

2
3

7
8

Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
1.1
Parameter Classification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
1.2
Parameter Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
VGCS Telecom Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
2.1
Site (CAE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
LCS Telecom Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
3.1
Network (CDE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
3.2
Site (CAE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
GSM Telecom Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
4.1
Network (CDE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
4.2
Site (CAE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
4.3
System (CST) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 722
GPRS Telecom Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 725
5.1
Network (CDE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 726
5.2
Site (CAE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 786
E-GPRS Telecom Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1121
6.1
Network (CDE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1122
6.2
Site (CAE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1125
DTM Telecom Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1141
7.1
Site (CAE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1142
2G-3G Telecom Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1145
8.1
Network (CDE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1146
8.2
Site (CAE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1147
Telecom Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1181
9.1
Site (CAE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

3 / 1182

Contents

4 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

Preface

Preface
Purpose
Whats New

The BSS Parameter Dictionary lists all of the Telecom Parameters for GSM
and GPRS.

In Edition 10
This document was generated from the edition 19rl of the BSS Telecom
Parameters database.

In Edition 09
This document was generated from the edition 16rl of the BSS Telecom
Parameters database.

In Edition 08
This document was generated from the edition 14rl of the BSS Telecom
Parameters database.

In Edition 07
This document was generated from the edition 13rl of the BSS Telecom
Parameters database.

In Edition 06
This document was generated from the edition 11rl of the BSS Telecom
Parameters database.

In Edition 05
This document was generated from the edition 07rl of the BSS Telecom
Parameters database.

In Edition 04
This document was generated from the edition 06rl of the BSS Telecom
Parameters database.

In Edition 03
This document was generated from the edition 05rl of the BSS Telecom
Parameters database.

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 / 1182

Preface

In Edition 02
This document was generated from the edition 04rl of the BSS Telecom
Parameters database.

In Edition 01
First official release of document.
This document was generated from the edition 03rl of the BSS Telecom
Parameters database.

Audience
Assumed Knowledge

6 / 1182

This manual is designed for OMC-R users, O&M technicians and system
designers.
Not applicable.

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1 Introduction

1 Introduction

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

7 / 1182

1 Introduction

1.1 Parameter Classification


The GSM and GPRS parameters are classified into three categories:
Network: customer dependent parameters, related to the network topology,
defined by the customer and valid for the complete network (e.g. BTS name,
Cell ID, LAC number ...). They can be adjusted by CDE scripts.
Site: adjustable parameters from one cell to the next or from one BSC to the
next. They are set to a default value. They can be adjusted from the OMC-R.
System: fixed parameters, i.e. BSS system mandatory rules or
automatically populated in the DLS skeleton and let unchanged because
not customer dependent. Some of them are coded in BTS Software and
configuration files.

1.2 Parameter Description


To each parameter are associated the following characteristics:
Logical Parameter Name: Mnemonic conventionally used in Alcatel
documentation.
Definition: definition/purpose of the parameter.
Coding rules:, Rules of coding, when necessary.
Mandatory rules: Mandatory relationships or inter-dependence of some
data.
Recommended rules: Recommended relationships or inter-dependence
of some data.
Feature: Indicates to which feature the parameter is linked.
Category: Category into which the parameter is classified.
Instance: Possible instance of the parameter.
Value
Min/Max values: Possible range of the parameter values.
Default value: Parameter value in release B9 for a generic configuration.
Modifiable: Indicates if the parameter is modifiable at the OMC-R.
Parameter Access: Indicates where the parameter is accessible at the
OMC-R.
External Comments: Specific information, when necessary, related
to the parameter.

8 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

9 / 1182

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1 Site (CAE)


2.1.1 (CELL_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS(n)) (CELL_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS(n))
Parameter Name

HMI Name

CELL_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS(n)

Logical Name

CELL_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS(n)

Definition

Level hysteresis for cell reselection applied when the new cell is in
a different location area.

Coding rules

step size = 2dB; coded on 3 bits (000 : 0 dB, 111 : 14 dB)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

14

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

10 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.2 (CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET) (CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET(n)(BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET

Logical Name

CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET(n)(BSC)

Definition

Permanent offset to C2 criterion.

Coding rules

step size = 2dB; coded on 6 bits (000000:0 dB, 111111 : 126 dB)

Mandatory rules

CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET(n)(MFS) =
CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET (n)(BSC)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

126

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

11 / 1182

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.3 (EN_INBAND_NOTIF) - (EN_INBAND_NOTIF)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_INBAND_NOTIF

Logical Name

EN_INBAND_NOTIF

Definition

Flag to disable/enable the in-band notification

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1:enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

12 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.4 (EN_INBAND_PAGING) - (EN_INBAND_PAGING)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_INBAND_PAGING

Logical Name

EN_INBAND_PAGING

Definition

Flag to disable/enable the in-band paging

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

13 / 1182

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.5 (EN_UPLINK_REPLY) - (EN_UPLINK_REPLY)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_UPLINK_REPLY

Logical Name

EN_UPLINK_REPLY

Definition

Flag to disable/enable the uplink reply procedure

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

14 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.6 (EN_VGCS) - (EN_VGCS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_VGCS

Logical Name

EN_VGCS

Definition

Flag to disable/enable the VGCS in the cell

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

EN_VGCS shall be set to disabled for non-Evolium BTS

Recommended rules

When the VGCS feature (EN_VGCS) is activated, it is recommended


to- include the Response Request in the HANDOVER REQUIRED
message (RESP_REQ).- to configure, at least, one TRX with
TRX_PREF_MARK <> 0 in the cell.- to set EN_TCH_PREEMPT to
enabled, otherwise to set the value of MIN_VGCS_TS to a value
greater or equal to 2

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

15 / 1182

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.7 (INBAND_PAGING_THR) - (INBAND_PAGING_THR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

INBAND_PAGING_THR

Logical Name

INBAND_PAGING_THR

Definition

If the eMLPP priority included in the Paging message from the MSC
is higher than or equal to this parameter, then the BSS shall trigger
in-band paging within cells, that are identified to be paged from the
PAGING message, and that have existing VGC active.

Coding rules

Coded over 3 bits000 : deactivation of inband paging001 : call


priority level 4 (lowest priority)010 : call priority level 3011 : call
priority level 2100 : call priority level 1101 : call priority level 0110 :
call priority level B111 : call priority level A (highest priority)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

16 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.8 (MAX_VGCS_TS) - (MAX_VGCS_TS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MAX_VGCS_TS

Logical Name

MAX_VGCS_TS

Definition

Maximum number of radio timeslots that can be used by the VGCS


calls in the cell.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

MIN_VGCS_TS <= MAX_VGCS_TSIf EN_VGCS= enabled, then


"(MAX_VGCS_TS + MAX_PDCH) < Total number of TCHs of the
cell".If EN_VGCS= disabled, then" MAX_VGCS_TS = 0"

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

127

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

127 is a theoretical value : 16 TRX * 8 PDCH - BCCH.To support


VGCS in a cell, it is mandatory to have Max_VGCS_TS > 0

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

17 / 1182

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.9 (MIN_VGCS_TS) - (MIN_VGCS_TS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MIN_VGCS_TS

Logical Name

MIN_VGCS_TS

Definition

Minimum number of radio timeslots that are reserved for the VGCS
calls in the cell in normal situation (point-to-point CS call can NOT
use these timeslots).

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

MIN_VGCS_TS <= MAX_VGCS_TS

Recommended rules

- The following rules about the upper limit are recommended :i)
MIN_VGCS_TS <= 8*(nb of TRXs with TRX_PREF_MARK <> 0)
- 2 if TRX_PREF_MARK <> 0 on BCCH TRX and CCCH_CONF
= "1: CCCH combined"ii) MIN_VGCS_TS <= 8*(nb of TRXs
with TRX_PREF_MARK <> 0) - 3 if TRX_PREF_MARK <> 0 on
BCCH TRX and CCCH_CONF = "0: CCCH not combined"iii)
MIN_VGCS_TS <= 8*(nb of TRXs with TRX_PREF_MARK <> 0) - 1
if TRX_PREF_MARK = 0 on BCCH TRX.- If EN_VGCS = enabled
, then Alcatel recommends to set EN_TCH_PREEMPT to enabled,
otherwise to set the value of MIN_VGCS_TS to a value greater or
equal to 2

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

31

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

127 is a theoretical value : 16 TRX * 8 PDCH - BCCH.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

18 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.10 (MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH) - (MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH(n)(BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH

Logical Name

MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH(n)(BSC)

Definition

Maximum transmission power an MS is allowed to use when


accessing the cell until otherwise commanded, broadcast on PBCCH
for CS service establishment.

Coding rules

P-GSM/G1 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 43 dBm, ..., 19: 5


dBm.GSM 850 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 39 dBm, 1: 39 dBm, 2:
39 dBm, 3: 37 dBm, 4: 35 dBm,..., 19: 5 dBm.DCS 1800 coding:step
size = 2 dBm; 0: 30 dBm, ..., 15: 0 dBm.DCS 1900 coding: range
0 to 15, 30, 31; 30: 33 dBm, 31: 32 dBm, 0: 30 dBm, 1: 28 dBm,
..., 15: 0 dBm.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

43

43

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

According to the 3GPP TS 05.05, if the BCCH frequency band is


P-GSM/G1, depending on the version of MS (Phase 1 MS or Phase
2/onwards MS), the coded value "0", "1" and "2" are interpreted
differently:- Coded value "0": (interpreted as 43 dBm by the Phase
1 MS; interpreted as 39 dBm by the Phase 2/onwards MS);- Coded
value "1": (interpreted as 41 dBm by the Phase 1 MS; interpreted as
39 dBm by the Phase 2/onwards MS);- Coded value "2": (interpreted
as 39 dBm by both the Phase 1 MS and the Phase 2/onwards MS).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

19 / 1182

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.11 (NOTIF_FACCH_OTHER_VGCS_CALL_THR) (NOTIF_FACCH_OTHER_VGCS_CALL_THR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NOTIF_FACCH_OTHER_VGCS_CALL_THR

Logical Name

NOTIF_FACCH_OTHER_VGCS_CALL_THR

Definition

If the eMLPP priority is higher than or equal to this parameter, the


Notifications message shall be sent on FACCH of all other on-going
VGCS call.

Coding rules

Coded over 3 bits000 : deactivation of notification on FACCH of other


on-going VGCS calls001 : call priority level 4 (lowest priority)010 :
call priority level 3011 : call priority level 2100 : call priority level
1101 : call priority level 0110 : call priority level B111 : call priority
level A (highest priority)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

20 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.12 (NOTIF_FACCH_PTP_CALL_THR) (NOTIF_FACCH_PTP_CALL_THR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NOTIF_FACCH_PTP_CALL_THR

Logical Name

NOTIF_FACCH_PTP_CALL_THR

Definition

If the eMLPP priority is higher than or equal to this parameter, the


Notifications message shall be sent on FACCH of all on-going point
to point call whose MS is VGCS capable.

Coding rules

Coded over 3 bits000 : deactivation of notification on FACCH of all


on going point to point calls in the cell001 : call priority level 4 (lowest
priority)010 : call priority level 3011 : call priority level 2100 : call
priority level 1101 : call priority level 0110 : call priority level B111 :
call priority level A (highest priority)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

21 / 1182

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.13 (NOTIF_PCH_THR) - (NOTIF_PCH_THR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NOTIF_PCH_THR

Logical Name

NOTIF_PCH_THR

Definition

The priority threshold for notification over PCH.The BSS shall


consider, for Notification/PCH, only VGCS-Calls which have a priority
(eMLPP priority) not below this parameter. If more than one is
selected, all these voice group calls shall be notified on PCH and all
with the same frequency of occurrence.

Coding rules

Coded over 3 bits000 : deactivation of notification on PCH in the


cell001 : call priority level 4 (lowest priority)010 : call priority level
3011 : call priority level 2100 : call priority level 1101 : call priority
level 0110 : call priority level B111 : call priority level A (highest
priority)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

22 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.14 (NUMBER_NCH_BLOCKS) - (NUMBER_NCH_BLOCKS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NUMBER_NCH_BLOCKS

Logical Name

NUMBER_NCH_BLOCKS

Definition

This parameter defines the maximum number of blocks usable for


NCH.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

if EN_VGCS is enabled :- BS_AG_BLKS_RES >=


NUMBER_NCH_BLOCKS- if BCCH_EXT = true, then
BS_AG_BLKS_RES > NUMBER_NCH_BLOCKS

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

The parameter is significant when EN_VGCS is enabled

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

23 / 1182

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.15 (NY2) - (NY2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NY2

Logical Name

NY2

Definition

Maximum number of repetitions for the VGCS UPLINK GRANT


message during an uplink access procedure

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

24 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.16 (PENALTY_TIME) - (PENALTY_TIME(n)(BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PENALTY_TIME

Logical Name

PENALTY_TIME(n)(BSC)

Definition

Time during which MS shall apply TEMPORARY_OFFSET to C2


criterion.

Coding rules

step size = 20s. 0: 20s, 1: 40s, ..., 30: 620s, 31: TEMPORARY
OFFSET ignored and cell_RESELECT_OFFSET has a negative
value

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

20

620

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

inhibited (31)

Umbrella

inhibited (31)

Concentric

inhibited (31)

Concentric Umbrella

inhibited (31)

Microcell

20 s (0)

Minicell

20 s (0)

Extended inner cell

inhibited (31)

Extended outer cell

inhibited (31)

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

25 / 1182

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.17 (RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN) - (RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN(n)(BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN

Logical Name

RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN(n)(BSC)

Definition

Minimum received level at the MS required for initial access to the


cell.

Coding rules

Coded on 6 bits, 0=-110 dBm, 63=-47 dBm, step size=1dBm.

Mandatory rules

RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN(n)(MFS) = RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN(n)(BSC)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

26 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.18 (START_UPLINK_REPLY) - (START_UPLINK_REPLY)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

START_UPLINK_REPLY

Logical Name

START_UPLINK_REPLY

Definition

Maximum number of repetitions for the UPLINK FREE message (with


the Uplink Access Request bit set to L) during the initial part of the
uplink access procedure (i.e. before sending the first UPLINK FREE
message with the Uplink Access Request bit set to H)

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

1024

256

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

The parameter is significant only if EN_UPLINK_REPLY is set to true.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

27 / 1182

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.19 (T_NOTIF_RESPONSE_DELAY) - (T_NOTIF_RESPONSE_DELAY)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_NOTIF_RESPONSE_DELAY

Logical Name

T_NOTIF_RESPONSE_DELAY

Definition

This Timer is used to delay the Multiple SACCH Info Modify and
the VGCS_ADD_INFO in order to give the MS a chance to receive
the immediately transmitted VGCS_ADD_INFO/FACCH and SI6
messages

Coding rules

step size = 100 ms

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

100

1000

200

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

28 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.20 (T_REPETITION_CHANNEL_RELEASE) (T_REPETITION_CHANNEL_RELEASE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_REPETITION_CHANNEL_RELEASE

Logical Name

T_REPETITION_CHANNEL_RELEASE

Definition

This parameter defines the repetition period of CHANNEL RELEASE


message sent on FACCH

Coding rules

step size = 100 ms

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

200

1000

200

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

29 / 1182

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.21 (T_REPETITION_UPLINK_FREE) - (T_REPETITION_UPLINK_FREE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_REPETITION_UPLINK_FREE

Logical Name

T_REPETITION_UPLINK_FREE

Definition

Delay between consecutive repetitions of the UPLINK FREE


message, sent to the mobile station. The UPLINK FREE messages
shall be repeated as long as no uplink is granted to a mobile station.

Coding rules

step size = 20 ms

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

20

480

200

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

30 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.22 (T_WAIT_UPLINK_ACCESS) - (T_WAIT_UPLINK_ACCESS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_WAIT_UPLINK_ACCESS

Logical Name

T_WAIT_UPLINK_ACCESS

Definition

Guard timer to wait for an Uplink Access. If no such bursts are


received at this timer expiry, the BSC releases the voice group call
channel in that cell and provide notifications containing no channel
description.

Coding rules

step size = 1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

T_Wait_Uplink_Access >= [START_UPLINK_REPLY + (10 *


WAIT_UPLINK_ACCESS)] * T_REPETITION_UPLINK_FREE

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

300

60

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

The parameter is significant only if EN_UPLINK_REPLY is set to true

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

31 / 1182

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.23 (T_WAIT_UPLINK_REQUEST_ACK) (T_WAIT_UPLINK_REQUEST_ACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_WAIT_UPLINK_REQUEST_ACK

Logical Name

T_WAIT_UPLINK_REQUEST_ACK

Definition

Guard timer to wait for UPLINK REQUEST ACK or UPLINK


REQUEST REJECT message from the MSC.

Coding rules

step size = 500 ms

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

500

5000

500

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

32 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.24 (T14) - (T14)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T14

Logical Name

T14

Definition

Maximum queuing time for the VGCS Assignment Requests

Coding rules

step size = 1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

19

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

33 / 1182

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.25 (T3115) - (T3115)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T3115

Logical Name

T3115

Definition

This timer is used for the repetition of the VGCS UPLINK GRANT
message during the uplink access procedure. If the timer expires
before the reception of a correctly decoded frame from MS, the BTS
repeats the VGCS UPLINK GRANT message to the requesting MS

Coding rules

step size = 20ms

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

100

480

200

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

34 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.26 (TEMPORARY_OFFSET) - (TEMPORARY_OFFSET(n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TEMPORARY_OFFSET

Logical Name

TEMPORARY_OFFSET(n)

Definition

Offset applied to C2 criterion for the duration of PENALTY_TIME.

Coding rules

step size = 10dB. 0: 0dB, 1:10dB, 6: 60dB, 7: infinity

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

infinity

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

0 dB (0)

Umbrella

0 dB (0)

Concentric

0 dB (0)

Concentric Umbrella

0 dB (0)

Microcell

infinity (7)

Minicell

infinity (7)

Extended inner cell

0 dB (0)

Extended outer cell

0 dB (0)

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

35 / 1182

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.27 (VGCS_FIX_AMR_FR_CODEC) - (VGCS_FIX_AMR_FR_CODEC)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

VGCS_FIX_AMR_FR_CODEC

Logical Name

VGCS_FIX_AMR_FR_CODEC

Definition

This parameter defines the type of FR AMR codec used in the


network.

Coding rules

0 : AMR Full Rate Codec 12,2 kbit/s;1 : AMR Full Rate Codec 10,2
kbit/s;2 : AMR Full Rate Codec 7,95 kbit/s;3 : AMR Full Rate Codec
7,40 kbit/s; 4 : AMR Full Rate Codec 6,70 kbit/s; 5 : AMR Full Rate
Codec 5,90 kbit/s; 6 : AMR Full Rate Codec 5,15 kbit/s; 7 : AMR Full
Rate Codec 4,75 kbit/st;

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

36 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.28 (VGCS_FIX_AMR_HR_CODEC) - (VGCS_FIX_AMR_HR_CODEC)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

VGCS_FIX_AMR_HR_CODEC

Logical Name

VGCS_FIX_AMR_HR_CODEC

Definition

This parameter defines the type of HR AMR codec used in the


network.

Coding rules

0 : AMR Half Rate Codec 7,95 kbit/s;1 : AMR Half Rate Codec 7,40
kbit/s;2 : AMR Half Rate Codec 6,70 kbit/s;3 : AMR Half Rate Codec
5,90 kbit/s;4 : AMR Half Rate Codec 5,15 kbit/s;5 : AMR Half Rate
Codec 4,75 kbit/s;

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

AMR Half Rate codec mode 7,95 kb/s is not supported by Alcatel
BSS.AMR Half Rate codec mode 7,4kb/s is not supported as a
"stand-alone" codec

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

37 / 1182

2 VGCS Telecom Parameters

2.1.29 (WAIT_UPLINK_ACCESS) - (WAIT_UPLINK_ACCESS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

WAIT_UPLINK_ACCESS

Logical Name

WAIT_UPLINK_ACCESS

Definition

Maximum number of repetitions for the UPLINK FREE message


(with the Uplink Access Request bit set to L) per cycle, during the
non-initial part of the uplink access procedure (i.e. after sending the
first UPLINK FREE message with the Uplink Access Request bit set
to H).Each time the value of this counter becomes zero, the BTS
send one UPLINK FREE message with the Uplink Access Request
bit set to H.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

32

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

The parameter is significant only if EN_UPLINK_REPLY is set to true.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

38 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

39 / 1182

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.1 Network (CDE)


3.1.1 (CONFIDENCE_ORIGIN) - (CONFIDENCE_ORIGIN)
Parameter Name

HMI Name

CONFIDENCE_ORIGIN

Logical Name

CONFIDENCE_ORIGIN

Definition

Confidence origin used in the 3D linear regression of the confidence


of the ellipsoid arc returned by the MFS when providing the reference
location to the A-GPS server.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

50.7

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

40 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.1.2 (CONFIDENCE_VS_ARC_FACTOR_SLOPE) (CONFIDENCE_VS_ARC_FACTOR_SLOPE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CONFIDENCE_VS_ARC_FACTOR_SLOPE

Logical Name

CONFIDENCE_VS_ARC_FACTOR_SLOPE

Definition

Slope ratio between the confidence and the arc factor used in the 3D
linear regression of the confidence of the ellipsoid arc returned by
the MFS when providing the reference location to the A-GPS server.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

25

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

41 / 1182

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.1.3 (CONFIDENCE_VS_RADIUS_SLOPE) (CONFIDENCE_VS_RADIUS_SLOPE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CONFIDENCE_VS_RADIUS_SLOPE

Logical Name

CONFIDENCE_VS_RADIUS_SLOPE

Definition

Slope ratio between the confidence and the sum of minimum radius
factor and maximum radius factor used in the 3D linear regression
of the confidence of the ellipsoid arc returned by the MFS when
providing the reference location to the A-GPS server.

Coding rules

step size = 0.01

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

15.28

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

42 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.1.4 (MS_BASED_AGPS_ASSIST_DATA_LIST) (MS_BASED_AGPS_ASSIST_DATA_LIST)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MS_BASED_AGPS_ASSIST_DATA_LIST

Logical Name

MS_BASED_AGPS_ASSIST_DATA_LIST

Definition

Bitmap (8 bits) defining the types of optional assistance data to be


retrieved from the A-GPS server when using the MS based A-GPS
positioning method. The following optional assistance data type are
considered: Almanac, UTC model, DGPS corrections, reference
time, acquisition assistance, real-time integrity.

Coding rules

bit 8 (most significant) and bit 7 are not used (i.e. always set to 0); bit
6=1: real-time integrity is retrieived; bit 5=1: acquisition assistance
is retrieived; bit 4=1: reference time is retrieived; bit 3=1: DGPS
corrections is retrieived; bit 2=1: UTC model is retrieived; bit 1 (least
significant)=1: Almanac is retrieived.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

63

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

43 / 1182

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.1.5 (PREF_GPS_LIST_Priority_1) - (PREF_GPS_LIST_Priority_1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PREF_GPS_LIST_Priority_1

Logical Name

PREF_GPS_LIST_Priority_1

Definition

The most preferred GPS positioning method.

Coding rules

It contains a reference to a GPS method: 1 for MS Assisted A-GPS,


2 for MS Based A-GPS, 3 for Conventional GPS.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

The same GPS methods reference should not be used for different
priorities

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

44 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.1.6 (PREF_GPS_LIST_Priority_2) - (PREF_GPS_LIST_Priority_2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PREF_GPS_LIST_Priority_2

Logical Name

PREF_GPS_LIST_Priority_2

Definition

The second preferred GPS positioning method.

Coding rules

It contains a reference to a GPS method: 1 for MS Assisted A-GPS,


2 for MS Based A-GPS, 3 for Conventional GPS.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

The same GPS methods reference should not be used for different
priorities.

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

45 / 1182

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.1.7 (PREF_GPS_LIST_Priority_3) - (PREF_GPS_LIST_Priority_3)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PREF_GPS_LIST_Priority_3

Logical Name

PREF_GPS_LIST_Priority_3

Definition

The third preferred GPS positioning method.

Coding rules

It contains a reference to a GPS method: 1 for MS Assisted A-GPS,


2 for MS Based A-GPS, 3 for Conventional GPS.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

The same GPS methods reference should not be used for different
priorities.

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

46 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.1.8 (SAGI_TCP_DATA_TIMEOUT) - (SAGI_TCP_DATA_TIMEOUT)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

SAGI_TCP_DATA_TIMEOUT

Logical Name

SAGI_TCP_DATA_TIMEOUT

Definition

Parameter used in the context of supervision of SAGI based on


TCP keep alive mechanism. This timer controls the retransmission
timeout for the sending of the individual data segments.

Coding rules

step size = 1 second

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

47 / 1182

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.1.9 (SAGI_TCP_KEEP_ALIVE_INTERVAL) (SAGI_TCP_KEEP_ALIVE_INTERVAL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

SAGI_TCP_KEEP_ALIVE_INTERVAL

Logical Name

SAGI_TCP_KEEP_ALIVE_INTERVAL

Definition

Parameter used in the context of supervision of SAGI based on TCP


keep alive mechanism. This timer determines the interval separating
keep alive retransmissions until a response is received. Once a
response is received, the delay until the next keep alive transmission
is again controlled by the value of this timer. The connection
will be aborted after the number of retransmissions specified by
SAGI_TCP_MAX_DATA_RETRANS have gone unanswered.

Coding rules

step size = 1 second

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

48 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.1.10 (SAGI_TCP_MAX_DATA_RETRANS) (SAGI_TCP_MAX_DATA_RETRANS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

SAGI_TCP_MAX_DATA_RETRANS

Logical Name

SAGI_TCP_MAX_DATA_RETRANS

Definition

Parameter used in the context of supervision of SAGI based on TCP


keep alive mechanism. This parameter controls the number of times
TCP will retransmit an individual data segment before aborting the
connection. The retransmission timeout is given by the parameter
SAGI_TCP_DATA_TIMEOUT.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

49 / 1182

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.1.11 (T_SAGI_GUARD) - (T_SAGI_GUARD)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_SAGI_GUARD

Logical Name

T_SAGI_GUARD

Definition

Timer to guard the response from the A-GPS server (on SAGI:
interface with A-GPS server).

Coding rules

step size = 1 sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

300

60

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

The timer is meaningful in the MFS when EN_SAGI=1.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

50 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2 Site (CAE)


3.2.1 (ARC_SIZE_FACTOR) - (ARC_SIZE_FACTOR)
Parameter Name

HMI Name

ARC_SIZE_FACTOR

Logical Name

ARC_SIZE_FACTOR

Definition

Factor used in the computation of the width in degree of the ellipsoid


arc returned by the MFS when computing location estimate based on
TA positionning method.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

1.5

1.2

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

51 / 1182

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.2 (AZIMUTH) - (LCS_AZIMUTH)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AZIMUTH

Logical Name

LCS_AZIMUTH

Definition

Antenna direction orientation for the sector supporting the cell (used
by the MFS to compute location estimate based on TA positionning
method).

Coding rules

0: 0 degree,, 359: 359 degree, 360: omnidirectional cell

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

360

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit cell / LCS

External Comment

0 corresponds to the North orientation and is counted clockwise.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

52 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.3 (EN_CONV_GPS) - (EN_CONV_GPS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_CONV_GPS

Logical Name

EN_CONV_GPS

Definition

Flag to enable or disable the positioning method Conventional GPS.

Coding rules

0 = disabled; 1 = enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit cell / LCS

External Comment

The activation of this positioning method is meaningful when


EN_LCS=1.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

53 / 1182

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.4 (EN_LCS) - (EN_LCS (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_LCS

Logical Name

EN_LCS (BSC)

Definition

Enables/Disables the Location Services (LCS) in the BSS.

Coding rules

0 = disabled; 1 = enabled

Mandatory rules

Equal to EN_LCS (MFS)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / LCS

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

54 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.5 (EN_LCS) - (EN_LCS (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_LCS

Logical Name

EN_LCS (MFS)

Definition

Enables/Disables the Location Services (LCS) in the BSS.

Coding rules

0 = disabled; 1 = enabled

Mandatory rules

Equal to EN_LCS (BSC)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / LCS

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

55 / 1182

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.6 (EN_MS_ASSISTED_AGPS) - (EN_MS_ASSISTED_AGPS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_MS_ASSISTED_AGPS

Logical Name

EN_MS_ASSISTED_AGPS

Definition

Flag to enable or disable the positioning method MS Assisted A-GPS.

Coding rules

0 = disabled; 1 = enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit cell / LCS

External Comment

The activation of this positioning method is meaningful when


EN_LCS=1.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

56 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.7 (EN_MS_BASED_AGPS) - (EN_MS_BASED_AGPS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_MS_BASED_AGPS

Logical Name

EN_MS_BASED_AGPS

Definition

Flag to enable or disable the positioning method MS Based A-GPS.

Coding rules

0 = disabled; 1 = enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / LCS

External Comment

The activation of this positioning method is meaningful when


EN_LCS=1.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

57 / 1182

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.8 (EN_SAGI) - (EN_SAGI)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_SAGI

Logical Name

EN_SAGI

Definition

Flag indicating whether SAGI (interface with the A-GPS server) is


configured or not for this BSS.

Coding rules

0: disabled; 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: ?

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / LCS

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

58 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.9 (Geographical Coordinates) (GEOGRAPHICAL_COORDINATES_FLAG)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Geographical Coordinates

Logical Name

GEOGRAPHICAL_COORDINATES_FLAG

Definition

Indicates whether latitude and longitude are significant or not.

Coding rules

0: not significant, 1: significant

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / LCS

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

59 / 1182

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.10 (HALFPWR_BEAM_WIDTH) - (HALFPWR_BEAM_WIDTH)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

HALFPWR_BEAM_WIDTH

Logical Name

HALFPWR_BEAM_WIDTH

Definition

Antenna half power beam for the sector supporting the cell (used by
the MFS to compute location estimate based on TA positionning
method).

Coding rules

0: half power beam width unknown, 1: 1 degree,, 360: 360 degree


(omnidirectional cell)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

360

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit cell / LCS

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

60 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.11 (LATITUDE) - (LCS_LATITUDE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

LATITUDE

Logical Name

LCS_LATITUDE

Definition

Latitude of the BTS supporting the cell (used by the MFS to compute
location estimate based on TA positionning method).

Coding rules

Sequence of:- number of degrees (from 0 to 90)- number of minutes


(from 0 to 59)- number of fractional minutes (from 0 to 9999)direction (boolean, true for South and false for North)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

List of numbers

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

None

0,0,0,false

90,59,9999,true #

Default

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / LCS

External Comment

1) 0 latitude corresponds to the Equator; 2) The coding for OMC-R


HMI is described in the "BSS O&M Parameters" document,
parameter "LCS-Latitude".

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

61 / 1182

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.12 (LONGITUDE) - (LCS_LONGITUDE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

LONGITUDE

Logical Name

LCS_LONGITUDE

Definition

Longitude of the BTS supporting the cell (used by the MFS to


compute location estimate based on TA positionning method).

Coding rules

Sequence of:- number of degrees (from 0 to 180)- number of minutes


(from 0 to 59)- number of fractional minutes (from 0 to 9999)direction (boolean, true for West and false for East)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

List of numbers

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

None

0,0,0,false

180,59,9999,true #

Default

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / LCS

External Comment

1) 0 longitude corresponds to the Greenwich Meridian;2) The


coding for OMC-R HMI is described in the "BSS O&M Parameters"
document, parameter "LCS-Longitude".

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

62 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.13 (MAX_RADIUS_FACTOR) - (MAX_RADIUS_FACTOR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MAX_RADIUS_FACTOR

Logical Name

MAX_RADIUS_FACTOR

Definition

Factor used in the computation of the maximum radius of the ellipsoid


arc returned by the MFS when computing location estimate based on
TA positionning method.

Coding rules

step size = 0.05

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.5

0.6

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

63 / 1182

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.14 (MIN_RADIUS_FACTOR) - (MIN_RADIUS_FACTOR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MIN_RADIUS_FACTOR

Logical Name

MIN_RADIUS_FACTOR

Definition

Factor used in the computation of the minimum radius of the ellipsoid


arc returned by the MFS when computing location estimate based on
TA positionning method.

Coding rules

step size = 0.05

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.5

0.85

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

64 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.15 (T_LCS_Delay_Tolerant) - (T_LCS_Delay_Tolerant)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_LCS_Delay_Tolerant

Logical Name

T_LCS_Delay_Tolerant

Definition

SMLC timer to guard the calculation of the MS position (including the


RRLP message exchange with the target MS) in case of a Delay
Tolerant Location Request.

Coding rules

step size = 1 sec

Mandatory rules

T_Location + T_Location_Longer > T_LCS_Delay_Tolerant >=


T_LCS_Low_Delay

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

300

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSS / LCS

External Comment

The timer is meaningful in the MFS when EN_LCS=1.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

65 / 1182

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.16 (T_LCS_Low_Delay) - (T_LCS_Low_Delay)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_LCS_Low_Delay

Logical Name

T_LCS_Low_Delay

Definition

SMLC timer to guard the calculation of the MS position (including


the RRLP message exchange with the target MS) in case of a Low
Delay Location Request.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 sec

Mandatory rules

T_Location + T_Location_Longer > T_LCS_Delay_Tolerant >=


T_LCS_Low_Delay

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.1

180

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSS / LCS

External Comment

The timer is meaningful in the MFS when EN_LCS=1.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

66 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.17 (T_Loc_abort) - (T_Loc_abort)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_Loc_abort

Logical Name

T_Loc_abort

Definition

BSC timer supervising the response from the SMLC in case of


Location Abort.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

T_Loc_abort < T_Location

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

30

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / LCS

External Comment

The timer is meaningful in the BSC when EN_LCS=1.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

67 / 1182

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.18 (T_Location) - (T_Location)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_Location

Logical Name

T_Location

Definition

BSC timer, on a per call basis, supervising the response from the
SMLC in case of Location request, when no RRLP exchange is
triggered with the MS.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 sec

Mandatory rules

T_Location + T_Location_Longer > T_LCS_Delay_Tolerant >=


T_LCS_Low_Delay

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

300

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / LCS

External Comment

The timer is meaningful in the BSC when EN_LCS=1.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

68 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.19 (T_Location_Longer) - (T_Location_Longer)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_Location_Longer

Logical Name

T_Location_Longer

Definition

BSC timer, on a per call basis, supervising the response from the
SMLC in case of Location request, when a RRLP exchange is
triggered with the MS.

Coding rules

step size = 1 sec

Mandatory rules

T_Location + T_Location_Longer > T_LCS_Delay_Tolerant >=


T_LCS_Low_Delay

Recommended rules

T_Location_Longer > T_Location

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

300

30

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / LCS

External Comment

The timer is meaningful in the BSC when EN_LCS=1, and replaces


T_Location timer in case of Conventional GPS, MS Assisted A-GPS
and MS Based A-GPS positioning methods.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

69 / 1182

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.20 (T_RRLP_Delay_Tolerant) - (T_RRLP_Delay_Tolerant)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_RRLP_Delay_Tolerant

Logical Name

T_RRLP_Delay_Tolerant

Definition

SMLC timer to guard the RRLP message exchange between the


SMLC and the target MS, in case of a Delay Tolerant Location
Request.

Coding rules

step size = 1 sec

Mandatory rules

T_LCS_Delay_Tolerant >
T_RRLP_Delay_TolerantT_RRLP_Delay_Tolerant >=
T_RRLP_Low_Delay

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

300

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSS / LCS

External Comment

The timer is meaningful in the MFS when EN_LCS=1.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

70 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

3.2.21 (T_RRLP_Low_Delay) - (T_RRLP_Low_Delay)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_RRLP_Low_Delay

Logical Name

T_RRLP_Low_Delay

Definition

SMLC timer to guard the RRLP message exchange between the


SMLC and the target MS, in case of a Low Delay Location Request.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 sec

Mandatory rules

T_Low_Delay > T_RRLP_Low_DelayT_RRLP_Delay_Tolerant >=


T_RRLP_Low_Delay

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.1

120

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / LCS

External Comment

The timer is meaningful in the MFS when EN_LCS=1.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

71 / 1182

3 LCS Telecom Parameters

72 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

73 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1 Network (CDE)


4.1.1 (ADDR_MON) - (ADDR_MON)
Parameter Name

HMI Name

ADDR_MON

Logical Name

ADDR_MON

Definition

Time it takes to ADDR_TR to be reached to report an alarm. On


timeout, the address error counter is reset.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

6553.5

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

74 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.2 (ADDR_TR) - (ADDR_TR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

ADDR_TR

Logical Name

ADDR_TR

Definition

Address error threshold for alarm detection.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

60

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

75 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.3 (Autocleaning_Timer) - (T_AUTOCLEANING_MEAS_REP)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Autocleaning_Timer

Logical Name

T_AUTOCLEANING_MEAS_REP

Definition

Guard time for detection of SDCCH/TCH autocleaning procedure.

Coding rules

step size = 1 sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

In micro cells, it is recommended to set N_BAD_SACCH so that


T_AUTOCLEANING_MEAS_REP > N_BAD_SACCH * 480ms + 30
seconds if T_AUTOCLEANING_MEAS_REP <> 0.

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

255

40

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / General timers and procedures

External Comment

T_AUTOCLEANING_MEAS_REP = 0 inhibits the autocleaning


procedure.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

76 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.4 (BF_HI_RX) - (BF_HI_RX)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BF_HI_RX

Logical Name

BF_HI_RX

Definition

Threshold on LAPD RX buffers occupancy for transition from normal


to busy condition.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

BF_HI_RX > BF_LO_RX

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

80

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

77 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.5 (BF_HI_TX) - (BF_HI_TX)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BF_HI_TX

Logical Name

BF_HI_TX

Definition

Threshold on LAPD TX buffers occupancy for transition from normal


to busy condition.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

BF_HI_TX > BF_LO_TX

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

30

16

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

78 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.6 (BF_LO_RX) - (BF_LO_RX)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BF_LO_RX

Logical Name

BF_LO_RX

Definition

Threshold on LAPD RX buffers occupancy for transition from busy


to normal condition.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

BF_LO_RX < BF_HI_RX

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

70

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

79 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.7 (BF_LO_TX) - (BF_LO_TX)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BF_LO_TX

Logical Name

BF_LO_TX

Definition

Threshold on LAPD TX buffers occupancy for transition from busy


to normal condition.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

BF_LO_TX < BF_HI_TX

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

30

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

80 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.8 (CGI_REQUIRED) - (CGI_REQD)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CGI_REQUIRED

Logical Name

CGI_REQD

Definition

Controls format of cell identifications sent to the MSC.

Coding rules

0: CGI not used, 1: CGI used

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Alcatel recommend to set the CGI_REQD parameter to 1 provided


that the MSC supports the CGI format. The CGI_REQD parameter
shall be set to 1 if the operator wants to allow inter-PLMN 2G
to 2G handovers. If this parameter needs to be changed, it is
recommended to change it during a migration phase to avoid any
additional Telecom outage.

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment

Depends on MSC Type. The value indicated here is for


implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

81 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.9 (COUNT_DECR) - (COUNT_DECR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

COUNT_DECR

Logical Name

COUNT_DECR

Definition

Stepsize by which the leaky bucket counter used during the reaction
to TCU overload is decremented upon T_COUNT_I expiry.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

82 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.10 (COUNT_I_THRESHOLD) - (COUNT_I_THRESHOLD)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

COUNT_I_THRESHOLD

Logical Name

COUNT_I_THRESHOLD

Definition

Leaky bucket counter threshold used to trigger defense actions upon


TCU overload.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

50

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

83 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.11 (COUNT_INCR_1) - (COUNT_INCR_1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

COUNT_INCR_1

Logical Name

COUNT_INCR_1

Definition

Stepsize by which the leaky bucket counter used during the reaction
to TCU overload is incremented upon TCU overload level 1.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

COUNT_INCR_1 <= COUNT_INCR_2

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

84 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.12 (COUNT_INCR_2) - (COUNT_INCR_2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

COUNT_INCR_2

Logical Name

COUNT_INCR_2

Definition

Stepsize by which the leaky bucket counter used during the reaction
to TCU overload is incremented upon TCU overload level 2.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

COUNT_INCR_2 >= COUNT_INCR_1

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

85 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.13 (CRC_MON) - (CRC_MON)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CRC_MON

Logical Name

CRC_MON

Definition

Time in which CRC_TR is to be reached to report an alarm. On


timeout, the CRC error counter is reset.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

25.5

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

86 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.14 (CRC_TR) - (CRC_TR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CRC_TR

Logical Name

CRC_TR

Definition

CRC error threshold for alarm detection.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

50

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

87 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.15 (EGSM_RR_ALLOC_STRATEGY) (EGSM_RR_ALLOC_STRATEGY)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EGSM_RR_ALLOC_STRATEGY

Logical Name

EGSM_RR_ALLOC_STRATEGY

Definition

Defines if the G1 non-capable MS is supported or not in the network.

Coding rules

0: G1 non-capable MS-s are only supported in the cells where the


BCCH is not configured on the G1 band (i.e. BCCH is configured on
PGSM band or on DCS1800 band) .1: G1 non-capable MS-s are
not supported in any cell that contains at least one G1 TRX of the
network (Note these MS-s are still supported in other cells).

Mandatory rules

When EGSM_RR_ALLOC_STRATEGY is set to "0", if the BCCH is


not configured on the G1 band (i.e. BCCH is configured on PGSM
band or on DCS1800 band), then:1) the OMC-R does not allow the
operator to define the CCCH, SDCCH and CBCH on a G1 TRX.2)
TRX_PREF_MARK must be <> 0 for a hopping G1 TRX .

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

88 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.16 (EN_FR_IF_HR_PREF) - (EN_FR_IF_HR_PREF)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_FR_IF_HR_PREF

Logical Name

EN_FR_IF_HR_PREF

Definition

When set, this flag allows, when bugged MS asking for a "dual rate,
half-rate preferred", to allocate a full rate channel.

Coding rules

0 : function disabled, 1 : function enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

89 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.17 (I_TX_LAPD) - (I_TX_LAPD)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

I_TX_LAPD

Logical Name

I_TX_LAPD

Definition

Maximum LAPD transmission queue length.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

204

105

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

90 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.18 (LB_DECR) - (LB_DECR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

LB_DECR

Logical Name

LB_DECR

Definition

Stepsize by which a leaky bucket overload counter in the BSC is


decremented on T_LB_OV expiry.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

91 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.19 (LB_INCR) - (LB_INCR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

LB_INCR

Logical Name

LB_INCR

Definition

Stepsize by which a leaky bucket overload counter in the BSC is


incremented each time an OVERLOAD is received from the FU.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

92 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.20 (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [1]) - (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [1])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [1]

Logical Name

MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [1]

Definition

Percentage of MEASUREMENT RESULT messages discarded by


the TCU at step I.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

93 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.21 (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [10]) - (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i


[10])
Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [10]

Logical Name

MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [10]

Definition

Percentage of MEASUREMENT RESULT messages discarded by


the TCU at step I.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

94 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.22 (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [2]) - (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [2])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [2]

Logical Name

MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [2]

Definition

Percentage of MEASUREMENT RESULT messages discarded by


the TCU at step I.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

95 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.23 (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [3]) - (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [3])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [3]

Logical Name

MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [3]

Definition

Percentage of MEASUREMENT RESULT messages discarded by


the TCU at step I.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

30

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

96 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.24 (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [4]) - (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [4])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [4]

Logical Name

MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [4]

Definition

Percentage of MEASUREMENT RESULT messages discarded by


the TCU at step I.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

40

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

97 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.25 (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [5]) - (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [5])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [5]

Logical Name

MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [5]

Definition

Percentage of MEASUREMENT RESULT messages discarded by


the TCU at step I.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

98 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.26 (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [6]) - (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [6])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [6]

Logical Name

MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [6]

Definition

Percentage of MEASUREMENT RESULT messages discarded by


the TCU at step I.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

99 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.27 (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [7]) - (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [7])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [7]

Logical Name

MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [7]

Definition

Percentage of MEASUREMENT RESULT messages discarded by


the TCU at step I.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

100 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.28 (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [8]) - (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [8])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [8]

Logical Name

MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [8]

Definition

Percentage of MEASUREMENT RESULT messages discarded by


the TCU at step I.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

101 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.29 (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [9]) - (MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [9])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [9]

Logical Name

MEAS_RES_DISCARDED_i [9]

Definition

Percentage of MEASUREMENT RESULT messages discarded by


the TCU at step I.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

102 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.30 (NBLK) - (NBLK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NBLK

Logical Name

NBLK

Definition

Maximum number of BLOCK messages that can be sent if the ACK


from the MSC is not received.

Coding rules

255: infinite transmission

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

103 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.31 (NBR_STEPS_OVRL_1) - (NBR_STEPS_OVRL_1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NBR_STEPS_OVRL_1

Logical Name

NBR_STEPS_OVRL_1

Definition

Number of steps needed to reduce the load upon TCU overload


level 1.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

NBR_STEPS_OVRL_1 <= NBR_STEPS_OVRL_2

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

104 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.32 (NBR_STEPS_OVRL_2) - (NBR_STEPS_OVRL_2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NBR_STEPS_OVRL_2

Logical Name

NBR_STEPS_OVRL_2

Definition

Number of steps to reduce the load upon TCU overload level 2.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

NBR_STEPS_OVRL_2 >= NBR_STEPS_OVRL_1

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

105 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.33 (NUBLK) - (NUBLK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NUBLK

Logical Name

NUBLK

Definition

Maximum number of UNBLOCK messages that are sent if the ACK


from the MSC is not received.

Coding rules

255: infinite transmission

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

106 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.34 (PROT_MON) - (PROT_MON)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PROT_MON

Logical Name

PROT_MON

Definition

Time in which PROT_TH is to be reached to report an alarm. On


timeout, the protocol error counter is reset.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

6553.5

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

107 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.35 (PROT_TH) - (PROT_TH)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PROT_TH

Logical Name

PROT_TH

Definition

Protocol error threshold for alarm detection.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

108 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.36 (SDCCH_AVG_PERIOD) - (SDCCH_AVG_PERIOD)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

SDCCH_AVG_PERIOD

Logical Name

SDCCH_AVG_PERIOD

Definition

Period used to average the processor occupancy measurements.

Coding rules

8 bits, step size=1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

16

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

109 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.37 (SDCCH_HIGH_DELAY) - (SDCCH_HIGH_DELAY)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

SDCCH_HIGH_DELAY

Logical Name

SDCCH_HIGH_DELAY

Definition

Delay added to SDCCH internal release when TCU processor load


is high.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

110 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.38 (SDCCH_LOW_DELAY) - (SDCCH_LOW_DELAY)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

SDCCH_LOW_DELAY

Logical Name

SDCCH_LOW_DELAY

Definition

Delay added to SDCCH internal release when TCU processor load is


low.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

111 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.39 (SMS_INHIBIT) - (SMS_INHIBIT)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

SMS_INHIBIT

Logical Name

SMS_INHIBIT

Definition

This flag enables/disables SMS support.

Coding rules

0: SMS permitted, 1: SMS inhibited

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

112 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.40 (SSF) - (SSF)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

SSF

Logical Name

SSF

Definition

This parameter inditifies the numbering plan of the Signalling Point


Code.

Coding rules

coded over 4 bits.only values 0, 4, 8 and 12 are defined : Value =


0, international network; Value = 4, Spare, reserved for international
use; Value = 8, National network; Value = 12 , Reserved for national
use

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

12

12

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

SSF (Sub-Service Field) is composed of 4 bits: 2bits for Network


Indicator and 2 spare bits.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

113 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.41 (T_BTS_EST_CNF) - (T_BTS_EST_CNF)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_BTS_EST_CNF

Logical Name

T_BTS_EST_CNF

Definition

Supervision of the SAPI 3 Establishment procedure.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

6553.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

114 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.42 (T_BTS_RLS_CNF) - (T_BTS_RLS_CNF)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_BTS_RLS_CNF

Logical Name

T_BTS_RLS_CNF

Definition

Supervision of the SAPI 3 Release procedure.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

6553.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

115 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.43 (T_CBC_READY) - (T_CBC_READY)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_CBC_READY

Logical Name

T_CBC_READY

Definition

Defines the maximum period during which the BSC tries to connect
to the CBC before issueing an alarm or returning CMD-MODE Resp.

Coding rules

step size: 1 sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

T_CBC_READY > 8 * T_CONNECT

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

10

600

300

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

116 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.44 (T_COUNT_I) - (T_COUNT_I)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_COUNT_I

Logical Name

T_COUNT_I

Definition

Supervision of the leaky bucket counter used during the reaction to


TCU overload.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

50

12

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

117 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.45 (T_i) - (T_i)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_i

Logical Name

T_i

Definition

Duration of SSP or SPI condition that triggers an Internal Reset


procedure.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

120

22

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

118 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.46 (T_LB_OV) - (T_LB_OV)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_LB_OV

Logical Name

T_LB_OV

Definition

Supervision of the leaky bucket counter used during the reaction


to FU overload.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.1

25.5

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

119 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.47 (T_OVL_MSC) - (T_OVL_MSC)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_OVL_MSC

Logical Name

T_OVL_MSC

Definition

Minimum delay between two consecutive OVERLOAD messages


sent to the MSC.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.1

6553.5

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

120 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.48 (T_RCR_ACK) - (T_RCR_ACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_RCR_ACK

Logical Name

T_RCR_ACK

Definition

Supervision of the RF Channel Release procedure.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

6553.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

121 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.49 (T_SMSCB_RESP) - (T_SMSCB_RESP)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_SMSCB_RESP

Logical Name

T_SMSCB_RESP

Definition

Maximum waiting time to get a response from the BTS to a primitive.

Coding rules

step size = 1 sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

122 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.50 (T_WAIT_DTM_TCH_REL) - (T_WAIT_DTM_TCH_REL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_WAIT_DTM_TCH_REL

Logical Name

T_WAIT_DTM_TCH_REL

Definition

This timer defines the time that, upon reception of a BSCGP BSC
Shared DTM Information Indication message indicating that the TCH
resource allocated to a DTM capable MS is being released at the
BSC side, the MFS shall wait before releasing the TCH resource
in its turn.

Coding rules

step size = 100 ms, coded from 0 to 50

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

5000

1000

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

The value "0" indicates that, upon reception of a BSCGP BSC


Shared DTM Information Indication message, the MFS shall release
immediately the related TCH resource

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

123 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.51 (T1_0858) - (T1_0858)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T1_0858

Logical Name

T1_0858

Definition

Delay during which, after reception of an OVERLOAD from the BTS,


a new OVERLOAD is ignored.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

T1_0858 < T2_0858

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

6553.5

30

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

124 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.52 (T2_0858) - (T2_0858)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T2_0858

Logical Name

T2_0858

Definition

Minimum delay between debarring of an access class, in the case


where the BTS stops sending OVERLOAD.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

T2_0858 > T1_0858

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

6553.5

50

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

125 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.53 (T9101) - (T9101)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T9101

Logical Name

T9101

Definition

Supervision of the SCCP connection release procedure.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

6553.5

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

126 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.54 (T9103) - (T9103)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T9103

Logical Name

T9103

Definition

Supervision of the Channel Activation procedure.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

6553.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

127 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.55 (T9108) - (T9108)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T9108

Logical Name

T9108

Definition

Supervision of the Physical Context procedure.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

6553.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

128 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.56 (T9110) - (T9110)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T9110

Logical Name

T9110

Definition

Guards the response of the MSC when no resources are


allocated to the SCCP connection (started on the reception
of CONN_IND(SCCP_CON_REQ) not carrying a HANDOVER
REQUEST message and stopped when a HANDOVER REQUEST
message is received on the same SCCP connection as the
SCCP_CON_REQ message). Guards also the response of the MSC
when a HANDOVER FAILURE or ASSIGNMENT FAILURE message
has been sent (stopped when a HANDOVER REQUEST or CLEAR
COMMAND message is received).

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

T9110 << max [T(ias), T(iar)].

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

6553.5

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

129 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.57 (TCH_INFO_PERIOD) - (TCH_INFO_PERIOD)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TCH_INFO_PERIOD

Logical Name

TCH_INFO_PERIOD

Definition

Periodicity of TCH usage information update in the BSC.

Coding rules

stepsize = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

25.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: Displayed RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / HO Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

130 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.58 (THR_LB_OV) - (THR_LB_OV)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THR_LB_OV

Logical Name

THR_LB_OV

Definition

Counter threshold for triggering global defence actions in the BSC


upon FU overload.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

50

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

131 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.59 (THRESHOLD_1_0) - (THRESHOLD_1_0)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THRESHOLD_1_0

Logical Name

THRESHOLD_1_0

Definition

Free buffer thresholds separating "no overload" condition and


"overload level 1" condition when pointer P points at position 0.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

THRESHOLD_1_0 >= THRESHOLD_2_0

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

25

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

132 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.60 (THRESHOLD_1_1) - (THRESHOLD_1_1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THRESHOLD_1_1

Logical Name

THRESHOLD_1_1

Definition

Free buffer thresholds separating "no overload" condition and


"overload level 1" condition when pointer P points at position 1.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

THRESHOLD_1_1 >= THRESHOLD_2_1

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

28

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

133 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.61 (THRESHOLD_1_10) - (THRESHOLD_1_10)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THRESHOLD_1_10

Logical Name

THRESHOLD_1_10

Definition

Free buffer thresholds separating "no overload" condition and


"overload level 1" condition when pointer P points at position 10.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

THRESHOLD_1_10 >= THRESHOLD_2_10

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

55

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

134 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.62 (THRESHOLD_1_2) - (THRESHOLD_1_2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THRESHOLD_1_2

Logical Name

THRESHOLD_1_2

Definition

Free buffer thresholds separating "no overload" condition and


"overload level 1" condition when pointer P points at position 2.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

THRESHOLD_1_2 >= THRESHOLD_2_2

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

31

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

135 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.63 (THRESHOLD_1_3) - (THRESHOLD_1_3)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THRESHOLD_1_3

Logical Name

THRESHOLD_1_3

Definition

Free buffer thresholds separating "no overload" condition and


"overload level 1" condition when pointer P points at position 3.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

THRESHOLD_1_3 >= THRESHOLD_2_3

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

34

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

136 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.64 (THRESHOLD_1_4) - (THRESHOLD_1_4)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THRESHOLD_1_4

Logical Name

THRESHOLD_1_4

Definition

Free buffer thresholds separating "no overload" condition and


"overload level 1" condition when pointer P points at position 4.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

THRESHOLD_1_4 >= THRESHOLD_2_4

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

37

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

137 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.65 (THRESHOLD_1_5) - (THRESHOLD_1_5)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THRESHOLD_1_5

Logical Name

THRESHOLD_1_5

Definition

Free buffer thresholds separating "no overload" condition and


"overload level 1" condition when pointer P points at position 5.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

THRESHOLD_1_5 >= THRESHOLD_2_5

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

40

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

138 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.66 (THRESHOLD_1_6) - (THRESHOLD_1_6)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THRESHOLD_1_6

Logical Name

THRESHOLD_1_6

Definition

Free buffer thresholds separating "no overload" condition and


"overload level 1" condition when pointer P points at position 6.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

THRESHOLD_1_6 >= THRESHOLD_2_6

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

43

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

139 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.67 (THRESHOLD_1_7) - (THRESHOLD_1_7)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THRESHOLD_1_7

Logical Name

THRESHOLD_1_7

Definition

Free buffer thresholds separating "no overload" condition and


"overload level 1" condition when pointer P points at position 7.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

THRESHOLD_1_7 >= THRESHOLD_2_7

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

46

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

140 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.68 (THRESHOLD_1_8) - (THRESHOLD_1_8)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THRESHOLD_1_8

Logical Name

THRESHOLD_1_8

Definition

Free buffer thresholds separating "no overload" condition and


"overload level 1" condition when pointer P points at position 8.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

THRESHOLD_1_8 >= THRESHOLD_2_8

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

49

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

141 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.69 (THRESHOLD_1_9) - (THRESHOLD_1_9)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THRESHOLD_1_9

Logical Name

THRESHOLD_1_9

Definition

Free buffer thresholds separating "no overload" condition and


"overload level 1" condition when pointer P points at position 9.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

THRESHOLD_1_9 >= THRESHOLD_2_9

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

52

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

142 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.70 (THRESHOLD_2_0) - (THRESHOLD_2_0)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THRESHOLD_2_0

Logical Name

THRESHOLD_2_0

Definition

Free buffer thresholds separating "overload level 1" condition and


"overload level 2" condition when pointer P points at position 0.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

THRESHOLD_2_0 <= THRESHOLD_1_0

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

22

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

143 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.71 (THRESHOLD_2_1) - (THRESHOLD_2_1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THRESHOLD_2_1

Logical Name

THRESHOLD_2_1

Definition

Free buffer thresholds separating "overload level 1" condition and


"overload level 2" condition when pointer P points at position 1.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

THRESHOLD_2_1 <= THRESHOLD_1_1

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

25

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

144 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.72 (THRESHOLD_2_10) - (THRESHOLD_2_10)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THRESHOLD_2_10

Logical Name

THRESHOLD_2_10

Definition

Free buffer thresholds separating "overload level 1" condition and


"overload level 2" condition when pointer P points at position 10.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

THRESHOLD_2_10 <= THRESHOLD_1_10

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

52

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

145 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.73 (THRESHOLD_2_2) - (THRESHOLD_2_2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THRESHOLD_2_2

Logical Name

THRESHOLD_2_2

Definition

Free buffer thresholds separating "overload level 1" condition and


"overload level 2" condition when pointer P points at position 2.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

THRESHOLD_2_2 <= THRESHOLD_1_2

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

28

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

146 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.74 (THRESHOLD_2_3) - (THRESHOLD_2_3)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THRESHOLD_2_3

Logical Name

THRESHOLD_2_3

Definition

Free buffer thresholds separating "overload level 1" condition and


"overload level 2" condition when pointer P points at position 3.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

THRESHOLD_2_3 <= THRESHOLD_1_3

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

31

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

147 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.75 (THRESHOLD_2_4) - (THRESHOLD_2_4)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THRESHOLD_2_4

Logical Name

THRESHOLD_2_4

Definition

Free buffer thresholds separating "overload level 1" condition and


"overload level 2" condition when pointer P points at position 4.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

THRESHOLD_2_4 <= THRESHOLD_1_4

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

34

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

148 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.76 (THRESHOLD_2_5) - (THRESHOLD_2_5)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THRESHOLD_2_5

Logical Name

THRESHOLD_2_5

Definition

Free buffer thresholds separating "overload level 1" condition and


"overload level 2" condition when pointer P points at position 5.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

THRESHOLD_2_5 <= THRESHOLD_1_5

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

37

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

149 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.77 (THRESHOLD_2_6) - (THRESHOLD_2_6)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THRESHOLD_2_6

Logical Name

THRESHOLD_2_6

Definition

Free buffer thresholds separating "overload level 1" condition and


"overload level 2" condition when pointer P points at position 6.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

THRESHOLD_2_6 <= THRESHOLD_1_6

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

40

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

150 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.78 (THRESHOLD_2_7) - (THRESHOLD_2_7)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THRESHOLD_2_7

Logical Name

THRESHOLD_2_7

Definition

Free buffer thresholds separating "overload level 1" condition and


"overload level 2" condition when pointer P points at position 7.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

THRESHOLD_2_7 <= THRESHOLD_1_7

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

43

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

151 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.79 (THRESHOLD_2_8) - (THRESHOLD_2_8)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THRESHOLD_2_8

Logical Name

THRESHOLD_2_8

Definition

Free buffer thresholds separating "overload level 1" condition and


"overload level 2" condition when pointer P points at position 8.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

THRESHOLD_2_8 <= THRESHOLD_1_8

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

46

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

152 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.80 (THRESHOLD_2_9) - (THRESHOLD_2_9)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THRESHOLD_2_9

Logical Name

THRESHOLD_2_9

Definition

Free buffer thresholds separating "overload level 1" condition and


"overload level 2" condition when pointer P points at position 9.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

THRESHOLD_2_9 <= THRESHOLD_1_9

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

49

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

153 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.81 (TL_TCUA) - (TL_TCUA)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TL_TCUA

Logical Name

TL_TCUA

Definition

Minimum delay between two consecutive TCU load increaseby the


local overload controller.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

TL_TCUA >TS_TCUA

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.1

50

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

154 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.82 (TL0) - (TL0)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TL0

Logical Name

TL0

Definition

Threshold on TCU Processor Occupancy Level. The TCU is in "Low


Overload" state if its Processor Occupancy Level is higher or equal
to TL0 and less than TL3." The TCU is in "No Overload" state if its
Processor Occupancy Level is less than TL0.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

TL0 < TL3 < TL4

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

60

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

155 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.83 (TL1) - (TL1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TL1

Logical Name

TL1

Definition

BSC processor occupancy threshold used to decrement pointer P


on buffer occupancy thresholds.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

TL1 < TL2

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

70

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

156 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.84 (TL2) - (TL2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TL2

Logical Name

TL2

Definition

BSC processor occupancy threshold used to increment pointer P


on buffer occupancy thresholds.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

TL3 > TL4

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

85

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

157 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.85 (TL3) - (TL3)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TL3

Logical Name

TL3

Definition

Threshold on TCU Processor Occupancy Level:1) In upward


direction, the TCU Overload State is in "High Overload" state if
"TL3 <= TCU Processor Occupancy Level < TL4";2) In downward
direction, the TCU Overload State is still in "Very High Overload"
State if "TL3 <= TCU Processor Occupancy Level < TL4";3) In
downward direction, the TCU Overload State is in "Low Overload"
state if "TL0 <= TCU Processor Occupancy Level < TL3.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

T0 < TL3 < TL4

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

75

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

158 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.86 (TL4) - (TL4)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TL4

Logical Name

TL4

Definition

Threshold on TCU Processor Occupancy Level. The TCU is in "Very


High Overload" state if its Processor Occupancy Level is higher or
equal to TL4.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

TL4 > TL3 > TL0

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

95

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

159 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.87 (TRG_SDCCH) - (TRG_SDCCH)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TRG_SDCCH

Logical Name

TRG_SDCCH

Definition

Controls if local overload controller is triggered upon SDCCH


overload.

Coding rules

1 for TCU, 0 for others

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC proc

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

This parameter is set by default to 1 for TCUs. It shall be set to 0


for other BSC processors

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

160 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.1.88 (TS_TCUA) - (TS_TCUA)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TS_TCUA

Logical Name

TS_TCUA

Definition

Minimum delay between two consecutive TCU load reduction by the


local overload controller.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

TS_TCUA < TL_TCUA

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.1

50

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

161 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2 Site (CAE)


4.2.1 (A_LEV_HO) - (A_LEV_HO)
Parameter Name

HMI Name

A_LEV_HO

Logical Name

A_LEV_HO

Definition

Window size for level averages for handover.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

A_LEV_HO + W_LEV_HO < 32

Recommended rules

A_LEV_HO = 2 x A_LEV_PC. A_PBGT_HO = 2 x A_LEV_HO

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

Samfr

31

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Averaging PC-HO Window Size

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

Umbrella

Concentric

Concentric Umbrella

Microcell

Minicell

Extended inner cell

Extended outer cell

Nb of TRX Dependent

162 / 1182

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.2 (A_LEV_MCHO) - (A_LEV_MCHO)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

A_LEV_MCHO

Logical Name

A_LEV_MCHO

Definition

Window size for level averages for microcell handover.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

A_LEV_MCHO + W_LEV_MCHO < 16

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

Samfr

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO Parameters /Lower Layer HO Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

N/A

Umbrella

N/A

Concentric

N/A

Concentric Umbrella

N/A

Microcell

Minicell

N/A

Extended inner cell

N/A

Extended outer cell

N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

163 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.3 (A_LEV_PC) - (A_LEV_PC)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

A_LEV_PC

Logical Name

A_LEV_PC

Definition

Window size for level averages for power control.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

A_LEV_PC + W_LEV_PC < 32

Recommended rules

A_LEV_HO = 2 x A_LEV_PC

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

Samfr

31

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Averaging PC-HO Window Size

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

164 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.4 (A_PBGT_DR) - (A_PBGT_DR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

A_PBGT_DR

Logical Name

A_PBGT_DR

Definition

Window size for neighbour cell level averages for forced directed retry.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

Samfr

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: DIR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Directed Retry

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

165 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.5 (A_PBGT_HO) - (A_PBGT_HO)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

A_PBGT_HO

Logical Name

A_PBGT_HO

Definition

Window size for averaging neighbour cell levels and averaging


current cell levels for power budget calculation.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

A_PBGT_HO + W_PBGT_HO < 32

Recommended rules

A_PBGT_HO = 2 x A_LEV_HO

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

Samfr

31

16

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Averaging PC-HO Window Size

External Comment

should be set to 6 in suburban area, to 8 in urban area and to 12


in rural area

Cell Type Dependent

Single

12

Umbrella

12

Concentric

12

Concentric Umbrella

12

Microcell

Minicell

12

Extended inner cell

12

Extended outer cell

12

Nb of TRX Dependent

166 / 1182

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.6 (A_QUAL_CA_FR_HR) - (A_QUAL_CA_FR_HR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

A_QUAL_CA_FR_HR

Logical Name

A_QUAL_CA_FR_HR

Definition

Quality averaging window size for AMR FR-to-HR channel adaptation.

Coding rules

step size = 1 Samfr

Mandatory rules

A_QUAL_CA_FR_HR >= A_QUAL_CA_HR_FR

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

Samfr

61

61

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Averaging PC-HO Window Size

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

167 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.7 (A_QUAL_CA_HR_FR) - (A_QUAL_CA_HR_FR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

A_QUAL_CA_HR_FR

Logical Name

A_QUAL_CA_HR_FR

Definition

Quality averaging window size for AMR HR-to-FR channel adaptation.

Coding rules

step size = 1 Samfr

Mandatory rules

A_QUAL_CA_FR_HR >= A_QUAL_CA_HR_FR

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

Samfr

61

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Averaging PC-HO Window Size

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

168 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.8 (A_QUAL_HO) - (A_QUAL_HO)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

A_QUAL_HO

Logical Name

A_QUAL_HO

Definition

Window size for quality averages for handover.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

A_QUAL_HO + W_QUAL_HO < 32

Recommended rules

A_QUAL_HO = 2 x A_QUAL_PC

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

Samfr

31

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Averaging PC-HO Window Size

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

Umbrella

Concentric

Concentric Umbrella

Microcell

Minicell

Extended inner cell

Extended outer cell

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

169 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.9 (A_QUAL_PC) - (A_QUAL_PC)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

A_QUAL_PC

Logical Name

A_QUAL_PC

Definition

Window size for quality averages for power control.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

A_QUAL_PC + W_QUAL_PC < 32

Recommended rules

A_QUAL_HO = 2 x A_QUAL_PC

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

Samfr

31

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Averaging PC-HO Window Size

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

170 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.10 (A_RANGE_HO) - (A_RANGE_HO)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

A_RANGE_HO

Logical Name

A_RANGE_HO

Definition

Window size for distance averages.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

Samfr

31

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Averaging PC-HO Window Size

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

171 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.11 (A_TRAFFIC_LOAD) - (A_TRAFFIC_LOAD)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

A_TRAFFIC_LOAD

Logical Name

A_TRAFFIC_LOAD

Definition

Window size for load averages.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

16

12

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent
t01

t02

t03

t04

t05

t06

t07

t08

t09

t010

t011

t012

12

12

12

12

12

12

12

12

172 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.12 (AC 0) - (AC_0)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AC 0

Logical Name

AC_0

Definition

Indicates if Access Class 0 is barred.

Coding rules

0: not barred, 1: barred

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

173 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.13 (AC 1) - (AC_1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AC 1

Logical Name

AC_1

Definition

Indicates if Access Class 1 is barred.

Coding rules

0: not barred, 1: barred

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

174 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.14 (AC 11) - (AC_11)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AC 11

Logical Name

AC_11

Definition

Indicates if Access Class 11 is barred.

Coding rules

0: not barred, 1: barred

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

175 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.15 (AC 12) - (AC_12)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AC 12

Logical Name

AC_12

Definition

Indicates if Access Class 12 is barred.

Coding rules

0: not barred, 1: barred

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

176 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.16 (AC 13) - (AC_13)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AC 13

Logical Name

AC_13

Definition

Indicates if Access Class 13 is barred.

Coding rules

0: not barred, 1: barred

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

177 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.17 (AC 14) - (AC_14)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AC 14

Logical Name

AC_14

Definition

Indicates if Access Class 14 is barred.

Coding rules

0: not barred, 1: barred

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

178 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.18 (AC 15) - (AC_15)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AC 15

Logical Name

AC_15

Definition

Indicates if Access Class 15 is barred.

Coding rules

0: not barred, 1: barred

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

179 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.19 (AC 2) - (AC_2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AC 2

Logical Name

AC_2

Definition

Indicates if Access Class 2 is barred.

Coding rules

0: not barred, 1: barred

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

180 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.20 (AC 3) - (AC_3)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AC 3

Logical Name

AC_3

Definition

Indicates if Access Class 3 is barred.

Coding rules

0: not barred, 1: barred

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

181 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.21 (AC 4) - (AC_4)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AC 4

Logical Name

AC_4

Definition

Indicates if Access Class 4 is barred.

Coding rules

0: not barred, 1: barred

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

182 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.22 (AC 5) - (AC_5)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AC 5

Logical Name

AC_5

Definition

Indicates if Access Class 5 is barred.

Coding rules

0: not barred, 1: barred

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

183 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.23 (AC 6) - (AC_6)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AC 6

Logical Name

AC_6

Definition

Indicates if Access Class 6 is barred.

Coding rules

0: not barred, 1: barred

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

184 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.24 (AC 7) - (AC_7)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AC 7

Logical Name

AC_7

Definition

Indicates if Access Class 7 is barred.

Coding rules

0: not barred, 1: barred

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

185 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.25 (AC 8) - (AC_8)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AC 8

Logical Name

AC_8

Definition

Indicates if Access Class 8 is barred.

Coding rules

0: not barred, 1: barred

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

186 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.26 (AC 9) - (AC_9)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AC 9

Logical Name

AC_9

Definition

Indicates if Access Class 9 is barred.

Coding rules

0: not barred, 1: barred

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

187 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.27 (ADDITIONAL_RESELECT_PARAM) (ADDITIONAL_RESELECT_PARAM)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

ADDITIONAL_RESELECT_PARAM

Logical Name

ADDITIONAL_RESELECT_PARAM

Definition

Indicates if C2 cell selection parameters are present in


SYS_INFO_7&8 or SYS_INFO_4.

Coding rules

1bit; 0= the SI 4 rest octets, if present, are used to derive the value of
PI and possibly C2 parameters.1= the value of PI and possibly C2
parameters in a SYS INFO TYPE or message 8 are used

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Selection

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

188 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.28 (AG_PREMPT_PCH) - (AG_PREMPT_PCH)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AG_PREMPT_PCH

Logical Name

AG_PREMPT_PCH

Definition

Flag to enable pre-emption of Paging sub-channels for Access Grant


messages when there is one remaining free AGCH block.

Coding rules

0 = disabled, 1 = enabled

Mandatory rules

Lets define the free AGCH blocks as the number of blocks remaining
for the AGCH messages when the BCCH extended block and NCH
blocks have been excluded.- If there is no free AGCH block then the
flag is not used (pre-emption mandatory, default value 0 is not used by
BTS )- If there is only one free AGCH block then AG_PREMPT_PCH
=1 or 0 (pre-emption allowed)- If there is more than one free AGCH
then AG_PREMPT_PCH = 0 (pre-emption forbidden).

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Ctrl Channel

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

189 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.29 (ALLOC_ANYWAY) - (ALLOC_ANYWAY)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

ALLOC_ANYWAY

Logical Name

ALLOC_ANYWAY

Definition

Controls whether a queued request can be allocated on free


resource at expiry of its queuing timer independently of the threshold
NUM_TCH_EGNCY_HO.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO Parameters / General HO Control

External Comment

only relevant when NUM_TCH_EGNCY_HO > 0

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

190 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.30 (AMR_FR_HYST) - (AMR_FR_HYST)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AMR_FR_HYST

Logical Name

AMR_FR_HYST

Definition

Hysteresis for AMR-NB FR codec mode adaptation.

Coding rules

step size=0.5 dB; 0 = 0.0 dB, 1 = 0.5 dB, , 15 = 7.5 dB

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

As the BTS is not able to compute C/I values higher than 16


dB, following rule is highly recommended : AMR_FR_HYST +
AMR_FR_THR_i <= 16dB (with i = 13).

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

7.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment

Default value corresponds to the optimal default codec subset


(12.2kbit/s, 7.95kbit/s, 5.9kbit/s).Significant only if EN_AMR_FR is
set to TRUE.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

191 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.31 (AMR_FR_SUBSET) - (AMR_FR_SUBSET)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AMR_FR_SUBSET

Logical Name

AMR_FR_SUBSET

Definition

Bitmap (8 bits) defining the codec subset that shall be used for
AMR-NB FR calls (1 to 4 codecs).

Coding rules

bit 8 (most significant)=1: 12,2 kbit/s is part of the subset; bit 7=1:
10,2 kbit/s is part of the subset; bit 6=1: 7,95 kbit/s is part of the
subset; bit 5=1: 7,40 kbit/s is part of the subset; bit 4=1: 6,70 kbit/s
is part of the subset; bit 3=1: 5,90 kbit/s is part of the subset; bit
2=1: 5,15 kbit/s is part of the subset; bit 1 (least significant)=1: 4,75
kbit/s is part of the subset

Mandatory rules

In one subset a maximum of 4 codec modes can be chosen (a


maximum of 4 bits can be set to 1).

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

240

164

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / AMR

External Comment

Default value corresponds to an optimal codec subset:12.2kbit/s,


7.95kbit/s, 5.9kbit/s

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

192 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.32 (AMR_FR_THR_1) - (AMR_FR_THR_1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AMR_FR_THR_1

Logical Name

AMR_FR_THR_1

Definition

Threshold for AMR-NB FR codec mode adaptation between lowest


codec mode and second lowest codec mode.

Coding rules

step size=0.5 dB; 0 = 0.0 dB, 1 = 0.5 dB, , 63 = 31.5 dB

Mandatory rules

AMR_FR_THR_1 <= AMR_FR_THR_2

Recommended rules

As the BTS is not able to compute C/I values higher than 16


dB, following rule is highly recommended : AMR_FR_HYST +
AMR_FR_THR_1 <= 16dB.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

31.5

6.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment

Default value corresponds to the optimal default codec subset


(12.2kbit/s, 7.95kbit/s, 5.9kbit/s). AMR_FR_THR_1 is not used if
less than 2 codecs are in the AMR FR subset.Significant only if
EN_AMR_FR is set to TRUE.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

193 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.33 (AMR_FR_THR_2) - (AMR_FR_THR_2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AMR_FR_THR_2

Logical Name

AMR_FR_THR_2

Definition

Threshold for AMR-NB FR codec mode adaptation between second


lowest codec mode and third lowest codec mode.

Coding rules

step size=0.5 dB; 0 = 0.0 dB, 1 = 0.5 dB, , 63 = 31.5 dB

Mandatory rules

AMR_FR_THR_3 >= AMR_FR_THR_2 >= AMR_FR_THR_1

Recommended rules

As the BTS is not able to compute C/I values higher than 16


dB, following rule is highly recommended : AMR_FR_HYST +
AMR_FR_THR_2 <= 16dB.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

31.5

11.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment

Default value corresponds to the optimal default codec subset


(12.2kbit/s, 7.95kbit/s, 5.9kbit/s). AMR_FR_THR_2 is not used if
less than 3 codecs are in the AMR FR subset.Significant only if
EN_AMR_FR is set to TRUE.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

194 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.34 (AMR_FR_THR_3) - (AMR_FR_THR_3)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AMR_FR_THR_3

Logical Name

AMR_FR_THR_3

Definition

Threshold for AMR-NB FR codec mode adaptation between third


lowest codec mode and fourth lowest codec mode.

Coding rules

step size=0.5 dB; 0 = 0.0 dB, 1 = 0.5 dB, , 63 = 31.5 dB

Mandatory rules

AMR_FR_THR_3 >= AMR_FR_THR_2

Recommended rules

As the BTS is not able to compute C/I values higher than 16


dB, following rule is highly recommended : AMR_FR_HYST +
AMR_FR_THR_3 <= 16dB.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

31.5

11.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment

Default value corresponds to the optimal default codec subset


(12.2kbit/s, 7.95kbit/s, 5.9kbit/s). AMR_FR_THR_3 is not used if
less than 4 codecs are in the AMR FR subset.Significant only if
EN_AMR_FR is set to TRUE.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

195 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.35 (AMR_HR_HYST) - (AMR_HR_HYST)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AMR_HR_HYST

Logical Name

AMR_HR_HYST

Definition

Hysteresis for AMR-NB HR codec mode adaptation.

Coding rules

step size=0.5 dB; 0 = 0.0 dB, 1 = 0.5 dB, , 15 = 7.5 dB

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

As the BTS is not able to compute C/I values higher than 16


dB, following rule is highly recommended : AMR_HR_HYST +
AMR_HR_THR_i <= 16dB (with i = 13).

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

7.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment

Default value corresponds to the optimal default codec subset


(7.4kbit/s, 5.9kbit/s, 5.15kbit/s).Significant only if EN_AMR_HR is
set to TRUE.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

196 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.36 (AMR_HR_SUBSET) - (AMR_HR_SUBSET)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AMR_HR_SUBSET

Logical Name

AMR_HR_SUBSET

Definition

Bitmap (6 bits) defining the codec subset that shall be used for
AMR-NB HR calls (1 to 4 codecs).

Coding rules

Coded on 1 byte. Bit 8 (most significant) = Bit 7 = 0; bit 6 =1: 7,95


kbit/s is part of the subset; bit 5=1: 7,40 kbit/s is part of the subset;
bit 4=1: 6,70 kbit/s is part of the subset; bit 3=1: 5,90 kbit/s is part
of the subset; bit 2=1: 5,15 kbit/s is part of the subset; bit 1 (least
significant)=1: 4,75 kbit/s is part of the subset;

Mandatory rules

In one subset a maximum of 4 codec modes can be chosen (a


maximum of 4 bits can be set to 1). The subset shall not contain only
7.4 kbit/s codec mode. The codec mode 7.95 kbit/s is not supported
by Alcatel BSS.

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

60

22

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / AMR

External Comment

Default value corresponds to the optimal default codec subset


(7.4kbit/s, 5.9kbit/s, 5.15kbit/s).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

197 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.37 (AMR_HR_THR_1) - (AMR_HR_THR_1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AMR_HR_THR_1

Logical Name

AMR_HR_THR_1

Definition

Threshold for AMR-NB HR codec mode adaptation between lowest


codec mode and second lowest codec mode.

Coding rules

step size=0.5 dB; 0 = 0.0 dB, 1 = 0.5 dB, , 63 = 31.5 dB

Mandatory rules

AMR_HR_THR_1 <= AMR_HR_THR_2

Recommended rules

As the BTS is not able to compute C/I values higher than 16


dB, following rule is highly recommended : AMR_HR_HYST +
AMR_HR_THR_1 <= 16dB.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

31.5

11

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment

Default value corresponds to the optimal default codec subset


(7.4kbit/s, 5.9kbit/s, 5.15kbit/s). AMR_HR_THR_1 is not used if
less than 2 codecs are in the AMR HR subset.Significant only if
EN_AMR_HR is set to TRUE.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

198 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.38 (AMR_HR_THR_2) - (AMR_HR_THR_2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AMR_HR_THR_2

Logical Name

AMR_HR_THR_2

Definition

Threshold for AMR-NB HR codec mode adaptation between second


lowest codec mode and third lowest codec mode.

Coding rules

step size=0.5 dB; 0 = 0.0 dB, 1 = 0.5 dB, , 63 = 31.5 dB

Mandatory rules

AMR_HR_THR_3 >= AMR_HR_THR_2 >= AMR_HR_THR_1

Recommended rules

As the BTS is not able to compute C/I values higher than 16


dB, following rule is highly recommended : AMR_HR_HYST +
AMR_HR_THR_2 <= 16dB.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

31.5

12.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment

Default value corresponds to the optimal default codec subset


(7.4kbit/s, 5.9kbit/s, 5.15kbit/s). AMR_HR_THR_2 is not used if
less than 3 codecs are in the AMR HR subset.Significant only if
EN_AMR_HR is set to TRUE.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

199 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.39 (AMR_HR_THR_3) - (AMR_HR_THR_3)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AMR_HR_THR_3

Logical Name

AMR_HR_THR_3

Definition

Threshold for AMR-NB HR codec mode adaptation between third


lowest codec mode and fourth lowest codec mode.

Coding rules

step size=0.5 dB; 0 = 0.0 dB, 1 = 0.5 dB, , 63 = 31.5 dB

Mandatory rules

AMR_HR_THR_3 >= AMR_HR_THR_2

Recommended rules

As the BTS is not able to compute C/I values higher than 16


dB, following rule is highly recommended : AMR_HR_HYST +
AMR_HR_THR_3 <= 16dB.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

31.5

12.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment

Default value corresponds to the optimal default codec subset


(7.4kbit/s, 5.9kbit/s, 5.15kbit/s). AMR_HR_THR_3 is not used if
less than 4 codecs are in the AMR HR subset.Significant only if
EN_AMR_HR is set to TRUE.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

200 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.40 (AMR_START_MODE_FR) - (AMR_START_MODE_FR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AMR_START_MODE_FR

Logical Name

AMR_START_MODE_FR

Definition

Indicates the codec used at the beginning of a AMR-NB FR call, until


codec mode adaptation is started by the BTS.

Coding rules

0: implicit rule is used for initial codec mode; 1: lowest codec mode
of the subset; 2: second lowest codec mode (used if the subset
contains more than one codec mode); 3: third lowest codec mode
(used if the subset contains more than two codec modes); 4: highest
codec mode (used if the subset contains four codec modes)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / AMR

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

201 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.41 (AMR_START_MODE_HR) - (AMR_START_MODE_HR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AMR_START_MODE_HR

Logical Name

AMR_START_MODE_HR

Definition

Indicates the codec used at the beginning of a AMR-NB HR call, until


codec mode adaptation is started by the BTS.

Coding rules

0: implicit rule is used for initial codec mode; 1: lowest codec mode
of the subset; 2: second lowest codec mode (used if the subset
contains more than one codec mode); 3: third lowest codec mode
(used if the subset contains more than two codec modes); 4: highest
codec mode (used if the subset contains four codec modes)

Mandatory rules

If AMR_START_MODE_HR is explicit (I.e. not equal to 0), the


chosen codec mode shall not correspond to 7.40 kbit/s.

Recommended rules

Use codec mode 6.7 kbit/s as start mode for AMR-NB HR should
be avoided.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC &SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / AMR

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

202 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.42 (AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_1) - (AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_1

Logical Name

AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_1

Definition

Hysteresis for AMR-WB GMSK codec mode adaptation, for transition


between lowest codec mode and second lowest codec mode.

Coding rules

step size=0.5 dB; 0 = 0.0 dB, 1 = 0.5 dB, , 15 = 7.5 dB

Mandatory rules

AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_1+AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_
1<=AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_2+AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_2

Recommended rules

As the BTS is not able to compute C/I values higher than 16 dB,
following rules is highly recommended : AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_1
+ AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_1 <= 16dB.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

7.5

2.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

203 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.43 (AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_2) - (AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_2

Logical Name

AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_2

Definition

Hysteresis for AMR-WB GMSK codec mode adaptation, for transition


between highest codec mode and second lowest codec mode.

Coding rules

step size=0.5 dB; 0 = 0.0 dB, 1 = 0.5 dB, , 15 = 7.5 dB

Mandatory rules

AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_1+AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_
1<=AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_2+AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_2

Recommended rules

As the BTS is not able to compute C/I values higher than 16 dB,
following rules is highly recommended : AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_2
+ AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_2 <= 16dB.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

7.5

2.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

204 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.44 (AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_1) - (AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_1

Logical Name

AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_1

Definition

Threshold for AMR-WB GMSK codec mode adaptation between


lowest codec mode and second lowest codec mode.

Coding rules

step size=0.5 dB; 0 = 0.0 dB, 1 = 0.5 dB, , 63 = 31.5 dB

Mandatory rules

AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_1 <
AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_2AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_1+
AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_1<=AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_2+
AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_2

Recommended rules

As the BTS is not able to compute C/I values higher than 16 dB,
following rule is highly recommended : AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_1 +
AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_1 <= 16dB.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

31.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

205 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.45 (AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_2) - (AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_2

Logical Name

AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_2

Definition

Threshold for AMR-WB GMSK codec mode adaptation between


second lowest codec mode and highest codec mode.

Coding rules

step size=0.5 dB; 0 = 0.0 dB, 1 = 0.5 dB, , 63 = 31.5 dB

Mandatory rules

AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_1 <
AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_2AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_1+
AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_1<=AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_2+
AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_2

Recommended rules

As the BTS is not able to compute C/I values higher than 16 dB,
following rule is highly recommended : AMR_WB_GMSK_HYST_2 +
AMR_WB_GMSK_THR_2 <= 16dB.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

31.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

206 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.46 (AUTO_BAR_BSS_OVERLOAD) - (EN_BSS_OVRL_CLASS_BAR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AUTO_BAR_BSS_OVERLOAD

Logical Name

EN_BSS_OVRL_CLASS_BAR

Definition

This flag enables/disables access class automatic barring upon


BTS/BSC overload.

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / Overload and Barring

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

207 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.47 (AUTO_BAR_CELL) - (AUT_BAR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AUTO_BAR_CELL

Logical Name

AUT_BAR

Definition

This flag enables/inhibits automatic barring of cell.

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / Overload and Barring

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

208 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.48 (AUTO_BAR_EC) - (EC_BAR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

AUTO_BAR_EC

Logical Name

EC_BAR

Definition

This flag enables/disables automatic barring of Emergency Class.

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / Overload and Barring

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

209 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.49 (Automatic AC barring on TCH load) - (EN_LOAD_MNGT)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Automatic AC barring on TCH load

Logical Name

EN_LOAD_MNGT

Definition

This flag enables/disables automatic barring of access classes on


TCH load criterion.

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

210 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.50 (B_NUM) - (B_NUM)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

B_NUM

Logical Name

B_NUM

Definition

Number of BLOCK/UNBLOCK messages sent in one burst.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

35

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment

Default value depends on MSC type.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

211 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.51 (BCC) - (BCC (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BCC

Logical Name

BCC (BSC)

Definition

BTS colour code of the cell.

Coding rules

coded over 3 bits

Mandatory rules

Equal to BCC (MFS)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description (+ Edit External cell


/ circuit1/2)

External Comment

Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated here


is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

212 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.52 (BCC) - (BCC (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BCC

Logical Name

BCC (MFS)

Definition

BTS colour code of the cell.

Coding rules

coded over 3 bits

Mandatory rules

Equal to BCC (BSC)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description (+ Edit External cell


/ circuit1/2)

External Comment

Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated here


is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

213 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.53 (BCC) - (BCC (n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BCC

Logical Name

BCC (n)

Definition

BTS colour code of the adjacent cell.

Coding rules

coded over 3 bits

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit External Cell / Circuit 1/2

External Comment

Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated here


is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

214 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.54 (BCCH_ARFCN) - (BCCH_ARFCN(n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BCCH_ARFCN

Logical Name

BCCH_ARFCN(n)

Definition

Absolute Radio Frequency Channel Number of the BCCH of the


adjacent cell.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

- BCCH_FREQUENCY(n) = BCCH_ARFCN(n)1) for Non


Evolium serving cell : The cell neighborhood for reselection is
controlled by EN_2G_TO_3G_CELL_RESELECTION value and
FDD_ARFCN_LIST content.The cell neighborhood for handover
is controlled by EN_3G_HO and FDD_ARFCN values.- if the
neighborhood of the serving cell for reselection is 2G only, then there
can be up to 32 different BCCH 2G frequencies for the set of all the
target cells.- if the neighborhood of the serving cell for reselection is
mixed 2G/3G, and if all 2G frequencies can be encoded in the SI2
or SI2bis message, and if the SI2ter message is used to encode
only 3G frequencies, then there shall be no more than 31 different
BCCH 2G frequencies for the set of all the target cells.- since the
neighborhood of the serving cell for handover is 2G only, then there
can be up to 32 different

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

1023

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Adjacencies

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

215 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.55 (BCCH_ARFCN) - (BCCH_FREQUENCY(n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BCCH_ARFCN

Logical Name

BCCH_FREQUENCY(n)

Definition

Indicates the frequency used as BCCH.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

- BCCH_FREQUENCY(n) = BCCH_ARFCN(n)1) for Non Evolium


serving cell :

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

1023

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

216 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.56 (BCCH_EXT) - (BCCH_EXT)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BCCH_EXT

Logical Name

BCCH_EXT

Definition

This flag enables / disables the use of extended BCCH.

Coding rules

0: false, 1:true

Mandatory rules

-BCCH_EXT cannot be set to true if the associated BTS is a


non-Evolium one.-When EN_SOLSA is enabled, the BCCH_EXT
shall be set to true.-When EN_VGCS is disabled :. if BCCH_EXT
= true, then BS_AG_BLKS_RES >= 1-When EN_VGCS
is enabled : . if BCCH_EXT = false, BS_AG_BLKS_RES
>= NUMBER_NCH_BLOCKS . if BCCH_EXT = true, then
BS_AG_BLKS_RES > NUMBER_NCH_BLOCKS

Recommended rules

The support of extended BCCH (parameter BCCH_EXT) is HIGHLY


recommended in cells having adjacent cells in several frequency
bands and at least 18 adjacent frequencies within the same band.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Radio Channel Config / TRX Configuration

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

217 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.57 (BS_AG_BLKS_RES) - (BS_AG_BLKS_RES (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BS_AG_BLKS_RES

Logical Name

BS_AG_BLKS_RES (BSC)

Definition

Number of CCCH blocks reserved for the access grant channel


(AGCH).

Coding rules

coded on 3 bits (000 : 0, ...111 : 7)

Mandatory rules

-BS_AG_BLKS_RES (MFS) = BS_AG_BLKS_RES (BSC) for a


given cell-when CCCH_CONF=0 and CBCH is configured in the
cell, BS_AG_BLKS_RES>0- when CCCH_CONF=2, max value of
BS_AG_BLKS_RES is 7 and BS_AG_BLKS_RES must be > 0 if
CBCH is configured in the cell.-When EN_VGCS is disabled :. if
BCCH_EXT = true, then BS_AG_BLKS_RES >= 1-When EN_VGCS
is enabled : . if BCCH_EXT = false, then BS_AG_BLKS_RES
>= NUMBER_NCH_BLOCKS . if BCCH_EXT = true, then
BS_AG_BLKS_RES > NUMBER_NCH_BLOCKS

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Ctrl Channel

External Comment

Maximum and Default values given for CCCH_CONF=0For


CCCH_CONF=1, max=2, def=1

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

218 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.58 (BS_P_CON_ACK) - (BS_P_CON_ACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BS_P_CON_ACK

Logical Name

BS_P_CON_ACK

Definition

Supervision of the BS Power Control procedure.

Coding rules

step size=1 (2 x Samfr)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

2 x Samfr

31

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

Umbrella

Concentric

Concentric Umbrella

Microcell

Minicell

Extended inner cell

Extended outer cell

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

219 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.59 (BS_P_CON_INT) - (BS_P_CON_INT)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BS_P_CON_INT

Logical Name

BS_P_CON_INT

Definition

Minimum delay between two consecutive BS power commands.

Coding rules

step size=1 (2 x Samfr)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

2 x Samfr

31

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

Umbrella

Concentric

Concentric Umbrella

Microcell

Minicell

Extended inner cell

Extended outer cell

Nb of TRX Dependent

220 / 1182

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.60 (BS_PA_MFRMS) - (BS_PA_MFRMS (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BS_PA_MFRMS

Logical Name

BS_PA_MFRMS (BSC)

Definition

Number of 51 frame multiframes between consecutive occurrences


of a Paging Group.

Coding rules

coded on 3 bits (000 : 2, ... 111: 9)

Mandatory rules

BS_PA_MFRMS (BSC) = BS_PA_MFRMS (MFS) for a given cell

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Ctrl Channel

External Comment

The bigger this parameter is, the lesser the MS power consumption
is.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

221 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.61 (BS_TXPWR_MAX) - (BS_TXPWR_MAX (BSC))


When a cell is shared, the BS_TX_POWER_MAX and
BS_TX_POWER_MAX_INNER powers must always be defined against the
actual physical power of the main sector. If the actual power of the secondary
sector is lower than the actual power of the main sector, the operator has to
adjust the values of BS_TX_POWER_MAX and BS_TX_POWER_MAX_INNER
to avoid requiring too high an output power than is actually available.
Parameter Name

HMI Name

BS_TXPWR_MAX

Logical Name

BS_TXPWR_MAX (BSC)

Definition

This parameter defines the power reduction relative to the maximum


GMSK output power of the BTS.

Coding rules

step size = 2dB. 0: 0 dB, 1: -2dB, ..., 15: -30dB

Mandatory rules

BS_TXPWR_MAX >= BS_TXPWR_MINEqual to BS_TXPWR_MAX


(MFS)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-30

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment

The BTS maximum allowed transmit power is defined relatively to


the BTS maximum RF transmit power in GMSK (due to hardware
limitation).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

222 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.62 (BS_TXPWR_MAX_INNER) - (BS_TXPWR_MAX_INNER (BSC))


When a cell is shared, the BS_TX_POWER_MAX and
BS_TX_POWER_MAX_INNER powers must always be defined against the
actual physical power of the main sector. If the actual power of the secondary
sector is lower than the actual power of the main sector, the operator has to
adjust the values of BS_TX_POWER_MAX and BS_TX_POWER_MAX_INNER
to avoid requiring too high an output power than is actually available.
Parameter Name

HMI Name

BS_TXPWR_MAX_INNER

Logical Name

BS_TXPWR_MAX_INNER (BSC)

Definition

This parameter defines the power reduction relative to the maximum


GMSK output power of the TRX of the inner zone in a concentric
or multi-band cell.

Coding rules

step size = 2dB. 0: 0 dB, 1: -2dB, ..., 15: -30dB

Mandatory rules

Equal to BS_TXPWR_MAX_INNER (MFS) and


BS_TXPWR_MAX_INNER >= BS_TXPWR_MIN

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-30

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment

The BTS maximum allowed transmit power is defined relatively to


the BTS maximum RF transmit power in GMSK (due to hardware
limitation).Default value depends on configuration. The value
indicated here is for implementation purposes.

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

223 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

Cell Type Dependent

Nb of TRX Dependent

224 / 1182

Single

N/A

Umbrella

N/A

Concentric

Concentric Umbrella

Microcell

N/A

Minicell

N/A

Extended inner cell

N/A

Extended outer cell

N/A

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.63 (BS_TXPWR_MIN) - (BS_TXPWR_MIN)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BS_TXPWR_MIN

Logical Name

BS_TXPWR_MIN

Definition

BTS minimum allowed transmission power.

Coding rules

step size = 2dB. 0: 0 dB, 1: -2dB, ..., 15: -30dB

Mandatory rules

BS_TXPWR_MIN <= BS_TXPWR_MAXBS_TXPWR_MAX_INNER


>= BS_TXPWR_MIN

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-30

-24

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

225 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.64 (BSC Primary X25 Address) - (BSC_X25_primary_address)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Primary X25 Address

Logical Name

BSC_X25_primary_address

Definition

BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules

0 to 15 characters string. *: default = empty string

Mandatory rules

changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

OMC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

226 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.65 (BSC Primary X25 Address [1]) - (BSC_X25_primary_address_i [1])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Primary X25 Address [1]

Logical Name

BSC_X25_primary_address_i [1]

Definition

First character of BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules

1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules

changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

227 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.66 (BSC Primary X25 Address [10]) - (BSC_X25_primary_address_i


[10])
Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Primary X25 Address [10]

Logical Name

BSC_X25_primary_address_i [10]

Definition

Tenth character of BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules

1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

228 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.67 (BSC Primary X25 Address [11]) - (BSC_X25_primary_address_i


[11])
Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Primary X25 Address [11]

Logical Name

BSC_X25_primary_address_i [11]

Definition

Eleventh character of BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules

1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules

changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

229 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.68 (BSC Primary X25 Address [12]) - (BSC_X25_primary_address_i


[12])
Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Primary X25 Address [12]

Logical Name

BSC_X25_primary_address_i [12]

Definition

Twelfth character of BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules

1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules

changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

230 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.69 (BSC Primary X25 Address [13]) - (BSC_X25_primary_address_i


[13])
Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Primary X25 Address [13]

Logical Name

BSC_X25_primary_address_i [13]

Definition

Thirteenth character of BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules

1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules

changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

231 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.70 (BSC Primary X25 Address [14]) - (BSC_X25_primary_address_i


[14])
Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Primary X25 Address [14]

Logical Name

BSC_X25_primary_address_i [14]

Definition

Fourteenth character of BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules

1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules

changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

232 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.71 (BSC Primary X25 Address [15]) - (BSC_X25_primary_address_i


[15])
Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Primary X25 Address [15]

Logical Name

BSC_X25_primary_address_i [15]

Definition

Fifteenth character of BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules

1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules

changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

233 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.72 (BSC Primary X25 Address [2]) - (BSC_X25_primary_address_i [2])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Primary X25 Address [2]

Logical Name

BSC_X25_primary_address_i [2]

Definition

Second character of BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules

1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules

changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

234 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.73 (BSC Primary X25 Address [3]) - (BSC_X25_primary_address_i [3])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Primary X25 Address [3]

Logical Name

BSC_X25_primary_address_i [3]

Definition

Third character of BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules

1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules

changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

235 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.74 (BSC Primary X25 Address [4]) - (BSC_X25_primary_address_i [4])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Primary X25 Address [4]

Logical Name

BSC_X25_primary_address_i [4]

Definition

Fourth character of BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules

1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules

changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

236 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.75 (BSC Primary X25 Address [5]) - (BSC_X25_primary_address_i [5])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Primary X25 Address [5]

Logical Name

BSC_X25_primary_address_i [5]

Definition

Fifth character of BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules

1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules

changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

237 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.76 (BSC Primary X25 Address [6]) - (BSC_X25_primary_address_i [6])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Primary X25 Address [6]

Logical Name

BSC_X25_primary_address_i [6]

Definition

Sixth character of BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules

1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules

changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

238 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.77 (BSC Primary X25 Address [7]) - (BSC_X25_primary_address_i [7])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Primary X25 Address [7]

Logical Name

BSC_X25_primary_address_i [7]

Definition

Seventh character of BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules

1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules

changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

239 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.78 (BSC Primary X25 Address [8]) - (BSC_X25_primary_address_i [8])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Primary X25 Address [8]

Logical Name

BSC_X25_primary_address_i [8]

Definition

Eighth character of BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules

1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules

changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

240 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.79 (BSC Primary X25 Address [9]) - (BSC_X25_primary_address_i [9])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Primary X25 Address [9]

Logical Name

BSC_X25_primary_address_i [9]

Definition

Ninth character of BSC X25 primary address.

Coding rules

1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules

changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

241 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.80 (BSC Secondary X25 Address) - (BSC_X25_secondary_address)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Secondary X25 Address

Logical Name

BSC_X25_secondary_address

Definition

BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules

0 to 15 characters string. *: default = empty string

Mandatory rules

changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

OMC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

242 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.81 (BSC Secondary X25 Address [1]) (BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [1])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Secondary X25 Address [1]

Logical Name

BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [1]

Definition

First character of BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules

1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

243 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.82 (BSC Secondary X25 Address [10]) (BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [10])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Secondary X25 Address [10]

Logical Name

BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [10]

Definition

Tenth character of BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules

1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

244 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.83 (BSC Secondary X25 Address [11]) (BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [11])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Secondary X25 Address [11]

Logical Name

BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [11]

Definition

Eleventh character of BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules

1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

245 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.84 (BSC Secondary X25 Address [12]) (BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [12])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Secondary X25 Address [12]

Logical Name

BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [12]

Definition

Twelfth character of BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules

1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules

changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

246 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.85 (BSC Secondary X25 Address [13]) (BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [13])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Secondary X25 Address [13]

Logical Name

BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [13]

Definition

Thirteenth character of BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules

1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules

changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

247 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.86 (BSC Secondary X25 Address [14]) (BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [14])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Secondary X25 Address [14]

Logical Name

BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [14]

Definition

Fourteenth character of BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules

1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules

changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

248 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.87 (BSC Secondary X25 Address [15]) (BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [15])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Secondary X25 Address [15]

Logical Name

BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [15]

Definition

Fifteenth character of BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules

1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules

changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

249 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.88 (BSC Secondary X25 Address [2]) (BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [2])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Secondary X25 Address [2]

Logical Name

BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [2]

Definition

Second character of BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules

1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules

changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

250 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.89 (BSC Secondary X25 Address [3]) (BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [3])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Secondary X25 Address [3]

Logical Name

BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [3]

Definition

Third character of BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules

1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules

changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

251 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.90 (BSC Secondary X25 Address [4]) (BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [4])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Secondary X25 Address [4]

Logical Name

BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [4]

Definition

Fourth character of BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules

1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules

changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

252 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.91 (BSC Secondary X25 Address [5]) (BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [5])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Secondary X25 Address [5]

Logical Name

BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [5]

Definition

Fifth character of BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules

1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules

changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

253 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.92 (BSC Secondary X25 Address [6]) (BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [6])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Secondary X25 Address [6]

Logical Name

BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [6]

Definition

Sixth character of BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules

1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules

changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

254 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.93 (BSC Secondary X25 Address [7]) (BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [7])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Secondary X25 Address [7]

Logical Name

BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [7]

Definition

Seventh character of BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules

1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules

changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

255 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.94 (BSC Secondary X25 Address [8]) (BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [8])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Secondary X25 Address [8]

Logical Name

BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [8]

Definition

Eighth character of BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules

1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules

changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

256 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.95 (BSC Secondary X25 Address [9]) (BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [9])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Secondary X25 Address [9]

Logical Name

BSC_X25_secondary_address_i [9]

Definition

Ninth character of BSC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules

1character of a string. default = blank character

Mandatory rules

changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: OAM RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN Management / Add a BSS

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

257 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.96 (BSC Signalling Point Code) - (OPC)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC Signalling Point Code

Logical Name

OPC

Definition

Signalling Point Code of the BSC.

Coding rules

coded over 14 bits

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

16383

12

Modifiable

OMC Changes: EML RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

BSS parameters / A interface info

External Comment

Must be equal to DPC and SSF used by the MSC for adressing the
BSC. Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated
here is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

258 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.97 (BSC_EN_RF_RES_IND) - (BSC_EN_RF_RES_IND)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSC_EN_RF_RES_IND

Logical Name

BSC_EN_RF_RES_IND

Definition

Enables/disables the RF RESOURCE INDICATION processing by


the BSC.

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

259 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.98 (BSIC) - (BSIC (GSM))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSIC

Logical Name

BSIC (GSM)

Definition

Concatenation of the NCC and the BCC.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Abstract

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

260 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.99 (BTS_Queue_Length) - (BTS_Q_LENGTH)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BTS_Queue_Length

Logical Name

BTS_Q_LENGTH

Definition

Maximum number of Assignment Requests and Handover Requests


that can be queued simultaneously.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

64

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent
t01

t02

t03

t04

t05

t06

t07

t08

t09

t010

t011

t012

10

10

10

10

10

10

10

10

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

261 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.100 (CALL_RE_ESTABLISHMENT) - (RE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CALL_RE_ESTABLISHMENT

Logical Name

RE

Definition

This flag indicates to the MS if call reestablishment is allowed in the


cell.

Coding rules

0: allowed, 1: not allowed

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

262 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.101 (Call_User_Data_Selector) - (Call_user_data_sel)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Call_User_Data_Selector

Logical Name

Call_user_data_sel

Definition

Identifies the higher protocol selector for an outgoing connection.

Coding rules

0 to 16 bytes string

Mandatory rules

Can be changed only when SMSCB_State is disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Interworking / CBC interworking

External Comment

Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated here is


for implementation purposes.Each byte of the string can get a value
in the range [0..255].

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

263 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.102 (Candidate cell priority) - (PRIORITY(0,n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Candidate cell priority

Logical Name

PRIORITY(0,n)

Definition

Priority of the cell n in the HO candidate cell evaluation process.

Coding rules

0: highest priority, 5: lowest priority

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Adjacencies

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

264 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.103 (CAPTURE_TRAFFIC_CONDITION) (CAPTURE_TRAFFIC_CONDITION)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CAPTURE_TRAFFIC_CONDITION

Logical Name

CAPTURE_TRAFFIC_CONDITION

Definition

This parameter determines the condition on traffic load in the serving


cell to trigger a "general capture" handover.

Coding rules

0: Any load, 1: Not low, 2: High

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Hierarchical and multiband HO ctrl

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

265 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.104 (CBC Primary X25 Address) - (CBC_X25_primary_address)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CBC Primary X25 Address

Logical Name

CBC_X25_primary_address

Definition

CBC X25 primary address.

Coding rules

0 to 15 characters string. *: default = empty string

Mandatory rules

changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

32

Modifiable

OMC Changes: changeable RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN management/Modify Peer Entities

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

266 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.105 (CBC Secondary X25 Address) - (CBC_X25_secondary_address)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CBC Secondary X25 Address

Logical Name

CBC_X25_secondary_address

Definition

CBC X25 secondary address.

Coding rules

0 to 15 characters string. *: default = empty string

Mandatory rules

changeable if SMSCB_STATE=disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

32

Modifiable

OMC Changes: changeable RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

DCN management/Modify Peer Entities

External Comment

The minimum, maximum and default values indicated are only for
implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

267 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.106 (CBC_Operator) - (Operator)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CBC_Operator

Logical Name

Operator

Definition

Identifies the CBC operator.

Coding rules

0 to 20 characters string (default = empty string) are sent by the


OMC on the OMC/BSC interface . BSC performs the padding of
OMC string with space characters on the right side of the string until
20 bytes are reached. At Upload, OMC RNL removes padded space
characters from the retrieved BSC value.

Mandatory rules

Can be changed only when SMSCB_State is disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

32

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Interworking / CBC interworking

External Comment

Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated here


is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

268 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.107 (CBC_Password) - (Password)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CBC_Password

Logical Name

Password

Definition

CBC password.

Coding rules

0 to 20 characters string (default = empty string) are sent by the


OMC on the OMC/BSC interface. BSC performs the padding of OMC
string with space characters on the right side of the string until 20
bytes are reached. At Upload, OMC RNL removes padded space
characters from the retrieved BSC value.

Mandatory rules

Can be changed only when SMSCB_State is disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

32

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Interworking / CBC interworking

External Comment

Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated here


is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

269 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.108 (CBC_Window) - (CBC_window)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CBC_Window

Logical Name

CBC_window

Definition

Maximum number of outstanding primitives on the BSC/CBC


interface for both incoming and outgoing primitives.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Can be changed only when SMSCB_State is disabledshall be set to


"1" when SMSCB_FEATURE_SET="FS1"

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Interworking / CBC interworking

External Comment

Default value corresponds to SMSCB_FEATURE_SET = FS1.If


SMSCB_FEATURE_SET = FS2, CBC_Window should be set to 3.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

270 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.109 (CCCH_LOAD_IND_PERIOD) - (RACHRT)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CCCH_LOAD_IND_PERIOD

Logical Name

RACHRT

Definition

Minimum delay between two consecutive sendings of CCCH LOAD


INDICATION messages.

Coding rules

step size=1 (51mfr)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

RACHRT > RACH_LOAD_MEAS_PER

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

51mfr

255

255

Modifiable

OMC Changes: Displayed(PRC&SC) RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Ctrl Channel

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

271 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.110 (CCCH_LOAD_MEAS_PERIOD) - (RACH_LOAD_MEAS_PER)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CCCH_LOAD_MEAS_PERIOD

Logical Name

RACH_LOAD_MEAS_PER

Definition

Period over which CCCH load measurements are made.

Coding rules

step size=1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

RACH_LOAD_MEAS_PER < RACHRT

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

51mfr

255

32

Modifiable

OMC Changes: Displayed(PRC&SC) RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Ctrl Channel

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

272 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.111 (Cell Type) - (Cell_Type)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Cell Type

Logical Name

Cell_Type

Definition

Combination of CELL_DIMENSION_TYPE, CELL_LAYER_TYPE,


CELL_PARTITION_TYPE, CELL_RANGE for an OMC own cell.
Used for cell default parameter template.

Coding rules

Single (0), Concentric (1), Umbrella (2), Micro (3), Umbrella


Concentric (4), Mini (5), Extended Inner (6), Extended Outer (7),
Mini Concentric (8), Micro Concentric (9), Indoor (10), Indoor
Concentric(11)

Mandatory rules

- EN_SYNCHRONISED_HO shall be set to disabled when


CELL_TYPE is equal to "Extended inner" or "Extended outer".A
couple of mate cells (Extended inner + extended outer) shall have
the same LAC (respectively RAC when they are PS capable).The "micro concentric", "mini concentric" and "indoor concentric"
cells must be multiband (the allowed FREQUENCY_RANGE is
"PGSM-DCS1800" or "EGSM-DCS1800"). This restriction does not
apply to the external cells.

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Abstract

SubSystem

OMC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes:


SEL/PAG/RRM/HPC/HOC/DIR/GPR

Parameter Access

Create Cell(+ External OMC cell information)

External Comment

*: possible values are:- Single- Umbrella- Umbrella ConcentricMicro- Mini- Micro Concentric- Mini Concentric - Indoor- Indoor
Concentric (labelled "Indoor Multiband" on the HMI)- Extended InnerExtended Outer

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

273 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.112 (CELL_BAR_QUALIFY) - (CELL_BAR_QUALIFY)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CELL_BAR_QUALIFY

Logical Name

CELL_BAR_QUALIFY

Definition

Indicates the priority of the cell for cell selection.

Coding rules

0: normal priority, 1: low priority

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

274 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.113 (CELL_EVALUATION) - (CELL_EV)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CELL_EVALUATION

Logical Name

CELL_EV

Definition

Handover cell evaluation process applied in the cell.

Coding rules

0: Order, 1: Grade

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

grade (1)

Umbrella

grade (1)

Concentric

grade (1)

Concentric Umbrella

grade (1)

Microcell

order (0)

Minicell

grade (1)

Extended inner cell

grade (1)

Extended outer cell

grade (1)

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

275 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.114 (CELL_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS) (CELL_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CELL_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS

Logical Name

CELL_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS

Definition

Level hysteresis for cell reselection applied when the new cell is in a
different location area or, for a GPRS MS, in a different routing area,
or when a GPRS MS is in GMM ready state.

Coding rules

step size = 2dB; coded on 3 bits (000 : 0 dB, 111 : 14 dB)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

14

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Selection

External Comment

If the VGCS is licensed, the parameter is modifiable only via the


provisioning context of the OMC.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

276 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.115 (CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET) - (CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET


(BSC))
Parameter Name

HMI Name

CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET

Logical Name

CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET (BSC)

Definition

Permanent offset to C2 criterion.

Coding rules

step size = 2dB; coded on 6 bits (000000:0 dB, 111111 : 126 dB)

Mandatory rules

CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET (MFS) = CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET


(BSC)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

126

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Selection

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

277 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.116 (CELL_RESELECT_PARAM_IND) (CELL_RESELECT_PARAM_IND)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CELL_RESELECT_PARAM_IND

Logical Name

CELL_RESELECT_PARAM_IND

Definition

Indicates to the MS if parameters for C2 reselection criterion are


broadcast.

Coding rules

0: not present, 1: present

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Selection

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

278 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.117 (Cell_Type) - (Cell_Type (n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Cell_Type

Logical Name

Cell_Type (n)

Definition

Combination of CELL_DIMENSION_TYPE, CELL_LAYER_TYPE,


CELL_PARTITION_TYPE, CELL_RANGE for an adjacent cell (OMC
own cell or OMC external cell).

Coding rules

Single (0), Concentric (1), Umbrella (2), Micro (3), Umbrella


Concentric (4), Mini (5), Extended Inner (6), Extended Outer (7),
Mini Concentric (8), Micro Concentric (9), Indoor (10), Indoor
Concentric(11), GAN(12)

Mandatory rules

- EN_SYNCHRONISED_HO shall be set to disabled when


CELL_TYPE is equal to "Extended inner" or "Extended outer".A
couple of mate cells (Extended inner + extended outer) shall have the
same LAC (respectively RAC when they are PS capable).- The "micro
concentric", "mini concentric" and "indoor concentric" cells must be
multiband (the allowed FREQUENCY_RANGE is "PGSM-DCS1800"
or "EGSM-DCS1800"). This restriction does not apply to the external
cells.The "GAN" value is allowed only for external cells.

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Abstract

SubSystem

OMC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

*: possible values are:- Single- Umbrella- Umbrella ConcentricMicro- Mini- Micro Concentric- Mini Concentric - Indoor- Indoor
Concentric (labelled "Indoor Multiband" on the HMI)- Extended InnerExtended Outer- GAN

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

279 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.118 (CI) - (CI (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CI

Logical Name

CI (BSC)

Definition

Cell Identity.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

LAC and CI can not be equal to 65535 at the same timeEqual to CI


(MFS)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

65535

65535

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description ( + Edit External cell


/ circuit1/2)

External Comment

Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated here


is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

280 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.119 (CI) - (CI(n)(BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CI

Logical Name

CI(n)(BSC)

Definition

Cell Identity of adjacent cell.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

LAC and CI can not be equal to 65535 at the same timeEqual to


CI(n)(MFS)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

65535

65535

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated here


is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

281 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.120 (Ciphering Algorithms Priority 1) - (BSS_CIPH_LIST (Priority 1))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Ciphering Algorithms Priority 1

Logical Name

BSS_CIPH_LIST (Priority 1)

Definition

List of encryption algorithms in their prioritized order.

Coding rules

coded as an array of 7 bytes. Each byte contains a reference to an


encryption algorithm: 1 for A5/1, ... 7 for A5/7.

Mandatory rules

The same encryption algorithm reference cannot be used for two


different priorities

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

List of numbers

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / Ciphering

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

282 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.121 (Ciphering Algorithms Priority 2) - (BSS_CIPH_LIST (Priority 2))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Ciphering Algorithms Priority 2

Logical Name

BSS_CIPH_LIST (Priority 2)

Definition

List of encryption algorithms in their prioritized order.

Coding rules

coded as an array of 7 bytes. Each byte contains a reference to an


encryption algorithm: 1 for A5/1, ... 7 for A5/7.

Mandatory rules

The same encryption algorithm reference cannot be used for two


different priorities

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

List of numbers

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

283 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.122 (ciphering capabilities) - (BTS_CIPH_CAP)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

ciphering capabilities

Logical Name

BTS_CIPH_CAP

Definition

List of flags indicating what are the BTS ciphering capabilities.

Coding rules

Coded as a 8 bits bitmap. Each bit indicates if corresponding


encryption algorithm is supported.bit 1 (LSB) : no encryption. bit 2 :
A5/1. bit 3 : A5/2...bit 8 : A5/7. bit x =0: encryption not supported.
bit x =1: encryption supported

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BTS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

Modifiable

OMC Changes: Displayed(EML) RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Create/Modify/Copy/Move BTS / Additional information

External Comment

Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated here


is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

284 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.123 (Circuit Identity Code) - (CIC)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Circuit Identity Code

Logical Name

CIC

Definition

Circuit Identity Code of an A interface circuit.

Coding rules

Coded over 16 bits: top 11 bits = pcm number, remaining 5 bits =


TS number

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

A ch

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

65535

65535

Modifiable

OMC Changes: displayed(EML) RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

BSS parameters / A interface info

External Comment

Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated here


is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

285 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.124 (DELTA_DEC_HO_MARGIN) - (DELTA_DEC_HO_margin)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

DELTA_DEC_HO_MARGIN

Logical Name

DELTA_DEC_HO_margin

Definition

Correction factor favouring handover cause "Power budget" when


traffic is high in the serving cell and low in neighbour cell(s).

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

24

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

5 dB (5)

Umbrella

5 dB (5)

Concentric

5 dB (5)

Concentric Umbrella

5 dB (5)

Microcell

4 dB (4)

Minicell

5 dB (5)

Extended inner cell

5 dB (5)

Extended outer cell

5 dB (5)

Nb of TRX Dependent

286 / 1182

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.125 (DELTA_INC_HO_MARGIN) - (DELTA_INC_HO_margin)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

DELTA_INC_HO_MARGIN

Logical Name

DELTA_INC_HO_margin

Definition

Correction factor penalizing handover cause "Power budget" when


traffic is low in the serving cell and high in neighbour cell(s).

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

24

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

5 dB (5)

Umbrella

5 dB (5)

Concentric

5 dB (5)

Concentric Umbrella

5 dB (5)

Microcell

4 dB (4)

Minicell

5 dB (5)

Extended inner cell

5 dB (5)

Extended outer cell

5 dB (5)

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

287 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.126 (Directed_Retry) - (EN_DR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Directed_Retry

Logical Name

EN_DR

Definition

This flag enables/disables the execution of Directed Retry.

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: DIR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Directed Retry

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

288 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.127 (DL_DTX_AMR_WB_GMSK) - (DL_DTX_AMR_WB_GMSK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

DL_DTX_AMR_WB_GMSK

Logical Name

DL_DTX_AMR_WB_GMSK

Definition

This flag enables / disables the use of downlink DTX for AMR-WB
GMSK speech calls.

Coding rules

0 : DL DTX for AMR-WB GMSK disabled, 1 : DL DTX for AMR-WB


GMSK enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

The value "1" is recommended when EN_TFO_AMR_WB =1

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

289 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.128 (Downlink DTX) - (DOWNLINK_DTX_ENABLE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Downlink DTX

Logical Name

DOWNLINK_DTX_ENABLE

Definition

This flag defines if downlink DTX is allowed for FR and EFR calls.

Coding rules

0: DTX not allowed, 1: DTX allowed

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

should be enabled when EN_TFO = 1

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

290 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.129 (DOWNLINK_DTX_AMR_FR) - (Downlink_DTX_enable_AMR_FR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

DOWNLINK_DTX_AMR_FR

Logical Name

Downlink_DTX_enable_AMR_FR

Definition

This flag enables / disables the use of downlink DTX for AMR-NB
FR speech calls.

Coding rules

0 : DL DTX for AMR FR disabled, 1 : DL DTX for AMR FR enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / AMR

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

291 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.130 (DOWNLINK_DTX_AMR_HR) - (Downlink_DTX_enable_AMR_HR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

DOWNLINK_DTX_AMR_HR

Logical Name

Downlink_DTX_enable_AMR_HR

Definition

This flag enables / disables the use of downlink DTX for AMR-NB
HR speech calls.

Coding rules

0 : DL DTX for AMR HR disabled, 1 : DL DTX for AMR HR enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / AMR

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

292 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.131 (DOWNLINK_DTX_HR) - (Downlink_DTX_enable_HR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

DOWNLINK_DTX_HR

Logical Name

Downlink_DTX_enable_HR

Definition

This flag enables / disables the use of downlink DTX for HR speech
calls.

Coding rules

0 : DL DTX for HR disabled, 1 : DL DTX for HR enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

should be enabled when EN_TFO = 1

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

293 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.132 (DTX_FR_INDICATOR) - (DTX_INDICATOR_FR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

DTX_FR_INDICATOR

Logical Name

DTX_INDICATOR_FR

Definition

Controls uplink DTX usage for GSM Phase 1 and 2 for FR. Applies
for all codecs types except AMR.

Coding rules

coding rules : 0: MS May Use DTX for FR 1: MS Shall Use DTX for
FR, 2: MS shall not use DTX for FR

Mandatory rules

The following combinations between DTX_INDICATOR_FR /


DTX_INDICATOR_HR are possible (FR/HR):may/shall, may/shall
not, may/may, shall/shall, shall/shall not, shall/may, shall not/shall
and shall not/shall not.The only combination that is NOT allowed is:
DTX_INDICATOR_FR = shall not and DTX_INDICATOR_HR = may,
I.e. shall not/may.

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

OMC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Description

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

294 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.133 (DTX_FR_INDICATOR_AMR) - (DTX_INDICATOR_FR_AMR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

DTX_FR_INDICATOR_AMR

Logical Name

DTX_INDICATOR_FR_AMR

Definition

Controls uplink DTX usage for GSM phase 2 MS. Applies only for
AMR-NB FR.

Coding rules

0: MS May Use DTX for AMR FR 1: MS Shall Use DTX for AMR FR,
2: MS shall not use DTX for AMR FR

Mandatory rules

The following combinations between DTX_INDICATOR_FR_AMR


/ DTX_INDICATOR_HR_AMR are possible (FR_AMR /
HR_AMR):may/shall, may/shall not, may/may, shall/shall, shall/shall
not, shall/may, shall not/shall and shall not/shall not.The only
combination that is NOT allowed is: DTX_INDICATOR_FR_AMR =
shall not and DTX_INDICATOR_HR_AMR = may, I.e. shall not/may.

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

OMC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Description

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

295 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.134 (DTX_HR_INDICATOR) - (DTX_INDICATOR_HR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

DTX_HR_INDICATOR

Logical Name

DTX_INDICATOR_HR

Definition

Controls uplink DTX usage for GSM phase 2 for HR. Applies for all
codecs types except AMR.

Coding rules

0: MS May Use DTX for HR 1: MS Shall Use DTX for HR, 2: MS


shall not use DTX for HR

Mandatory rules

The following combinations between DTX_INDICATOR_FR /


DTX_INDICATOR_HR are possible (FR/HR):may/shall, may/shall
not, may/may, shall/shall, shall/shall not, shall/may, shall not/shall
and shall not/shall not.The only combination that is NOT allowed is:
DTX_INDICATOR_FR = shall not and DTX_INDICATOR_HR = may,
I.e. shall not/may.

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

OMC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Description

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

296 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.135 (DTX_HR_INDICATOR_AMR) - (DTX_INDICATOR_HR_AMR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

DTX_HR_INDICATOR_AMR

Logical Name

DTX_INDICATOR_HR_AMR

Definition

Controls uplink DTX usage for GSM phase 2 MS. Applies only for
AMR-NB HR.

Coding rules

0: MS May Use DTX for AMR HR 1: MS Shall Use DTX for AMR HR,
2: MS shall not use DTX for AMR HR

Mandatory rules

The following combinations between DTX_INDICATOR_FR_AMR


/ DTX_INDICATOR_HR_AMR are possible (FR_AMR /
HR_AMR):may/shall, may/shall not, may/may, shall/shall, shall/shall
not, shall/may, shall not/shall and shall not/shall not.The only
combination that is NOT allowed is: DTX_INDICATOR_FR_AMR =
shall not and DTX_INDICATOR_HR_AMR = may, I.e. shall not/may.

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

OMC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Description

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

297 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.136 (DTX_INDICATOR_SACCH_AMR_WB_GMSK) (DTX_INDICATOR_SACCH_AMR_WB_GMSK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

DTX_INDICATOR_SACCH_AMR_WB_GMSK

Logical Name

DTX_INDICATOR_SACCH_AMR_WB_GMSK

Definition

Controls uplink DTX usage for GSM phase 2 MS. Applies only to
AMR-WB GMSK.

Coding rules

0= the MS may use UL DTX for AMR-WB GMSK, 1= the MS shall


use UL DTX for AMR-WB GMSK, 2=the MS shall not use UL DTX
for AMR-WB GMSK,

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

The value "1" is recommended when EN_TFO_AMR_WB =1

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

298 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.137 (DWELL_TIME_STEP) - (DWELL_TIME_STEP)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

DWELL_TIME_STEP

Logical Name

DWELL_TIME_STEP

Definition

Step value for the modification (increasing or decreasing) of


MIN_DWELL_TIME.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

30

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / HO Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

299 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.138 (EDR_ASSIGN_FAIL_CAUSE) - (EDR_ASSIGN_FAIL_CAUSE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EDR_ASSIGN_FAIL_CAUSE

Logical Name

EDR_ASSIGN_FAIL_CAUSE

Definition

This parameter determines the cause filled in ASSIGNMENT


FAILURE sent in case of External Directed Retry.

Coding rules

coded over 8 bits

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

127

13

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / External Direct retry

External Comment

Default value depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

300 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.139 (EDR_MSG_ORDER) - (EDR_MSG_ORDER)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EDR_MSG_ORDER

Logical Name

EDR_MSG_ORDER

Definition

This parameter determines the order of transmission of


ASSIGNMENT FAILURE and HANDOVER REQUIRED on the A
interface in case of an External Directed Retry.

Coding rules

0: Ass Failure before HO Reqd, 1: Ass Failure after HO Reqd

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / External Direct retry

External Comment

Default value depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

301 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.140 (EDR_QUEUING_MAINTAINED) - (EDR_QUEUING_MAINTAINED)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EDR_QUEUING_MAINTAINED

Logical Name

EDR_QUEUING_MAINTAINED

Definition

This flag indicates whether or not Assignment Request is maintained


in queue during External Directed Retry attempt.

Coding rules

0: Request not maintained in queue, 1: Request maintained in queue

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / External Direct retry

External Comment

Default value depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

302 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.141 (EDR_SEND_ASSIGN_FAIL) - (EDR_SEND_ASSIGN_FAIL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EDR_SEND_ASSIGN_FAIL

Logical Name

EDR_SEND_ASSIGN_FAIL

Definition

This flag indicates whether ASSIGNMENT FAILURE is sent to the


MSC in case of External Directed Retry.

Coding rules

0: Assignment Failure not sent, 1: Assignment Failure sent

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / External Direct retry

External Comment

Default value depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

303 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.142 (EFR_ENABLED) - (EFR_ENABLED)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EFR_ENABLED

Logical Name

EFR_ENABLED

Definition

This flag indicates whether the operation of enhanced full rate (EFR)
is allowed in the cell.

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

304 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.143 (EMERGENCY_CALL) - (EC)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EMERGENCY_CALL

Logical Name

EC

Definition

Indicates if Emergency calls are allowed for all access classes or


only for access classes 11 to 15.

Coding rules

0: all access classes, 1: access classes 11 to 15 only

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

305 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.144 (EN_4_DR_TRE_PER_TCU) - (EN_4_DR_TRE_PER_TCU)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_4_DR_TRE_PER_TCU

Logical Name

EN_4_DR_TRE_PER_TCU

Definition

Defines if the limitation of TRE is static or dynamic. For static


limitation only Nb FR TRE + 2 x DR TRE < 200 is allowed. For
dynamic limitation only Nb TRE < 200 is allowed.

Coding rules

0: static1:dynamic

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

306 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.145 (EN_AMR_CA_FR_HR) - (EN_AMR_CA_FR_HR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_AMR_CA_FR_HR

Logical Name

EN_AMR_CA_FR_HR

Definition

This flag enables/disables intracell HO for AMR-NB channel


adaptation (Handover Cause 27).

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

EN_AMR_CA_FR_HR can be enabled only if {EN_AMR_FR=1 AND


EN_AMR_HR=1}

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

307 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.146 (EN_AMR_CA_HR_FR) - (EN_AMR_CA_HR_FR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_AMR_CA_HR_FR

Logical Name

EN_AMR_CA_HR_FR

Definition

This flag enables/disables intracell HO for AMR-NB channel


adaptation (Handover Cause 26).

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

EN_AMR_CA_HR_FR can be enabled only if {EN_AMR_FR=1 AND


EN_AMR_HR=1}

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

308 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.147 (EN_AMR_FR) - (EN_AMR_FR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_AMR_FR

Logical Name

EN_AMR_FR

Definition

This flag controls whether or not AMR-NB full rate is allowed in the
cell.

Coding rules

0: disabled; 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

309 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.148 (EN_AMR_HR) - (EN_AMR_HR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_AMR_HR

Logical Name

EN_AMR_HR

Definition

This flag controls whether or not AMR-NB half rate is allowed in the
cell.

Coding rules

0: disabled; 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

310 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.149 (EN_AMR_WB_GMSK) - (EN_AMR_WB_GMSK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_AMR_WB_GMSK

Logical Name

EN_AMR_WB_GMSK

Definition

This flag controls whether or not AMR WB GMSK is allowed in the


cell.

Coding rules

0: disabled; 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

In front of non-Evolium cells, the parameter value shall be forced to 0.

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

311 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.150 (EN_BALANCED_CI) - (EN_BALANCED_CI)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_BALANCED_CI

Logical Name

EN_BALANCED_CI

Definition

This flag enables/disables to balance the C/I measure.

Coding rules

0:disable, 1: enable

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X / Description

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

312 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.151 (EN_BETTER_ZONE_HO) - (EN_BETTER_ZONE_HO)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_BETTER_ZONE_HO

Logical Name

EN_BETTER_ZONE_HO

Definition

This flag enables/disables the detection of "too high level in outer


zone" handover cause (cause 13).

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

N/A

Umbrella

N/A

Concentric

enable (1)

Concentric Umbrella

enable (1)

Microcell

N/A

Minicell

N/A

Extended inner cell

N/A

Extended outer cell

N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

313 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.152 (EN_BI-BAND_MS(n)) - (EN_BI-BAND_MS(n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_BI-BAND_MS(n)

Logical Name

EN_BI-BAND_MS(n)

Definition

This flag enables/disables the incoming handovers of bi-band MSs


from the preferred band.

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control (+ Edit External


cell / circuit1/2)

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

314 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.153 (EN_BS_PC) - (EN_BS_PC)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_BS_PC

Logical Name

EN_BS_PC

Definition

This flag enables/disables BS Power Control.

Coding rules

0: disabled1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

315 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.154 (EN_CIRCUIT_GROUP) - (EN_CIRCUIT_GROUP)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_CIRCUIT_GROUP

Logical Name

EN_CIRCUIT_GROUP

Definition

This flag enables/disables the sending of Circuit group messages.

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

316 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.155 (EN_DIST_HO) - (EN_DIST_HO)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_DIST_HO

Logical Name

EN_DIST_HO

Definition

This flag enables/disables the detection of "distance" handover


cause (cause 6).

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Distance

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

enable (1)

Umbrella

enable (1)

Concentric

enable (1)

Concentric Umbrella

enable (1)

Microcell

disable (0)

Minicell

enable (1)

Extended inner cell

enable (1)

Extended outer cell

enable (1)

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

317 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.156 (EN_EDR) - (EN_EXT_DR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_EDR

Logical Name

EN_EXT_DR

Definition

This flag enables/disables the Outgoing External Directed Retry


procedure.

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

EN_EXT_DR should be set to enable when EN_TCH_PREEMPT is


set to enable.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / External Direct retry

External Comment

For external directed retries, the serving BSC does not know whether
or not the external target cells (towards which the directed retry
is triggered) are congested. Therefore, Alcatel recommend to set
RESP_REQ to 1 if EN_EDR is enabled in order to get a Handover
Reject message from the MSC in case all target cells are congested
and thus to attempt other procedures.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

318 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.157 (EN_EXT_MEAS_REP) - (EN_EXT_MEAS_REP)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_EXT_MEAS_REP

Logical Name

EN_EXT_MEAS_REP

Definition

This flag enables/disables the extended measurement reporting for


Mobile Assisted Frequency Allocation.

Coding rules

0: disabled; 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / RMS & MAFA

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

319 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.158 (EN_FAST_TRAFFIC_HO) - (EN_FAST_TRAFFIC_HO)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_FAST_TRAFFIC_HO

Logical Name

EN_FAST_TRAFFIC_HO

Definition

This flag enables/disables the use of Fast traffic handovers.

Coding rules

0: disabled; 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO Parameters / General HO Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

320 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.159 (EN_FORCED_DR) - (EN_FORCED_DR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_FORCED_DR

Logical Name

EN_FORCED_DR

Definition

This flag enables/disables the "Forced Directed Retry" handover


cause detection.

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Directed Retry

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

321 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.160 (EN_GAN_HO) - (EN_GAN_HO)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_GAN_HO

Logical Name

EN_GAN_HO

Definition

This flag enables/disables the handover to GAN

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

322 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.161 (EN_GENERAL_CAPTURE_HO) - (EN_GENERAL_CAPTURE_HO)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_GENERAL_CAPTURE_HO

Logical Name

EN_GENERAL_CAPTURE_HO

Definition

This flag enables/disables the detection of "general capture"


handover cause (cause 24).

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Hierarchical and Multiband HO ctrl

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

323 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.162 (EN_HSL) - (EN_HSL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_HSL

Logical Name

EN_HSL

Definition

Enables SS7 HSL (High speed Signalling Link).

Coding rules

0: HSL disabled1: HSL enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Changeable on the BSC terminal.if EN_HSL = 1 the following


new Q703 parameters:Q703_N1_HSL, Q_703_N2_HSL,
Q703_T1_HSL, Q703_T4E_HSL and Q703_T4N_HSLreplaces
the old ones:Q703_N1, Q_703_N2, Q703_T1, Q703_T4E and
Q703_T4N.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

324 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.163 (EN_IMM_ASS_REJ) - (EN_IM_ASS_REJ)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_IMM_ASS_REJ

Logical Name

EN_IM_ASS_REJ

Definition

This flag indicates if the Immediate Assignment Reject procedure


is enabled.

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment

This parameter is only valid for circuit switched traffic. For packet
traffic (GPRS or EGPRS) sending of IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT
REJECT messages cannot be disabled.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

325 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.164 (EN_INCOMING_HO) - (EN_IC_HO)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_INCOMING_HO

Logical Name

EN_IC_HO

Definition

This flag enables/disables incoming handovers in the cell.

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

326 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.165 (EN_INTERBAND_HO) - (EN_INTERBAND_NEIGH)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_INTERBAND_HO

Logical Name

EN_INTERBAND_NEIGH

Definition

This flag enables / disables the multiband operation by filtering the


sending of SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 2ter/5ter.

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / HO Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

327 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.166 (EN_INTRA_DL) - (EN_INTRA_DL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_INTRA_DL

Logical Name

EN_INTRA_DL

Definition

This flag enables/disables the detection of "intracell downlink"


handover cause (cause 16) for non AMR calls.

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

328 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.167 (EN_INTRA_DL_AMR) - (EN_INTRA_DL_AMR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_INTRA_DL_AMR

Logical Name

EN_INTRA_DL_AMR

Definition

This flag enables/disables the detection of "intracell downlink"


handover cause (cause 16) for AMR-NB calls.

Coding rules

0: disable, 1: enable

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

It is recommended to disable this intracell uplink handover when


frequency hopping is applied

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

329 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.168 (EN_INTRA_DL_AMR_WB_GMSK) (EN_INTRA_DL_AMR_WB_GMSK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_INTRA_DL_AMR_WB_GMSK

Logical Name

EN_INTRA_DL_AMR_WB_GMSK

Definition

This flag enables/disables the detection of "intracell downlink"


handover cause (cause 16)

Coding rules

0: disable, 1: enable

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

It is recommended to disable this intracell uplink handover when


frequency hopping is applied.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

330 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.169 (EN_INTRA_UL) - (EN_INTRA_UL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_INTRA_UL

Logical Name

EN_INTRA_UL

Definition

This flag enables/disables the detection of "intracell uplink" handover


cause (cause 15) for non AMR calls.

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

331 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.170 (EN_INTRA_UL_AMR) - (EN_INTRA_UL_AMR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_INTRA_UL_AMR

Logical Name

EN_INTRA_UL_AMR

Definition

This flag enables/disables the detection of "intracell uplink" handover


cause (cause 15) for AMR-NB calls.

Coding rules

0: disable, 1: enable

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

It is recommended to disable this intracell uplink handover when


frequency hopping is applied

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

332 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.171 (EN_INTRA_UL_AMR_WB_GMSK) (EN_INTRA_UL_AMR_WB_GMSK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_INTRA_UL_AMR_WB_GMSK

Logical Name

EN_INTRA_UL_AMR_WB_GMSK

Definition

This flag enables/disables the detection of "intracell uplink" handover


cause (cause 15) for AMR-WB GMSK calls.

Coding rules

0: disable, 1: enable

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

It is recommended to disable this intracell uplink handover when


frequency hopping is applied.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

333 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.172 (EN_INTRACELL_REPEATED) - (EN_INTRACELL_REPEATED)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_INTRACELL_REPEATED

Logical Name

EN_INTRACELL_REPEATED

Definition

This flag enables/disables the repetition of intracell handover


attempts.

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

334 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.173 (EN_LOAD_BALANCE) - (EN_LOAD_BALANCE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_LOAD_BALANCE

Logical Name

EN_LOAD_BALANCE

Definition

Flag to enable/disable the balancing of load between the inner and


outer zone of a multiband cell.

Coding rules

0: disabled; 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

EN_LOAD_BALANCE & EN_LOAD_OUTER should not be both


"Enabled".

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell /HO Parameters / Hierarchical & Multiband HO Control

External Comment

EN_LOAD_BALANCE significant only if EN_BETTER_ZONE_HO


is enabled

Cell Type Dependent

Single

N/A

Umbrella

N/A

Concentric

disable (0)

Concentric Umbrella

disable (0)

Microcell

N/A

Minicell

N/A

Extended inner cell

N/A

Extended outer cell

N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

335 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.174 (EN_LOAD_ORDER) - (EN_LOAD_ORDER)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_LOAD_ORDER

Logical Name

EN_LOAD_ORDER

Definition

This flag indicates whether or not traffic load has to be taken into
account when setting up the list of target cells.

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

336 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.175 (EN_MA_SELECTION) - (EN_MA_SELECTION)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_MA_SELECTION

Logical Name

EN_MA_SELECTION

Definition

This flag enables/disables channel selection according to Mobile


Allocation criterion.

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

337 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.176 (EN_MCHO_H_DL) - (EN_MCHO_H_DL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_MCHO_H_DL

Logical Name

EN_MCHO_H_DL

Definition

This flag enables/disables the detection of "level downlink micro-cell"


handover cause (cause 18).

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO Parameters / Lower Layer HO Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

disable (0) *

Umbrella

disable (0) *

Concentric

disable (0) *

Concentric Umbrella

disable (0) *

Microcell

enable (1)

Minicell

disable (0) *

Extended inner cell

disable (0) *

Extended outer cell

disable (0) *

Nb of TRX Dependent

338 / 1182

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.177 (EN_MCHO_H_UL) - (EN_MCHO_H_UL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_MCHO_H_UL

Logical Name

EN_MCHO_H_UL

Definition

This flag enables/disables the detection of "level uplink mirco-cell "


handover cause (cause 17).

Coding rules

0: disabled1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Lower Layer HO Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

disable (0) *

Umbrella

disable (0) *

Concentric

disable (0) *

Concentric Umbrella

disable (0) *

Microcell

enable (1)

Minicell

disable (0) *

Extended inner cell

disable (0) *

Extended outer cell

disable (0) *

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

339 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.178 (EN_MCHO_NCELL) - (EN_MCHO_NCELL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_MCHO_NCELL

Logical Name

EN_MCHO_NCELL

Definition

This flag enables/disables the detection of "high level in neighbour


lower or indoor cell" handover cause (cause 14).

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

In a lower layer cell, the flag shall be disabled if there is no indoor


layer.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Hierarchical and multiband HO Ctrl

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

disable (0) *

Umbrella

enable (1)

Concentric

disable (0) *

Concentric Umbrella

enable (1)

Microcell

disable (0)

Minicell

disable (0)

Extended inner cell

disable (0) *

Extended outer cell

disable (0) *

Nb of TRX Dependent

340 / 1182

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.179 (EN_MCHO_RESCUE) - (EN_MCHO_RESCUE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_MCHO_RESCUE

Logical Name

EN_MCHO_RESCUE

Definition

This flag enables/disables the detection of "consecutive bad SACCH


frames" handover cause (cause 7).

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO Parameters / Lower Layer HO Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

disable (0) *

Umbrella

disable (0) *

Concentric

disable (0) *

Concentric Umbrella

disable (0) *

Microcell

enable (1)

Minicell

disable (0) *

Extended inner cell

disable (0) *

Extended outer cell

disable (0) *

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

341 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.180 (EN_MS_PC) - (EN_MS_PC)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_MS_PC

Logical Name

EN_MS_PC

Definition

This flag enables/disables MS Power Control.

Coding rules

0: disabled1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

342 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.181 (EN_MULTIBAND_PBGT_HO) - (EN_MULTIBAND_PBGT_HO)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_MULTIBAND_PBGT_HO

Logical Name

EN_MULTIBAND_PBGT_HO

Definition

This flag enables/disables the power budget handovers Cause 12


and the traffic handovers Cause 23 between cells belonging to
different frequency bands.

Coding rules

0 : function disabled, 1 : function enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

343 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.182 (EN_PBGT_FILTERING) - (EN_PBGT_FILTERING)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_PBGT_FILTERING

Logical Name

EN_PBGT_FILTERING

Definition

This flag enables/disables filtering of candidate neighbour cells on


HO_MARGIN_DIST/LEV/QUAL criterion.

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

This parameter must be set to disabled in case of extended cell

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

enable (1)

Umbrella

enable (1)

Concentric

enable (1)

Concentric Umbrella

enable (1)

Microcell

disable (0)

Minicell

enable (1)

Extended inner cell

disable (0)

Extended outer cell

disable (0)

Nb of TRX Dependent

344 / 1182

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.183 (EN_PBGT_HO) - (EN_PBGT_HO)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_PBGT_HO

Logical Name

EN_PBGT_HO

Definition

This flag enables/disables the detection of "power budget" handover


cause (cause 12).

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

345 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.184 (EN_PREFERRED_BAND_HO) - (EN_PREFERRED_BAND_HO)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_PREFERRED_BAND_HO

Logical Name

EN_PREFERRED_BAND_HO

Definition

This flag enables/disables the detection of handover cause 21 (high


level in neighbour cell in the preferred band).

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Hierarchical and multiband HO Ctrl

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

346 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.185 (EN_PRIORITY_ORDERING) - (EN_PRIORITY_ORDERING)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_PRIORITY_ORDERING

Logical Name

EN_PRIORITY_ORDERING

Definition

This flag enables/disables the use of the parameter PRIORITY(0,n)


in the candidate cell evaluation process.

Coding rules

0: Priority(0,n) not taken into account, 1: Priority(0,n) taken into


account

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

347 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.186 (EN_RADIOLINK_RECOVERY) - (EN_RL_RECOV)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_RADIOLINK_RECOVERY

Logical Name

EN_RL_RECOV

Definition

This flag enables/disables the Radio Link Recovery procedure.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / PC parameters / Radio Link Supervision

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

enable (1)

Umbrella

enable (1)

Concentric

enable (1)

Concentric Umbrella

enable (1)

Microcell

enable (1)

Minicell

enable (1)

Extended inner cell

enable (1)

Extended outer cell

enable (1)

Nb of TRX Dependent

348 / 1182

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.187 (EN_RESCUE_UMBRELLA) - (EN_RESCUE_UM)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_RESCUE_UMBRELLA

Logical Name

EN_RESCUE_UM

Definition

This flag determines if emergency handovers are directed


preferentially to umbrella cells.

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled, 2: indefinite

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Hierarchical and multiband HO Ctrl

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

N/A

Umbrella

N/A

Concentric

N/A

Concentric Umbrella

N/A

Microcell

enable (1)

Minicell

disable (0)

Extended inner cell

N/A

Extended outer cell

N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

349 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.188 (EN_RETURN_CS_ZONE_HO) - (EN_RETURN_CS_ZONE_HO)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_RETURN_CS_ZONE_HO

Logical Name

EN_RETURN_CS_ZONE_HO

Definition

Flag enabling the intracell handovers allowing to move TCH from the
PS zone to the CS zone of PDCH/TCH allocation

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

350 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.189 (EN_RXLEV_DL) - (EN_RXLEV_DL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_RXLEV_DL

Logical Name

EN_RXLEV_DL

Definition

This flag enables/disables the detection of "level downlink" handover


cause (cause 5).

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

351 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.190 (EN_RXLEV_UL) - (EN_RXLEV_UL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_RXLEV_UL

Logical Name

EN_RXLEV_UL

Definition

This flag enables/disables the detection of "level uplink" handover


cause (cause 3).

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

352 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.191 (EN_RXQUAL_DL) - (EN_RXQUAL_DL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_RXQUAL_DL

Logical Name

EN_RXQUAL_DL

Definition

This flag enables/disables the detection of "quality downlink"


handover cause (cause 4).

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

353 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.192 (EN_RXQUAL_UL) - (EN_RXQUAL_UL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_RXQUAL_UL

Logical Name

EN_RXQUAL_UL

Definition

This flag enables/disables the detection of "quality uplink" handover


cause (cause 2).

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

354 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.193 (EN_SEND_OLD_CHAN_MODE) - (EN_SEND_OLD_CHAN_MODE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_SEND_OLD_CHAN_MODE

Logical Name

EN_SEND_OLD_CHAN_MODE

Definition

This flag controls "Current channel" OIE inclusion in HANDOVER


REQUIRED.

Coding rules

0: IE is not included, 1: IE is included

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / HO Control

External Comment

Default value depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

355 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.194 (EN_SEND_SPEECH_VER) - (EN_SEND_SPEECH_VER)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_SEND_SPEECH_VER

Logical Name

EN_SEND_SPEECH_VER

Definition

This flag controls "Speech version (used)" OIE inclusion in


HANDOVER REQUIRED.

Coding rules

0: IE is not included, 1: IE is included

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / HO Control

External Comment

Default value depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

356 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.195 (EN_SOLSA) - (EN_SOLSA)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_SOLSA

Logical Name

EN_SOLSA

Definition

This flag enables / disables SoLSA feature.

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

May be set to Enabled only if BCCH_EXT=TRUE.

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 3/3

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

357 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.196 (EN_SOLSA) - (EN_SOLSA(n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_SOLSA

Logical Name

EN_SOLSA(n)

Definition

This flag enables / disables SoLSA feature.

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit External Cell / Circuit 2/2

External Comment

This parameter is for every cell. The operator needs only to configure
the value of that parameter for OMC external cells ; the parameter
is autonomously filled by the OMC in case the adjacent cell is an
OMC internal cell.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

358 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.197 (EN_SPEED_DISCRIMINATION) - (EN_SPEED_DISC)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_SPEED_DISCRIMINATION

Logical Name

EN_SPEED_DISC

Definition

This flag enables/disables the speed discrimination process.

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Hierarchical and multiband HO Ctrl

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

disable (0) *

Umbrella

disable (0)

Concentric

disable (0) *

Concentric Umbrella

disable (0)

Microcell

disable (0)

Minicell

disable (0)

Extended inner cell

disable (0) *

Extended outer cell

disable (0) *

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

359 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.198 (EN_TCH_PREEMPT) - (EN_TCH_PREEMPT)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_TCH_PREEMPT

Logical Name

EN_TCH_PREEMPT

Definition

This flag enables/disables the TCH/VGCH pre-emption feature. If


enabled, a point-to-point or voice group call with the pvi (pre-emption
vulnerability indication) bit set might be pre-empted for a point-to-point
or voice group call that has the pci (pre-emption capability indication)
bit set if the concerned cell is in congestion state.

Coding rules

0:disabled, 1:enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

- EN_EXT_DR should be set to enable when EN_TCH_PREEMPT is


set to enable.- If EN_VGCS = enabled , then Alcatel recommends to
set EN_TCH_PREEMPT to enabled, otherwise to set the value of
MIN_VGCS_TS to a value greater or equal to 2.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / Gen. Timers & Proc.

External Comment

In case one or more TCHs have been reserved for emergency


handovers (NUM_TCH_EGNCY_HO > 0) in the concerned cell,
the BSC will first try to use one of these resources before actually
releasing an ongoing call with lower priority and the pvi bit set.In
case the cell is congested, if EN_TCH_PREEMPT is enabled and
the MSC does not allow the queing, the BSC will queue an incoming
point-to-point request with pre-emption capability indicator set during
at most T11_forced seconds for a normal assignment or during at
most T_qho seconds for an handover request. For the voice group
call request, the BSC will follow the MSC indicator.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

360 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.199 (EN_TFO) - (EN_TFO)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_TFO

Logical Name

EN_TFO

Definition

This flag enables/ disables TFO function for FR, EFR and HR codecs.

Coding rules

0: disabled; 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

361 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.200 (EN_TFO_AMR_WB) - (EN_TFO_AMR_WB)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_TFO_AMR_WB

Logical Name

EN_TFO_AMR_WB

Definition

This flag enables/ disables TFO function for AMR-WB codec.

Coding rules

0: disabled; 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

362 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.201 (EN_TFO_MATCH) - (EN_TFO_MATCH)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_TFO_MATCH

Logical Name

EN_TFO_MATCH

Definition

This flag enables/disables TFO codec mismatch resolution function


(for FR, EFR, AMR-WB and HR codecs).

Coding rules

0: disabled; 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

may be set to 1 only if EN_TFO=1or if EN_TFO_AMR_WB=1May be


set to 0 only if EN_TFO_OPT = 0

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

363 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.202 (EN_TFO_OPT) - (EN_TFO_OPT)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_TFO_OPT

Logical Name

EN_TFO_OPT

Definition

This flag enables/disables TFO codec optimisation function.

Coding rules

0: disabled; 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

may be set to 1 only if EN_TFO_MATCH=1

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

364 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.203 (EN_TRAFFIC_HO) - (EN_TRAFFIC_HO(0,n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_TRAFFIC_HO

Logical Name

EN_TRAFFIC_HO(0,n)

Definition

This flag enables/disables the detection of "traffic" handover cause


(cause 23).

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Adjacencies

External Comment

As the traffic load of cells external to the BSC is unknown,


no HO cause 23 will be triggered towards these cells, even if
EN_TRAFFIC_HO = 1.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

365 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.204 (EN_UNEQUIPPED_CIRCUIT) - (EN_UNEQUIPPED_CIRCUIT)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_UNEQUIPPED_CIRCUIT

Logical Name

EN_UNEQUIPPED_CIRCUIT

Definition

This flag enables/disables the sending of UNEQUIPPED CIRCUIT


message.

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment

Default value depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

366 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.205 (EXT_HO_FORCED) - (EXT_HO_FORCED)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EXT_HO_FORCED

Logical Name

EXT_HO_FORCED

Definition

This flag, when set, forces internal intercell handovers to be executed


as external HO.

Coding rules

0: BSC performs internal HO, 1: MSC performs internal HO

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

367 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.206 (Extended CBCH) - (Use_of_Extended_CBCH)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Extended CBCH

Logical Name

Use_of_Extended_CBCH

Definition

This flag indicates if the extended CBCH is used.

Coding rules

0: not used, 1: used

Mandatory rules

shall be set to "No" when SMSCB_FEATURE_SET="FS1"can be


changed only when SMSCB_STATE="inactive"

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / SMSCB

External Comment

Default value correspond to SMSCB_FEATURE_SET = FS1.If


SMSCB_FEATURE_SET = FS2, Use_of_Extended_CBCH should
be set to "Yes".

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

368 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.207 (FORBID_AMR_NS) - (FORBID_AMR_NS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

FORBID_AMR_NS

Logical Name

FORBID_AMR_NS

Definition

Flag to forbid / allow AMR noise suppressor in the MS.

Coding rules

0: the MS can use AMR NS, 1: the MS shall not use AMR NS.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / AMR

External Comment

Significant only if EN_AMR_FR, EN_AMR_HR or


EN_AMR_WB_GMSK is set to TRUE.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

369 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.208 (FORBID_DTXD_NH_BCCH_F) - (FORBID_DTXD_NH_BCCH_F)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

FORBID_DTXD_NH_BCCH_F

Logical Name

FORBID_DTXD_NH_BCCH_F

Definition

Forbid use of downlink DTX on non hopping TCH of the BCCH TRX.

Coding rules

0 : DTX DL on non-hopping BCCH TRX is allowed; 1 : DTX DL on


non-hopping BCCH TRX is forbidden

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / General timers and procedures

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

370 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.209 (Force TFO versus AMR) - (FORCE_TFO_VS_AMR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Force TFO versus AMR

Logical Name

FORCE_TFO_VS_AMR

Definition

Flag to enable/disable the basic functions of Tandem Free Operation


(TFO) for GSM FR SV1, FR SV2 and HR SV1 codec types when the
current codec is AMR-NB FR or AMR-NB HR.

Coding rules

0: disabled (no TFO negotiation if AMR used); 1: enabled (TFO


negotiation will start even if AMR used)

Mandatory rules

FORCE_TFO_VS_AMR = 1 only if EN_TFO=1

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment

FORCE_TFO_VS_AMR relevant only if (EN_AMR_FR = 1) OR


(EN_AMR_HR = 1)

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

371 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.210 (Forced_Queuing) - (QUEUE_ANYWAY)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Forced_Queuing

Logical Name

QUEUE_ANYWAY

Definition

This flag enables/disables forced queuing for Assignment requests


when queuing is not allowed by the MSC.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

372 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.211 (Forward_CM_3) - (EN_SEND_CM3)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Forward_CM_3

Logical Name

EN_SEND_CM3

Definition

This flag enables/disables sending of "Classmark 3" IE to the MSC.

Coding rules

0: Disabled, 1: Enabled

Mandatory rules

EN_SEND_CM3 and STRIP_O5_CM2 shall not be both set to 1 at


the same time.

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment

The value of this parameter depends on whether the MSC supports


the MS classmark 3 IE or not: if the MSC supports the MS classmark
3 IE then the parameter shall be set to "1", otherwise the parameter
shall be set to "0".

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

373 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.212 (Free_Factor_1) - (Freefactor_1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Free_Factor_1

Logical Name

Freefactor_1

Definition

Correction factor used in the cell evaluation process to take into


account the number of free TCHs in the candidate cell.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Freefactor_1 <= Freefactor_2

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-16

16

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

374 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.213 (Free_Factor_2) - (Freefactor_2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Free_Factor_2

Logical Name

Freefactor_2

Definition

Correction factor used in the cell evaluation process to take into


account the number of free TCHs in the candidate cell.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Freefactor_1 <= Freefactor_2 <= Freefactor_3

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-16

16

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

375 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.214 (Free_Factor_3) - (Freefactor_3)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Free_Factor_3

Logical Name

Freefactor_3

Definition

Correction factor used in the cell evaluation process to take into


account the number of free TCHs in the candidate cell.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Freefactor_2 <= Freefactor_3 <= Freefactor_4

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-16

16

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

376 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.215 (Free_Factor_4) - (Freefactor_4)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Free_Factor_4

Logical Name

Freefactor_4

Definition

Correction factor used in the cell evaluation process to take into


account the number of free TCHs in the candidate cell.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Freefactor_3 <= Freefactor_4 <= Freefactor_5

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-16

16

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

377 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.216 (Free_Factor_5) - (Freefactor_5)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Free_Factor_5

Logical Name

Freefactor_5

Definition

Correction factor used in the cell evaluation process to take into


account the number of free TCHs in the candidate cell.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Freefactor_5 >= Freefactor_4

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-16

16

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

378 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.217 (Free_Level_1) - (Freelevel_1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Free_Level_1

Logical Name

Freelevel_1

Definition

Boundary on free TCH number for determination of Freefactor of


the cell.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Freelevel_1 < Freelevel_2

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent
t01

t02

t03

t04

t05

t06

t07

t08

t09

t010

t011

t012

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

379 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.218 (Free_Level_2) - (Freelevel_2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Free_Level_2

Logical Name

Freelevel_2

Definition

Boundary on free TCH number for determination of Freefactor of


the cell.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Freelevel_3 > Freelevel_2 > Freelevel_1

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent
t01

t02

t03

t04

t05

t06

t07

t08

t09

t010

t011

t012

10

12

13

14

16

17

380 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.219 (Free_Level_3) - (Freelevel_3)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Free_Level_3

Logical Name

Freelevel_3

Definition

Boundary on free TCH number for determination of Freefactor of


the cell.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Freelevel_4 > Freelevel_3 > Freelevel_2

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent
t01

t02

t03

t04

t05

t06

t07

t08

t09

t010

t011

t012

10

12

14

17

20

23

26

28

31

34

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

381 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.220 (Free_Level_4) - (Freelevel_4)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Free_Level_4

Logical Name

Freelevel_4

Definition

Boundary on free TCH number for determination of Freefactor of


the cell.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Freelevel_4 > Freelevel_3

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent
t01

t02

t03

t04

t05

t06

t07

t08

t09

t010

t011

t012

12

15

21

26

30

34

38

42

47

51

382 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.221 (Free_Level_DR) - (Freelevel_DR(n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Free_Level_DR

Logical Name

Freelevel_DR(n)

Definition

Minimum number of free TCHs in neighbour cell n to allow forced


directed retry to cell n.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Freelevel_DR > N_TCH_HO

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: DIR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Directed Retry (+ Edit External cell /


circuit1/2)

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

See TRXnb

Umbrella

See TRXnb

Concentric

See TRXnb

Concentric Umbrella

See TRXnb

Microcell

See TRXnb

Minicell

See TRXnb

Extended inner cell

255 *

Extended outer cell

255 *

Nb of TRX Dependent
t01

t02

t03

t04

t05

t06

t07

t08

t09

t010

t011

t012

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

383 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.222 (FREQUENCY_RANGE) - (FREQUENCY_RANGE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

FREQUENCY_RANGE

Logical Name

FREQUENCY_RANGE

Definition

This parameter indicates the frequency range of the cell.

Coding rules

0: PGSM (GSM 900), 1: DCS 1800, 2: EGSM, 3: DCS 1900, 4:


PGSM-DCS1800, 5: EGSM-DCS1800, 6: GSM 850, 7..255: for
future use. The parameter shall be coded over 8 bits as a provision
for future frequency bands support.

Mandatory rules

- if FREQUENCY_RANGE = "GSM-DCS" then


CELL_PARTITION_TYPE must be equal to "Concentric" .The "micro concentric", "mini concentric" and "indoor concentric"
cells must be multiband (the allowed FREQUENCY_RANGE is
"PGSM-DCS1800" or "EGSM-DCS1800"). This restriction does not
apply to the external cells.- The frequency range of an extended inner
cell has to be the same as the frequency range of the corresponding
extended outer cell, where PGSM (0) and EGSM (2) are here
considered as belonging to the same frequency range.The OMC-R
checks the consistency between the setting of FREQUENCY_RANGE
and PLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS parameters:- At cell creationWhen the value of FREQUENCY_RANGE parameter
is modified.However, no check is performed when the
PLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS is modified.Only the following values
of the FREQUENCY_RANGE parameter are allowed depending
on the value of the PLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS parameter:FREQUENCY_RANGE = "PGSM (GSM900)" or "EGSM (GSM900)"
or "DCS1800" or "PGSM-DCS1800" or "EGSM-DCS1800" if the
PLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS is set to "GSM900 and DCS1800
bands",- FREQUENCY_RANGE = "GSM850" or "DCS1800" if the
PLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS is set to "GSM850 and DCS1800
bands",- FREQUENCY_RANGE = "GSM850" or "DCS1900" if the
PLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS is set to "GSM850 and DCS1900
bands",- FREQUENCY_RANGE = "PGSM (GSM900)" or "EGSM
(GSM900)" or "DCS1900" if the PLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS is set
to "GSM900 and DCS1900 bands".

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

384 / 1182

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes:


SEL/PAG/RRM/HPC/HOC/DIR/GPR

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Description (+ Edit External cell / circuit1/2)

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

385 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.223 (FREQUENCY_RANGE) - (FREQUENCY_RANGE(n)(MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

FREQUENCY_RANGE

Logical Name

FREQUENCY_RANGE(n)(MFS)

Definition

This parameter indicates the frequency range of the adjacent cell


(GAN cell excluded).

Coding rules

0: PGSM (GSM 900), 1: DCS 1800, 2: EGSM, 3: DCS 1900, 4:


PGSM-DCS1800, 5: EGSM-DCS1800, 6: GSM 850, 7..255: for
future use. The parameter shall be coded over 8 bits as a provision
for future frequency bands support.

Mandatory rules

- If FREQUENCY_RANGE(n) = "GSM-DCS" then


CELL_PARTITION_TYPE(n) must be equal to "Concentric". The "micro concentric", "mini concentric" and "indoor concentric"
cells must be multiband (the allowed FREQUENCY_RANGE(n) is
"PGSM-DCS1800" or "EGSM-DCS1800"). This restriction does not
apply to the external cells.- The frequency range of an extended inner
cell has to be the same as the frequency range of the corresponding
extended outer cell, where PGSM (0) and EGSM (2) are here
considered as belonging to the same frequency range.

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit external cell / circuit 1/2

External Comment

Within the same PLMN, the FREQUENCY_RANGE parameter of a


given cell shall be selected among one of the following values:- PGSM
(GSM900) or EGSM (GSM900) or DCS1800 or PGSM-DCS1800
or EGSM-DCS1800 if the PLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS is set
to "GSM900 and DCS1800 bands",- GSM850 or DCS1800 if the
PLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS is set to "GSM850 and DCS1800
bands",- GSM850 or DCS1900 if the PLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS
is set to "GSM850 and DCS1900 bands.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

386 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.224 (FREQUENCY_RANGE) - (FREQUENCY_RANGE(n)(OMC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

FREQUENCY_RANGE

Logical Name

FREQUENCY_RANGE(n)(OMC)

Definition

This parameter indicates the frequency range of the adjacent cell


(internal or external to the OMC).

Coding rules

0: PGSM (GSM 900), 1: DCS 1800, 2: EGSM, 3: DCS 1900, 4:


PGSM-DCS1800, 5: EGSM-DCS1800, 6: GSM 850, 7: GAN,
8..255: for future use. The parameter shall be coded over 8 bits as a
provision for future frequency bands support.

Mandatory rules

- if FREQUENCY_RANGE = "GSM-DCS" then


CELL_PARTITION_TYPE must be equal to "Concentric" .if FREQUENCY_RANGE = "GAN" then CELL_RANGE must
be equal to "GAN"- the value GAN is only allowed for the
OMC external cells- The "micro concentric", "mini concentric"
and "indoor concentric" cells must be multiband (the allowed
FREQUENCY_RANGE is "PGSM-DCS1800" or "EGSM-DCS1800").
This restriction does not apply to the external cells.- The
frequency range of an extended inner cell has to be the same
as the frequency range of the corresponding extended outer
cell, where PGSM (0) and EGSM (2) are here considered as
belonging to the same frequency range.The OMC-R checks
the consistency between the setting of FREQUENCY_RANGE
and PLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS parameters:- At cell
creation- When the value of FREQUENCY_RANGE parameter
is modified.However, no check is performed when the
PLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS is modified.Only the following values
of the FREQUENCY_RANGE parameter are allowed depending
on the value of the PLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS parameter:FREQUENCY_RANGE = "PGSM (GSM900)" or "EGSM (GSM900)"
or "DCS1800" or "PGSM-DCS1800" or "EGSM-DCS1800" if the
PLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS is set to "GSM900 and DCS1800
bands",- FREQUENCY_RANGE = "GSM850" or "DCS1800" if the
PLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS is set to "GSM850 and DCS1800
bands",- FREQUENCY_RANGE = "GSM850" or "DCS1900" if the
PLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS is set to "GSM850 and DCS1900
bands",- FREQUENCY_RANGE = "PGSM (GSM900)" or "EGSM
(GSM900)" or "DCS1900" if the PLMN_FREQUENCY_BANDS is set
to "GSM900 and DCS1900 bands".

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

OMC

Instance

cell

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

387 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Value "7" exists only starting from MR2.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

388 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.225 (GSM_PHASE) - (GSM_PHASE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

GSM_PHASE

Logical Name

GSM_PHASE

Definition

This flag indicates the GSM Phase used by the BSC to format
messages towards the MSC.

Coding rules

0: GSM Phase 1, 1: GSM Phase 2

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment

Default value depends on MSC type.The value indicated here is for


implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

389 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.226 (H_LOAD_OBJ) - (H_LOAD_OBJ)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

H_LOAD_OBJ

Logical Name

H_LOAD_OBJ

Definition

High threshold on busy TCH timeslots percentage to reduce


MIN_DWELL_TIME variable.

Coding rules

step size = 10%

Mandatory rules

H_LOAD_OBJ >= L_LOAD_OBJ

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

80

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Hierarchical and multiband HO Ctrl

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

N/A

Umbrella

See TRXnb

Concentric

N/A

Concentric Umbrella

See TRXnb

Microcell

N/A

Minicell

N/A

Extended inner cell

N/A

Extended outer cell

N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent
t01

t02

t03

t04

t05

t06

t07

t08

t09

t010

t011

t012

80

80

80

80

80

80

80

80

80

80

80

80

390 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.227 (H_MIN_DWELL_TIME) - (H_MIN_DWELL_TIME)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

H_MIN_DWELL_TIME

Logical Name

H_MIN_DWELL_TIME

Definition

Maximum allowed value for MIN_DWELL_TIME variable.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

H_MIN_DWELL_TIME >= L_MIN_DWELL_TIME

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

120

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / HO Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

391 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.228 (High Priority Access Class Ordering P1) (AC_PRIORITY_LIST(priority=1))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

High Priority Access Class Ordering P1

Logical Name

AC_PRIORITY_LIST(priority=1)

Definition

List of access classes 11..15 and EC (=10) in their priority order.

Coding rules

Priority 1 is the highest priority, Priority 6 is the lowest priority, 10


(EC) is coded as 5, 11 (access class 11) is coded as 0, 12 (access
class 12) is coded as 1, 13 (access class 13) is coded as 2, 14
(access class 14) is coded as 3, 15 (access class 15) is coded as 4.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

10

15

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / Overload and Barring

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

392 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.229 (High Priority Access Class Ordering P2) (AC_PRIORITY_LIST(priority=2))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

High Priority Access Class Ordering P2

Logical Name

AC_PRIORITY_LIST(priority=2)

Definition

List of access classes 11..15 and EC (=10) in their priority order.

Coding rules

Priority 1 is the highest priority, Priority 6 is the lowest priority 10 (EC)


is coded as 5, 11 (access class 11) is coded as 0, 12 (access class
12) is coded as 1, 13 (access class 13) is coded as 2, 14 (access
class 14) is coded as 3, 15 (access class 15) is coded as 4.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

10

15

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / Overload and Barring

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

393 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.230 (High Priority Access Class Ordering P3) (AC_PRIORITY_LIST(priority=3))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

High Priority Access Class Ordering P3

Logical Name

AC_PRIORITY_LIST(priority=3)

Definition

List of access classes 11..15 and EC (=10) in their priority order.

Coding rules

Priority 1 is the highest priority, Priority 6 is the lowest priority10 (EC)


is coded as 5, 11 (access class 11) is coded as 0, 12 (access class
12) is coded as 1, 13 (access class 13) is coded as 2, 14 (access
class 14) is coded as 3, 15 (access class 15) is coded as 4.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

10

15

14

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / Overload and Barring

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

394 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.231 (High Priority Access Class Ordering P4) (AC_PRIORITY_LIST(priority=4))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

High Priority Access Class Ordering P4

Logical Name

AC_PRIORITY_LIST(priority=4)

Definition

List of access classes 11..15 and EC (=10) in their priority order.

Coding rules

Priority 1 is the highest priority, Priority 6 is the lowest priority10 (EC)


is coded as 5, 11 (access class 11) is coded as 0, 12 (access class
12) is coded as 1, 13 (access class 13) is coded as 2, 14 (access
class 14) is coded as 3, 15 (access class 15) is coded as 4.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

10

15

13

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / Overload and Barring

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

395 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.232 (High Priority Access Class Ordering P5) (AC_PRIORITY_LIST(priority=5))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

High Priority Access Class Ordering P5

Logical Name

AC_PRIORITY_LIST(priority=5)

Definition

List of access classes 11..15 and EC (=10) in their priority order.

Coding rules

Priority 1 is the highest priority, Priority 6 is the lowest priority10 (EC)


is coded as 5, 11 (access class 11) is coded as 0, 12 (access class
12) is coded as 1, 13 (access class 13) is coded as 2, 14 (access
class 14) is coded as 3, 15 (access class 15) is coded as 4.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

10

15

12

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / Overload and Barring

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

396 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.233 (High Priority Access Class Ordering P6) (AC_PRIORITY_LIST(priority=6))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

High Priority Access Class Ordering P6

Logical Name

AC_PRIORITY_LIST(priority=6)

Definition

List of access classes 11..15 and EC (=10) in their priority order.

Coding rules

Priority 1 is the highest priority, Priority 6 is the lowest priority10 (EC)


is coded as 5, 11 (access class 11) is coded as 0, 12 (access class
12) is coded as 1, 13 (access class 13) is coded as 2, 14 (access
class 14) is coded as 3, 15 (access class 15) is coded as 4.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

10

15

11

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / Overload and Barring

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

397 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.234 (HIGH_TRAFFIC_LOAD) - (HIGH_TRAFFIC_LOAD)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

HIGH_TRAFFIC_LOAD

Logical Name

HIGH_TRAFFIC_LOAD

Definition

Load threshold used to determine when traffic load is high for circuit
switched calls.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

HIGH_TRAFFIC_LOAD >= LOW_TRAFFIC_LOAD

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

80

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment

Default value depends on the number of TRX in the cell (see TRXnb
default value). The value indicated here is for implementation
purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent
t01

t02

t03

t04

t05

t06

t07

t08

t09

t010

t011

t012

70

70

80

80

80

80

80

80

80

80

80

80

398 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.235 (Highest BA range ARFCNs) - (RANGEi_HIGHER (1<=i<=13))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Highest BA range ARFCNs

Logical Name

RANGEi_HIGHER (1<=i<=13)

Definition

Highest ARFCN of range i indicated in "BA Range" Information


Element.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

RANGEi_HIGHER >= RANGEi_LOWER

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

-1

1023

-1

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Reselection

External Comment

RANGEi_HIGHER = -1 means that it shall not be included in "BA


Range" IE. Moreover, all BA RANGE following this one will be
considered as not significant by the OMC and not send to the BSC.
(i.e. -1 = indicator of end of BA Range)

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

399 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.236 (HO_ALARM_PERSISTENCE) - (T_FILTER)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

HO_ALARM_PERSISTENCE

Logical Name

T_FILTER

Definition

Maximum time a handover alarm is maintained while no more alarm


condition is detected.

Coding rules

step size = 2 x SACCH frames = 0.96s. Coded over 5 bits:0: 0s, 1:


0.96s, , 31: 29.76s

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

2 x Samfr

31

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

400 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.237 (HO_MARGIN) - (HOmargin (0,n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

HO_MARGIN

Logical Name

HOmargin (0,n)

Definition

Difference in power budget (PBGT) between cell(0) and cell(n) which


is required for a power budget HO.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-127

127

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Adjacencies

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

5 dB

Umbrella

5 dB

Concentric

5 dB

Concentric Umbrella

5 dB

Microcell

4 dB

Minicell

5 dB

Extended inner cell

5 dB

Extended outer cell

5 dB

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

401 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.238 (HO_MARGIN_DIST) - (HO_MARGIN_DIST(0,n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

HO_MARGIN_DIST

Logical Name

HO_MARGIN_DIST(0,n)

Definition

Criterion for candidate neighbour cell filtering on distance handover


causes.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-127

127

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Adjacencies

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

2 dB

Umbrella

2 dB

Concentric

2 dB

Concentric Umbrella

2 dB

Microcell

5 dB

Minicell

2 dB

Extended inner cell

-29 dB

Extended outer cell

5 dB

Nb of TRX Dependent

402 / 1182

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.239 (HO_MARGIN_LEV) - (HO_MARGIN_LEV(0,n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

HO_MARGIN_LEV

Logical Name

HO_MARGIN_LEV(0,n)

Definition

Criterion for candidate neighbour cell filtering on level handover


causes.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-127

127

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Adjacencies

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

2 dB

Umbrella

2 dB

Concentric

0 dB

Concentric Umbrella

0 dB

Microcell

5 dB

Minicell

0 dB

Extended inner cell

-29 dB

Extended outer cell

5 dB

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

403 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.240 (HO_MARGIN_QUAL) - (HO_MARGIN_QUAL(0,n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

HO_MARGIN_QUAL

Logical Name

HO_MARGIN_QUAL(0,n)

Definition

Criterion for candidate neighbour cell filtering on quality handover


causes

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-127

127

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Adjacencies

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

1 dB

Umbrella

1 dB

Concentric

1 dB

Concentric Umbrella

1 dB

Microcell

5 dB

Minicell

1 dB

Extended inner cell

-29 dB

Extended outer cell

5 dB

Nb of TRX Dependent

404 / 1182

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.241 (HR_ENABLED) - (HR_ENABLED)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

HR_ENABLED

Logical Name

HR_ENABLED

Definition

This flag controls if Half Rate TCH is enabled.

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

405 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.242 (IGNORE_2Mbit_FAILURE) - (IGNORE_2MBIT_FAIL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

IGNORE_2Mbit_FAILURE

Logical Name

IGNORE_2MBIT_FAIL

Definition

This flag indicates whether or not a transmission alarm triggers the


telecom defence activities (call release, blocking messages towards
MSC). Note that the O&M activities are not dependent on this flag.

Coding rules

0: transmission alarms are not ignored and the telecom defence


activities (call release, blocking messages towards MSC) are
triggered;1: transmission alarms are ignored and telecom defence
activities (call release, blocking messages towards MSC) are not
triggered;

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

If BSS_TRANSPORT_MODE = IP, should be set to FALSE. Due to


TDM switching on TC side, there is no more interaction between
Atermux and ATR failures.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

406 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.243 (IMSI Attach/Detach) - (ATT (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

IMSI Attach/Detach

Logical Name

ATT (BSC)

Definition

This flag indicates to the MS if IMSI Attach/detach procedure is


allowed in the cell.

Coding rules

0: not allowed, 1: allowed

Mandatory rules

Equal to ATT (MFS)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

407 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.244 (IMSI Attach/Detach) - (ATT (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

IMSI Attach/Detach

Logical Name

ATT (MFS)

Definition

This flag indicates to the MS whether IMSI Attach/detach procedure


is allowed in the cell.

Coding rules

0: not allowed, 1: allowed

Mandatory rules

Equal to ATT (BSC)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

408 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.245 (IND_TRAFFIC_LOAD) - (IND_TRAFFIC_LOAD)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

IND_TRAFFIC_LOAD

Logical Name

IND_TRAFFIC_LOAD

Definition

Load threshold used to determine when traffic load is indefinite for


circuit switched calls.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

IND_TRAFFIC_LOAD = 0 OR LOW_TRAFFIC_LOAD <=


IND_TRAFFIC_LOAD <= HIGH_TRAFFIC_LOAD

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent
t01

t02

t03

t04

t05

t06

t07

t08

t09

t010

t011

t012

45

45

60

60

60

60

60

60

60

60

60

60

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

409 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.246 (INTAVE) - (INTAVE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

INTAVE

Logical Name

INTAVE

Definition

Averaging period for interference measurements on idle TCH


timeslots.

Coding rules

step size=1 Samfr

Mandatory rules

INTAVE < T_INTRF_L3

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

Samfr

31

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

410 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.247 (INTERCELL_HO) - (HO_INTERCELL_ALLOWED)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

INTERCELL_HO

Logical Name

HO_INTERCELL_ALLOWED

Definition

This flag enables/disables the execution of all outgoing intercell


handovers.

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment

Valid for both TCH and SDCCH. This parameter has no influence
on Directed Retry

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

411 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.248 (Interference bands 1-2 limit) - (INTFBD1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Interference bands 1-2 limit

Logical Name

INTFBD1

Definition

Limit between interference band 1 and interference band 2.

Coding rules

Coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules

INTFBD1 < INTFBD2

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

412 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.249 (Interference bands 2-3 limit) - (INTFBD2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Interference bands 2-3 limit

Logical Name

INTFBD2

Definition

Limit between interference band 2 and interference band 3.

Coding rules

Coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules

INTFBD3 > INTFBD2 > INTFBD1

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-95

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

413 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.250 (Interference bands 3-4 limit) - (INTFBD3)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Interference bands 3-4 limit

Logical Name

INTFBD3

Definition

Limit between interference band 3 and interference band 4.

Coding rules

Coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules

INTFBD4 > INTFBD3 > INTFBD2

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-90

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

414 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.251 (Interference bands 4-5 limit) - (INTFBD4)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Interference bands 4-5 limit

Logical Name

INTFBD4

Definition

Limit between interference band 4 and interference band 5.

Coding rules

Coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules

INTFBD5 > INTFBD4 > INTFBD3

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-85

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

415 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.252 (INTRACELL_HO) - (HO_INTRACELL_ALLOWED)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

INTRACELL_HO

Logical Name

HO_INTRACELL_ALLOWED

Definition

This flag enables/disables the execution of intracell handovers.

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment

Valid for both TCH and SDCCH.The flags specific to the TFO
feature, I.e. EN_TFO, EN_TFO_MATCH, EN_TFO_OPT,
EN_IPE_PREF_CODEC_TYPE, are set independently of
the flag HO_INTRACELL_ALLOWED. Additionally, the flag
related to handover cause 30, EN_RETURN_CS_ZONE_HO is
setindependently of the flag HO_INTRACELL_ALLOWED. The
handovers for TFO reasons (cause 29) and RAE4 reasons (cause
30) can therefore be performed even if HO_INTRACELL_ALLOWED
= disabled.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

416 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.253 (Keep codec on handover) - (KEEP_CODEC_HO)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Keep codec on handover

Logical Name

KEEP_CODEC_HO

Definition

Indicates if the BSC tries to keep the same codec for internal
incoming handovers.

Coding rules

0:free choice of the codec ; 1:try to maintain codec for TFO calls
only; 2: try to maintain codec for all calls

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

417 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.254 (L_LOAD_OBJ) - (L_LOAD_OBJ)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

L_LOAD_OBJ

Logical Name

L_LOAD_OBJ

Definition

Low threshold on busy TCH timeslots percentage to increase


MIN_DWELL_TIME variable.

Coding rules

step size = 10%

Mandatory rules

L_LOAD_OBJ <= H_LOAD_OBJ

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

60

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Hierarchical and multiband HO Ctrl

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

N/A

Umbrella

See TRXnb

Concentric

N/A

Concentric Umbrella

See TRXnb

Microcell

N/A

Minicell

N/A

Extended inner cell

N/A

Extended outer cell

N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent
t01

t02

t03

t04

t05

t06

t07

t08

t09

t010

t011

t012

10

20

40

40

40

40

40

40

40

40

40

418 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.255 (L_MIN_DWELL_TIME) - (L_MIN_DWELL_TIME)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

L_MIN_DWELL_TIME

Logical Name

L_MIN_DWELL_TIME

Definition

Minimum allowed value for MIN_DWELL_TIME variable.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

L_MIN_DWELL_TIME <= H_MIN_DWELL_TIME

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

120

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / HO Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

419 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.256 (L_RXLEV_CPT_HO) - (L_RXLEV_CPT_HO(0,n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

L_RXLEV_CPT_HO

Logical Name

L_RXLEV_CPT_HO(0,n)

Definition

Minimum received downlink level from cell n for umbrella to neighbour


lower layer cell n handover or from classical band to preferred band
cell n handover.

Coding rules

Coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-85

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Hierarchical and multiband HO Ctrl (+


Edit Adjacency)

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

420 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.257 (L_RXLEV_DL_H) - (L_RXLEV_DL_H)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

L_RXLEV_DL_H

Logical Name

L_RXLEV_DL_H

Definition

Downlink level threshold for handover.

Coding rules

Coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules

L_RXLEV_DL_H < U_RXLEV_DL_P.L_RXLEV_DL_H <


RXLEV_DL_IH

Recommended rules

L_RXLEV_D_H < L_RXLEV_DL_PIf CELL_PARTITION_TYPE =


"Concentric" AND FREQUENCY_RANGE = "PGSM" or "DCS1800"
or "EGSM" or "DCS 1900":RXLEV_DL_ZONE >= L_RXLEV_DL_H
(This rule only applies to concentric and monoband cell.)

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-96

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

-91 dBm (19)

Umbrella

-91 dBm (19)

Concentric

-91 dBm (19)

Concentric Umbrella

-91 dBm (19)

Microcell

-96 dBm (14)

Minicell

-91 dBm (19)

Extended inner cell

-96 dBm (14)

Extended outer cell

-98 dBm (12)

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

421 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.258 (L_RXLEV_DL_P) - (L_RXLEV_DL_P)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

L_RXLEV_DL_P

Logical Name

L_RXLEV_DL_P

Definition

Lower downlink level threshold for power control.

Coding rules

Coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules

L_RXLEV_DL_P < U_RXLEV_DL_P

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-85

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

422 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.259 (L_RXLEV_NCELL_DR) - (L_RXLEV_NCELL_DR(n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

L_RXLEV_NCELL_DR

Logical Name

L_RXLEV_NCELL_DR(n)

Definition

Minimum level received from neighbour cell n to allow forced directed


retry to cell n.

Coding rules

Coded over 6 bits :0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-110

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: DIR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Directed Retry (+ Edit External cell /


circuit1/2)

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

-85 dBm (25)

Umbrella

-85 dBm (25)

Concentric

-85 dBm (25)

Concentric Umbrella

-85 dBm (25)

Microcell

-70 dBm (40)

Minicell

-85 dBm (25)

Extended inner cell

N/A

Extended outer cell

N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

423 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.260 (L_RXLEV_UL_H) - (L_RXLEV_UL_H)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

L_RXLEV_UL_H

Logical Name

L_RXLEV_UL_H

Definition

Uplink level threshold for handover.

Coding rules

Coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules

L_RXLEV_UL_H < U_RXLEV_UL_P L_RXLEV_UL_H <


RXLEV_UL_IH

Recommended rules

L_RXLEV_UL_H < L_RXLEV_UL_PIf CELL_PARTITION_TYPE =


"Concentric" AND FREQUENCY_RANGE = "PGSM" or "DCS1800"
or "EGSM" or "DCS 1900":RXLEV_UL_ZONE >= L_RXLEV_UL_H
(This rule only applies to concentric and monoband cell.)

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

-100 dBm (10)

Umbrella

-100 dBm (10)

Concentric

-100 dBm (10)

Concentric Umbrella

-100 dBm (10)

Microcell

-100 dBm (10)

Minicell

-100 dBm (10)

Extended inner cell

-100 dBm (10)

Extended outer cell

-100 dBm (10)

Nb of TRX Dependent

424 / 1182

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.261 (L_RXLEV_UL_P) - (L_RXLEV_UL_P)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

L_RXLEV_UL_P

Logical Name

L_RXLEV_UL_P

Definition

Lower uplink level threshold for power control.

Coding rules

Coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules

L_RXLEV_UL_P < U_RXLEV_UL_P

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-90

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

-95 dBm (15)

Umbrella

-95 dBm (15)

Concentric

-95 dBm (15)

Concentric Umbrella

-95 dBm (15)

Microcell

-85 dBm (25)

Minicell

-95 dBm (15)

Extended inner cell

-95 dBm (15)

Extended outer cell

-95 dBm (15)

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

425 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.262 (L_RXQUAL_DL_H) - (L_RXQUAL_DL_H)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

L_RXQUAL_DL_H

Logical Name

L_RXQUAL_DL_H

Definition

Downlink quality threshold for handover for non AMR calls.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1, (1==0.1 70==7)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

L_RXQUAL_DL_H >= L_RXQUAL_DL_P

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment

Higher value is the worst quality

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

426 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.263 (L_RXQUAL_DL_H_AMR) - (L_RXQUAL_DL_H_AMR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

L_RXQUAL_DL_H_AMR

Logical Name

L_RXQUAL_DL_H_AMR

Definition

Downlink quality threshold for handovers (cause 16) on AMR-NB


calls.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1, (1==0.1 70==7)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

4.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

427 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.264 (L_RXQUAL_DL_H_AMR_WB_GMSK) (L_RXQUAL_DL_H_AMR_WB_GMSK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

L_RXQUAL_DL_H_AMR_WB_GMSK

Logical Name

L_RXQUAL_DL_H_AMR_WB_GMSK

Definition

Downlink quality threshold for handovers (cause 16) on AMR-WB


GMSK calls.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1, (1==0.1 70==7)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

4.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

428 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.265 (L_RXQUAL_DL_P) - (L_RXQUAL_DL_P)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

L_RXQUAL_DL_P

Logical Name

L_RXQUAL_DL_P

Definition

Lower downlink quality threshold for power control.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 (1==0.1 70==7)

Mandatory rules

L_RXQUAL_DL_P > U_RXQUAL_DL_P

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment

Higher value is the worst quality

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

429 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.266 (L_RXQUAL_UL_H) - (L_RXQUAL_UL_H)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

L_RXQUAL_UL_H

Logical Name

L_RXQUAL_UL_H

Definition

Uplink quality threshold for handover for non AMR calls.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 (1==0.1 70==7)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

L_RXQUAL_UL_H >= L_RXQUAL_UL_P

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment

Higher value is the worst quality

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

430 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.267 (L_RXQUAL_UL_H_AMR) - (L_RXQUAL_UL_H_AMR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

L_RXQUAL_UL_H_AMR

Logical Name

L_RXQUAL_UL_H_AMR

Definition

Uplink quality threshold for handovers (cause 15) on AMR-NB calls.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1, (1==0.1 70==7)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

4.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

431 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.268 (L_RXQUAL_UL_H_AMR_WB_GMSK) (L_RXQUAL_UL_H_AMR_WB_GMSK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

L_RXQUAL_UL_H_AMR_WB_GMSK

Logical Name

L_RXQUAL_UL_H_AMR_WB_GMSK

Definition

Uplink quality threshold for handovers (cause 15) on AMR-WB


GMSK calls.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1, (1==0.1 70==7)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

4.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

432 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.269 (L_RXQUAL_UL_P) - (L_RXQUAL_UL_P)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

L_RXQUAL_UL_P

Logical Name

L_RXQUAL_UL_P

Definition

Lower uplink quality threshold for power control.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 (1==0.1 70==7)

Mandatory rules

L_RXQUAL_UL_P > U_RXQUAL_UL_P

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment

Higher value is the worst quality

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

433 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.270 (LAC) - (LAC (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

LAC

Logical Name

LAC (BSC)

Definition

Location Area Code.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

LAC and CI can not be equal to 65535 at the same timeEqual to LAC
(MFS)A couple of mate extended cells (Extended inner + extended
outer) shall have the same LAC.

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

65535

65535

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description ( + Edit External cell


/ circuit1/2)

External Comment

Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated here


is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

434 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.271 (Link_factor) - (Linkfactor (0,n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Link_factor

Logical Name

Linkfactor (0,n)

Definition

Correction factor used in cell evaluation process to handicap or


favour cell n.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-24

24

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Adjacencies

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

435 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.272 (Load computation in outer zone) - (EN_LOAD_OUTER)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Load computation in outer zone

Logical Name

EN_LOAD_OUTER

Definition

Flag to enable/disable the load computation on the outer zone of a


Concentric/multiband cell instead of the load computation on the
whole cell.

Coding rules

0: disabled; 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

When enabled, the values of the parameters FREElevel_1 to


FREElevel_4 need to be updated to number of TRX considered in
the load computation.EN_LOAD_BALANCE & EN_LOAD_OUTER
should not be both "Enabled".

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / HO

External Comment

significant only for concentric and multiband cells.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

436 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.273 (LOAD_EV_PERIOD) - (LOAD_EV_PERIOD)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

LOAD_EV_PERIOD

Logical Name

LOAD_EV_PERIOD

Definition

Number of load samples (received every TCH_INFO_PERIOD) for


load averaging.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

30

12

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

437 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.274 (Load_Factor_1) - (Loadfactor_1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Load_Factor_1

Logical Name

Loadfactor_1

Definition

Correction factor used in cell evaluation process to take into account


the TCH load in the candidate cell.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Loadfactor_1 >= Loadfactor_2

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-16

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

438 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.275 (Load_Factor_2) - (Loadfactor_2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Load_Factor_2

Logical Name

Loadfactor_2

Definition

Correction factor used in cell evaluation process to take into account


the TCH load in the candidate cell.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Loadfactor_1 >= Loadfactor_2 >= Loadfactor_3

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-16

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

-2

Umbrella

-2

Concentric

-2

Concentric Umbrella

-2

Microcell

-2

Minicell

-2

Extended inner cell

Extended outer cell

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

439 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.276 (Load_Factor_3) - (Loadfactor_3)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Load_Factor_3

Logical Name

Loadfactor_3

Definition

Correction factor used in cell evaluation process to take into account


the TCH load in the candidate cell.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Loadfactor_2 >= Loadfactor_3 >= Loadfactor_4

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-16

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

-5

Umbrella

-5

Concentric

-5

Concentric Umbrella

-5

Microcell

-4

Minicell

-5

Extended inner cell

Extended outer cell

Nb of TRX Dependent

440 / 1182

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.277 (Load_Factor_4) - (Loadfactor_4)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Load_Factor_4

Logical Name

Loadfactor_4

Definition

Correction factor used in cell evaluation process to take into account


the TCH load in the candidate cell.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Loadfactor_3 >= Loadfactor_4 >= Loadfactor_5

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-16

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

-7

Umbrella

-7

Concentric

-7

Concentric Umbrella

-7

Microcell

-6

Minicell

-7

Extended inner cell

Extended outer cell

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

441 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.278 (Load_Factor_5) - (Loadfactor_5)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Load_Factor_5

Logical Name

Loadfactor_5

Definition

Correction factor used in cell evaluation process to take into account


the TCH load in the candidate cell.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Loadfactor_5 <= Loadfactor_4

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-16

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

-10

Umbrella

-10

Concentric

-10

Concentric Umbrella

-10

Microcell

-8

Minicell

-10

Extended inner cell

Extended outer cell

Nb of TRX Dependent

442 / 1182

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.279 (Load_Level_1) - (Loadlevel_1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Load_Level_1

Logical Name

Loadlevel_1

Definition

Boundary on cell load for determination of Loadfactor of the cell.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Loadlevel_1 < Loadlevel_2

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

50

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

443 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.280 (Load_Level_2) - (Loadlevel_2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Load_Level_2

Logical Name

Loadlevel_2

Definition

Boundary on cell load for determination of Loadfactor of the cell.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Loadlevel_1 < Loadlevel_2 < Loadlevel_3

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

60

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

444 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.281 (Load_Level_3) - (Loadlevel_3)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Load_Level_3

Logical Name

Loadlevel_3

Definition

Boundary on cell load for determination of Loadfactor of the cell.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Loadlevel_2 < Loadlevel_3 < Loadlevel_4

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

80

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

445 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.282 (Load_Level_4) - (Loadlevel_4)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Load_Level_4

Logical Name

Loadlevel_4

Definition

Boundary on cell load for determination of Loadfactor of the cell.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Loadlevel_4 > Loadlevel_3

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

90

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HOC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Load Classif

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

446 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.283 (LOW_TRAFFIC_LOAD) - (LOW_TRAFFIC_LOAD)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

LOW_TRAFFIC_LOAD

Logical Name

LOW_TRAFFIC_LOAD

Definition

Load threshold used to determine when traffic load is low for circuit
switched calls.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

LOW_TRAFFIC_LOAD <= HIGH_TRAFFIC_LOAD

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment

If LOW_TRAFFIC_LOAD is set to 0 in a given cell n, then no


Handover Cause 23 (i.e. Traffic Handovers) can be triggered towards
that cell n.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent
t01

t02

t03

t04

t05

t06

t07

t08

t09

t010

t011

t012

20

20

50

50

50

50

50

50

50

50

50

50

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

447 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.284 (LOWER_TIMING_ADVANCE) - (L_TIME_ADVANCE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

LOWER_TIMING_ADVANCE

Logical Name

L_TIME_ADVANCE

Definition

Low threshold to trigger handover cause "too short distance" in outer


cell.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

bper

63

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Distance

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

N/A

Umbrella

N/A

Concentric

N/A

Concentric Umbrella

N/A

Microcell

N/A

Minicell

N/A

Extended inner cell

N/A

Extended outer cell

Nb of TRX Dependent

448 / 1182

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.285 (Lowest BA range ARFCNs) - (RANGEi_LOWER (1<=i<=13))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Lowest BA range ARFCNs

Logical Name

RANGEi_LOWER (1<=i<=13)

Definition

Lowest ARFCN of range i indicated in "BA Range" Information


Element.

Coding rules

Coded on 16 bits.

Mandatory rules

RANGEi_HIGHER >= RANGEi_LOWER

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

-1

1023

-1

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Reselection

External Comment

RANGEi_LOWER = -1 means that it shall not be included in "BA


Range" IE Moreover, all BA RANGE following this one will be
considered as not significant by the OMC and not send to the BSC.
(i.e. -1 = indicator of end of BA Range)

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

449 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.286 (LSA_ID_I) - (LSA_ID_array (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

LSA_ID_I

Logical Name

LSA_ID_array (BSC)

Definition

List of authorised LSAs on a cell (up to 5).

Coding rules

coded on 3 bytes max

Mandatory rules

Equal to LSA_ID_array (MFS)

Recommended rules

The LSA_ID may either be a Universal LSA identity (in case of odd
number) or a PLMN significant LSA identity (in case of even number),
as defined in GSM 03.03.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

16777215

16777215

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 3/3

External Comment

The default value depends on the configuration. The value given


here is for implementation purposes only.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

450 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.287 (LSA_ID_I) - (LSA_ID_array (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

LSA_ID_I

Logical Name

LSA_ID_array (MFS)

Definition

List of authorised LSAs on a cell (up to 5).

Coding rules

coded on 3 bytes max

Mandatory rules

Equal to LSA_ID_array (BSC)

Recommended rules

The LSA_ID may either be a Universal LSA identity (in case of odd
number) or a PLMN significant LSA identity (in case of even number),
as defined in GSM 03.03.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

16777215

16777215

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 3/3

External Comment

The default value depends on the configuration. The value given


here is for implementation purposes only.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

451 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.288 (LSA_ID_I(n)) - (LSA_ID_array (n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

LSA_ID_I(n)

Logical Name

LSA_ID_array (n)

Definition

List of authorised LSAs on a neighbour cell (up to 5).

Coding rules

coded on 3 bytes max

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

16777215

16777215

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Cell / Circuit 2/2

External Comment

This parameter is for every cell. The operator needs only to configure
the value of that parameter for OMC external cells ; the parameter
is autonomously filled by the OMC in case the adjacent cell is an
OMC internal cell.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

452 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.289 (LSA_OFFSET) - (LSA_OFFSET)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

LSA_OFFSET

Logical Name

LSA_OFFSET

Definition

Offset to be used for LSA cell reselection between cells with the
same LSA priorities.

Coding rules

coded from 0 to 7, where 0 = 0 dB, 1 = 4 dB, 2 = 8 dB, 3 = 16 dB,


4 = 24 dB, 5 = 32 dB, 6 = 48 dB, 7 = 64 dB.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

64

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 3/3

External Comment

The default value corresponds to an unused parameter for the MS.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

453 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.290 (LSA_PRIO_THR) - (PRIO_THR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

LSA_PRIO_THR

Logical Name

PRIO_THR

Definition

Signal threshold for applying LSA cell reselection.

Coding rules

coded from 0 to 7; step size = 6 dB (i.e. 0 = 0 dB, 1 = 6 dB, 2 = 12


dB, 3 = 18 dB, 4 = 24 dB, 5 = 30 dB, 6 = 36 dB, 7 = infinite = 42 dB).

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

42

42

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 3/3

External Comment

The default value corresponds to an unused parameter for the


MS.The maximum and default values correspond to an infinite
threshold.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

454 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.291 (MATE_CI) - (MATE_CI (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MATE_CI

Logical Name

MATE_CI (BSC)

Definition

Cell Identity of the Mate cell

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

MATE_CI (BSC) = MATE_CI (MFS)If one mate cell is configured


with GPRS (MAX_PDCH > 0) then the other mate cell shall also
be configured with GPRS (MAX_PDCH > 0)For an extended cell,
MATE_LAC and MATE_CI can not be equal to 65535 at the same
time

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

65535

65535

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated here is


for implementation purposes.(MATE_LAC + MATE_CI) is relevant for
extended cells only

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

455 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.292 (MATE_LAC) - (MATE_LAC)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MATE_LAC

Logical Name

MATE_LAC

Definition

Location Area Code of the Mate cell.

Coding rules

Step size = 1

Mandatory rules

For an extended cell, MATE_LAC and MATE_CI can not be equal to


65535 at the same time A couple of mate extended cells (Extended
inner + extended outer) shall have the same LAC

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

65535

65535

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated here is


for implementation purposes.(MATE_LAC + MATE_CI) is relevant for
extended cells only

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

456 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.293 (MAX_POW_INC) - (MAX_POW_INC)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MAX_POW_INC

Logical Name

MAX_POW_INC

Definition

Maximum Power increase in one power command.

Coding rules

step size = 2dB

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

16

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

457 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.294 (MAX_POW_RED) - (MAX_POW_RED)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MAX_POW_RED

Logical Name

MAX_POW_RED

Definition

Maximum Power reduction in one power command.

Coding rules

step size = 2dB

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

16

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

458 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.295 (MAX_RETRANS) - (Max_retrans (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MAX_RETRANS

Logical Name

Max_retrans (BSC)

Definition

Maximum number of CHANNEL REQUEST retransmissions by the


MS on the RACH.

Coding rules

Possible values are:1, 2 ,4 and 7 respectively binary coded:00, 01,


10 and 11

Mandatory rules

Max_retrans (BSC) = Max_retrans (MFS) for a given cell

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

459 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.296 (MEAS_STAT_BFI_1) - (MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [1])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_BFI_1

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [1]

Definition

Threshold on successive Bad Frame Indication to define bands used


for Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_BFI2 > MEAS_STAT_BFI1

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

24

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

460 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.297 (MEAS_STAT_BFI_2) - (MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [2])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_BFI_2

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [2]

Definition

Threshold on successive Bad Frame Indication to define bands used


for Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_BFI3 > MEAS_STAT_BFI2 > MEAS_STAT_BFI1

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

24

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

461 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.298 (MEAS_STAT_BFI_3) - (MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [3])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_BFI_3

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [3]

Definition

Threshold on successive Bad Frame Indication to define bands used


for Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_BFI4 > MEAS_STAT_BFI3 > MEAS_STAT_BFI2

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

24

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

462 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.299 (MEAS_STAT_BFI_4) - (MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [4])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_BFI_4

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [4]

Definition

Threshold on successive Bad Frame Indication to define bands used


for Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_BFI5 > MEAS_STAT_BFI4 > MEAS_STAT_BFI3

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

24

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

463 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.300 (MEAS_STAT_BFI_5) - (MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [5])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_BFI_5

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [5]

Definition

Threshold on successive Bad Frame Indication to define bands used


for Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_BFI6 > MEAS_STAT_BFI5 > MEAS_STAT_BFI4

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

24

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

464 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.301 (MEAS_STAT_BFI_6) - (MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [6])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_BFI_6

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [6]

Definition

Threshold on successive Bad Frame Indication to define bands used


for Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_BFI7 > MEAS_STAT_BFI6 > MEAS_STAT_BFI5

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

24

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

465 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.302 (MEAS_STAT_BFI_7) - (MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [7])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_BFI_7

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [7]

Definition

Threshold on successive Bad Frame Indication to define bands used


for Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_BFI8 > MEAS_STAT_BFI7 > MEAS_STAT_BFI6

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

24

14

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

466 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.303 (MEAS_STAT_BFI_8) - (MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [8])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_BFI_8

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [8]

Definition

Threshold on successive Bad Frame Indication to define bands used


for Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_BFI9 > MEAS_STAT_BFI8 > MEAS_STAT_BFI7

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

24

18

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

467 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.304 (MEAS_STAT_BFI_9) - (MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [9])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_BFI_9

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_BFI_i [9]

Definition

Threshold on successive Bad Frame Indication to define bands used


for Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_BFI9 > MEAS_STAT_BFI8

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

24

22

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

468 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.305 (MEAS_STAT_C_I_1) - (MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [1])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_C_I_1

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [1]

Definition

Threshold on radio C/I (Carrier/Interference) measurements to define


bands used for Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

coded from 1 to +125, step size = 1dB ( 1= -62 db, , 125 = +62 dB)

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_CI1 < MEAS_STAT_CI2

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-62

62

-12

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

469 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.306 (MEAS_STAT_C_I_2) - (MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [2])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_C_I_2

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [2]

Definition

Threshold on radio C/I (Carrier/Interference) measurements to define


bands used for Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

coded from 1 to +125, step size = 1dB ( 1= -62 db, , 125 = +62 dB)

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_CI1 < MEAS_STAT_CI2 < MEAS_STAT_CI3

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-62

62

-9

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

470 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.307 (MEAS_STAT_C_I_3) - (MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [3])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_C_I_3

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [3]

Definition

Threshold on radio C/I (Carrier/Interference) measurements to define


bands used for Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

coded from 1 to +125, step size = 1dB ( 1= -62 db, , 125 = +62 dB)

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_CI2 < MEAS_STAT_CI3 < MEAS_STAT_CI4

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-62

62

-6

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

471 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.308 (MEAS_STAT_C_I_4) - (MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [4])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_C_I_4

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [4]

Definition

Threshold on radio C/I (Carrier/Interference) measurements to define


bands used for Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

coded from 1 to +125, step size = 1dB ( 1= -62 db, , 125 = +62 dB)

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_CI3 < MEAS_STAT_CI4 < MEAS_STAT_CI5

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-62

62

-3

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

472 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.309 (MEAS_STAT_C_I_5) - (MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [5])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_C_I_5

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [5]

Definition

Threshold on radio C/I (Carrier/Interference) measurements to define


bands used for Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

coded from 1 to +125, step size = 1dB ( 1= -62 db, , 125 = +62 dB)

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_CI4 < MEAS_STAT_CI5 < MEAS_STAT_CI6

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-62

62

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

473 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.310 (MEAS_STAT_C_I_6) - (MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [6])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_C_I_6

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [6]

Definition

Threshold on radio C/I (Carrier/Interference) measurements to define


bands used for Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

coded from 1 to +125, step size = 1dB ( 1= -62 db, , 125 = +62 dB)

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_CI5 < MEAS_STAT_CI6 < MEAS_STAT_CI7

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-62

62

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

474 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.311 (MEAS_STAT_C_I_7) - (MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [7])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_C_I_7

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [7]

Definition

Threshold on radio C/I (Carrier/Interference) measurements to define


bands used for Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

coded from 1 to +125, step size = 1dB ( 1= -62 db, , 125 = +62 dB)

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_CI6 < MEAS_STAT_CI7 < MEAS_STAT_CI8

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-62

62

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

475 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.312 (MEAS_STAT_C_I_8) - (MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [8])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_C_I_8

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [8]

Definition

Threshold on radio C/I (Carrier/Interference) measurements to define


bands used for Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

coded from 1 to +125, step size = 1dB ( 1= -62 db, , 125 = +62 dB)

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_CI7 < MEAS_STAT_CI8 < MEAS_STAT_CI9

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-62

62

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

476 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.313 (MEAS_STAT_C_I_9) - (MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [9])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_C_I_9

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_C_I_i [9]

Definition

Threshold on radio C/I (Carrier/Interference) measurements to define


bands used for Radio Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

coded from 1 to +125, step size = 1dB ( 1= -62 db, , 125 = +62 dB)

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_CI8 < MEAS_STAT_CI9

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-62

62

12

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

477 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.314 (MEAS_STAT_LEV_1) - (MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [1])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_LEV_1

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [1]

Definition

Threshold on radio level to define bands used for Radio


Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

coded 1 to 62, 1 = -109 dBm, . . . 62 = -48 dBm, step = 1dBm

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_LEV_1 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_2

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-109

-48

-53

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

478 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.315 (MEAS_STAT_LEV_2) - (MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [2])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_LEV_2

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [2]

Definition

Threshold on radio level to define bands used for Radio


Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

coded 1 to 62, 1 = -109 dBm, . . . 62 = -48 dBm, step = 1dBm

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_LEV_1 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_2 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_3

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-109

-48

-60

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

479 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.316 (MEAS_STAT_LEV_3) - (MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [3])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_LEV_3

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [3]

Definition

Threshold on radio level to define bands used for Radio


Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

coded 1 to 62, 1 = -109 dBm, . . . 62 = -48 dBm, step = 1dBm

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_LEV_2 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_3 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_4

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-109

-48

-66

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

480 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.317 (MEAS_STAT_LEV_4) - (MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [4])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_LEV_4

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [4]

Definition

Threshold on radio level to define bands used for Radio


Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

coded 1 to 62, 1 = -109 dBm, . . . 62 = -48 dBm, step = 1dBm

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_LEV_3 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_4 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_5

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-109

-48

-72

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

481 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.318 (MEAS_STAT_LEV_5) - (MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [5])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_LEV_5

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [5]

Definition

Threshold on radio level to define bands used for Radio


Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

coded 1 to 62, 1 = -109 dBm, . . . 62 = -48 dBm, step = 1dBm

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_LEV_4 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_5 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_6

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-109

-48

-79

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

482 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.319 (MEAS_STAT_LEV_6) - (MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [6])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_LEV_6

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [6]

Definition

Threshold on radio level to define bands used for Radio


Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

coded 1 to 62, 1 = -109 dBm, . . . 62 = -48 dBm, step = 1dBm

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_LEV_5 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_6 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_7

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-109

-48

-85

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

483 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.320 (MEAS_STAT_LEV_7) - (MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [7])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_LEV_7

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [7]

Definition

Threshold on radio level to define bands used for Radio


Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

coded 1 to 62, 1 = -109 dBm, . . . 62 = -48 dBm, step = 1dBm

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_LEV_6 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_7 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_8

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-109

-48

-91

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

484 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.321 (MEAS_STAT_LEV_8) - (MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [8])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_LEV_8

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [8]

Definition

Threshold on radio level to define bands used for Radio


Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

coded 1 to 62, 1 = -109 dBm, . . . 62 = -48 dBm, step = 1dBm

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_LEV_7 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_8 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_9

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-109

-48

-97

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

485 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.322 (MEAS_STAT_LEV_9) - (MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [9])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_LEV_9

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_LEV_i [9]

Definition

Threshold on radio level to define bands used for Radio


Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

coded 1 to 62, 1 = -109 dBm, . . . 62 = -48 dBm, step = 1dBm

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_LEV_8 > MEAS_STAT_LEV_9

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-109

-48

-104

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 3/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

486 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.323 (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_1) - (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [1])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_1

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [1]

Definition

Threshold on path balance to define bands used for Radio


Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

coded from 1 to +219, step size = 1dB (1 = -109 dB, 219 = +109 dB)

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL1 < MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL2

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-109

109

-50

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 2/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

487 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.324 (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_2) - (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [2])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_2

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [2]

Definition

Threshold on path balance to define bands used for Radio


Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

coded from 1 to +219, step size = 1dB (1 = -109 dB, 219 = +109 dB)

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL3 > MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL2 >


MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL1

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-109

109

-30

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 2/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

488 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.325 (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_3) - (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [3])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_3

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [3]

Definition

Threshold on path balance to define bands used for Radio


Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

coded from 1 to +219, step size = 1dB (1 = -109 dB, 219 = +109 dB)

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL4 > MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL3 >


MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL2

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-109

109

-20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 2/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

489 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.326 (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_4) - (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [4])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_4

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [4]

Definition

Threshold on path balance to define bands used for Radio


Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

coded from 1 to +219, step size = 1dB (1 = -109 dB, 219 = +109 dB)

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL5 > MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL4 >


MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL3

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-109

109

-10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 2/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

490 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.327 (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_5) - (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [5])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_5

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [5]

Definition

Threshold on path balance to define bands used for Radio


Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

coded from 1 to +219, step size = 1dB (1 = -109 dB, 219 = +109 dB)

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL6 > MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL5 >


MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL4

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-109

109

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 2/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

491 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.328 (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_6) - (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [6])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_6

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [6]

Definition

Threshold on path balance to define bands used for Radio


Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

coded from 1 to +219, step size = 1dB (1 = -109 dB, 219 = +109 dB)

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL7 > MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL6 >


MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL5

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-109

109

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 2/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

492 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.329 (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_7) - (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [7])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_7

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [7]

Definition

Threshold on path balance to define bands used for Radio


Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

coded from 1 to +219, step size = 1dB (1 = -109 dB, 219 = +109 dB)

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL8 > MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL7 >


MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL6

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-109

109

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 2/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

493 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.330 (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_8) - (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [8])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_8

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [8]

Definition

Threshold on path balance to define bands used for Radio


Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

coded from 1 to +219, step size = 1dB (1 = -109 dB, 219 = +109 dB)

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL9 > MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL8 >


MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL7

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-109

109

30

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 2/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

494 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.331 (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_9) - (MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [9])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_9

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL_i [9]

Definition

Threshold on path balance to define bands used for Radio


Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

coded from 1 to +219, step size = 1dB (1 = -109 dB, 219 = +109 dB)

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL9 > MEAS_STAT_PATH_BAL8

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-109

109

50

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 2/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

495 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.332 (MEAS_STAT_S_1) - (MEAS_STAT_S_i [1])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_S_1

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_S_i [1]

Definition

Threshold on radio link counter to define bands used for Radio


Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

step size = 1 Samfr

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_S1 < MEAS_STAT_S2

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

Samfr

127

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

496 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.333 (MEAS_STAT_S_2) - (MEAS_STAT_S_i [2])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_S_2

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_S_i [2]

Definition

Threshold on radio link counter to define bands used for Radio


Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

step size = 1 Samfr

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_S3 > MEAS_STAT_S2 > MEAS_STAT_S1

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

Samfr

127

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

497 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.334 (MEAS_STAT_S_3) - (MEAS_STAT_S_i [3])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_S_3

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_S_i [3]

Definition

Threshold on radio link counter to define bands used for Radio


Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

step size = 1 Samfr

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_S4 > MEAS_STAT_S3 > MEAS_STAT_S2

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

Samfr

127

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

498 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.335 (MEAS_STAT_S_4) - (MEAS_STAT_S_i [4])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_S_4

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_S_i [4]

Definition

Threshold on radio link counter to define bands used for Radio


Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

step size = 1 Samfr

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_S5 > MEAS_STAT_S4 > MEAS_STAT_S3

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

Samfr

127

12

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

499 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.336 (MEAS_STAT_S_5) - (MEAS_STAT_S_i [5])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_S_5

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_S_i [5]

Definition

Threshold on radio link counter to define bands used for Radio


Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

step size = 1 Samfr

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_S6 > MEAS_STAT_S5 > MEAS_STAT_S4

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

Samfr

127

14

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

500 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.337 (MEAS_STAT_S_6) - (MEAS_STAT_S_i [6])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_S_6

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_S_i [6]

Definition

Threshold on radio link counter to define bands used for Radio


Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

step size = 1 Samfr

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_S7 > MEAS_STAT_S6 > MEAS_STAT_S5

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

Samfr

127

16

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

501 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.338 (MEAS_STAT_S_7) - (MEAS_STAT_S_i [7])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_S_7

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_S_i [7]

Definition

Threshold on radio link counter to define bands used for Radio


Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

step size = 1 Samfr

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_S8 > MEAS_STAT_S7 > MEAS_STAT_S6

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

Samfr

127

18

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

502 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.339 (MEAS_STAT_S_8) - (MEAS_STAT_S_i [8])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_S_8

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_S_i [8]

Definition

Threshold on radio link counter to define bands used for Radio


Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

step size = 1 Samfr

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_S9 > MEAS_STAT_S8 > MEAS_STAT_S7

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

Samfr

127

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

503 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.340 (MEAS_STAT_S_9) - (MEAS_STAT_S_i [9])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_S_9

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_S_i [9]

Definition

Threshold on radio link counter to define bands used for Radio


Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

step size = 1 Samfr

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_S9 > MEAS_STAT_S8

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

Samfr

127

22

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Measurements 1/3

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

504 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.341 (MEAS_STAT_TA_1) - (MEAS_STAT_TA_i [1])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_TA_1

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_TA_i [1]

Definition

Upper limit of the first TA band, lower limit of the second TA band
(for the RMS TA measurements)

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

0 < MEAS_STAT_TA_1 < MEAS_STAT_TA_2

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

bper

62

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

505 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.342 (MEAS_STAT_TA_2) - (MEAS_STAT_TA_i [2])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_TA_2

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_TA_i [2]

Definition

Upper limit of the 2nd TA band, lower limit of the 3rd TA band (for the
RMS TA measurements)

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_TA_1 < MEAS_STAT_TA_2 < MEAS_STAT_TA_3

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

bper

62

13

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

506 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.343 (MEAS_STAT_TA_3) - (MEAS_STAT_TA_i [3])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_TA_3

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_TA_i [3]

Definition

Upper limit of the 3rd TA band, lower limit of the 4th TA band (for the
RMS TA measurements)

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_TA_2 < MEAS_STAT_TA_3 < MEAS_STAT_TA_4

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

bper

62

19

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

507 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.344 (MEAS_STAT_TA_4) - (MEAS_STAT_TA_i [4])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_TA_4

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_TA_i [4]

Definition

Upper limit of the 4th TA band, lower limit of the 5th TA band (for the
RMS TA measurements)

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_TA_3 < MEAS_STAT_TA_4 < MEAS_STAT_TA_5

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

bper

62

25

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

508 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.345 (MEAS_STAT_TA_5) - (MEAS_STAT_TA_i [5])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_TA_5

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_TA_i [5]

Definition

Upper limit of the 5th TA band, lower limit of the 6th TA band (for the
RMS TA measurements)

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_TA_4 < MEAS_STAT_TA_5 < MEAS_STAT_TA_6

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

bper

62

31

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

509 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.346 (MEAS_STAT_TA_6) - (MEAS_STAT_TA_i [6])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_TA_6

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_TA_i [6]

Definition

Upper limit of the 6th TA band, lower limit of the 7th TA band (for the
RMS TA measurements)

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_TA_5 < MEAS_STAT_TA_6 < MEAS_STAT_TA_7

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

bper

62

37

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

510 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.347 (MEAS_STAT_TA_7) - (MEAS_STAT_TA_i [7])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_TA_7

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_TA_i [7]

Definition

Upper limit of the 7th TA band, lower limit of the 8th TA band (for the
RMS TA measurements)

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_TA_6 < MEAS_STAT_TA_7 < MEAS_STAT_TA_8

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

bper

62

43

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

511 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.348 (MEAS_STAT_TA_8) - (MEAS_STAT_TA_i [8])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_TA_8

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_TA_i [8]

Definition

Upper limit of the 8th TA band, lower limit of the 9th TA band (for the
RMS TA measurements)

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_TA_7 < MEAS_STAT_TA_8 < MEAS_STAT_TA_9

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

bper

62

49

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

512 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.349 (MEAS_STAT_TA_9) - (MEAS_STAT_TA_i [9])


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MEAS_STAT_TA_9

Logical Name

MEAS_STAT_TA_i [9]

Definition

Upper limit of the 9th TA band, lower limit of the 10th TA band (for the
RMS TA measurements)

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

MEAS_STAT_TA_8 < MEAS_STAT_TA_9 < 63

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

bper

62

55

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS templates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

513 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.350 (MIN_CONNECT_TIME) - (MIN_CONNECT_TIME)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MIN_CONNECT_TIME

Logical Name

MIN_CONNECT_TIME

Definition

Maximum connection time after a handover in an overlaid cell to


declare the MS "fast" when leaving the cell with a handover.

Coding rules

step size=1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

120

40

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO Parameters / Lower Layer HO Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

N/A

Umbrella

N/A

Concentric

N/A

Concentric Umbrella

N/A

Microcell

20 s

Minicell

40 s

Extended inner cell

N/A

Extended outer cell

N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent

514 / 1182

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.351 (MIN_RLF_TIME_DL) - (MIN_RLF_TIME_DL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MIN_RLF_TIME_DL

Logical Name

MIN_RLF_TIME_DL

Definition

Minimum time before detecting a radio link failure of a DL TBF,


triggered by N3105 or NstagnatingWindowDL.

Coding rules

step size = 100 ms

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

It is recommended to set a value close to the time of temporary very


bad radio conditions that the operator would like to support during a
DL TBF. Typically, a few seconds.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

25000

4000

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

515 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.352 (Mobile Country Code (MCC)) - (MCC (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Mobile Country Code (MCC)

Logical Name

MCC (BSC)

Definition

Mobile Country Code of the own PLMN.

Coding rules

3 digits BCD

Mandatory rules

The OMC-R shall ensure that the following rules are always fulfilled:MCC (BSC) = MCC (MFS).- The cells belonging to the same BSC
shall have the same (MCC,MNC) couple.- The (MCC,MNC) couple
of cells internal to the OMC-R shall be selected from the set of own
PLMNs.- The (MCC,MNC) couple of cells external to the OMC-R can
be selected from the set of own or foreign PLMNs.

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

999

999

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Network

External Comment

The value depends on the configuration. The default value indicated


here is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

516 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.353 (Mobile Network Code (MNC)) - (MNC (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Mobile Network Code (MNC)

Logical Name

MNC (BSC)

Definition

Mobile Network Code of the own PLMN.

Coding rules

3 digits BCD

Mandatory rules

The OMC-R shall ensure that the following rules are always fulfilled:MNC (BSC) = MNC (MFS).- The cells belonging to the same BSC
shall have the same (MCC,MNC) couple.- The (MCC,MNC) couple
of cells internal to the OMC-R shall be selected from the set of own
PLMNs.- The (MCC,MNC) couple of cells external to the OMC-R can
be selected from the set of own or foreign PLMNs.

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

999

999

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

RNUSM / Edit Network

External Comment

The value depends on configuration. The default value indicated here


is for implementation purposes.The operator is allowed to enter 2 or
3 digits MNC in the CDE table.MNC such as yz or Fyz correspond
to a 2 digits MNC (y, z = 0..9). (F binary coded 1111)MNC such as
xyz correspond to a 3 digits MNC (x = 0..9).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

517 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.354 (MS_P_CON_ACK) - (MS_P_CON_ACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MS_P_CON_ACK

Logical Name

MS_P_CON_ACK

Definition

Supervision of the MS Power Control procedure.

Coding rules

step size=1 (2 x Samfr)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

2 x Samfr

31

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

3s

Umbrella

3s

Concentric

3s

Concentric Umbrella

3s

Microcell

2s

Minicell

3s

Extended inner cell

3s

Extended outer cell

3s

Nb of TRX Dependent

518 / 1182

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.355 (MS_P_CON_INT) - (MS_P_CON_INT)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MS_P_CON_INT

Logical Name

MS_P_CON_INT

Definition

Minimum delay between two consecutive MS power commands.

Coding rules

step size=1 (2 x Samfr)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

2 x Samfr

31

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

1s

Umbrella

1s

Concentric

1s

Concentric Umbrella

1s

Microcell

0s

Minicell

1s

Extended inner cell

1s

Extended outer cell

1s

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

519 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.356 (MS_TXPWR_MAX) - (MS_TXPWR_MAX)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MS_TXPWR_MAX

Logical Name

MS_TXPWR_MAX

Definition

MS maximum allowed transmission power.

Coding rules

P-GSM/G1 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 43 dBm,...., 19: 5


dBm.GSM 850 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 39 dBm, 1: 39 dBm, 2:
39 dBm, 3: 37 dBm, 4: 35 dBm,..., 19: 5 dBm.DCS 1800 coding:step
size = 2 dBm; 0: 30 dBm,..., 15: 0 dBm.DCS 1900 coding: range 0
to 15, 30, 31; 0: 30 dBm, 1: 28 dBm, ..., 15: 0 dBm, 30: 33 dBm,
31: 32 dBm.

Mandatory rules

MS_TXPWR_MAX >= MS_TXPWR_MIN

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

43

43

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control (+ Edit External cell


/ circuit1/2)

External Comment

According to the 3GPP TS 05.05, if the BCCH frequency band is


P-GSM/G1, depending on the version of MS (Phase 1 MS or Phase
2/onwards MS), the coded value "0", "1" and "2" are interpreted
differently:- Coded value "0": (interpreted as 43 dBm by the Phase
1 MS; interpreted as 39 dBm by the Phase 2/onwards MS);- Coded
value "1": (interpreted as 41 dBm by the Phase 1 MS; interpreted as
39 dBm by the Phase 2/onwards MS);- Coded value "2": (interpreted
as 39 dBm by both the Phase 1 MS and the Phase 2/onwards MS).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

520 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.357 (MS_TXPWR_MAX) - (MS_TXPWR_MAX(n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MS_TXPWR_MAX

Logical Name

MS_TXPWR_MAX(n)

Definition

MS maximum allowed transmission power.

Coding rules

P-GSM/G1 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 43 dBm, ..., 19: 5


dBm.GSM 850 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 39 dBm, 1: 39 dBm, 2:
39 dBm, 3: 37 dBm, 4: 35 dBm,..., 19: 5 dBm.DCS 1800 coding:step
size = 2 dBm; 0: 30 dBm, ..., 15: 0 dBm.DCS 1900 coding: range 0
to 15, 30, 31; 0: 30 dBm, 1: 28 dBm, ..., 15: 0 dBm, 30: 33 dBm,
31: 32 dBm.

Mandatory rules

MS_TXPWR_MAX >= MS_TXPWR_MIN

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

43

43

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Cell / Circuit 1/2

External Comment

According to the 3GPP TS 05.05, if the BCCH frequency band is


P-GSM/G1, depending on the version of MS (Phase 1 MS or Phase
2/onwards MS), the coded value "0", "1" and "2" are interpreted
differently:- Coded value "0": (interpreted as 43 dBm by the Phase
1 MS; interpreted as 39 dBm by the Phase 2/onwards MS);- Coded
value "1": (interpreted as 41 dBm by the Phase 1 MS; interpreted as
39 dBm by the Phase 2/onwards MS);-Coded value "2": (interpreted
as 39 dBm by both the Phase 1 MS and the Phase 2/onwards MS).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

521 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.358 (MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH) - (MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH

Logical Name

MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH (BSC)

Definition

Maximum transmission power an MS is allowed to use when


accessing the cell until otherwise commanded.

Coding rules

P-GSM/G1 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 43 dBm, ..., 19: 5


dBm.GSM 850 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 39 dBm, 1: 39 dBm, 2:
39 dBm, 3: 37 dBm, 4: 35 dBm,..., 19: 5 dBm.DCS 1800 coding:step
size = 2 dBm; 0: 30 dBm, ..., 15: 0 dBm.DCS 1900 coding: range 0
to 15, 30, 31; 0: 30 dBm, 1: 28 dBm, ..., 15: 0 dBm, 30: 33 dBm,
31: 32 dBm.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

43

43

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Selection

External Comment

According to the 3GPP TS 05.05, if the BCCH frequency band is


P-GSM/G1, depending on the version of MS (Phase 1 MS or Phase
2/onwards MS), the coded value "0", "1" and "2" are interpreted
differently:- Coded value "0": (interpreted as 43 dBm by the Phase
1 MS; interpreted as 39 dBm by the Phase 2/onwards MS);- Coded
value "1": (interpreted as 41 dBm by the Phase 1 MS; interpreted as
39 dBm by the Phase 2/onwards MS);- Coded value "2": (interpreted
as 39 dBm by both the Phase 1 MS and the Phase 2/onwards MS).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

522 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.359 (MS_TXPWR_MAX_INNER) - (MS_TXPWR_MAX_INNER)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MS_TXPWR_MAX_INNER

Logical Name

MS_TXPWR_MAX_INNER

Definition

MS maximum allowed transmission power in the inner zone of a


concentric or multiband cell.

Coding rules

P-GSM/G1 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 43 dBm, ..., 19: 5


dBm.GSM 850 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 39 dBm, 1: 39 dBm, 2:
39 dBm, 3: 37 dBm, 4: 35 dBm,..., 19: 5 dBm.DCS 1800 coding:step
size = 2 dBm; 0: 30 dBm, ..., 15: 0 dBm.DCS 1900 coding: range 0
to 15, 30, 31; 0: 30 dBm, 1: 28 dBm, ..., 15: 0 dBm, 30: 33 dBm,
31: 32 dBm.

Mandatory rules

MS_TXPWR_MAX_INNER >= MS_TXPWR_MIN

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

43

43

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment

According to the 3GPP TS 05.05, if the BCCH frequency band is


P-GSM/G1, depending on the version of MS (Phase 1 MS or Phase
2/onwards MS), the coded value "0", "1" and "2" are interpreted
differently:- Coded value "0": (interpreted as 43 dBm by the Phase
1 MS; interpreted as 39 dBm by the Phase 2/onwards MS);- Coded
value "1": (interpreted as 41 dBm by the Phase 1 MS; interpreted as
39 dBm by the Phase 2/onwards MS);- Coded value "2": (interpreted
as 39 dBm by both the Phase 1 MS and the Phase 2/onwards
MS).Meaninful only in cells where: CELL_PARTITION_TYPE =
concentric.

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

523 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

Cell Type Dependent

Nb of TRX Dependent

524 / 1182

Single

N/A

Umbrella

N/A

Concentric

Concentric Umbrella

Microcell

N/A

Minicell

N/A

Extended inner cell

N/A

Extended outer cell

N/A

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.360 (MS_TXPWR_MIN) - (MS_TXPWR_MIN)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MS_TXPWR_MIN

Logical Name

MS_TXPWR_MIN

Definition

MS minimum allowed transmission power.

Coding rules

P-GSM/G1 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 43 dBm, ...,13: 17 dBm,,


19: 5 dBm.GSM 850 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 39 dBm, 1: 39
dBm, 2: 39 dBm, 3: 37 dBm, 4: 35 dBm,..., 13: 17 dBm,, 19: 5
dBm.DCS 1800 coding:step size = 2 dBm; 0: 30 dBm, ..., 13: 4 dBm,,
15: 0 dBm.DCS 1900 coding: range 0 to 15, 30, 31; 0: 30 dBm, 1:
28 dBm, ..., 13: 4 dBm,, 15: 0 dBm, 30: 33 dBm, 31: 32 dBm.

Mandatory rules

MS_TXPWR_MIN <= MS_TXPWR_MAX and


MS_TXPWR_MAX_INNER >= MS_TXPWR_MIN

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

43

17

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control (+ Edit External cell


/ circuit1/2)

External Comment

The default value depends on the BCCH frequency band:Default


value for P-GSM/G1: 17 dBmDefault value for GSM850: 17
dBmDefault value for DCS1800: 4 dBmDefault value for DCS1900:
4 dBm

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

525 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.361 (MSC Signalling Point Code) - (DPC)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MSC Signalling Point Code

Logical Name

DPC

Definition

Signalling Point Code of the MSC.

Coding rules

coded over 14 bits

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

16383

12

Modifiable

OMC Changes: EML RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

BSS parameters / A interface info

External Comment

Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated here


is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

526 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.362 (MSCR) - (MSCR (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MSCR

Logical Name

MSCR (BSC)

Definition

Year corresponding to the version of ETSI/3GPP recommendations


used to implement MSC software.

Coding rules

0 = MSC is release 98 or older; 1 = MSC is release 99 onwards

Mandatory rules

MSCR (BSC) = MSCR (MFS)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Internetworking MSC Internetworking

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

527 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.363 (MSCR) - (MSCR (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MSCR

Logical Name

MSCR (MFS)

Definition

Year corresponding to the version of ETSI/3GPP recommendations


used to implement MSC software.

Coding rules

0 = MSC is release 98 or older; 1 = MSC is release 99 onwards

Mandatory rules

MSCR (BSC) = MSCR (MFS)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Internetworking MSC Internetworking

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

528 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.364 (MTP_Sequence_Number_Format) (MTP_Sequence_Number_Format)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MTP_Sequence_Number_Format

Logical Name

MTP_Sequence_Number_Format

Definition

Defines the format to be used for the sequence number of MTP2.

Coding rules

0: Normal1: Extended

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Value "Extended" is refused by the BSC if EN_HSL=0

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

529 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.365 (MULTIBAND_REPORTING) - (MULTIBAND_REPORTING (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MULTIBAND_REPORTING

Logical Name

MULTIBAND_REPORTING (BSC)

Definition

Minimum number of cells of each supported frequency band to be


included in MEASUREMENT REPORT by the MS.

Coding rules

Coded over 2 bits:00: normal reporting of the six strongest cells,


with known and allowed NCC part of BSIC, irrespective of the band
used;01: the MS shall report the strongest cell, with known and
allowed NCC part of BSIC, in each of the frequency bands in the BA
list, excluding the frequency band of the serving cell;10: the MS shall
report the two strongest cells, with known and allowed NCC part
of BSIC, in each of the frequency bands in the BA list, excluding
the frequency band of the serving cell; 11: the MS shall report the
three strongest cells, with known and allowed NCC part of BSIC, in
each of the frequency bands in the BA list, excluding the frequency
band of the serving cell.

Mandatory rules

Equal to MULTIBAND_REPORTING (MFS)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Hierarchical and multiband HO Ctrl

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

530 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.366 (MULTIBAND_REPORTING) - (MULTIBAND_REPORTING (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MULTIBAND_REPORTING

Logical Name

MULTIBAND_REPORTING (MFS)

Definition

Minimum number of cells of each supported frequency band to be


included in MEASUREMENT REPORT by the MS.

Coding rules

Coded over 2 bits:00: normal reporting of the six strongest cells,


with known and allowed NCC part of BSIC, irrespective of the band
used;01: the MS shall report the strongest cell, with known and
allowed NCC part of BSIC, in each of the frequency bands in the BA
list, excluding the frequency band of the serving cell;10: the MS shall
report the two strongest cells, with known and allowed NCC part
of BSIC, in each of the frequency bands in the BA list, excluding
the frequency band of the serving cell; 11: the MS shall report the
three strongest cells, with known and allowed NCC part of BSIC, in
each of the frequency bands in the BA list, excluding the frequency
band of the serving cell.

Mandatory rules

Equal to MULTIBAND_REPORTING (BSC)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Hierarchical and multiband HO Ctrl

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

531 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.367 (MULTIBAND_TRAFFIC_CONDITION) (MULTIBAND_TRAFFIC_CONDITION)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MULTIBAND_TRAFFIC_CONDITION

Logical Name

MULTIBAND_TRAFFIC_CONDITION

Definition

This parameter determines the condition on traffic load in the serving


cell to trigger a multiband handover.

Coding rules

0: Any load, 1: Not low, 2: High

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / Hierarchical and multiband HO Ctrl

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

532 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.368 (N_BAD_SACCH) - (N_BAD_SACCH)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

N_BAD_SACCH

Logical Name

N_BAD_SACCH

Definition

Number of consecutive bad SACCH frames to trigger a rescue


handover.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

1) N_BAD_SACCH = RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT_BS - N_BSTXPWR_M


+ 12) In micro cells, it is recommended to set N_BAD_SACCH so
that T_AUTOCLEANING_MEAS_REP > N_BAD_SACCH * 480ms +
30 seconds if T_AUTOCLEANING_MEAS_REP <> 0.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

Samfr

128

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO Parameters / Lower Layer HO Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

N/A

Umbrella

N/A

Concentric

N/A

Concentric Umbrella

N/A

Microcell

Minicell

N/A

Extended inner cell

N/A

Extended outer cell

N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

533 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.369 (N_TCH_HO) - (N_TCH_HO)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

N_TCH_HO

Logical Name

N_TCH_HO

Definition

Number of less interfered Full Rate TCH reserved for handover.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

534 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.370 (N_TRAFFIC_LOAD) - (N_TRAFFIC_LOAD)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

N_TRAFFIC_LOAD

Logical Name

N_TRAFFIC_LOAD

Definition

Number of consecutive load averages used in traffic load evaluation


process.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent
t01

t02

t03

t04

t05

t06

t07

t08

t09

t010

t011

t012

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

535 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.371 (NB_CLR_REQ) - (N_CLR_REQ)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NB_CLR_REQ

Logical Name

N_CLR_REQ

Definition

Maximum number of CLEAR REQUEST message transmission.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

536 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.372 (NB_PREF_CELLS) - (N_PREF_CELLS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NB_PREF_CELLS

Logical Name

N_PREF_CELLS

Definition

Maximum number of candidate cells sent in one HANDOVER


REQUIRED.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

16

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / Handover Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

537 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.373 (Nbr AC 11-15 unbarred in one step) - (M2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Nbr AC 11-15 unbarred in one step

Logical Name

M2

Definition

Number of high priority access classes (11..15) are unbarred in one


step.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / Overload and Barring

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

538 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.374 (Nbr. AC 0-9 barred in one step) - (N1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Nbr. AC 0-9 barred in one step

Logical Name

N1

Definition

Number of low priority access classes (0..9) are barred in one step.

Coding rules

Value 0 inhibits the automatic barring of low priority access classes.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / Overload and Barring

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

539 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.375 (Nbr. AC 0-9 unbarred in one step) - (N2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Nbr. AC 0-9 unbarred in one step

Logical Name

N2

Definition

Number of low priority access classes (0..9) are unbarred in one step.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / Overload and Barring

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

540 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.376 (Nbr. AC 11-15 barred in one step) - (M1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Nbr. AC 11-15 barred in one step

Logical Name

M1

Definition

Number of high priority access classes (11..15) are barred in one


step.

Coding rules

Value 0 inhibits the automatic barring of high priority access classes

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC /Procedures / Overload and Barring

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

541 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.377 (NBR_RESET_CIC_REP) - (NBR_RESET_CIC_REP)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NBR_RESET_CIC_REP

Logical Name

NBR_RESET_CIC_REP

Definition

Maximum number of RESET CIRCUIT message repetitions when


not acknowledged by the MSC.

Coding rules

255: RESET CIRCUIT message is indefinitely repeated

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

542 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.378 (NBR_RESET_REP) - (NBR_RESET_REP)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NBR_RESET_REP

Logical Name

NBR_RESET_REP

Definition

Number of times the RESET message is sent without being


acknowledged by the MSC before an alarm is reported.

Coding rules

If NBR_RESET_REP = 0, RESET message is not sent

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

127

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

543 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.379 (NCC) - (NCC (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NCC

Logical Name

NCC (BSC)

Definition

Network Colour code of the cell.

Coding rules

Coded over 3 bits.

Mandatory rules

Equal to NCC (MFS)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description (+Edit External cell


/ circuit1/2)

External Comment

Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated here


is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

544 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.380 (NCC) - (NCC (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NCC

Logical Name

NCC (MFS)

Definition

Network Colour code of the cell.

Coding rules

Coded over 3 bits.

Mandatory rules

Equal to NCC (BSC)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description (+ Edit External cell


/ circuit1/2)

External Comment

Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated here


is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

545 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.381 (NCC) - (NCC(n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NCC

Logical Name

NCC(n)

Definition

Network Colour code of the neighbour cell.

Coding rules

Coded over 3 bits.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description (+ Edit External cell


/ circuit1/2)

External Comment

Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated here is


for implementation purposes.This parameter is for every cell. The
operator needs only to configure the value of that parameter for OMC
external cells ; the parameter is autonomously filled by the OMC in
case the adjacent cell is an OMC internal cell

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

546 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.382 (NCC permitted) - (NCC_permitted)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NCC permitted

Logical Name

NCC_permitted

Definition

Indicates which NCC values the MS considers as belonging to the


network.

Coding rules

Coded over 8 bits. each bit corresponds to a NCC value: MSB


corresponds to NCC = 7, LSB corresponds to NCC = 0. For each
bit:0= NCC not permitted, 1= NCC permitted

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

List of numbers

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description

External Comment

The value depends on configuration. The default value indicated


here is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

547 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.383 (NCI) - (NCI)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NCI

Logical Name

NCI

Definition

This flag indicates to the MS if it reports a HANDOVER FAILURE in


case of out of range timing advance.

Coding rules

0: Out of range timing advance is ignored, 1: Out of range timing


advance triggers a Handover Failure procedure

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / HO Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

548 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.384 (NEIGHBOUR_RXLEV) - (NEIGHBOUR_RXLEV(0,n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NEIGHBOUR_RXLEV

Logical Name

NEIGHBOUR_RXLEV(0,n)

Definition

Threshold of maximum received level from the neighbour cells for


cause 13.

Coding rules

coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-47

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Adjacencies

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

N/A

Umbrella

N/A

Concentric

-47 dBm (63)

Concentric Umbrella

-47 dBm (63)

Microcell

N/A

Minicell

N/A

Extended inner cell

N/A

Extended outer cell

N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

549 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.385 (NUM_TCH_EMERGENCY_HO) - (NUM_TCH_EGNCY_HO)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NUM_TCH_EMERGENCY_HO

Logical Name

NUM_TCH_EGNCY_HO

Definition

Number of full rate TCH reserved for incoming emergency handovers


(plus Cause 12 and Cause 27 handovers).

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO Parameters / General HO Control

External Comment

The Pre-emption procedure (in case EN_TCH_PREEMPT =


enabled) might use these reserved TCHs in order to avoid releasing
an on-going call unnecessarily.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

550 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.386 (NY_1) - (NY1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NY_1

Logical Name

NY1

Definition

Maximum number of repetitions of PHYSICAL INFORMATION.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

For rules, see T3105_D and T3105_F_FR, T3105_F_HR.

Recommended rules

For rules, see T3105_D and T3105_F_FR, T3105_F_HR.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

35

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Timers

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

551 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.387 (OFFSET_CA_HIGH) - (OFFSET_CA_HIGH)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

OFFSET_CA_HIGH

Logical Name

OFFSET_CA_HIGH

Definition

Offset for AMR channel adaptation hysteresis under high load.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 (0 coded as 0, 0.1 coded as 1 7 coded as 70)

Mandatory rules

OFFSET_CA_HIGH >= OFFSET_CA_NORMAL

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

4.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

552 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.388 (OFFSET_CA_NORMAL) - (OFFSET_CA_NORMAL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

OFFSET_CA_NORMAL

Logical Name

OFFSET_CA_NORMAL

Definition

Offset for AMR channel adaptation hysteresis under normal load.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 (0 coded as 0, 0.1 coded as 1 7 coded as 70)

Mandatory rules

OFFSET_CA_HIGH >= OFFSET_CA_NORMAL

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

4.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

553 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.389 (OFFSET_HO_MARGIN_INNER) - (OFFSET_HO_MARGIN_INNER)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

OFFSET_HO_MARGIN_INNER

Logical Name

OFFSET_HO_MARGIN_INNER

Definition

Offset which allows to take into account the radio differences


between the inner and the outer zone (especially in multiband cells).

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-127

127

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

554 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.390 (OFFSET_HOPPING_HO) - (Offset_Hopping_HO)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

OFFSET_HOPPING_HO

Logical Name

Offset_Hopping_HO

Definition

Offset applied in the handover quality causes for radio hopping


channels.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 (1==0.1 70==7)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

555 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.391 (OFFSET_HOPPING_PC) - (Offset_Hopping_PC)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

OFFSET_HOPPING_PC

Logical Name

Offset_Hopping_PC

Definition

Offset applied in the power control quality causes for hopping radio
channels.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 (1==0.1 70==7)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

556 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.392 (OUTDOOR_UMB_LEV) - (OUTDOOR_UMB_LEV(0,n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

OUTDOOR_UMB_LEV

Logical Name

OUTDOOR_UMB_LEV(0,n)

Definition

Minimum received level from umbrella cell n to allow handover cause


"level uplink micro-cell" or "level downlink micro-cell".

Coding rules

coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-80

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO Parameters / Low Layer HO Ctrl (+ Edit Adjacency)

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

N/A

Umbrella

N/A

Concentric

N/A

Concentric Umbrella

N/A

Microcell

-88 dBm (22)

Minicell

-88 dBm (22)

Extended inner cell

N/A

Extended outer cell

N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

557 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.393 (PAGING) - (PAG_BAR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PAGING

Logical Name

PAG_BAR

Definition

This flag indicates if transmission of Pagings is allowed in the cell.

Coding rules

0: Pagings are not barred, 1: Pagings are barred

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description

External Comment

this flag can be used by an operator to temporarily prevent phones


from ringing in specific cells

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

558 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.394 (PENALTY_TIME) - (PENALTY_TIME(BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PENALTY_TIME

Logical Name

PENALTY_TIME(BSC)

Definition

Time during which MS shall apply TEMPORARY_OFFSET to C2


criterion.

Coding rules

step size = 20s. 0: 20s, 1: 40s, ..., 30: 620s, 31: TEMPORARY
OFFSET ignored and cell_RESELECT_OFFSET has a negative
value

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

20

620

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Selection

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

inhibited (31)

Umbrella

inhibited (31)

Concentric

inhibited (31)

Concentric Umbrella

inhibited (31)

Microcell

20 s (0)

Minicell

20 s (0)

Extended inner cell

inhibited (31)

Extended outer cell

inhibited (31)

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

559 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.395 (PENALTY_TIME) - (PENALTY_TIME(MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PENALTY_TIME

Logical Name

PENALTY_TIME(MFS)

Definition

Time during which MS shall apply TEMPORARY_OFFSET to C2


criterion.

Coding rules

step size = 20s. 0: 20s, 1: 40s, ..., 30: 620s, 31: TEMPORARY
OFFSET ignored and cell_RESELECT_OFFSET has a negative
value.

Mandatory rules

PENALTY_TIME(MFS) = PENALTY_TIME(BSC)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

20

620

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Selection

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

560 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.396 (PENALTY_TIME) - (PENALTY_TIME(n)(MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PENALTY_TIME

Logical Name

PENALTY_TIME(n)(MFS)

Definition

Time during which MS shall apply TEMPORARY_OFFSET to C2


criterion.

Coding rules

step size = 20s. 0: 20s, 1: 40s, ..., 30: 620s, 31: TEMPORARY
OFFSET ignored and cell_RESELECT_OFFSET has a negative
value

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

20

620

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit external cell / packet

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

561 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.397 (PING_PONG_HANDICAP) - (PING_PONG_HCP)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PING_PONG_HANDICAP

Logical Name

PING_PONG_HCP

Definition

A transient handicap is applied to power budget of previous cell to


avoid a "ping-pong" effect.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

127

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

562 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.398 (POW_INC_FACTOR) - (POW_INC_FACTOR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

POW_INC_FACTOR

Logical Name

POW_INC_FACTOR

Definition

Weighting factor for power increase.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

POW_INC_FACTOR >= POW_RED_FACTOR

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.8

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

563 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.399 (POW_INC_STEP_SIZE) - (POW_INC_STEP_SIZE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

POW_INC_STEP_SIZE

Logical Name

POW_INC_STEP_SIZE

Definition

Power increase step size in case of power command triggered on


quality criterion.

Coding rules

step size = 2dB. 1: 2dB, 2: 4dB, ..., 7: 14 dB

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

POW_INC_STEP_SIZE > POW_RED_STEP_SIZE

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

14

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

564 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.400 (POW_RED_FACTOR) - (POW_RED_FACTOR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

POW_RED_FACTOR

Logical Name

POW_RED_FACTOR

Definition

Weighting factor for power reduction.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

POW_RED_FACTOR <= POW_INC_FACTOR

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

565 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.401 (POW_RED_STEP_SIZE) - (POW_RED_STEP_SIZE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

POW_RED_STEP_SIZE

Logical Name

POW_RED_STEP_SIZE

Definition

Power reduction step size in case of power command triggered on


quality criterion.

Coding rules

step size = 2dB. 1: 2dB, 2: 4dB

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

POW_RED_STEP_SIZE < POW_INC_STEP_SIZE

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

566 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.402 (Preference Mark) - (TRX_PREF_MARK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Preference Mark

Logical Name

TRX_PREF_MARK

Definition

Preference mark assigned to a given TRX.

Coding rules

0: PS/CS TRX: This TRX can carry PS and CS traffic and has the
lowest preference in the TCH sub-channel selection process used
to serve a CS call. 1: CS TRX with preference mark 1: This TRX
can carry only CS traffic and has the preference mark 1 in the TCH
sub-channel selection process used to serve a CS call.7: CS TRX
with preference mark 7: This TRX can carry only CS traffic and has
the highest preference in the TCH sub-channel selection process
used to served a CS call. It means that this TRX has the highest
priority for CS traffic.

Mandatory rules

1) For a TRX in the inner zone of a monoband or multiband concentric


cell, the parameter TRX_PREF_MARK shall be set to a non-null
value.2) For a hopping G1 TRX, if EGSM_RR_ALLOC_STRATEGY
= 0 and BCCH/CCCH are configured on PGSM TRX then
TRX_PREF_MARK <> 03)The following conditions are verified
by the OMC-R in order to check the upper limit of MAX_PDCH:i)
MAX_PDCH <= 8*(nb of TRXs with TRX_PREF_MARK = 0) 1 if TRX_PREF_MARK = 0 on BCCH TRX and CCCH_CONF
= "1: CCCH combined"ii) MAX_PDCH <= 8*(nb of TRXs with
TRX_PREF_MARK = 0) - 2 if TRX_PREF_MARK = 0 on BCCH
TRX and CCCH_CONF = "0: CCCH not combined"iii) MAX_PDCH
<= NB_TS_MPDCH + 8*(nb of TRXs with TRX_PREF_MARK = 0)
if TRX_PREF_MARK <> 0 on BCCH TRX.4) In case of cell shared
over 2 BTSs, the GPRS TRXs of the cell (ie TRX_PREF_MARK=0)
can be either on the main sector or on the secondary, but not on both.

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

TRX

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / TRX Configuration

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

567 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

External Comment

If EGPRS is activated in the cell, TRX_PREF_MARK (BCCH TRX)


= 0 and the BCCH TRX is associated to a TRE hardware and a
transmission pool allowing the usage of 8-PSK, the operator shall
ensure that the difference in the mean output powers between GSMK
and 8-PSK signals is less than 2 dB in order to be compliant with
3GPP TS 05.05 and 3GPP TS 05.08 requirements (or 4 dB if an
SDCCH timeslot is defined in timeslot number 7 of the BCCH TRX).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

568 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.403 (PREFERRED_BAND) - (PREFERRED_BAND)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PREFERRED_BAND

Logical Name

PREFERRED_BAND

Definition

Frequency band to which the multiband MS are preferentially


directed.

Coding rules

0: none, 1: GSM, 2: DCS

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / HO Control

External Comment

Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated here


is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

569 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.404 (Preventive cyclic retransmission flag) - (EN_PCR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Preventive cyclic retransmission flag

Logical Name

EN_PCR

Definition

This flag enables preventive cyclic retransmission.

Coding rules

0 : disabled, 1 : enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

This parameter is set to 1 by the BSC in case the Ater links of a BSS
are configured as satellite links.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

570 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.405 (PWRC) - (PWRC (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PWRC

Logical Name

PWRC (BSC)

Definition

This flag indicates to the MS if it includes measurements made on


BCCH frequency in case of frequency hopping channel.

Coding rules

0: measurements made on BCCH frequency are included, 1:


measurements made on BCCH frequency are not included.

Mandatory rules

Equal to PWRC (MFS)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

571 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.406 (PWRC) - (PWRC (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PWRC

Logical Name

PWRC (MFS)

Definition

This flag indicates to the MS whether or not it shall include


measurements made on BCCH frequency in case of frequency
hopping channel.

Coding rules

0: measurements made on BCCH frequency shall be included, 1:


measurements made on BCCH frequency shall not be included

Mandatory rules

Equal to PWRC (BSC)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

572 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.407 (Q703_N1) - (Q703_N1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Q703_N1

Logical Name

Q703_N1

Definition

Maximum number of MSU available for retransmission.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

127

127

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

not used if EN_HSL = 1

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

573 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.408 (Q703_N1_HSL) - (Q703_N1_HSL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Q703_N1_HSL

Logical Name

Q703_N1_HSL

Definition

Maximum number of MSU available for retransmission (if HSL is


used).

Coding rules

step size 1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

4095

4095

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

used if EN_HSL = 1

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

574 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.409 (Q703_N2) - (Q703_N2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Q703_N2

Logical Name

Q703_N2

Definition

Maximum number of MSU octets which are available for


retransmission.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

bytes

8192

4096

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

not used if EN_HSL = 1

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

575 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.410 (Q703_N2_HSL) - (Q703_N2_HSL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Q703_N2_HSL

Logical Name

Q703_N2_HSL

Definition

Maximum number of MSU octets which are available for


retransmission (if HSL is used).

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

bytes

65535

32767

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

used if EN_HSL = 1

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

576 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.411 (Q703_T1) - (Q703_T1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Q703_T1

Logical Name

Q703_T1

Definition

MTP2 timer "alignment ready".

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

40

50

50

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

not used if EN_HSL = 1

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

577 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.412 (Q703_T1_HSL) - (Q703_T1_HSL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Q703_T1_HSL

Logical Name

Q703_T1_HSL

Definition

MTP2 timer "alignment ready" for 2Mbit/s (if HSL is used).

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

25

350

300

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

used if EN_HSL = 1

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

578 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.413 (Q703_T2) - (Q703_T2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Q703_T2

Logical Name

Q703_T2

Definition

MTP2 timer "not aligned".

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

150

30

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

579 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.414 (Q703_T3) - (Q703_T3)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Q703_T3

Logical Name

Q703_T3

Definition

MTP2 timer "aligned".

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

580 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.415 (Q703_T4E) - (Q703_T4E)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Q703_T4E

Logical Name

Q703_T4E

Definition

MTP2 Emergency proving period.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.4

0.6

0.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Applicable to LSL and HSL.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

581 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.416 (Q703_T4N) - (Q703_T4N)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Q703_T4N

Logical Name

Q703_T4N

Definition

MTP2 Normal proving period.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

7.5

9.5

8.2

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

not used if EN_HSL = 1

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

582 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.417 (Q703_T4N_HSL) - (Q703_T4N_HSL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Q703_T4N_HSL

Logical Name

Q703_T4N_HSL

Definition

MTP2 Normal proving period for 2Mbit/s (if HSL is used).

Coding rules

step size = 1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

70

30

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

used if EN_HSL = 1

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

583 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.418 (Q703_T5) - (Q703_T5)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Q703_T5

Logical Name

Q703_T5

Definition

MTP2 timer "sending SIB".

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

80

120

100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

584 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.419 (Q703_T6) - (Q703_T6)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Q703_T6

Logical Name

Q703_T6

Definition

MTP2 timer "remote congestion".

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Q707_T1 >= Q703_T6

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

5.4

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

585 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.420 (Q703_T7) - (Q703_T7)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Q703_T7

Logical Name

Q703_T7

Definition

MTP2 timer "excessive delay of acknowledgement".

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

In case of a Ater satellite connection, this parameter is set to 2


seconds by the BSC.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

586 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.421 (Q704_T2) - (Q704_T2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Q704_T2

Logical Name

Q704_T2

Definition

MTP3 timer supervising the reception of changeover


acknowledgement.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.7

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

587 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.422 (Q704_T4) - (Q704_T4)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Q704_T4

Logical Name

Q704_T4

Definition

MTP3 timer supervising the reception of changeback


acknowledgement (first attempt).

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.5

1.2

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

588 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.423 (Q704_T5) - (Q704_T5)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Q704_T5

Logical Name

Q704_T5

Definition

MTP3 timer supervising the reception of changeback


acknowledgement (second attempt).

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.5

1.2

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

589 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.424 (Q707_T1) - (Q707_T1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Q707_T1

Logical Name

Q707_T1

Definition

MTP3 timer supervising the reception of signalling link test


acknowledgement.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Q707_T1 >= Q703_T6

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

12

6.4

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

590 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.425 (Q707_T2) - (Q707_T2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Q707_T2

Logical Name

Q707_T2

Definition

MTP3 delay between transmission of consecutive signalling link


test message.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

30

90

60

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

591 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.426 (RACH/PRACH_TA_FILTER) - (RACH_TA_FILTER (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

RACH/PRACH_TA_FILTER

Logical Name

RACH_TA_FILTER (BSC)

Definition

Timing Advance threshold for CHANNEL REQUIRED and PACKET


CHANNEL REQUEST filtering.

Coding rules

64: no filtering

Mandatory rules

Equal to RACH_TA_FILTER (MFS).

Recommended rules

Disable the filtering for extended cells.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

bper

64

64

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment

One unit corresponds to a distance of about 550m. CHANNEL


REQUIRED or PACKET CHANNEL REQUEST messages with
Timing Advance greater or equal to RACH_TA_FILTER are
discarded.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

592 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.427 (RACH_BUSY_THRES) - (RACH_BUSY_THRES)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

RACH_BUSY_THRES

Logical Name

RACH_BUSY_THRES

Definition

Received level above which a RACH TS is deemed busy.

Coding rules

This parameter is encoded with a step size of 4 dB as follows:1:


-110 dBm5: -106 dBm9: -102 dBm13: -98 dBm17: -94 dBm21:
-90 dBm25: -86 dBm29: -82 dBm33: -78 dBm37: -74 dBm41: -70
dBm45: -66 dBm49: -62 dBm53: -58 dBm57: -54 dBm61: -50 dBm

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-50

-106

Modifiable

OMC Changes: Displayed(PRC&SC) RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Ctrl Channel

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

593 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.428 (RADIOLINK_FAILURE_THRES) - (RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT_BS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

RADIOLINK_FAILURE_THRES

Logical Name

RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT_BS

Definition

Counter threshold to detect a radio link failure on the uplink path.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT_BS > N_BSTXPWR_M

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

Samfr

255

18

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / PC parameters / Radio Link Supervision

External Comment

Values higher than 128 are not recommended by Alcatel-Lucent


(very far to the 3GPP values):It will significantly increase the delay
for retransmission of a message. For instance, if a HANDOVER
COMMAND is sent to a given MS, but not received, the MS will have
to wait longer to get the repeated HO CMD, which may lead to call
drop in the meantime.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

594 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.429 (RADIOLINK_FAILURE_THRES_AMR) (RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT_BS_AMR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

RADIOLINK_FAILURE_THRES_AMR

Logical Name

RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT_BS_AMR

Definition

Counter threshold to detect a radio link failure on the uplink path


for calls using an AMR codec.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT_BS_AMR > N_BSTXPWR_M

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

Samfr

255

18

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

This parameter applies only to Evolium BTSs.Values higher than


128 are not recommended by Alcatel-Lucent (very far to the 3GPP
values): It will significantly increase the delay for retransmission
of a message. For instance, if a HANDOVER COMMAND is sent
to a given MS, but not received, the MS will have to wait longer
to get the repeated HO CMD, which may lead to call drop in the
meantime.Moreover, it can increase congestion in the BSS, as the
call duration is artificially increased.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

595 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.430 (RADIOLINK_RECOVERY_THRES) - (N_BSTXPWR_M)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

RADIOLINK_RECOVERY_THRES

Logical Name

N_BSTXPWR_M

Definition

Counter threshold to trigger a radio link recovery.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

N_BSTXPWR_M < RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT_BS

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

Samfr

127

13

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / PC parameters / Radio Link Supervision

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

13

Umbrella

13

Concentric

13

Concentric Umbrella

13

Microcell

15

Minicell

13

Extended inner cell

13

Extended outer cell

13

Nb of TRX Dependent

596 / 1182

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.431 (RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT) - (RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT

Logical Name

RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT (BSC)

Definition

Initial value of MS counter for radio link supervision.

Coding rules

step size = 4 Samfr, coded from 0 to 15 (0 == 4 Samfr, 1 == 8 Samfr


... 15 == 64 Samfr

Mandatory rules

Equal to RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT (MFS)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

Samfr

64

16

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

597 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.432 (RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT) - (RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT

Logical Name

RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT (MFS)

Definition

Initial value of MS counter for radio link supervision.

Coding rules

step size = 4 Samfr, coded from 0 to 15 (0 == 4 Samfr, 1 == 8 Samfr


... 15 == 64 Samfr

Mandatory rules

Equal to RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT (BSC)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

Samfr

64

16

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

598 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.433 (RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT_AMR) - (RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT_AMR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT_AMR

Logical Name

RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT_AMR

Definition

Initial value of MS counter for radio link supervision, when an AMR


codec is used.

Coding rules

step size = 4 Samfr, coded from 0 to 15 (0 == 4 Samfr, 1 == 8 Samfr


... 15 == 64 Samfr

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

Samfr

64

16

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

This parameter applies only to Evolium BTSs.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

599 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.434 (Reserved Slots Number for Basic CBCH) (Nb_of_reserved_slots_for_basic_CBCH)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Reserved Slots Number for Basic CBCH

Logical Name

Nb_of_reserved_slots_for_basic_CBCH

Definition

This parameter indicates the number of slots reserved for high


priority messages within the schedule period for basic CBCH.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

shall be set to "0" when SMSCB_FEATURE_SET="FS1"

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

40

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / SMSCB

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

600 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.435 (Reserved Slots Number for Extended CBCH) (Nb_of_reserved_slots_for_extended_CBCH)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Reserved Slots Number for Extended CBCH

Logical Name

Nb_of_reserved_slots_for_extended_CBCH

Definition

This parameter indicates the number of slots reserved for high


priority messages within the schedule period for extended CBCH.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

40

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / SMSCB

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

601 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.436 (RESET_INDEFINITE) - (RESET_INDEFINITE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

RESET_INDEFINITE

Logical Name

RESET_INDEFINITE

Definition

This flag determines whether or not the RESET message shall be


sent indefinitely (as long as it is not acknowledged).

Coding rules

0: RESET message is sent a maximum of NBR_RESET_REP times,


1: The Reset procedure is repeated until a RESET or RESET ACK
message is received.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment

Default value depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

602 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.437 (RESP_REQ) - (RESP_REQ)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

RESP_REQ

Logical Name

RESP_REQ

Definition

This flag controls "Response request" OIE inclusion in HANDOVER


REQUIRED.

Coding rules

0: IE not included, 1: IE included

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

When the VGCS feature (EN_VGCS) is activated, it is recommended


to include the Response Request in the HANDOVER REQUIRED
message (RESP_REQ).

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / HO Control

External Comment

Default value depends on MSC typeFor external directed retries,


the serving BSC does not know whether or not the external target
cells (towards which the directed retry is triggered) are congested.
Therefore, Alcatel recommend to set RESP_REQ to 1 if EN_EXT_DR
is set to enabled in order to get a Handover Reject message from
the MSC in case all target cells are congested and thus to attempt
other procedures.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

603 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.438 (RF_RES_IND_PERIOD) - (T_INTRF_L3)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

RF_RES_IND_PERIOD

Logical Name

T_INTRF_L3

Definition

Delay between two consecutive RF RESOURCE INDICATION.

Coding rules

step size = 1sec

Mandatory rules

T_INTRF_L3 > Max (T11, T_qho, T11_FORCED) & T_INTRF_L3 >


INTAVE

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

10

180

60

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

604 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.439 (RMS_TEMPLATE) - (RMS_TEMPLATE_INDEX)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

RMS_TEMPLATE

Logical Name

RMS_TEMPLATE_INDEX

Definition

Template of values of RMS parameters to be applied to the


concerned cell (concerns the parameters MEAS_STAT_C_Ix,
MEAS_STAT_BFIx, MEAS_STAT_LEVx, MEAS_STAT_PATH_BALx,
MEAS_STAT_Sx, EN_BALANCED_CI, VQ_AVERAGE,
VQ_BAD_RXFER, VQ_FER_THRESHOLD, VQ_GOOD_RXFER,
VQ_INTF_THRESHOLD, VQ_RXLEV, VQ_RXQUAL,
VQ_RXQUAL_VS_RXFER).

Coding rules

coded from 1 to 16

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

16

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / RMS & MAFA

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

605 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.440 (ROT) - (ROT)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

ROT

Logical Name

ROT

Definition

Indicates to the MS whether or not it shall include "Time Difference"


IE in HANDOVER COMPLETE.

Coding rules

0: "Mobile Time Difference" IE is NOT included in HANDOVER


COMPLETE, 1: "Mobile Time Difference" IE is included in
HANDOVER COMPLETE

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / HO Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

606 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.441 (RSL_RATE (BSC)) - (RSL_RATE (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

RSL_RATE (BSC)

Logical Name

RSL_RATE (BSC)

Definition

Rate used on all RSL links towards a BTS.

Coding rules

0: 16 kbit/s, 1: 64 kbit/s

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BTS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

607 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.442 (RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN) - (RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN

Logical Name

RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN (BSC)

Definition

Minimum received level at the MS required for initial access to the


cell.

Coding rules

Coded on 6 bits, 0=-110 dBm, 63=-47 dBm, step size=1dBm.

Mandatory rules

RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN (MFS) = RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN (BSC)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Selection

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

608 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.443 (RXLEV_DL_IH) - (RXLEV_DL_IH)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

RXLEV_DL_IH

Logical Name

RXLEV_DL_IH

Definition

Downlink level threshold for decision between intracell and intercell


handover in case of bad downlink quality.

Coding rules

Coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm.

Mandatory rules

RXLEV_DL_IH > L_RXLEV_DL_H

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-65

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

-65 dBm (45)

Umbrella

-65 dBm (45)

Concentric

-65 dBm (45)

Concentric Umbrella

-65 dBm (45)

Microcell

-65 dBm (45)

Minicell

-65 dBm (45)

Extended inner cell

-70 dBm (40)

Extended outer cell

-60 dBm (50)

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

609 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.444 (RXLEV_DL_ZONE) - (RXLEV_DL_ZONE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

RXLEV_DL_ZONE

Logical Name

RXLEV_DL_ZONE

Definition

Downlink level threshold for inner to outer zone handover.

Coding rules

Coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

If CELL_PARTITION_TYPE = "Concentric" AND


FREQUENCY_RANGE = "PGSM" or "DCS1800" or
"EGSM" or "DCS 1900":RXLEV_DL_ZONE >= L_RXLEV_DL_H
(This rule only applies to concentric and monoband cell.)

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-71

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

N/A

Umbrella

N/A

Concentric

-71 dBm (39)

Concentric Umbrella

-71 dBm (39)

Microcell

N/A

Minicell

N/A

Extended inner cell

N/A

Extended outer cell

N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent

610 / 1182

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.445 (RXLEV_LIMIT_PBGT_HO) - (RXLEV_LIMIT_PBGT_HO)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

RXLEV_LIMIT_PBGT_HO

Logical Name

RXLEV_LIMIT_PBGT_HO

Definition

Threshold on the downlink received level above which it is not


necessary to trigger a handover on power budget (cause 12).

Coding rules

Coded over 6 bits:0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-47

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

-65 dBm (45)

Umbrella

-65 dBm (45)

Concentric

-65 dBm (45)

Concentric Umbrella

-65 dBm (45)

Microcell

-65 dBm (45)

Minicell

-65 dBm (45)

Extended inner cell

-70 dBm (40)

Extended outer cell

-60 dBm (50)

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

611 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.446 (RXLEV_MIN_n) - (RXLEVmin(n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

RXLEV_MIN_n

Logical Name

RXLEVmin(n)

Definition

Minimum level received from cell n to allow reception of handover.

Coding rules

Coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-96

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Selection (+ Edit External cell


/ circuit1/2)

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

-100 dBm (10)

Umbrella

-100 dBm (10)

Concentric

-100 dBm (10)

Concentric Umbrella

-100 dBm (10)

Microcell

-100 dBm (10)

Minicell

-100 dBm (10)

Extended inner cell

-100 dBm (10)

Extended outer cell

-102 dBm (8)

Nb of TRX Dependent

612 / 1182

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.447 (RXLEV_UL_IH) - (RXLEV_UL_IH)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

RXLEV_UL_IH

Logical Name

RXLEV_UL_IH

Definition

Uplink level threshold for decision between intracell and intercell


handover in case of bad uplink quality.

Coding rules

Coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm.

Mandatory rules

RXLEV_UL_IH > L_RXLEV_UL_H

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-65

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

-75 dBm (35)

Umbrella

-75 dBm (35)

Concentric

-75 dBm (35)

Concentric Umbrella

-75 dBm (35)

Microcell

-65 dBm (45)

Minicell

-70 dBm (40)

Extended inner cell

-75 dBm (35)

Extended outer cell

-75 dBm (35)

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

613 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.448 (RXLEV_UL_ZONE) - (RXLEV_UL_ZONE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

RXLEV_UL_ZONE

Logical Name

RXLEV_UL_ZONE

Definition

Uplink level threshold for inner to outer zone handover.

Coding rules

Coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

If CELL_PARTITION_TYPE = "Concentric" AND


FREQUENCY_RANGE = "PGSM" or "DCS1800" or
"EGSM" or "DCS 1900":RXLEV_UL_ZONE >= L_RXLEV_UL_H
(This rule only applies to concentric and monoband cell.)

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-78

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

N/A

Umbrella

N/A

Concentric

-78 dBm (32)

Concentric Umbrella

-78 dBm (32)

Microcell

N/A

Minicell

N/A

Extended inner cell

N/A

Extended outer cell

N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent

614 / 1182

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.449 (Schedule Period for Basic CBCH) (Schedule_period_for_basic_CBCH)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Schedule Period for Basic CBCH

Logical Name

Schedule_period_for_basic_CBCH

Definition

Length of the DRX schedule period for the basic CBCH.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

CBper

40

32

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / SMSCB

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

615 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.450 (Schedule period for Extended CBCH) (Schedule_period_for_extended_CBCH)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Schedule period for Extended CBCH

Logical Name

Schedule_period_for_extended_CBCH

Definition

Length of the DRX schedule period for the extended CBCH.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

CBper

40

32

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / SMSCB

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

616 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.451 (SDCCH_COUNTER) - (SDCCH_COUNTER)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

SDCCH_COUNTER

Logical Name

SDCCH_COUNTER

Definition

Time during which SDCCH handovers are forbidden after completion


of the Immediate Assignment procedure.

Coding rules

step size=1 (2 x Samfr)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

SDCCH_COUNTER <= T_SDCCH_PC

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

2 x Samfr

31

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment

"0" means that SDCCH handover is immediately allowed after


completion of the Immediate Assignment procedure.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

617 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.452 (SDCCH_HO) - (HO_SDCCH_INHIBIT)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

SDCCH_HO

Logical Name

HO_SDCCH_INHIBIT

Definition

The flag inhibits/enables the execution of SDCCH handovers.

Coding rules

0: SDCCH HO enabled1: SDCCH HO disabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment

This parameter has no influence on Directed Retry

Cell Type Dependent

Single

enable (0)

Umbrella

enable (0)

Concentric

enable (0)

Concentric Umbrella

enable (0)

Microcell

enable (0)

Minicell

enable (0)

Extended inner cell

disabled (1) *

Extended outer cell

disabled (1) *

Nb of TRX Dependent

618 / 1182

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.453 (Send_CM_Enquiry) - (BSS_SEND_CM_ENQUIRY)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Send_CM_Enquiry

Logical Name

BSS_SEND_CM_ENQUIRY

Definition

Controls the trigger of Classmark Enquiry procedure at call


establishment time.

Coding rules

0: the classmark enquiry is never initiated by the BSC;1: on


reception of a LOCATION UPDATING REQUEST message with ES
IND flag set to 0, the BSC will always initiate a classmark enquiry;2:
on reception of a LOCATION UPDATING REQUEST message with
ES IND flag set to 0, the BSC will initiate the classmark enquiry if
algorithm A5/1 is not available (information available in MS classmark
1 IE sent in the LOCATION UPDATING REQUEST).

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

619 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.454 (Signalling Link Code) - (SLC)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Signalling Link Code

Logical Name

SLC

Definition

Signalling Link Code.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

N7 ch

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: EML RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

BSS parameters / A interface info

External Comment

Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated here


is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

620 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.455 (SMSCB_Features_Set) - (SMSCB_Features_set)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

SMSCB_Features_Set

Logical Name

SMSCB_Features_set

Definition

This parameter indicates which features are usable with the SMSCB
product.

Coding rules

1: Features set 1, 2: Features set 2

Mandatory rules

Can be changed only when SMSCB_STATE = "inactive".If


SMSCB_Features_set = FS1, then CBC_Window shall be equal
to "1"- If SMSCB_Features_set = FS1, then SMSCB_Recovery
shall be set to "No"- If SMSCB_Features_set = FS1, then
for all the BSC cells Use_of_Extended_CBCH shall be set to
"No"- If SMSCB_Features_set = FS1, then for all the BSC cells
Nb_of_reserved_slots_for_basic_CBCH shall be set to "0"

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Interworking / CBC interworking

External Comment

When migrating from FS1 to FS2,USE_OF_EXTENDED_CBCH


shall be set to "Yes",CBC_WINDOW shall be set to 4.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

621 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.456 (SMSCB_Phase) - (SMSCB_Phase)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

SMSCB_Phase

Logical Name

SMSCB_Phase

Definition

This parameter indicates whether the feature operates in GSM


Phase2 or Phase 2+ mode.

Coding rules

0: Phase 2, 1: Phase 2+

Mandatory rules

If SMSCB_FEATURES_SET="FS1", SMSCB_PHASE shall be set


to "phase2"If SMSCB_FEATURES_SET="FS2", SMSCB_PHASE
shall be set to "phase2+"SMSCB_Phase can be changed only when
SMSCB_STATE="inactive"

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Interworking / CBC interworking

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

622 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.457 (SMSCB_Recovery) - (SMSCB_Recovery)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

SMSCB_Recovery

Logical Name

SMSCB_Recovery

Definition

This parameter indicates if the CBC accepts the recovery-indication


in Restart-Indication message.

Coding rules

0: No, 1: Yes

Mandatory rules

shall be set to "No" when SMSCB_FEATURE_SET="FS1"can be


changed only when SMSCB_STATE="inactive"

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Interworking / CBC interworking

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

623 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.458 (SMSCB_State) - (SMSCB_State)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

SMSCB_State

Logical Name

SMSCB_State

Definition

This flag indicates if the feature is activated or deactivated.

Coding rules

0: activated, 1: deactivated

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: Displayed(PRC&SC) RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Interworking / CBC interworking

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

624 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.459 (Strip_Octet_5_In_CM2) - (STRIP_O5_CM2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Strip_Octet_5_In_CM2

Logical Name

STRIP_O5_CM2

Definition

This flag controls the format of the "Classmark 2" IE sent to the MSC.

Coding rules

0: no modification on "Classmark2" IE, 1: octet 5 of "Classmark2" IE


is stripped out

Mandatory rules

EN_SEND_CM3 and STRIP_O5_CM2 shall not be both set to 1 at


the same time.

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment

Default value depends on MSC type.The value indicated here is for


implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

625 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.460 (SYNCHRONISED_HO) - (EN_SYNCHRONISED_HO)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

SYNCHRONISED_HO

Logical Name

EN_SYNCHRONISED_HO

Definition

This flag enables/disables synchronous handovers between


synchronized cells.

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

EN_SYNCHRONISED_HO shall be set to disabled when


CELL_TYPE is equal to "Extended inner" or "Extended outer".

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

626 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.461 (T(conn est)) - (T(conn est))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T(conn est)

Logical Name

T(conn est)

Definition

SCCP timer supervising the reception of Connection Confirm


message.

Coding rules

step size = 0.5sec

Mandatory rules

T(conn est) < T9105

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

10

127.5

30

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

627 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.462 (T(iar)) - (T(iar))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T(iar)

Logical Name

T(iar)

Definition

SCCP timer supervising the activity on SCCP connection.

Coding rules

step size = 6sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Must be greater than T(ias) used by the MSCIt is recommended to


configure T(iar) > (2 x T(ias) used by the MSC) + 1 min

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

402

1530

1260

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

628 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.463 (T(ias)) - (T(ias))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T(ias)

Logical Name

T(ias)

Definition

SCCP timer supervising the sending of Inactivity Test message.

Coding rules

step size = 6sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Must be less than T(iar) used by the MSCIt is recommended to


configure T(ias) < (T(iar) used by the MSC - 1 min) / 2

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

96

450

300

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

629 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.464 (T(rel)) - (T(rel))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T(rel)

Logical Name

T(rel)

Definition

SCCP timer supervising the reception of Release Complete


message.

Coding rules

step size = 0.5sec, coded from 16 to 255, 16 == 8 sec, 255 == 127.5


sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

127.5

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

630 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.465 (T(sst)) - (T(sst))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T(sst)

Logical Name

T(sst)

Definition

SCCP delay between sending of consecutive Subsystem Status Test


messages.

Coding rules

step size = 6sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

1200

30

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

631 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.466 (T_BIND_CNF) - (T_BIND_CNF)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_BIND_CNF

Logical Name

T_BIND_CNF

Definition

Maximum waiting time to get a response to a CBSE-BIND primitive.

Coding rules

step size = 1 sec

Mandatory rules

Can be changed only when SMSCB_State is disabled

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

10

300

30

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Interworking / CBC interworking

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

632 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.467 (T_BURST) - (T_BURST)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_BURST

Logical Name

T_BURST

Definition

Delay between consecutive bursts of BLOCK or UNBLOCK


messages.

Coding rules

step size =0.1 sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

(31 x T_BURST) / B_NUM < T1_short

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.1

25.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment

Default value depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

633 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.468 (T_HCP) - (T_HCP)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_HCP

Logical Name

T_HCP

Definition

Time during which PING_PONG_HCP is applied after handover.

Coding rules

step size= 1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

240

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO parameters / General HO Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

634 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.469 (T_HO_REQD_LOST) - (T_HO_REQD_LOST)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_HO_REQD_LOST

Logical Name

T_HO_REQD_LOST

Definition

Supervision of the MSC response after sending of HANDOVER


REQUIRED.

Coding rules

step size = 1sec

Mandatory rules

T_HO_REQD_LOST > T7

Recommended rules

T_HO_REQD_LOST value shall be greater than the maximum time


for external handover execution

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

120

30

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / HO Control

External Comment

Depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

635 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.470 (T_IA) - (T_IA)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_IA

Logical Name

T_IA

Definition

Indicates the maximum time a CS IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT


message remains in the AGCH queue.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

T_IA<T3101

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

2.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Timers

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

636 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.471 (T_INHIBIT_CPT) - (T_INHIBIT_CPT)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_INHIBIT_CPT

Logical Name

T_INHIBIT_CPT

Definition

Time during which the HO Causes 14, 21, and 24 are inhibited.

Coding rules

step size = 1 sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

240

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO Parameters / Hierarchical & Multiband HO Control

External Comment

T_INHIBIT_CPT = 0 inhibits the anti ping-pong function.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

637 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.472 (T_MS_CELL_REJ) - (T_MS_CELL_REJ)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_MS_CELL_REJ

Logical Name

T_MS_CELL_REJ

Definition

Delay where the cells the MS failed to handover, cannot be selected


as targets in subsequent handover attempts.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / HO Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

638 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.473 (T_PAG_CS) - (T_PAG_CS (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_PAG_CS

Logical Name

T_PAG_CS (BSC)

Definition

This timer indicates the maximum time a CS PAGING message can


remain in a Paging Group Queue. It includes the round-trip delay on
A and A-bis or Gs/Gb and A-bis interface.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Equal to T_PAG_CS (MFS)

Recommended rules

T_PAG_CS<T3113 (MSC timer)

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

25.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Ctrl Channel

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

639 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.474 (T_PAG_CS) - (T_PAG_CS (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_PAG_CS

Logical Name

T_PAG_CS (MFS)

Definition

This timer indicates the maximum time a CS PAGING message can


remain in a Paging Group Queue. It includes the round-trip delay on
A and A-bis or Gs/Gb and A-bis interface.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Equal to T_PAG_CS (BSC)

Recommended rules

T_PAG_CS<T3113 (MSC timer)

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

25.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Ctrl Channel

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

640 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.475 (T_QHO) - (T_qho)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_QHO

Logical Name

T_qho

Definition

Maximum queuing time for Handover Requests.

Coding rules

step size = 1sec

Mandatory rules

T_INTRF_L3 > Max (T11, T_qho, T11_FORCED)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

641 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.476 (T_SDCCH_PC) - (T_SDCCH_PC)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_SDCCH_PC

Logical Name

T_SDCCH_PC

Definition

Time during which power control on SDCCH is inhibited after


completion of the Immediate Assignment procedure.

Coding rules

step size = 1 (2 x Samfr)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

T_SDCCH_PC >= SDCCH_COUNTER

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

2 x Samfr

31

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

642 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.477 (T1) - (T1_short)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T1

Logical Name

T1_short

Definition

Supervision of the Blocking/Unblocking procedure.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

T1_short > (31 x T_BURST) / B_NUM

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

10

25.5

16

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment

Default value depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

643 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.478 (T11) - (T11)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T11

Logical Name

T11

Definition

Maximum queuing time for Assignment Requests.

Coding rules

step size = 1 s

Mandatory rules

T_INTRF_L3 > Max (T11, T_qho, T11_FORCED)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

19

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment

Default value depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

644 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.479 (T11_FORCED) - (T11_FORCED)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T11_FORCED

Logical Name

T11_FORCED

Definition

Maximum queuing time for Assignment Requests where queuing is


not allowed by the MSC.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

T_INTRF_L3 > Max (T11, T_qho, T11_FORCED)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

19

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment

Default value depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

645 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.480 (T13) - (T13)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T13

Logical Name

T13

Definition

Delay for acknowledgement of RESET received from MSC.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

6553.5

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment

Default value depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

646 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.481 (T17) - (T17)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T17

Logical Name

T17

Definition

Period of time where a new OVERLOAD that is received from the


MSC, is not processed after reception of a processed OVERLOAD.

Coding rules

step size: 0.1 sec

Mandatory rules

T17 < T18_overload

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

6553.5

30

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / Overload and Barring

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

647 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.482 (T18) - (T18)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T18

Logical Name

T18

Definition

Delay between consecutive debarring actions after a BSS outage.

Coding rules

Step size: 0.1 sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

6553.5

50

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / Overload and Barring

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

648 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.483 (T18_OVERLOAD) - (T18_Overload)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T18_OVERLOAD

Logical Name

T18_Overload

Definition

Delay between the latest MSC OVERLOAD message or DTC


internal overload detection and debarring action. Also delay between
consecutive debarring actions for overload procedure and Telecom
global reset procedure.

Coding rules

step size: 0.1 sec

Mandatory rules

T18_OVERLOAD > T17

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

6553.5

50

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Barring

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

649 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.484 (T19) - (T19)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T19

Logical Name

T19

Definition

Supervision of the Reset Circuit procedure.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.1

25.5

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment

Default value depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

650 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.485 (T20) - (T20)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T20

Logical Name

T20

Definition

Supervision of Circuit Group Blocking procedure.

Coding rules

step size=0.1 sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

10

25.5

16

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

651 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.486 (T200 (BSC)) - (T200 (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T200 (BSC)

Logical Name

T200 (BSC)

Definition

Supervision of acknowledgements.

Coding rules

step size: 100ms; (1: 100ms, 2: 200ms, 3: 300ms, 4: 400ms, .. .


, 10: 1000ms

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

The recommended value for Abis via satellite is 1000 ms.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

A-bis link

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

300

1000

300

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

The value of T200 (BSC) is driven by the associated Abis connection


type.It can be changed indirectly from the OMC (through the change
of Abis connection type)The default value 300 ms corresponds to
Abis terrestrial link.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

652 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.487 (T200_TF) - (T200_TF)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T200_TF

Logical Name

T200_TF

Definition

Supervision of acknowledgements for FACCH (TCH FR associated)


SAPI 0.

Coding rules

Step size = 20 msec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

200

5100

200

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Modification of the value of this parameter will trigger an automatic


restart of all TREs of the cell, leading to a release of all ongoing
calls.Values higher than 1000ms are not recommended by
Alcatel-Lucent (very far to the 3GPP values):It will significantly
increase the delay for retransmission of a message. For instance, if
a HANDOVER COMMAND is sent to a given MS, but not received,
the MS will have to wait longer to get the repeated HO CMD, which
may lead to call drop in the meantime.Moreover, it can increase
congestion in the BSS, as the call duration is artificially increased.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

653 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.488 (T200_TH) - (T200_TH)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T200_TH

Logical Name

T200_TH

Definition

Supervision of acknowledgements for FACCH (TCH HR associated)


SAPI 0.

Coding rules

step size = 20 msec.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

180

5100

180

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Modification of the value of this parameter will trigger an automatic


restart of all TREs of the cell, leading to a release of all ongoing
calls.Values higher than 1000ms are not recommended by
Alcatel-Lucent (very far to the 3GPP values):It will significantly
increase the delay for retransmission of a message. For instance, if
a HANDOVER COMMAND is sent to a given MS, but not received,
the MS will have to wait longer to get the repeated HO CMD, which
may lead to call drop in the meantime.Moreover, it can increase
congestion in the BSS, as the call duration is artificially increased.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

654 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.489 (T3101) - (T3101)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T3101

Logical Name

T3101

Definition

Supervision of the Immediate Assignment procedure.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

T3101 > 2s

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

25.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

655 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.490 (T3103) - (T3103)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T3103

Logical Name

T3103

Definition

Supervision of the Internal Handover procedure.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

T3103 > Ny1 x T3105_D. T3103 > Ny1 x T3105_F_FR. T3103 > Ny1
x T3105_F_HR.T3103 > T3106_D.T3103 > T3106_F

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

25.5

16.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / HO Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

656 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.491 (T3105D) - (T3105_D)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T3105D

Logical Name

T3105_D

Definition

Delay between consecutive repetitions of PHYSICAL INFORMATION


on SDCCH.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

T3105_D x Ny1 < T3103T3105_D x Ny1 < T9113

Recommended rules

T3105_D x Ny1 > T3124T3105_D << T3124 (T3124 = 675 ms on


SDCCH)

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

200

220

200

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Timers

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

657 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.492 (T3105D_STOP) - (T3105_D_STOP)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T3105D_STOP

Logical Name

T3105_D_STOP

Definition

Criterion to stop T3105_D timer.

Coding rules

0: stopped on reception of SABM frame, 1: stopped on reception of


any correct L2 signalling frame

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Timers

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

658 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.493 (T3105F_FR) - (T3105_F_FR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T3105F_FR

Logical Name

T3105_F_FR

Definition

Delay between consecutive repetitions of PHYSICAL INFORMATION


on FACCH for FR channels.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

T3105_F_FR x Ny1 < T3103 T3105_F_FR x Ny1 < T9113

Recommended rules

T3105_F_FR x Ny1 > T3124 T3105_F_FR << T3124 (T3124 = 320


ms on TCH)

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

20

250

50

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Timers

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

659 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.494 (T3105F_HR) - (T3105_F_HR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T3105F_HR

Logical Name

T3105_F_HR

Definition

Delay between consecutive repetitions of PHYSICAL INFORMATION


on FACCH for HR channels.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

T3105_F_HR x Ny1 < T3103 T3105_F_HR x Ny1 < T9113

Recommended rules

T3105_F_HR x Ny1 > T3124 T3105_F_HR << T3124 (T3124 = 320


ms on TCH)

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

20

250

100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Timers

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

660 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.495 (T3105F_STOP) - (T3105_F_STOP)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T3105F_STOP

Logical Name

T3105_F_STOP

Definition

Criterion to stop T3105_F timer.

Coding rules

0: stopped on reception of SABM frame, 1: stopped on reception of


any correct L2 signalling frame or of a correct traffic frame

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Timers

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

661 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.496 (T3106D) - (T3106_D)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T3106D

Logical Name

T3106_D

Definition

This parameter is used for two different things:1) Supervision of


the reception of valid frame from the MS on the target cell in case
of SDCCH synchronous handover. 2) In parallel, the LSB, used in
combinations with the LSB of T3106_F, allow to perform the fine BTS
power tuning (per step of 0,1dB).

Coding rules

coded on 16 bits: - The 16 bits are used to define T3106_D valueThe 3 LSB are also used, in combinations with the 2 LSB of T3106_F,
to perform the fine BTS power tuning (per step of 0,1dB), following
the table below:T3106_D LSB: T3106_F LSB: Power attenuation:000
00 0dB000 01 0.1dB000 10 0.2dB000 11 0.3dB001 00 0,4dB001 01
0.5dB001 10 0.6dB001 11 0.7dB010 00 0,8dB010 01 0.9dB010 10
1,0dB010 11 1,1dB011 00 1,2dB011 01 1,3dB011 10 1,4dB011 11
1,5dB1xx 00 1,6dB1xx 01 1,7dB1xx 10 1,8dB1xx 11 1,9dBNote:
LSB = Less Significant Bits

Mandatory rules

T3106_D < T3103T3106_D < T9113

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

1100

1500

1200

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Timers

External Comment

The applied power attenuation can vary up to +/- 0,15db around the
specified value.Note: on OMC screen, this tuning is also possible
with the new parameter PWR_ADJUSTEMENT.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

662 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.497 (T3106D_STOP) - (T3106_D_STOP)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T3106D_STOP

Logical Name

T3106_D_STOP

Definition

Criterion to stop T3106_D timer.

Coding rules

0: stopped on reception of SABM frame, 1: stopped on reception of


any correct L2 signalling frame

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Timers

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

663 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.498 (T3106F) - (T3106_F)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T3106F

Logical Name

T3106_F

Definition

This parameter is used for two different things:1) Supervision of the


reception of valid frame from the MS on the target cell in case of TCH
synchronous handover.2) In parallel, the LSB, used in combinations
with the LSB of T3106_D, allow to perform the fine BTS power tuning
(per step of 0,1dB).

Coding rules

Coded on 16 bits:- The 16 bits are used to define T3106_F value- The
2 LSB are also used, in combinations with the 3 LSB of T3106_D,
to perform the fine BTS power tuning (per step of 0,1dB), following
the table below:T3106_D LSB: T3106_F LSB: Power attenuation:000
00 0dB000 01 0.1dB000 10 0.2dB000 11 0.3dB001 00 0,4dB001 01
0.5dB001 10 0.6dB001 11 0.7dB010 00 0,8dB010 01 0.9dB010 10
1,0dB010 11 1,1dB011 00 1,2dB011 01 1,3dB011 10 1,4dB011 11
1,5dB1xx 00 1,6dB1xx 01 1,7dB1xx 10 1,8dB1xx 11 1,9dBNote:
LSB = Less Significant Bits

Mandatory rules

T3106_F < T3103T3106_F < T9113

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

500

1000

1000

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Timers

External Comment

The applied power attenuation can vary up to +/- 0,15db around the
specified value.Note: on OMC screen, this tuning is also possible
with the new parameter PWR_ADJUSTEMENT.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

664 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.499 (T3106F_STOP) - (T3106_F_STOP)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T3106F_STOP

Logical Name

T3106_F_STOP

Definition

Criterion to stop T3106_F timer.

Coding rules

0: stopped on reception of SABM frame, 1: stopped on reception of


any correct L2 signalling frame or of a correct traffic frame

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Timers

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

665 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.500 (T3107) - (T3107)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T3107

Logical Name

T3107

Definition

Supervision of the Assignment procedure.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

25.5

14

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

666 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.501 (T3109) - (T3109)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T3109

Logical Name

T3109

Definition

Supervision of the Channel Release procedure.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

T3109 > RADIOLINK_TIMEOUT + 1s

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

35

12

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

667 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.502 (T3111) - (T3111)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T3111

Logical Name

T3111

Definition

Delay of the RF Channel Release procedure.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

T3111 > 2 x T200_D. T3111 > 2 x T200_TH. T3111 = T3110 (MS)

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

668 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.503 (T3212) - (T3212 (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T3212

Logical Name

T3212 (BSC)

Definition

This timer indicates to the MS the delay between two consecutive


Periodic Location Update procedures.

Coding rules

0: no periodic location update

Mandatory rules

Equal to T3212 (MFS)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

6 mn

255

30

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

669 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.504 (T4) - (T4)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T4

Logical Name

T4

Definition

Supervision of RESET message sent to the MSC.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

6553.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment

T4 shall be set greater than T2 (timer in MSC).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

670 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.505 (T7) - (T7)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T7

Logical Name

T7

Definition

Timer controlling the repetition of HANDOVER REQUIRED.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

T7 < T_HO_REQD_LOST

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / Handover Control

External Comment

Default value depends on MSC type

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

671 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.506 (T8) - (T8)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T8

Logical Name

T8

Definition

Supervision of the External Handover procedure in the serving BSC.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

25.5

14

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / Handover Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

672 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.507 (T9104) - (T9104)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T9104

Logical Name

T9104

Definition

Supervision of the call clearing procedure when triggered by the BSC.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

25.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

673 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.508 (T9105) - (T9105)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T9105

Logical Name

T9105

Definition

Supervision of the SCCP Connection procedure.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

T9105 > T(conn est)

Recommended rules

T9105 > max T3210. T9105 > max T3220. T9105 > max T3230

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

11

6553,5

31

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

674 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.509 (T9112) - (T9112)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T9112

Logical Name

T9112

Definition

Supervision of the channel modification in the MS.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

T9112 >= 15s. T9112 <= T9114. T9112 is inferior to the MSC timer
supervising the Modify procedure.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.1

6553.5

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Procedures / General Timers and procedure

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

675 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.510 (T9113) - (T9113)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T9113

Logical Name

T9113

Definition

Supervision of the External Handover procedure in the target BSC.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

T9113 > T3105_D x Ny1. T9113 > T3105_F x Ny1. T9113 >
T3106_D. T9113 > T3106_F

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

25.5

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / HO/Reselection / Handover Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

676 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.511 (TA_STAT) - (TA_STAT)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TA_STAT

Logical Name

TA_STAT

Definition

Threshold on timing advance to define the cell limit used for Radio
Measurements Statistics.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

bper

63

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / RMS & MAFA

External Comment

1 bper corresponds to about 550m

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

677 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.512 (TCH load threshold for Auto AC) - (N_threshold)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TCH load threshold for Auto AC

Logical Name

N_threshold

Definition

Threshold on busy TCH timeslots percentage for automatic barring


of access classes.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: RRM

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

678 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.513 (TEMPORARY_OFFSET) - (TEMPORARY_OFFSET)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TEMPORARY_OFFSET

Logical Name

TEMPORARY_OFFSET

Definition

Offset applied to C2 criterion for the duration of PENALTY_TIME.

Coding rules

step size = 10dB. 0: 0dB, 1:10dB, 6: 60dB, 7: infinity

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

infinity

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Selection

External Comment

If the VGCS is licensed, the parameter is modifiable only via the


provisioning context of the OMC.

Cell Type Dependent

Single

0 dB (0)

Umbrella

0 dB (0)

Concentric

0 dB (0)

Concentric Umbrella

0 dB (0)

Microcell

infinity (7)

Minicell

infinity (7)

Extended inner cell

0 dB (0)

Extended outer cell

0 dB (0)

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

679 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.514 (TFO HR when loaded) - (FORCE_TFO_HR_WHEN_LOADED)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TFO HR when loaded

Logical Name

FORCE_TFO_HR_WHEN_LOADED

Definition

Flag to control the establishment of TFO in Half Rate, when the cell
is loaded and the call is currently allocated with an Half Rate codec
type (HR or AMR-NB HR).

Coding rules

0 : "TFO with Half Rate codec not forced", if for load reasons the
call is established with an Half Rate codec, the BSC will propose to
establish TFO with all the supported codec types, including the Full
Rate ones (except the FR AMR-WB codec)1 : "TFO with Half Rate
codec only", if for load reasons the call is established with an Half
Rate codec, it will stay in Half Rate even in case of TFO mismatch
situation (if TFO is not possible in Half Rate on remote side, TFO is
not established).2 : "TFO with Half Rate codec preferred", if for load
reasons the call is established with an Half Rate codec, the BSC will
propose in a first step to establish TFO providing only the supported
Half Rate codecs only. If TFO is not possible in Half Rate on remote
side, the BSC will try to establish TFO with all the supported codec
types, including the Full Rate ones (except the FR AMR-WB codec),
provided that EN_TFO_MATCH=1.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

If FORCE_TFO_HR_WHEN_LOADED=2, EN_TFO_MATCH should


be set to 1

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Enumerated

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

680 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.515 (THR_CCCH_LOAD) - (THR_CCCH_LOAD)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THR_CCCH_LOAD

Logical Name

THR_CCCH_LOAD

Definition

Threshold triggering the sending of CCCH LOAD INDICATION


message.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

3000

500

Modifiable

OMC Changes: Displayed(PRC&SC) RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Ctrl Channel

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

681 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.516 (THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV1) - (THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV1

Logical Name

THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV1

Definition

Lower load threshold for allocation policy definition in dual rate cell.

Coding rules

step size = 10%

Mandatory rules

THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV1 <= THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV1 &


THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV1>=THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV3

Recommended rules

When choosing the THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV1 value, it is


recommanded to check that the number of DR TCH in the cell is
greater than (100 - THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV1) /100*total number of
TCH in the cell.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent
t01

t02

t03

t04

t05

t06

t07

t08

t09

t010

t011

t012

20

30

40

40

40

40

40

40

40

40

40

682 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.517 (THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV3) - (THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV3)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV3

Logical Name

THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV3

Definition

Lower load threshold for allocation policy of AMR-NB HR in a dual


rate cell supporting AMR-NB HR.

Coding rules

Step size = 10%

Mandatory rules

THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV3 <= THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV3 &


THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV3<=THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV1

Recommended rules

When choosing the THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV3 value, it is


recommended to check that the number of DR TCH in the cell is
greater than (100 - THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV3) /100*total number of
TCH in the cell.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent
t01

t02

t03

t04

t05

t06

t07

t08

t09

t010

t011

t012

20

30

40

40

40

40

40

40

40

40

40

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

683 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.518 (THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV1) - (THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV1

Logical Name

THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV1

Definition

Higher load threshold for allocation policy definition in dual rate cell.

Coding rules

Step size = 10%

Mandatory rules

THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV1 >= THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV1 &


THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV1>=THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV3

Recommended rules

When choosing the THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV1 value, it is


recommanded to check that the number of DR TCH in the cell is
greater than (100 - THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV1) /100*total number of
TCH in the cell.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent
t01

t02

t03

t04

t05

t06

t07

t08

t09

t010

t011

t012

70

70

70

70

70

70

70

70

70

70

70

70

684 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.519 (THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV3) - (THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV3)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV3

Logical Name

THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV3

Definition

Higher load threshold for allocation policy of AMR-NB HR in a dual


rate cell supporting AMR-NB HR.

Coding rules

Step size = 10%

Mandatory rules

THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV3 >= THR_FR_LOAD_L_SV3 &


THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV3<=THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV1

Recommended rules

When choosing the THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV3 value, it is


recommended to check that the number of DR TCH in the cell is
greater than (100 - THR_FR_LOAD_U_SV3) /100*total number of
TCH in the cell.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 2/3

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent
t01

t02

t03

t04

t05

t06

t07

t08

t09

t010

t011

t012

70

70

70

70

70

70

70

70

70

70

70

70

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

685 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.520 (THR_RXQUAL_CA_HIGH) - (THR_RXQUAL_CA_HIGH)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THR_RXQUAL_CA_HIGH

Logical Name

THR_RXQUAL_CA_HIGH

Definition

Threshold for channel adaptation under high load.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 (0 coded as 0, 0.1 coded as 1 7 coded as 70)

Mandatory rules

THR_RXQUAL_CA_HIGH >= THR_RXQUAL_CA_NORMAL

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

686 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.521 (THR_RXQUAL_CA_NORMAL) - (THR_RXQUAL_CA_NORMAL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THR_RXQUAL_CA_NORMAL

Logical Name

THR_RXQUAL_CA_NORMAL

Definition

Threshold for channel adaptation under normal load.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 (0 coded as 0, 0.1 coded as 1 7 coded as 70)

Mandatory rules

THR_RXQUAL_CA_HIGH >= THR_RXQUAL_CA_NORMAL

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

687 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.522 (TRAFFIC_EV_PERIOD) - (TRAFFIC_EV_PERIOD)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TRAFFIC_EV_PERIOD

Logical Name

TRAFFIC_EV_PERIOD

Definition

Periodicity of traffic load update in resource allocation algorithms =


N_TRAFFIC_LOAD x A_TRAFFIC_LOAD x TCH_INFO_PERIOD.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

OMC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

3264

120

Modifiable

OMC Changes: Displayed(PRC&SC) RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment

The given default value corresponds to the value calculated by the


OMC, based on the values of N_TRAFFIC_LOAD (which depends
on the nb of TRX in the cell, not reflected by DLS default value),
A_TRAFFIC_LOAD (which depends on the nb of TRX in the cell, not
reflected by DLS default value), TCH_INFO_PERIOD.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

688 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.523 (TRX zone) - (ZONE_TYPE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TRX zone

Logical Name

ZONE_TYPE

Definition

Determines which TRX(s) belong to the inner zone and which TRX(s)
belong to the outer zone of a concentric cell.

Coding rules

Coded as a 16 bits bitmap. Each bit specifies the zone the


corresponding TRX (if declared) belongs to. 0: Outer zone, 1: Inner
zone.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

List of numbers

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

TRX

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

65535

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Radio Channel Config. / TRX Configuration

External Comment

Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated here


is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

Single

N/A

Umbrella

N/A

Concentric

Concentric Umbrella

Microcell

N/A

Minicell

N/A

Extended inner cell

N/A

Extended outer cell

N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

689 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.524 (TSC) - (TSC)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TSC

Logical Name

TSC

Definition

Training Sequence Code for any (packet) channel except for BCCH,
CCCH and CBCH

Coding rules

coded over 3 bits

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description

External Comment

Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated here is


for implementation purposes.Two training sequence codes are used
in Alcatel BSS:*) TSC for BCCH, CCCH and CBCH: the BSS sets
the TSC to the O&M parameter BCC. This behaviour is compliant to
3GPP TS 05.02 which states that for BCCH and CCCH, the TSC
must be equal to the BCC. In Alcatel BSS, for CBCH, the TSC is also
set to BCC.**) TSC for any other (packet) channel: the BSS sets the
TSC to the O&M parameter TSC.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

690 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.525 (TX_INTEGER) - (Tx_integer (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TX_INTEGER

Logical Name

Tx_integer (BSC)

Definition

Number of RACH timeslots that spread transmission of CHANNEL


REQUEST.

Coding rules

Possible values are:3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 14, 16, 20, 25, 32,
50 respectively binary coded from 0000 to 1111

Mandatory rules

Equal to Tx_integer (MFS)

Recommended rules

When the GPRS is supported through Abis or Ater terrestrial


links, it is recommended to set:TX_INTEGER = 32 if the CCCH
is not combined, i.e. CCCH_CONF = 0TX_INTEGER = 12 if the
CCCH is combined, i.e. CCCH_CONF = 1.When the GPRS is
supported through Abis or Ater satellite links, it is recommended to
set:TX_INTEGER = 32 whatever the configuration of the CCCH.The
number of slots belonging to the MSs RACH between 2 successive
Channel Request messages is a random value drawn randomly
for each new retransmission with uniform distribution in the set
(S, S+1, ...,S+T-1). With T = Tx_Integer and S depending on the
CCCH configuration as shown below:1) for non combined CCCH:Tx_Integer = 3, 8, 14, 50 > S = 55 RACH frames (i.e. 253.8
ms)- Tx_Integer = 4, 9, 16 > S = 76 RACH frames (i.e. 349.6
ms)- Tx_Integer = 5, 10, 20 > S = 109 RACH frames (i.e. 501.4
ms)- Tx_Integer = 6, 11, 25 > S = 163 RACH frames (i.e. 749.8
ms)Tx_Integer = 7, 12, 32 > S = 217 RACH frames (i.e. 998.2 ms)2)
for combined CCCH:- Tx_Integer = 3, 8, 14, 50 > S = 41 RACH
frames (i.e. 357.5 ms)- Tx_Integer = 4, 9, 16 > S = 52 RACH frames
(i.e. 453.4 ms)- Tx_Integer = 5, 10, 20 > S = 58 RACH frames (i.e.
505.7 ms)- Tx_Integer = 6, 11, 25 > S = 86 RACH frames (i.e.
749.9 ms)- Tx_Integer = 7, 12, 32 > S = 115 RACH frames (i.e.
1002.8 ms)Note: - In the non-combined CCCH configuration, there
are 51 RACH frames per 51-multiframe- In the combined CCCH
configuration, there are 27 RACH frames per 51-multiframe.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

50

32

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

691 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

External Comment

When EN_GPRS=1, it is recommended to set: TX_INTEGER = 32 if


the CCCH is not combined, i.e. CCCH_CONF = 0TX_INTEGER =
12 if the CCCH is combined, i.e. CCCH_CONF = 1

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

692 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.526 (U_RXLEV_DL_MCHO) - (U_RXLEV_DL_MCHO)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

U_RXLEV_DL_MCHO

Logical Name

U_RXLEV_DL_MCHO

Definition

Downlink level threshold for Microcell to Macrocell handover.

Coding rules

coded over 6 bits :0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-47

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO Parameters / Lower Layer HO Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

N/A

Umbrella

N/A

Concentric

N/A

Concentric Umbrella

N/A

Microcell

-91 dBm (19)

Minicell

N/A

Extended inner cell

N/A

Extended outer cell

N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

693 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.527 (U_RXLEV_DL_P) - (U_RXLEV_DL_P)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

U_RXLEV_DL_P

Logical Name

U_RXLEV_DL_P

Definition

Upper downlink level threshold for power control.

Coding rules

coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules

U_RXLEV_DL_P > L_RXLEV_DL_P

Recommended rules

U_RXLEV_DL_P >= L_RXLEV_DL_P + 10 dB

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-75

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

694 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.528 (U_RXLEV_UL_MCHO) - (U_RXLEV_UL_MCHO)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

U_RXLEV_UL_MCHO

Logical Name

U_RXLEV_UL_MCHO

Definition

Uplink level threshold for Microcell to Macrocell handover.

Coding rules

coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-47

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO Parameters / Lower Layer HO Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

N/A

Umbrella

N/A

Concentric

N/A

Concentric Umbrella

N/A

Microcell

-98 dBm (12)

Minicell

N/A

Extended inner cell

N/A

Extended outer cell

N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

695 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.529 (U_RXLEV_UL_P) - (U_RXLEV_UL_P)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

U_RXLEV_UL_P

Logical Name

U_RXLEV_UL_P

Definition

Upper uplink level threshold for power control.

Coding rules

coded over 6 bits :0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules

U_RXLEV_UL_P > L_RXLEV_UL_P

Recommended rules

U_RXLEV_UL_P >= L_RXLEV_UL_P + 10 dB

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-75

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

-85 dBm (25)

Umbrella

-85 dBm (25)

Concentric

-85 dBm (25)

Concentric Umbrella

-85 dBm (25)

Microcell

-75 dBm (35)

Minicell

-85 dBm (25)

Extended inner cell

-85 dBm (25)

Extended outer cell

-85 dBm (25)

Nb of TRX Dependent

696 / 1182

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.530 (U_RXQUAL_DL_P) - (U_RXQUAL_DL_P)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

U_RXQUAL_DL_P

Logical Name

U_RXQUAL_DL_P

Definition

Upper downlink quality threshold for power control.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 (1==0.1 70==7)

Mandatory rules

U_RXQUAL_DL_P < L_RXQUAL_DL_P

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment

Highest value is the worst quality

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

697 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.531 (U_RXQUAL_UL_P) - (U_RXQUAL_UL_P)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

U_RXQUAL_UL_P

Logical Name

U_RXQUAL_UL_P

Definition

Upper uplink quality threshold for power control.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 (1==0.1 70==7)

Mandatory rules

U_RXQUAL_UL_P < L_RXQUAL_UL_P

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Quality

External Comment

Highest value is the worst quality

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

698 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.532 (UPPER_TIMING_ADVANCE) - (U_TIME_ADVANCE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

UPPER_TIMING_ADVANCE

Logical Name

U_TIME_ADVANCE

Definition

Timing Advance threshold for distance handover.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

bper

63

63

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Distance

External Comment

One unit corresponds to a distance of about 550m

Cell Type Dependent

Single

35 km (63)

Umbrella

35 km (63)

Concentric

35 km (63)

Concentric Umbrella

35 km (63)

Microcell

1 km (2)

Minicell

35 km (63)

Extended inner cell

34.5 km (62)

Extended outer cell

35 km (63)

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

699 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.533 (VQ_AVERAGE) - (VQ_AVERAGE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

VQ_AVERAGE

Logical Name

VQ_AVERAGE

Definition

Average window size on measurements to obtain samples for Voice


Quality statistics.

Coding rules

step size = 1 Samfr

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

Samfr

128

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Description

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS tempates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

700 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.534 (VQ_BAD_RXFER) - (VQ_BAD_RXFER)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

VQ_BAD_RXFER

Logical Name

VQ_BAD_RXFER

Definition

Radio bad FER threshold to specify bad quality samples for Voice
Quality statistics.

Coding rules

coded 0 to 200, step size=0.1% (0= 0%, 1 = 0.1 %, , 200 = 20%)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Description

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS tempates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

701 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.535 (VQ_FER_THRESHOLD) - (VQ_FER_THRESHOLD)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

VQ_FER_THRESHOLD

Logical Name

VQ_FER_THRESHOLD

Definition

Radio FER threshold to detect calls with bad speech quality for Voice
Quality statistics.

Coding rules

step size = 1%

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

30

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Description

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS tempates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

702 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.536 (VQ_GOOD_RXFER) - (VQ_GOOD_RXFER)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

VQ_GOOD_RXFER

Logical Name

VQ_GOOD_RXFER

Definition

Radio good FER threshold to specify bad quality samples for Voice
Quality statistics.

Coding rules

coded 0 to 200, step size=0.1% (0= 0%, 1 = 0.1 %, , 200 = 20%)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Description

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS tempates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

703 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.537 (VQ_INTF_THRESHOLD) - (VQ_INTF_THRESHOLD)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

VQ_INTF_THRESHOLD

Logical Name

VQ_INTF_THRESHOLD

Definition

Radio interference threshold to detect noisy calls for Voice Quality


statistics.

Coding rules

step size = 1%

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

30

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Description

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS tempates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

704 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.538 (VQ_RXLEV) - (VQ_RXLEV)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

VQ_RXLEV

Logical Name

VQ_RXLEV

Definition

Radio level threshold to specify bad quality samples for Voice Quality
statistics.

Coding rules

0 = -110 dBm, 1 = -109 dBm, 62 = -48 dBm, 63 = -47 dBm, step


= 1dBm

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-95

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Description

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS tempates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

705 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.539 (VQ_RXQUAL) - (VQ_RXQUAL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

VQ_RXQUAL

Logical Name

VQ_RXQUAL

Definition

Radio quality threshold to specify bad quality samples for Voice


Quality statistics.

Coding rules

step size=0.1 (1==0.1 70==7)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Description

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS tempates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

706 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.540 (VQ_RXQUAL_VS_RXFER) - (VQ_RXQUAL_VS_RXFER)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

VQ_RXQUAL_VS_RXFER

Logical Name

VQ_RXQUAL_VS_RXFER

Definition

Radio quality threshold to specify correlation between quality


samples for Voice Quality statistics.

Coding rules

step size=0.1 (1==0.1 70==7)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit RMS Template / Template X/ Description

External Comment

Up to 16 instances of this parameter with different values can be


defined. This allows to define "RMS tempates" (see parameter
RMS_template).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

707 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.541 (W_LEV_HO) - (W_LEV_HO)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

W_LEV_HO

Logical Name

W_LEV_HO

Definition

Weight applicable to level samples for handover when no DTX is


applied.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

A_LEV_HO + W_LEV_HO < 32

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Averaging PC-HO Window Size

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

708 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.542 (W_LEV_MCHO) - (W_LEV_MCHO)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

W_LEV_MCHO

Logical Name

W_LEV_MCHO

Definition

Weight applicable to level samples for microcell handover when no


DTX is applied.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

A_LEV_MCHO + W_LEV_MCHO < 16

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO Parameters / Lower Layer HO Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

N/A

Umbrella

N/A

Concentric

N/A

Concentric Umbrella

N/A

Microcell

Minicell

N/A

Extended inner cell

N/A

Extended outer cell

N/A

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

709 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.543 (W_LEV_PC) - (W_LEV_PC)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

W_LEV_PC

Logical Name

W_LEV_PC

Definition

Weight applicable to level samples for power control when no DTX


is applied.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

A_LEV_PC + W_LEV_PC < 32

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Averaging PC-HO Window Size

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

710 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.544 (W_PBGT_HO) - (W_PBGT_HO)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

W_PBGT_HO

Logical Name

W_PBGT_HO

Definition

Weight applicable to level samples for power budget when no DTX


is applied.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

A_PBGT_HO + W_PBGT_HO < 32

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Averaging PC-HO Window Size

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

711 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.545 (W_QUAL_CA) - (W_QUAL_CA)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

W_QUAL_CA

Logical Name

W_QUAL_CA

Definition

Averaging weight applicable for full quality (Channel adaptation).

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Averaging PC-HO Window Size

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

712 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.546 (W_QUAL_HO) - (W_QUAL_HO)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

W_QUAL_HO

Logical Name

W_QUAL_HO

Definition

Weight applicable to quality samples for handover when no DTX


is applied.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

A_QUAL_HO + W_QUAL_HO < 32

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Averaging PC-HO Window Size

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

713 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.547 (W_QUAL_PC) - (W_QUAL_PC)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

W_QUAL_PC

Logical Name

W_QUAL_PC

Definition

Weight applicable to quality samples for power control when no DTX


is applied.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

A_QUAL_PC + W_QUAL_PC < 32

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Averaging PC-HO Window Size

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

714 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.548 (WHITE_BOOK_INTERWORKING) - (MTP3_WB_INTERWORKING)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

WHITE_BOOK_INTERWORKING

Logical Name

MTP3_WB_INTERWORKING

Definition

This flag indicates if the BSC sends a Q.704 TRA message upon first
reception of SLTA from the MSC.

Coding rules

0 : TRA not sent upon first SLTA reception, 1 : TRA sent upon first
SLTA reception

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Interworking / MSC interworking

External Comment

This flag is set to 1 for interworking with a "White Book" MSC. It is set
to 0 for interworking with a "Blue Book" MSC.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

715 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.549 (WI_CR) - (WI_CR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

WI_CR

Logical Name

WI_CR

Definition

Value of Wait Indication for Establishment cause = "Call


Re-establishment".

Coding rules

0: 0s, 1: 1s, ..., 254: 254s, 255: no IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT


REJECT message is sent.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Timers

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

716 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.550 (WI_EC) - (WI_EC)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

WI_EC

Logical Name

WI_EC

Definition

Value of Wait Indication for Establishment cause = "Emergency call".

Coding rules

0: 0s, 1: 1s, ..., 254: 254s, 255: no IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT


REJECT message is sent.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Timers

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

717 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.551 (WI_OC) - (WI_OC)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

WI_OC

Logical Name

WI_OC

Definition

Value of Wait Indication for Establishment cause = "Originating call".

Coding rules

0: 0s, 1: 1s, ..., 254: 254s, 255: no IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT


REJECT message is sent.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Timers

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

718 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.552 (WI_OP) - (WI_OP)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

WI_OP

Logical Name

WI_OP

Definition

Value of Wait Indication for Establishment cause = "Location


updating" or "Other procedures which can be completed with an
SDCCH".

Coding rules

0: 0s, 1: 1s, ..., 254: 254s, 255: no IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT


REJECT message is sent.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Timers

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

719 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.553 (ZONE_HO_HYST_DL) - (ZONE_HO_HYST_DL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

ZONE_HO_HYST_DL

Logical Name

ZONE_HO_HYST_DL

Definition

Hysteresis applied to RXLEV_DL_ZONE for outer to inner zone


handover.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-40

40

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

720 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.2.554 (ZONE_HO_HYST_UL) - (ZONE_HO_HYST_UL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

ZONE_HO_HYST_UL

Logical Name

ZONE_HO_HYST_UL

Definition

Hysteresis applied to RXLEV_UL_ZONE for outer to inner zone


handover.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-40

40

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / HO & PC thresholds / Level

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

721 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.3 System (CST)


4.3.1 (Interference band 5 upper limit) - (INTFBD5)
Parameter Name

HMI Name

Interference band 5 upper limit

Logical Name

INTFBD5

Definition

Upper limit of interference band 5.

Coding rules

Coded over 6 bits: 0: -110 dBm, 1: -109 dBm...63: -47 dBm

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

System (CST)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-47

Modifiable

OMC Changes: displayed RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Dedicated Radio Resources 1/3

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

722 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

4.3.2 (SMSCB_Mode) - (SMSCB_Mode)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

SMSCB_Mode

Logical Name

SMSCB_Mode

Definition

This parameter enables to select the mode of operation, either


OMC-R or CBC.

Coding rules

0: OMC-R, 1: CBC

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

System (CST)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Interworking / CBC interworking

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

723 / 1182

4 GSM Telecom Parameters

724 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

725 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1 Network (CDE)


5.1.1 (Ater_Usage_Threshold_Short_Data) (Ater_Usage_Threshold_Short_Data)
Parameter Name

HMI Name

Ater_Usage_Threshold_Short_Data

Logical Name

Ater_Usage_Threshold_Short_Data

Definition

Threshold (percentage of used Ater nibbles, in a GPU) above which


the Ater usage is optimized for "short data" MS transfers.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

If Ater_Usage_Threshold_Short_Data is not set to 100% (100%


meaning that there is no Ater usage optimization for "short data"
MS transfers), then it is recommended to set it to 30%, except if the
drawbacks of another value (as explained in the external comments)
are deemed acceptable.For all the Ater_Usage_Threshold
values being defined for the BSSs handled by the MFS,
Ater_Usage_Threshold_Short_Data <= Ater_Usage_Threshold
30%. Indeed, for consistency reasons, "short data" MS transfer
optimizations should come prior to high Ater usage optimizations.If
it is seen as an important goal to save Ater resources in the
GPU, a value of Ater_Usage_Threshold_Short_Data < 100%
is coherent with a low value of the T_GCH_INACTIVITY and
T_GCH_INACTIVITY_LAST timers.

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Setting Ater_Usage_Threshold_Short_Data to 100% means that


there is no Ater usage optimization for "short data" MS transfers.If
Ater_Usage_Threshold_Short_Data is not set to 100%:- the higher
the Ater_Usage_Threshold_Short_Data value, the fewer ping time
degradations and data transfer delays will be experienced,- the lower
the Ater_Usage_Threshold_Short_Data value, the more accurate
the Ater consumption in the GPU will be (i.e. potential wastes of Ater
resources will be minimized in the GPU).

726 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

727 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.2 (BSSGP_T3) - (bssgp_T3)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSSGP_T3

Logical Name

bssgp_T3

Definition

Timer used by MFS to wait for Suspend acknowledgement from


SGSN.

Coding rules

1:0,1 ; 2: 0,2 ; ; 10: 1 ; ; 100: 10

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.1

10

0.6

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

728 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.3 (BSSGP_T4) - (bssgp_T4)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BSSGP_T4

Logical Name

bssgp_T4

Definition

Timer used by MFS to wait for Resume acknowledgement from


SGSN.

Coding rules

1:0,1 ; 2: 0,2 ; ; 10: 1 ; ; 100: 10

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

BSSGP_T4 < T_GPRS_Resume/ (Resume_retries+1))

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.1

10

0.6

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

729 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.4 (EN_AUTONOMOUS_REROUTING) (EN_AUTONOMOUS_REROUTING)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_AUTONOMOUS_REROUTING

Logical Name

EN_AUTONOMOUS_REROUTING

Definition

This flag enables / disables autonomous rerouting of DL LLC PDUs.

Coding rules

0 : disabled, 1 : enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

It is recommended not to activate simultaneously extended UL TBF


feature (EN_EXTENDED_UL_TBF) and the DL PDU rerouting
feature (EN_AUTONOMOUS_REROUTING)

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

730 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.5 (EN_CBL) - (EN_CBL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_CBL

Logical Name

EN_CBL

Definition

This flag enables / disables CBL feature (Leaky Bucket


Synchronisation)

Coding rules

0 : disabled, 1 : enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

731 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.6 (FLOW_DIM_Safety_BVC) - (FLOW_DIM_Safety_BVC)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

FLOW_DIM_Safety_BVC

Logical Name

FLOW_DIM_Safety_BVC

Definition

Safety factor to size BVC_Bucket_Size parameter, for downlink flow


control, on Gb interface.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

100

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

732 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.7 (FLOW_DIM_Safety_MS) - (FLOW_DIM_Safety_MS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

FLOW_DIM_Safety_MS

Logical Name

FLOW_DIM_Safety_MS

Definition

Safety factor to size default MS_Bucket_Size parameter, for downlink


flow control, on Gb interface.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

FLOW_DIM_Safety_MS should be set to a value corresponding to


the maximum multi-slot class of the MS present on the network

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

733 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.8 (INIT_PDCH_SHORT_DATA_EGPRS) (INIT_PDCH_SHORT_DATA_EGPRS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

INIT_PDCH_SHORT_DATA_EGPRS

Logical Name

INIT_PDCH_SHORT_DATA_EGPRS

Definition

Number of PDCHs on which MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_DL


and MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_UL are targeted when
establishing GCHs for an EGPRS TBF associated to a "short data"
MS transfer.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

734 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.9 (INIT_PDCH_SHORT_DATA_GPRS) (INIT_PDCH_SHORT_DATA_GPRS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

INIT_PDCH_SHORT_DATA_GPRS

Logical Name

INIT_PDCH_SHORT_DATA_GPRS

Definition

Number of PDCHs on which MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_DL


and MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_UL are targeted when
establishing GCHs for a GPRS TBF associated to a "short data"
MS transfer.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

735 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.10 (K_GSL (BSC)) - (K_GSL (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

K_GSL (BSC)

Logical Name

K_GSL (BSC)

Definition

Maximum number of outstanding I frames on a GSL link.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

It is recommended to set this parameter as follows depending


whether or not GPRS traffic is carried through Ater satellite links:K_GSL = 7 if GPRS traffic is carried through Ater terrestrial links in
all BSC of the MFS.- K_GSL = 16 if GPRS traffic is carried through
Ater satellite links in at least one BSC of the MFS.

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

16

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

736 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.11 (K_GSL (MFS)) - (K_GSL (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

K_GSL (MFS)

Logical Name

K_GSL (MFS)

Definition

Maximum number of outstanding I frames on a GSL link.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

It is recommended to set this parameter as follows depending


whether or not GPRS traffic is carried through Ater satellite links:K_GSL = 7 if GPRS traffic is carried through Ater terrestrial links in
all BSC of the MFS.- K_GSL = 16 if GPRS traffic is carried through
Ater satellite links in at least one BSC of the MFS.

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

32

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

737 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.12 (MAX_BLER) - (MAX_BLER)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MAX_BLER

Logical Name

MAX_BLER

Definition

Maximum mean BLER value that a TBF can possibly reach

Coding rules

step size = 0,05

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.95

0.35

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

The MAX_BLER value is used by RRM to evaluate the minimum


number of GCHs necessary to support RT traffic on a TRX.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

738 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.13 (MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_DL) (MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_DL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_DL

Logical Name

MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_DL

Definition

Maximum Modulation and Coding Scheme used for the DL EGPRS


TBFs associated to a "short data" MS transfer.

Coding rules

0: MCS-1; 1: MCS-2; 2: MCS-3; 3: MCS-4;4: MCS-5; 5: MCS-6;6:


MCS-7; 7: MCS-8;8: MCS-9.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

For consistency reasons, MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_DL


shall NOT be higher than any of the MAX_EGPRS_MCS values
defined in the cells of the MFS.In order to avoid establishing too
many GCHs during the "short data" MS transfer phases, it is
recommended that MAX [MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_DL,
MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_UL] <= MIN
[TBF_DL_INIT_MCS, TBF_UL_INIT_MCS] in all the cells
of the MFS. This rule also tends to reduce the TBF
blocking rate in the MFS (by recommending low values for
MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_DL/UL) and to simplify the MFS
configuration.

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Setting this parameter to MCS-2 might introduce some problems


(because a MCS-2 block consumes exactly 1.00 GCH and might
therefore block some of the MFS-BTS signalling messages to be
sent in the M-EGCH link in DL).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

739 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.14 (MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_UL) (MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_UL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_UL

Logical Name

MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_UL

Definition

Maximum Modulation and Coding Scheme used for the UL EGPRS


TBFs associated to a "short data" MS transfer.

Coding rules

0: MCS-1; 1: MCS-2; 2: MCS-3; 3: MCS-4;4: MCS-5; 5: MCS-6;6:


MCS-7; 7: MCS-8;8: MCS-9.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

For consistency reasons, MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_UL


shall NOT be higher than any of the MAX_EGPRS_MCS values
defined in the cells of the MFS.In order to avoid establishing too
many GCHs during the "short data" MS transfer phases, it is
recommended that MAX [MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_DL,
MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_UL] <= MIN
[TBF_DL_INIT_MCS, TBF_UL_INIT_MCS] in all the cells
of the MFS. This rule also tends to reduce the TBF
blocking rate in the MFS (by recommending low values for
MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_DL/UL) and to simplify the MFS
configuration.

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

740 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.15 (MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_DL) (MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_DL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_DL

Logical Name

MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_DL

Definition

Maximum coding scheme used for the DL GPRS TBFs associated to


a "short data" MS transfer.

Coding rules

0 : CS-1;1 : CS-2; 2 : CS-3; 3 : CS-4.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

For consistency reasons, MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_DL


shall NOT be higher than any of the MAX_GPRS_CS values
defined in the cells of the MFS.In order to avoid establishing too
many GCHs during the "short data" MS transfer phases, it is
recommended that MAX [MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_DL,
MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_UL] <= MIN [TBF_DL_INIT_CS,
TBF_UL_INIT_CS] in all the cells of the MFS. This rule also tends
to reduce the TBF blocking rate in the MFS (by recommending low
values for MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_DL/UL) and to simplify
the MFS configuration.

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Setting this parameter to CS-2 might introduce some problems


(because a CS-2 block consumes exactly 1.00 GCH and might
therefore block some of the MFS-BTS signalling messages to be
sent in the M-EGCH link in DL).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

741 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.16 (MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_UL) (MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_UL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_UL

Logical Name

MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_UL

Definition

Maximum coding scheme used for the UL GPRS TBFs associated to


a "short data" MS transfer.

Coding rules

0 : CS-1;1 : CS-2; 2 : CS-3; 3 : CS-4.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

For consistency reasons, MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_UL


shall NOT be higher than any of the MAX_GPRS_CS values
defined in the cells of the MFS.In order to avoid establishing too
many GCHs during the "short data" MS transfer phases, it is
recommended that MAX [MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_DL,
MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_UL] <= MIN [TBF_DL_INIT_CS,
TBF_UL_INIT_CS] in all the cells of the MFS. This rule also tends
to reduce the TBF blocking rate in the MFS (by recommending low
values for MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_DL/UL) and to simplify
the MFS configuration.

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

742 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.17 (N_DATA_BYTES_MAX_TRANS) - (N_DATA_BYTES_MAX_TRANS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

N_DATA_BYTES_MAX_TRANS

Logical Name

N_DATA_BYTES_MAX_TRANS

Definition

Number of bytes below which an MS transfer is considered to be


"short data".

Coding rules

step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

N_DATA_BYTES_MAX_TRANS <=
N_DATA_BYTES_MAX_TRANS_PERIODIC

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

byte

20

10000

150

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

An MS transfer is considered to be "short data" as long as less than


N_DATA_BYTES_MAX_TRANS bytes have been transferred in
both directions (since the TBF establishment(s)). Else, if more than
N_DATA_BYTES_MAX_TRANS bytes have been transferred in at
least one direction, the MS transfer is considered to be "long data".

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

743 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.18 (N_DATA_BYTES_MAX_TRANS_PERIODIC) (N_DATA_BYTES_MAX_TRANS_PERIODIC)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

N_DATA_BYTES_MAX_TRANS_PERIODIC

Logical Name

N_DATA_BYTES_MAX_TRANS_PERIODIC

Definition

Number of bytes above which a transition from "short data" to "long


data" MS transfer shall be periodically reattempted (only useful in the
rare cases where such a transition previously failed).

Coding rules

step size = 100 bytes

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

N_DATA_BYTES_MAX_TRANS <=
N_DATA_BYTES_MAX_TRANS_PERIODIC

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

byte

100

100000

10000

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

A transition from "short data" to "long data" MS transfer can only


fail in the rare cases where there is a too high number of TBFs on
the TRX / in some very specific reallocation failure scenarios.A
low value of N_DATA_BYTES_MAX_TRANS_PERIODIC should
be avoided because it will tend to increase the CPU load of the
MFS for a defence case which should be rare (if TRX and Abis/Ater
transmission resources are properly dimensioned).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

744 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.19 (N391) - (N391)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

N391

Logical Name

N391

Definition

Number of polling cycles before Frame Relay " full status enquiry"
(see ITU Q.933 Annex A, A.7).

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

745 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.20 (N392) - (N392)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

N392

Logical Name

N392

Definition

Error threshold (Frame Relay, see Q.933, Annex A).

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

N392*T391 is the value of the link failure detection time

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

746 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.21 (N393) - (N393)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

N393

Logical Name

N393

Definition

Monitored error counts (Frame Relay, see ITU Q.933 Annex A, A.7).

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

747 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.22 (NB_MSG_GSL_OUTPUT_BUFFER_XOFF_G2_BSC) (NB_MSG_GSL_OUTPUT_BUFFER_XOFF_G2_BSC)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NB_MSG_GSL_OUTPUT_BUFFER_XOFF_G2_BSC

Logical Name

NB_MSG_GSL_OUTPUT_BUFFER_XOFF_G2_BSC

Definition

In a G2 BSC, Xoff threshold (in terms of number of BSCGP messages


queued in the "GSL output buffer") above which channel requests are no
longer allowed to be sent on this GSL link.The interest of those Xon/Xoff
thresholds is to avoid "GSL output buffer" overflow.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

NB_MSG_GSL_OUTPUT_BUFFER_XON_G2_BSC <
NB_MSG_GSL_OUTPUT_BUFFER_XOFF_G2_BSC

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

105

84

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

- Applicable only to TDM mode.- A high value will tend to decrease the
efficiency of the BSC defence to avoid "GSL output buffer" overflow.A low value can lead to discard too many PS channel requests (QoS
degradation).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

748 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.23 (NB_MSG_GSL_OUTPUT_BUFFER_XOFF_MX_BSC) (NB_MSG_GSL_OUTPUT_BUFFER_XOFF_MX_BSC)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NB_MSG_GSL_OUTPUT_BUFFER_XOFF_MX_BSC

Logical Name

NB_MSG_GSL_OUTPUT_BUFFER_XOFF_MX_BSC

Definition

In a MX BSC, Xoff threshold (in terms of number of BSCGP messages


queued in the "GSL output buffer") above which channel requests are no
longer allowed to be sent on this GSL link.The interest of those Xon/Xoff
thresholds is to avoid "GSL output buffer" overflow.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

NB_MSG_GSL_OUTPUT_BUFFER_XON_MX_BSC <
NB_MSG_GSL_OUTPUT_BUFFER_XOFF_MX_BSC

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

105

84

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

- Applicable only to TDM mode. - A high value will tend to decrease the
efficiency of the BSC defence to avoid "GSL output buffer" overflow.- A low
value can lead to discard too many PS channel requests (QoS degradation).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

749 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.24 (NB_MSG_GSL_OUTPUT_BUFFER_XON_G2_BSC) (NB_MSG_GSL_OUTPUT_BUFFER_XON_G2_BSC)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NB_MSG_GSL_OUTPUT_BUFFER_XON_G2_BSC

Logical Name

NB_MSG_GSL_OUTPUT_BUFFER_XON_G2_BSC

Definition

In a G2 BSC, Xon hysteresis threshold (in terms of number of BSCGP


messages queued in the "GSL output buffer") below which channel requests
can again be sent on this GSL link.The interest of those Xon/Xoff thresholds
is to avoid "GSL output buffer" overflow.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

NB_MSG_GSL_OUTPUT_BUFFER_XON_G2_BSC <
NB_MSG_GSL_OUTPUT_BUFFER_XOFF_G2_BSC

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

105

52

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Applicable only to TDM mode.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

750 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.25 (NB_MSG_GSL_OUTPUT_BUFFER_XON_MX_BSC) (NB_MSG_GSL_OUTPUT_BUFFER_XON_MX_BSC)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NB_MSG_GSL_OUTPUT_BUFFER_XON_MX_BSC

Logical Name

NB_MSG_GSL_OUTPUT_BUFFER_XON_MX_BSC

Definition

In a MX BSC, Xon hysteresis threshold (in terms of number of BSCGP


messages queued in the "GSL output buffer") below which channel requests
can again be sent on this GSL link.The interest of those Xon/Xoff thresholds
is to avoid "GSL output buffer" overflow.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

NB_MSG_GSL_OUTPUT_BUFFER_XON_MX_BSC <
NB_MSG_GSL_OUTPUT_BUFFER_XOFF_MX_BSC

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

105

52

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Applicable only to TDM mode.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

751 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.26 (NRT_GUARANTEED_MARGIN) - (NRT_GUARANTEED_MARGIN)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NRT_GUARANTEED_MARGIN

Logical Name

NRT_GUARANTEED_MARGIN

Definition

For a PDCH, percentage of channel capacity (in terms of radio


block scheduling) which is exclusively reserved to NRT TBFs. That
capacity is not allowed to be allocated to a streaming TBF (RT PFC).

Coding rules

step size = 1%

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

In each direction (DL or UL), the minimum number of NRT


TBFs which are possible (in all cases) to be established on
a PDCH is equal to ((NRT_GUARANTEED_MARGIN/100) *
(T_MAX_FOR_TBF_SCHEDULING/20ms)) rounded down to the
closest integer value. This minimum number of NRT TBFs is
guaranteed even in case of RT PFC allocation on the PDCH. The
higher the value of NRT_GUARANTEED_MARGIN, the higher the
risks of rejecting RT PFC creation requests. The lower the value of
NRT_GUARANTEED_MARGIN, the higher the risks of rejecting NRT
TBF establishment requests (signalling or data traffic).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

752 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.27 (P0_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS) - (P0_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

P0_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS

Logical Name

P0_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS

Definition

Defines the priority indicated in L2 protocol (e.g. ethernet),


corresponding to the P0 internal priority (the highest).

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

P0_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS >= P1_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS

Recommended rules

The operator shall ensure that it is equal to


P0_LAYER2_MAPPING_BSC

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Each internal priority can be mapped to a L2 priority using the


parameter Px_layer2_mapping and mapped to a L3 priority using the
parameter Px_layer3_mapping.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

753 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.28 (P0_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS) - (P0_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

P0_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS

Logical Name

P0_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS

Definition

Defines the Diffserv DSCP value used on the IP network by MFS


flows having the P0 internal BSS priority (P0 is the highest priority).

Coding rules

Step size = 1.Only a subset of the possible values are defined in the
standard: 00 for BE, 10,12,14 for AF1; 18,20,22 for AF2; 26, 28,30
for AF3; 34, 36, 38 for AF4 and 46 for EF.

Mandatory rules

P0_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS >= P1_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS

Recommended rules

The operator shall ensure that it is equal to


P0_LAYER3_MAPPING_BSC

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

63

46

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Each internal priority can be mapped to a L2 priority using the


parameter Px_layer2_mapping and mapped to a L3 priority using the
parameter Px_layer3_mapping.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

754 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.29 (P1_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS) - (P1_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

P1_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS

Logical Name

P1_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS

Definition

Defines the priority indicated in L2 protocol (e.g. ethernet),


corresponding to the P1 internal priority.

Coding rules

Step size = 1

Mandatory rules

P0_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS >= P1_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS >=


P2_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS

Recommended rules

The operator shall ensure that it is equal to


P1_LAYER2_MAPPING_BSC

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Each internal priority can be mapped to a L2 priority using the


parameter Px_layer2_mapping and mapped to a L3 priority using the
parameter Px_layer3_mapping.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

755 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.30 (P1_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS) - (P1_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

P1_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS

Logical Name

P1_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS

Definition

Defines the Diffserv DSCP value used on the IP network by MFS


flows having the P1 internal BSS priority (P3 is the lowest priority).

Coding rules

Step size = 1.Only a subset of the possible values are defined in the
standard: 00 for BE, 10,12,14 for AF1; 18,20,22 for AF2; 26, 28,30
for AF3; 34, 36, 38 for AF4 and 46 for EF.

Mandatory rules

P0_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS >= P1_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS >=


P2_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS

Recommended rules

The operator shall ensure that it is equal to


P1_LAYER3_MAPPING_BSC

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

63

34

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Each internal priority can be mapped to a L2 priority using the


parameter Px_layer2_mapping and mapped to a L3 priority using the
parameter Px_layer3_mapping.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

756 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.31 (P2_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS) - (P2_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

P2_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS

Logical Name

P2_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS

Definition

Defines the priority indicated in L2 protocol (e.g. ethernet),


corresponding to the P2 internal priority.

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

P1_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS >= P2_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS >=


P3_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS

Recommended rules

The operator shall ensure that it is equal to


P2_LAYER2_MAPPING_BSC

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Each internal priority can be mapped to a L2 priority using the


parameter Px_layer2_mapping and mapped to a L3 priority using the
parameter Px_layer3_mapping.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

757 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.32 (P2_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS) - (P2_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

P2_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS

Logical Name

P2_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS

Definition

Defines the Diffserv DSCP value used on the IP network by MFS


flows having the P2 internal BSS priority (P3 is the lowest priority).

Coding rules

Step size = 1.Only a subset of the possible values are defined in the
standard: 00 for BE, 10,12,14 for AF1; 18,20,22 for AF2; 26, 28,30
for AF3; 34, 36, 38 for AF4 and 46 for EF.

Mandatory rules

P1_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS >= P2_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS >=


P3_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS

Recommended rules

The operator shall ensure that it is equal to


P2_LAYER3_MAPPING_BSC

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

63

26

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Each internal priority can be mapped to a L2 priority using the


parameter Px_layer2_mapping and mapped to a L3 priority using the
parameter Px_layer3_mapping.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

758 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.33 (P3_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS) - (P3_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

P3_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS

Logical Name

P3_LAYER2_MAPPING_MFS

Definition

Defines the priority indicated in L2 protocol (e.g. ethernet),


corresponding to the P3 internal priority (the lowest).

Coding rules

step size = 1.

Mandatory rules

P2_LAYER2_MAPPING_BSC >= P3_LAYER2_MAPPING_BSC

Recommended rules

The operator shall ensure that it is equal to


P3_LAYER2_MAPPING_BSC

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Each internal priority can be mapped to a L2 priority using the


parameter Px_layer2_mapping and mapped to a L3 priority using the
parameter Px_layer3_mapping.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

759 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.34 (P3_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS) - (P3_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

P3_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS

Logical Name

P3_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS

Definition

Defines the Diffserv DSCP value used on the IP network by MFS


flows having the P3 internal BSS priority (P3 is the lowest priority).

Coding rules

Step size = 1.Only a subset of the possible values are defined in the
standard: 00 for BE, 10,12,14 for AF1; 18,20,22 for AF2; 26, 28,30
for AF3; 34, 36, 38 for AF4 and 46 for EF.

Mandatory rules

P2_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS >= P3_LAYER3_MAPPING_MFS

Recommended rules

The operator shall ensure that it is equal to


P3_LAYER3_MAPPING_BSC

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

63

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Each internal priority can be mapped to a L2 priority using the


parameter Px_layer2_mapping and mapped to a L3 priority using the
parameter Px_layer3_mapping.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

760 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.35 (PDU_LIFETIME_ORDER) - (PDU_LIFETIME_ORDER)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PDU_LIFETIME_ORDER

Logical Name

PDU_LIFETIME_ORDER

Definition

Authorize or inhibit DL LLC PDU ordering according to the remaining


PDU lifetime.

Coding rules

0: ordering disabled, 1 : ordering enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Should be set to "ordering disabled", when the MFS interfaces with


an Ericsson SGSN or any SGSN modifying the PDU Lifetime value
during data flows addressed to the same MS on the same LLC SAPI
in a non-acceptable manner, otherwise should be set to "ordering
enabled".

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Customer BUL file

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

761 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.36 (S_BECN) - (S_BECN)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

S_BECN

Logical Name

S_BECN

Definition

Number of consecutive frames with BECN bit before congestion is


stated.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Customer BUL files

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

762 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.37 (SCHEDULING_PRIORITY_FACTOR) (SCHEDULING_PRIORITY_FACTOR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

SCHEDULING_PRIORITY_FACTOR

Logical Name

SCHEDULING_PRIORITY_FACTOR

Definition

When computing the best candidate timeslot allocation for an NRT


TBF, this factor enables to give a higher weight (PDCH capacity)
to the already-established NRT TBFs having a higher scheduling
priority (combination of THP and of Precedence) than the TBF to
be established or reallocated.This factor will tend to avoid piling up
several TBFs with different scheduling priorities on the same PDCHs,
which would degrade the throughput of the low-priority TBFs.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

The higher the value of T_MAX_FOR_TBF_SCHEDULING is, the


higher the value of SCHEDULING_PRIORITY_FACTOR shall be,
in order to avoid degrading the throughput of the low-priority TBFs
in a significant manner (if it is possible according to the available
PDCHs in the cell).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

763 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.38 (T_ACK_WAIT) - (T_ACK_WAIT)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_ACK_WAIT

Logical Name

T_ACK_WAIT

Definition

Timer defining the maximum time to wait for an MS answer (i.e.


Packet Control Ack or beginning of an UL TBF) to a network
solicitation sent on PACCH/DL when the MS is in PTM, or on PPCH
when the MS is in PIM and non-DRX mode, or on main DCCH when
the MS is in dedicated mode.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

It is recommended to set this parameter as follows depending


whether or not GPRS traffic is carried through Abis or Ater satellite
links:- T_ack_wait = 1200 ms if GPRS traffic is carried through Abis
and Ater terrestrial links in all the cells of the MFS.- T_ack_wait =
1700 ms if GPRS traffic is carried either through Abis satellite links or
Ater satellite links in at least one cell of the MFS.

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.5

1.2

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

764 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.39 (T_ACK_WAIT_DRX_PCCCH) - (T_ACK_WAIT_DRX_PCCCH)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_ACK_WAIT_DRX_PCCCH

Logical Name

T_ACK_WAIT_DRX_PCCCH

Definition

Timer defining the maximum time to wait for a MS answer (i.e. Packet
Control Ack) to a network sollicitation sent on PPCH when the MS is
in PIM and DRX mode.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 sec ; 0 = 0; 1 = 0.1;... ;100 = 10

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

It is recommended to set this parameter as follows depending


whether or not GPRS traffic is carried through Abis or Ater satellite
links:- T_ACK_WAIT_DRX_PCCCH = 2.5 s if GPRS traffic is carried
through Abis and Ater terrestrial links in all the cells of the MFS,T_ACK_WAIT_DRX_PCCCH = 3 s if GPRS traffic is carried either
through Abis satellite links or Ater satellite links in at least one cell
of the MFS.

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

10

2.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

765 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.40 (T_CANDIDATE_TBF_REALLOC) (T_CANDIDATE_TBF_REALLOC)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_CANDIDATE_TBF_REALLOC

Logical Name

T_CANDIDATE_TBF_REALLOC

Definition

Timer value controlling the time duration between successive resource


reallocation attempts for candidate MSs (triggers T3 and T4).In a
given cell, at each expiry of the T_CANDIDATE_TBF_REALLOC
timer :- up to N_MAX_PERIODIC_REALLOC_ATTEMPT_T4
T4 TBF reallocation attempts are performed,- up to
N_MAX_PERIODIC_REALLOC_ATTEMPT_T4 T4 reallocations are
performed,- up to 2 x N_MAX_PERIODIC_REALLOC_ATTEMPT_T3
T3 TBF reallocation attempts are performed- up to 2 x
N_MAX_PERIODIC_REALLOC_SUCCESS_T3 T3 reallocations
are performed.

Coding rules

step size = 1 sec; value 1 means 1 sec; value 2 means 2 sec, and
so on

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

T_GCH_INACTIVITY > T_CANDIDATE_TBF_REALLOC in all the


cells of the BSS.This constraints avoids as much as possible that
some GCHs are released and reestablished again some moments
later. This way, the T3 and T4 TBF reallocations can benefit from the
GCHs which are currently unused, but still established.

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Customer BUL files

External Comment

This parameter, together with the parameters


N_MAX_PERIODIC_REALLOC_ATTEMPT_T3,
N_MAX_PERIODIC_REALLOC_SUCCESS_T3 and
N_MAX_PERIODIC_REALLOC_ATTEMPT_T4, allows to :- to
control the reactivity of the BSS with regards to T3 and T4 TBF
reallocations,- and to control the extra CPU load generated by
T3 and T4 TBF reallocation attempts (the lowest the value of
T_CANDIDATE_TBF_REALLOC, the highest the generated CPU
load).

766 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

767 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.41 (T_GCH_release) - (Trelease)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_GCH_release

Logical Name

Trelease

Definition

Supervision of GCH link release for 16k channel.

Coding rules

step size = 100 ms

Mandatory rules

Trelease > TdslTreq_pending > Trelease

Recommended rules

It is recommended to set this parameter as follows depending


whether or not GPRS traffic is carried through Abis or Ater satellite
links:- Trelease = 500 ms if GPRS traffic is carried through Abis and
Ater terrestrial links in all the cells of the MFS,- Trelease = 1000 ms
if GPRS traffic is carried either through Abis satellite links or Ater
satellite links in at least one cell of the MFS.

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

200

1200

500

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

HMI name changed to precise that this timer is valid for GCH
channels. Former HMI name Trelease.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

768 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.42 (T_GPRS_Resume) - (T_GPRS_Resume)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_GPRS_Resume

Logical Name

T_GPRS_Resume

Definition

Timer used by BSC, to wait for Resume acknowledgement from


SGSN before releasing the CS channel.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 sec, coded from 2 to 50

Mandatory rules

T_GPRS_Resume < T3240 (10s)

Recommended rules

T_GPRS_Resume > (BSSGP_T4 * (Resume_retries+1))It is


recommended to set this parameter as follows depending
whether or not GPRS traffic is carried through Ater satellite links:T_GPRS_RESUME = 1 s if GPRS traffic is carried through Ater
terrestrial links in all the cells of the MFS,- T_GPRS_RESUME =
1.5 s if GPRS traffic is carried through Ater satellite links in at least
one cell of the MFS.

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.2

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

T3240 is a MS timer see 3GPP TS 24.008

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

769 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.43 (T_MAX_FOR_TBF_SCHEDULING) (T_MAX_FOR_TBF_SCHEDULING)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_MAX_FOR_TBF_SCHEDULING

Logical Name

T_MAX_FOR_TBF_SCHEDULING

Definition

Maximum time between two scheduling of a given NRT TBF (either


between two DL block requests for a NRT DL TBF, or between two
UL blocks received for a given NRT UL TBF).

Coding rules

step size = 20 ms

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.12

0.3

0.3

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

770 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.44 (T_MS_CONTEXT_FLUSH_PERSISTENCE) (T_MS_CONTEXT_FLUSH_PERSISTENCE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_MS_CONTEXT_FLUSH_PERSISTENCE

Logical Name

T_MS_CONTEXT_FLUSH_PERSISTENCE

Definition

This timer controls the duration during which a MS context is kept


after receipt of a FLUSH-LL.

Coding rules

step size = 100 ms

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

5000

1000

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

771 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.45 (T_REROUTING_REQUEST_GUARD) (T_REROUTING_REQUEST_GUARD)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_REROUTING_REQUEST_GUARD

Logical Name

T_REROUTING_REQUEST_GUARD

Definition

This timer controls the maximum time during which a GPU waits for
the response to a rerouting request.

Coding rules

step size = 50 ms

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

50

2000

500

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

772 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.46 (T_ul_2_ph_access) - (T_One_Block)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_ul_2_ph_access

Logical Name

T_One_Block

Definition

- For Non Evolium BTS : Timer to postpone the release of one slave
PDCH, when it does not support any (E)GPRS traffic, but a one uplink
block has been allocated on it to a MS for a 2 phase access TBF
establishment. - For Evolium BTS : Timer to postpone the release
of the M-EGCH link of a TRX, when the TRX does not support any
(E)GPRS traffic, but a one uplink block has been allocated to a MS for
a 2 phase access TBF establishment on one of the RTSs of the TRX

Coding rules

step size = 1 sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

It is recommended to set this parameter as follows depending


whether or not GPRS traffic is carried through Abis or Ater satellite
links:- T_one_block = 4 s if GPRS traffic is carried through Abis and
Ater terrestrial links in all the cells of the MFS,- T_one_block = 5 s
if GPRS traffic is carried either through Abis satellite links or Ater
satellite links in at least one cell of the MFS.

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: MFS RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

773 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.47 (T_ul_access_max) - (T_ul_access_max)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_ul_access_max

Logical Name

T_ul_access_max

Definition

Timer to limit the duration of an UL TBF establishment.

Coding rules

step size = 50 ms, 0 = 0 ms, 1 = 50 ms,... , 100 = 5000 ms

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

The two following rules are recommended:i) The Time


T_ul_access_max shall be longer than the duration of a radio
allocation requested towards the BSC.ii) A too long value of
T_ul_access_max may lead to reserve unnecessarily radio
resources. It is recommended to set T_ul_access_max = T_repeat
+ 240 ms Round_Trip_Delay, where the T_Repeat is the maximum
time between two successive packet channel requests, 240 ms is a
given margin. The value of T_Repeat depends on the parameters S,
TX_INT, and TX_INTEGER.It is recommended to set this parameter
as follows depending on whether or not GPRS traffic is carried
through Ater satellite links:- T_ul_access_max = 1400 ms if GPRS
traffic is carried through Ater terrestrial links in all the cells of the
MFS,- T_ul_access_max = 1900 ms if GPRS traffic is carried through
Ater satellite links in at least one cell of the MFS.

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

5000

1400

Modifiable

OMC Changes: MFS RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

774 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.48 (T_WAIT_FLUSH) - (T_WAIT_FLUSH)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_WAIT_FLUSH

Logical Name

T_WAIT_FLUSH

Definition

Timer monitoring the receipt of a Flush message or a GPRS suspend


message further to the release of the on-going TBF(s)

Coding rules

Step size : 0.5 sec1 coded 1; 1,5 coded 2; 2 coded 3; 2,5 coded 4;
.15,5 coded 30 and 16 coded 31

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

The timer T_WAIT_FLUSH shall be set to the maximum cell


reselection duration plus the time for the MS to switch back to the old
cell and send a Packet Cell Change Failure message.

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

16

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

775 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.49 (T1) - (bssgp_T1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T1

Logical Name

bssgp_T1

Definition

Guards the (un)blocking procedures.

Coding rules

step size=1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

30

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Customer BUL file

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

776 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.50 (T2) - (bssgp_T2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T2

Logical Name

bssgp_T2

Definition

Guards the reset procedure.

Coding rules

step size=1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

120

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Customer BUL file

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

777 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.51 (T200_GSL (MFS)) - (T200_GSL (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T200_GSL (MFS)

Logical Name

T200_GSL (MFS)

Definition

Supervision of acknowledgements on the GSL link.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

T_GSL_Ack (MFS) > T200_GSL (MFS) * (1 + N200_GSL (MFS))It


is recommended to set this parameter as follows depending
whether or not GPRS traffic is carried through Ater satellite links:T200_GSL(MFS) = 1 if GPRS traffic is carried through Ater terrestrial
links in all BSC of the MFS.- T200_GSL(MFS) = 2 if GPRS traffic is
carried through Ater satellite links in at least one BSC of the MFS.

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

778 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.52 (T391) - (T391)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T391

Logical Name

T391

Definition

Link integrity verification polling timer (Frame Relay, see ITU Q.933,
Annex A, A.7).

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

N392*T391 is the value of the link failure detection time

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

30

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Customer BUL file

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

779 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.53 (TBF_GCH_RATIO_DL) - (TBF_GCH_RATIO_DL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TBF_GCH_RATIO_DL

Logical Name

TBF_GCH_RATIO_DL

Definition

Multiplication factor used in the computation of the maximum number


of DL TBFs allowed to be established on a TRX for a given number
of GCHs on this TRX (i.e. in the M-EGCH link of this TRX).

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.1

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

If there is a great amount of "short data" TBFs in the network


(delayed DL or extended UL phases are longer than actual TBF
traffic phases), the existing TBF limitations (in number of TBFs
established on a TRX for a given number of GCHs on this TRX) may
be too restrictive and lead to some TBF establishment failures. The
TBF_GCH_RATIO_DL and TBF_GCH_RATIO_UL parameters allow
to increase this limit, so to be more flexible. Another justification for
the TBF_GCH_RATIO_DL and TBF_GCH_RATIO_UL parameters
is that the limits for DL and UL TBF numbers may be different.The
TBF_GCH_RATIO_DL and TBF_GCH_RATIO_UL parameters are
used in the formulae to compute Min_Nb_GCH_Best_Effort_XL
(RRM-PRH). An increase of their value should be validated by load
tests (in order to check, among others, that the DSP can support the
induced extra CPU load).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

780 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.54 (TBF_GCH_RATIO_UL) - (TBF_GCH_RATIO_UL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TBF_GCH_RATIO_UL

Logical Name

TBF_GCH_RATIO_UL

Definition

Multiplication factor used in the computation of the maximum number


of UL TBFs allowed to be established on a TRX for a given number
of GCHs on this TRX (i.e. in the M-EGCH link of this TRX).

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.1

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

If there is a great amount of "short data" TBFs in the network


(delayed DL or extended UL phases are longer than actual TBF
traffic phases), the existing TBF limitations (in number of TBFs
established on a TRX for a given number of GCHs on this TRX) may
be too restrictive and lead to some TBF establishment failures. The
TBF_GCH_RATIO_DL and TBF_GCH_RATIO_UL parameters allow
to increase this limit, so to be more flexible. Another justification for
the TBF_GCH_RATIO_DL and TBF_GCH_RATIO_UL parameters
is that the limits for DL and UL TBF numbers may be different.The
TBF_GCH_RATIO_DL and TBF_GCH_RATIO_UL parameters are
used in the formulae to compute Min_Nb_GCH_Best_Effort_XL
(RRM-PRH). An increase of their value should be validated by load
tests (in order to check, among others, that the DSP can support the
induced extra CPU load).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

781 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.55 (TnsBlock) - (Tns_block)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TnsBlock

Logical Name

Tns_block

Definition

Time-out to trigger the block/unblock procedure.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

120

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Customer BUL file

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

782 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.56 (TnsReset) - (Tns_reset)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TnsReset

Logical Name

Tns_reset

Definition

Time-out for reset procedure.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

120

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Customer BUL file

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

783 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.57 (TnsTest) - (Tns_test)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TnsTest

Logical Name

Tns_test

Definition

Overall time-out to test an NS-VC.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

60

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Customer BUL file

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

784 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.1.58 (Treq_pending) - (Treq_pending)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Treq_pending

Logical Name

Treq_pending

Definition

Maximum time during which a GCH establishment or release request


from PMU can be delayed in MEGCH layer.

Coding rules

step size = 20 ms

Mandatory rules

Treq_pending > Trelease+Tcorr

Recommended rules

Treq_pending > Testab+Tcorr

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

1000

5200

2000

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

785 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2 Site (CAE)


5.2.1 (ACCESS_BURST_TYPE) - (ACCESS_BURST_TYPE)
Parameter Name

HMI Name

ACCESS_BURST_TYPE

Logical Name

ACCESS_BURST_TYPE

Definition

Format of the access burst used by (E)GPRS MSs when


sending a PACKET CHANNEL REQUEST, a PACKET CONTROL
ACKNOWLEDGEMENT or a PTCCH/U message.

Coding rules

0 : 8 bits access bursts, 1 : 11 bits access bursts

Mandatory rules

For Non-Evolium BTS (i.e. DRFU BTS), the OMC-R shall force the
ACCESS_BURST_TYPE parameter to "8-bits access bursts".A
couple of mate cells (Extended inner + extended outer) shall have
the same ACCESS_BURST_TYPE when they are PS capable.

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Cnct Ctrl 2/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

786 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.2 (Allowed priority classes) - (PRIORITY_ACCESS_THRESHOLD


(BSC))
Parameter Name

HMI Name

Allowed priority classes

Logical Name

PRIORITY_ACCESS_THRESHOLD (BSC)

Definition

This parameter indicates whether or not a MS of a certain priority


class is allowed to do Packet access.

Coding rules

Coded over 3 bits . 000: packet access not allowed in the cell;
011:packet access allowed for priority level 1; 100: packet access
allowed for priority level 1 to 2; 101: packet access allowed for priority
level 1 to 3; 110: packet access allowed for priority level 1 to 4

Mandatory rules

Equal to PRIORITY_ACCESS_THRESHOLD (MFS)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Connection Control 2/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

787 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.3 (Allowed priority classes) - (PRIORITY_ACCESS_THRESHOLD


(MFS))
Parameter Name

HMI Name

Allowed priority classes

Logical Name

PRIORITY_ACCESS_THRESHOLD (MFS)

Definition

This parameter indicates whether or not a MS of a certain priority


class is allowed to do a Packet access.

Coding rules

Coded over 3 bits . 000: packet access is not allowed in the cell;
011:packet access is allowed for priority level 1; 100: packet access
is allowed for priority level 1 to 2; 101: packet access is allowed for
priority level 1 to 3; 110: packet access allowed for priority level 1 to 4

Mandatory rules

Equal to PRIORITY_ACCESS_THRESHOLD (BSC)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Connection Control 2/2

External Comment

Persistence level parameter for priority (i) is meaningless if the Radio


Priority (i) is not allowed

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

788 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.4 (ALPHA) - (ALPHA (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

ALPHA

Logical Name

ALPHA (BSC)

Definition

Alpha power control parameter.

Coding rules

Possible values are : 0.0 to 1.0 with step of 0.1respectively binary


coded : 0000, 0001, 0010 1010

Mandatory rules

Equal to ALPHA (MFS)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Power Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

789 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.5 (ALPHA) - (ALPHA (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

ALPHA

Logical Name

ALPHA (MFS)

Definition

Alpha power control parameter.

Coding rules

Possible values are : 0.0 to 1.0 with step of 0.1respectively binary


coded : 0000, 0001, 0010 1010

Mandatory rules

Equal to ALPHA (BSC)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Power Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

790 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.6 (Ater_Usage_Threshold) - (Ater_Usage_Threshold)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Ater_Usage_Threshold

Logical Name

Ater_Usage_Threshold

Definition

Threshold (percentage of used Ater nibbles, in a GPU) above which


the Ater usage is said "high".

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

A low value of GCH_RED_Factor_High_Ater_Usage can be


coherent with a high value of Ater_Usage_Threshold (it will avoid
reaching the saturation point of 100% of the Ater resources used
at the same moment in the GPU). Reciprocally, a high value
of GCH_RED_Factor_High_Ater_Usage can be coherent with
a low value of Ater_Usage_Threshold (it will limit the risks of
wasting, i.e. of not using, Ater resources in the GPU).For all
the Ater_Usage_Threshold values being defined for the BSSs
handled by the MFS, Ater_Usage_Threshold_Short_Data <=
Ater_Usage_Threshold 30%. Indeed, for consistency reasons,
"short data" MS transfer optimizations should come prior to high
Ater usage optimizations.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

70

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

When the Ater usage is "high", the


GCH_RED_FACTOR_High_Ater_Usage is applied,
whereas when the Ater usage is "normal" (i.e. percentage of used
Ater nibbles is below the threshold), no GCH reduction factor is
applied.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

791 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.7 (BEST_EFFORT_PRIORITY) - (BEST_EFFORT_PRIORITY)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BEST_EFFORT_PRIORITY

Logical Name

BEST_EFFORT_PRIORITY

Definition

Defines the relative priority used for the pre-defined Best Effort
Packet Flow Context, and for all MS traffic without PFC

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

12

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Default value corresponds to the priority for interactive THP3.The


minimum value (the highest priority) corresponds to one priority level
below the streaming class.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

792 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.8 (BS_AG_BLKS_RES) - (BS_AG_BLKS_RES (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BS_AG_BLKS_RES

Logical Name

BS_AG_BLKS_RES (MFS)

Definition

Number of CCCH blocks reserved for the access grant channel


(AGCH), broadcast on the PBCCH for CS service establishment.

Coding rules

coded on 3 bits (000 : 0, ...111 : 7)

Mandatory rules

-BS_AG_BLKS_RES (MFS) = BS_AG_BLKS_RES (BSC) for a


given cell-when CCCH_CONF=0 and CBCH is configured in the
cell, BS_AG_BLKS_RES>0- when CCCH_CONF=2, max value of
BS_AG_BLKS_RES is 7 and BS_AG_BLKS_RES must be > 0 if
CBCH is configured in the cell.-When EN_VGCS is disabled :. if
BCCH_EXT = true, then BS_AG_BLKS_RES >= 1-When EN_VGCS
is enabled : . if BCCH_EXT = false, then BS_AG_BLKS_RES
>= NUMBER_NCH_BLOCKS . if BCCH_EXT = true, then
BS_AG_BLKS_RES > NUMBER_NCH_BLOCKS

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Ctrl Channel

External Comment

Maximum and Default values given for CCCH_CONF=0For


CCCH_CONF=1, max=2, def=1

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

793 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.9 (BS_CV_MAX) - (BS_CV_MAX (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BS_CV_MAX

Logical Name

BS_CV_MAX (BSC)

Definition

Number of remaining RLC data blocks sent (per assigned PDCH) by


the MS, below which the Count Down procedure is entered.One third
of the number of RLC data blocks per assigned PDCH before the MS
checks if the resolution contention has failed.

Coding rules

Coded on 4 bits (1==0001, 2 == 0010 .. 15 == 1111).

Mandatory rules

Equal to BS_CV_MAX (MFS)

Recommended rules

BS_CV_MAX should be set to a value equal to the "minimum" round


trip delay to optimise the uplink re-transmission of non-acknowledged
blocks and minimise window-stalled situations.If BS_CV_MAX
is set greater than round-trip-delay, uplink retransmissions of
unacknowledged blocks may be delayed.It is recommended to set
this parameter as follows depending whether or not GPRS traffic is
carried through Abis or Ater satellite links:- BS_CV_MAX = 9 if GPRS
traffic is carried through Abis and Ater terrestrial links in the serving
cell,- BS_CV_MAX = 15 if GPRS traffic is carried either through Abis
satellite links or Ater satellite links in the serving cell.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / RLC/MAC

External Comment

Used by the MS to start the countdown value process (release of


UL TBF) or to consider acknowledgement messages as valid for a
given RLC data block. Lower values avoid too many TBF releases
and reestablishments.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

794 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.10 (BS_CV_MAX) - (BS_CV_MAX (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BS_CV_MAX

Logical Name

BS_CV_MAX (MFS)

Definition

Number of remaining RLC data blocks sent (per assigned PDCH) by


the MS, below which the Count Down procedure is entered.One third
of the number of RLC data blocks per assigned PDCH before the MS
checks if the resolution contention has failed.

Coding rules

Coded on 4 bits (1==0001, 2 == 0010 .. 15 == 1111).

Mandatory rules

Equal to BS_CV_MAX (BSC)

Recommended rules

BS_CV_MAX should be set to a value equal to the "minimum" round


trip delay to optimise the uplink re-transmission of non-acknowledged
blocks and minimise window-stalled situations.If BS_CV_MAX
is set greater than round-trip-delay, uplink retransmissions of
unacknowledged blocks may be delayed.It is recommended to set
this parameter as follows depending whether or not GPRS traffic is
carried through Abis or Ater satellite links:- BS_CV_MAX = 9 if GPRS
traffic is carried through Abis and Ater terrestrial links in the serving
cell,- BS_CV_MAX = 15 if GPRS traffic is carried either through Abis
satellite links or Ater satellite links in the serving cell.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / RLC/MAC

External Comment

Used by the MS to start the countdown value process (release of


UL TBF) or to consider acknowledgement messages as valid for a
given RLC data block. Lower values avoid too many TBF releases
and reestablishments.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

795 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.11 (BS_PA_MFRMS) - (BS_PA_MFRMS (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BS_PA_MFRMS

Logical Name

BS_PA_MFRMS (MFS)

Definition

Number of 51 frame multiframes between consecutive occurrences


of a Paging Group, broadcast on the PBCCH for the CS service
establishment.

Coding rules

coded on 3 bits (000 : 2, ... 111: 9)

Mandatory rules

BS_PA_MFRMS (BSC) = BS_PA_MFRMS (MFS) for a given cell

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Ctrl Channel

External Comment

The bigger this parameter is, the lesser the MS power consumption
is.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

796 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.12 (BS_PAG_BLKS_RES) - (BS_PAG_BLKS_RES)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BS_PAG_BLKS_RES

Logical Name

BS_PAG_BLKS_RES

Definition

Number of blocks allocated to the PAGCH or PDTCH or PACCH per


52 multiframe.

Coding rules

coded on 4 bits (0001: 1, ..., 1010: 10)The codepoints 0000: 0,


1011: 11 and 1100: 12 are not supported by the ALCATEL BSS.

Mandatory rules

BS_PAG_BLKS_RES < 12 BS_PBCCH_BLKS

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 1/2

External Comment

According to 3GPP TS 05.02, the number of paging blocks "available"


on one PCCCH =(12 - BS_PAG_BLKS_RES - BS_PBCCH_BLKS)
* 64. In order for the network to be able to page GPRS-attached
Mobile Stations when PCCCH is present in the cell, there shall be
at least one radio block where paging can occur. This requires (12
- BS_PAG_BLKS_RES - BS_PBCCH_BLKS) to be strictly greater
than 0.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

797 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.13 (BS_PBCCH_BLKS) - (BS_PBCCH_BLKS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BS_PBCCH_BLKS

Logical Name

BS_PBCCH_BLKS

Definition

Number of blocks allocated to the PBCCH per 52 multiframe.

Coding rules

coded on 2 bits : 00=Block B0 used for PBCCH, 01=Block B0, B6


used for PBCCH, 10=Block B0, B6, B3 used for PBCCH, 11=Block
B0, B6, B3, B9 used for PBCCH

Mandatory rules

BS_PBCCH_BLKS < 12 - BS_PAG_BLKS_RES

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

798 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.14 (BS_PRACH_BLKS_MIN) - (BS_PRACH_BLKS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BS_PRACH_BLKS_MIN

Logical Name

BS_PRACH_BLKS

Definition

Number of blocks statically allocated to the PRACH per 52 multiframe


on each MPDCH.

Coding rules

coded on 4 bits (0001: 1, .., 1000: 8)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

799 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.15 (BS_TXPWR_MAX) - (BS_TXPWR_MAX (MFS))


When a cell is shared, the BS_TX_POWER_MAX and
BS_TX_POWER_MAX_INNER powers must always be defined against the
actual physical power of the main sector. If the actual power of the secondary
sector is lower than the actual power of the main sector, the operator has to
adjust the values of BS_TX_POWER_MAX and BS_TX_POWER_MAX_INNER
to avoid requiring too high an output power than is actually available.
Parameter Name

HMI Name

BS_TXPWR_MAX

Logical Name

BS_TXPWR_MAX (MFS)

Definition

This parameter defines the power reduction relative to the maximum


GMSK output power of the BTS.

Coding rules

0 0 0 0 = 0 dB, 0 0 0 1 = -2 dB, 0 0 1 0 = -4 dB, ..., 1 1 1 1 = -30 dB

Mandatory rules

Equal to BS_TXPWR_MAX (BSC)BS_TXPWR_MAX >=


BS_TXPWR_MIN

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-30

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / PC parameters / General PC Control

External Comment

The BTS maximum allowed transmit power is defined relatively to


the BTS maximum RF transmit power in GMSK (due to hardware
limitation).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

800 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.16 (BVCI) - (PTP_BVCI)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BVCI

Logical Name

PTP_BVCI

Definition

PTP BVCI value.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

65535

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Cell Menu / Show GPRS Bvci

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

801 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.17 (C31_HYST) - (C31_HYST)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

C31_HYST

Logical Name

C31_HYST

Definition

Determines whether an additional cell hysteresis shall


be applied to the C31 criterion. The hysteresis is
GPRS_CELL_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS (for NC0 mode).

Coding rules

0 : no, 1 : yes

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 2/2 (+ Edit External Cell / Packet)

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

802 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.18 (C32_QUAL) - (C32_QUAL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

C32_QUAL

Logical Name

C32_QUAL

Definition

Flag indicating an exception rule for GPRS_RESELECT_OFFSET


in NC0 mode.

Coding rules

0=NO, 1=YES

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 2/2 (+ Edit External Cell / Packet)

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

803 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.19 (Capacity) - (ACCESS_RATE_BC (OMC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Capacity

Logical Name

ACCESS_RATE_BC (OMC)

Definition

Physical access rate of the Frame Relay bearer channel.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

CIR <= NIR <= CIR x (1 + EBS/CBS) <= ACCESS_RATE_BC (OMC)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

OMC

Instance

BC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

kbit/s

64

1984

64

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

804 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.20 (CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET) - (CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET

Logical Name

CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET (MFS)

Definition

Permanent offset to C2 criterion.

Coding rules

step size = 2dB; coded on 6 bits (000000:0 dB, 111111 : 126 dB)

Mandatory rules

CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET (MFS) = CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET


(BSC)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

126

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Selection

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

805 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.21 (CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET) (CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET(n)(MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET

Logical Name

CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET(n)(MFS)

Definition

Permanent offset to C2 criterion.

Coding rules

step size = 2dB; coded on 6 bits (000000:0 dB, 111111 : 126 dB)

Mandatory rules

CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET(n)(MFS) =
CELL_RESELECT_OFFSET (n)(BSC)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

126

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit External Cell/ Packet2/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

806 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.22 (CI) - (CI (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CI

Logical Name

CI (MFS)

Definition

Cell Identity.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

LAC and CI can not be equal to 65535 at the same timeEqual to


CI (BSC)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

65535

65535

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description

External Comment

Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated here


is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

807 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.23 (CI) - (CI(n) (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CI

Logical Name

CI(n) (MFS)

Definition

Cell Identity of adjacent cell.

Coding rules

Values 0..65535 correspond to the standard CI-value.

Mandatory rules

LAC and CI can not be equal to 65535 at the same time.Equal to


CI(n)(BSC)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

65535

65535

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Adjacencies

External Comment

Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated here


is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

808 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.24 (Commited Burst Size) - (CBS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Commited Burst Size

Logical Name

CBS

Definition

Commited Burst Size.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

CIR=0 <=> CBS=0 => EBS > 0CIR <= NIR <= CIR x (1 + EBS/CBS)
<= ACCESS_RATE_BC

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

PVC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

kbyte

248

Modifiable

OMC Changes: MFS RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Create NS-VC

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

809 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.25 (Committed Information Rate) - (CIR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Committed Information Rate

Logical Name

CIR

Definition

Committed Information Rate.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

CIR=0 when "direct access" is used, CIR=0 <=> CBS=0 => EBS >
0CIR <= NIR <= CIR x (1 + EBS/CBS) <= ACCESS_RATE_BC

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

PVC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

kbit/s

1984

Modifiable

OMC Changes: MFS RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Create NS-VC

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

810 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.26 (CS_AVG_PERIOD_LT) - (CS_AVG_PERIOD_LT)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_AVG_PERIOD_LT

Logical Name

CS_AVG_PERIOD_LT

Definition

"Forgetting time" in the long term averaging of channel quality


measurements in the GPRS link Adaptation: measurements which
are older than CS_AVG_PERIOD_LT are negligible in the average of
channel quality measurements.

Coding rules

step size = 20ms

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.02

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Parameter change: any modification impacts the telecom PS service.


The on-going PS traffic of the BSS is broken and no new traffic is
accepted until the related GP/GPU(s) restarted.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

811 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.27 (CS_AVG_PERIOD_ST) - (CS_AVG_PERIOD_ST)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_AVG_PERIOD_ST

Logical Name

CS_AVG_PERIOD_ST

Definition

"Forgetting time" in the short term averaging of channel quality


measurements in the GPRS link adaptation: measurements which
are older than CS_AVG_PERIOD_ST are negligible in the average of
channel quality measurements.

Coding rules

step size = 20ms

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.02

0.32

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Parameter change: any modification impacts the telecom PS service.


The on-going PS traffic of the BSS is broken and no new traffic is
accepted until the related GP/GPU(s) restarted.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

812 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.28 (CS_BLER_DL_3_4) - (CS_BLER_DL_3_4)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_BLER_DL_3_4

Logical Name

CS_BLER_DL_3_4

Definition

CS3 BLER threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change


the Coding Scheme from CS3 to CS4 in the downlink direction when
the SIR measurements are not reported by the MS

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

813 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.29 (CS_BLER_DL_4_3) - (CS_BLER_DL_4_3)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_BLER_DL_4_3

Logical Name

CS_BLER_DL_4_3

Definition

CS4 BLER threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change


the Coding Scheme from CS4 to CS3 in the downlink direction when
the SIR measurements are not reported by the MS.

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

814 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.30 (CS_HST_DL_LT) - (CS_HST_DL_LT)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_HST_DL_LT

Logical Name

CS_HST_DL_LT

Definition

Hysteresis value for AV_RXQUAL_LT thresholds used in the downlink


radio link supervision to change the TBF coding scheme.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 2/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

815 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.31 (CS_HST_DL_ST) - (CS_HST_DL_ST)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_HST_DL_ST

Logical Name

CS_HST_DL_ST

Definition

Hysteresis value for AV_RXQUAL_ST thresholds used in the


downlink radio link supervision to change the TBF coding scheme.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

1.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 2/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

816 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.32 (CS_HST_UL_LT) - (CS_HST_UL_LT)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_HST_UL_LT

Logical Name

CS_HST_UL_LT

Definition

Hysteresis value for AV_RXQUAL_LT thresholds used in the uplink


radio link supervision to change the TBF coding scheme.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 2/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

817 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.33 (CS_HST_UL_ST) - (CS_HST_UL_ST)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_HST_UL_ST

Logical Name

CS_HST_UL_ST

Definition

Hysteresis value for AV_RXQUAL_ST thresholds used in the uplink


radio link supervision to change the TBF coding scheme.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

1.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 2/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

818 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.34 (CS_MAX_IDLE_PERIOD) - (CS_MAX_IDLE_PERIOD)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_MAX_IDLE_PERIOD

Logical Name

CS_MAX_IDLE_PERIOD

Definition

Maximum transfer inactivity time to reuse the previous (Modulation


and) Coding Scheme. This applies in case of transfer resumption
during inactive TBF phase (delayed downlink TBF mode / extended
uplink TBF mode) and in case of uplink TBF establishment on
PACCH while extended uplink TBF mode is not used (with some
additional restrictions).

Coding rules

step size = 20 ms

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

5000

680

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Cnct Ctrl 1/2

External Comment

This parameter applies to both GPRS and EGPRS TBFs.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

819 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.35 (CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_FH_ACK) - (CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_FH_ACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_FH_ACK

Logical Name

CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_FH_ACK

Definition

RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change


the Coding Scheme from CS1 to CS2 in the downlink direction when
the RLC mode is acknowledged and the TBF is established on a
hopping TRX.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

820 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.36 (CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_FH_NACK) - (CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_FH_NACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_FH_NACK

Logical Name

CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_FH_NACK

Definition

RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change


the Coding Scheme from CS1 to CS2 in the downlink direction when
the RLC mode is unacknowledged and the TBF is established on a
hopping TRX.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

821 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.37 (CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_NFH_ACK) - (CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_NFH_ACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_NFH_ACK

Logical Name

CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_NFH_ACK

Definition

RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change


the Coding Scheme from CS1 to CS2 in the downlink direction when
the RLC mode is acknowledged and the TBF is established on a
non-hopping TRX.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

822 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.38 (CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_NFH_NACK) (CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_NFH_NACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_NFH_NACK

Logical Name

CS_QUAL_DL_1_2_NFH_NACK

Definition

RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change


the Coding Scheme from CS1 to CS2 in the downlink direction when
the RLC mode is unacknowledged and the TBF is established on a
non-hopping TRX.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

823 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.39 (CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_FH_ACK) - (CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_FH_ACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_FH_ACK

Logical Name

CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_FH_ACK

Definition

RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change


the Coding Scheme from CS2 to CS3 in the downlink direction when
the RLC mode is acknowledged and the TBF is established on a
hopping TRX.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

824 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.40 (CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_FH_NACK) - (CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_FH_NACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_FH_NACK

Logical Name

CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_FH_NACK

Definition

RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change


the Coding Scheme from CS2 to CS3 in the downlink direction when
the RLC mode is unacknowledged and the TBF is established on a
hopping TRX.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

825 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.41 (CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_NFH_ACK) - (CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_NFH_ACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_NFH_ACK

Logical Name

CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_NFH_ACK

Definition

RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change


the Coding Scheme from CS2 to CS3 in the downlink direction when
the RLC mode is acknowledged and the TBF is established on a
non-hopping TRX.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

3.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

826 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.42 (CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_NFH_NACK) (CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_NFH_NACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_NFH_NACK

Logical Name

CS_QUAL_DL_2_3_NFH_NACK

Definition

RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change


the Coding Scheme from CS2 to CS3 in the downlink direction when
the RLC mode is unacknowledged and the TBF is established on a
non-hopping TRX.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

827 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.43 (CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_FH_ACK) - (CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_FH_ACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_FH_ACK

Logical Name

CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_FH_ACK

Definition

RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change


the Coding Scheme from CS3 to CS4 in the downlink direction when
the RLC mode is acknowledged and the TBF is established on a
hopping TRX.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

828 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.44 (CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_FH_NACK) - (CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_FH_NACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_FH_NACK

Logical Name

CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_FH_NACK

Definition

RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change


the Coding Scheme from CS3 to CS4 in the downlink direction when
the RLC mode is unacknowledged and the TBF is established on a
hopping TRX.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

829 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.45 (CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_NFH_ACK) - (CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_NFH_ACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_NFH_ACK

Logical Name

CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_NFH_ACK

Definition

RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change


the Coding Scheme from CS3 to CS4 in the downlink direction when
the RLC mode is acknowledged and the TBF is established on a
non-hopping TRX.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

830 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.46 (CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_NFH_NACK) (CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_NFH_NACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_NFH_NACK

Logical Name

CS_QUAL_DL_3_4_NFH_NACK

Definition

RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change


the Coding Scheme from CS3 to CS4 in the downlink direction when
the RLC mode is unacknowledged and the TBF is established on a
non-hopping TRX.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

831 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.47 (CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_FH_ACK) - (CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_FH_ACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_FH_ACK

Logical Name

CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_FH_ACK

Definition

RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change


the Coding Scheme from CS1 to CS2 in the uplink direction when
the RLC mode is acknowledged and the TBF is established on a
hopping TRX.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

832 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.48 (CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_FH_NACK) - (CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_FH_NACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_FH_NACK

Logical Name

CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_FH_NACK

Definition

RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change


the Coding Scheme from CS1 to CS2 in the uplink direction when
the RLC mode is unacknowledged and the TBF is established on a
hopping TRX.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

833 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.49 (CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_NFH_ACK) - (CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_NFH_ACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_NFH_ACK

Logical Name

CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_NFH_ACK

Definition

RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change


the Coding Scheme from CS1 to CS2 in the uplink direction when
the RLC mode is acknowledged and the TBF is established on a
non-hopping TRX.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

834 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.50 (CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_NFH_NACK) (CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_NFH_NACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_NFH_NACK

Logical Name

CS_QUAL_UL_1_2_NFH_NACK

Definition

RXQUAL threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change


the Coding Scheme from CS1 to CS2 in the uplink direction when
the RLC mode is unacknowledged and the TBF is established on a
non-hopping TRX.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

835 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.51 (CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_FH_ACK) - (CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_FH_ACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_FH_ACK

Logical Name

CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_FH_ACK

Definition

Threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change the


Coding Scheme from CS2 to CS3 in the uplink direction when the
RLC mode is acknowledged and the TBF is established on a hopping
TRX.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

836 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.52 (CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_FH_NACK) - (CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_FH_NACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_FH_NACK

Logical Name

CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_FH_NACK

Definition

Threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change the


Coding Scheme from CS2 to CS3 in the uplink direction when the
RLC mode is unacknowledged and the TBF is established on a
hopping TRX.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

837 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.53 (CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_NFH_ACK) - (CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_NFH_ACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_NFH_ACK

Logical Name

CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_NFH_ACK

Definition

Threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change the


Coding Scheme from CS2 to CS3 in the uplink direction when
the RLC mode is acknowledged and the TBF is established on a
non-hopping TRX.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

3.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

838 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.54 (CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_NFH_NACK) (CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_NFH_NACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_NFH_NACK

Logical Name

CS_QUAL_UL_2_3_NFH_NACK

Definition

Threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change the


Coding Scheme from CS2 to CS3 in the uplink direction when the
RLC mode is unacknowledged and the TBF is established on a
non-hopping TRX.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

839 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.55 (CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_FH_ACK) - (CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_FH_ACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_FH_ACK

Logical Name

CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_FH_ACK

Definition

Threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change the


Coding Scheme from CS3 to CS4 in the uplink direction when the
RLC mode is acknowledged and the TBF is established on a hopping
TRX.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

840 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.56 (CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_FH_NACK) - (CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_FH_NACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_FH_NACK

Logical Name

CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_FH_NACK

Definition

Threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change the


Coding Scheme from CS3 to CS4 in the uplink direction when the
RLC mode is unacknowledged and the TBF is established on a
hopping TRX.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

841 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.57 (CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_NFH_ACK) - (CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_NFH_ACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_NFH_ACK

Logical Name

CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_NFH_ACK

Definition

Threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change the


Coding Scheme from CS3 to CS4 in the uplink direction when
the RLC mode is acknowledged and the TBF is established on a
non-hopping TRX.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

842 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.58 (CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_NFH_NACK) (CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_NFH_NACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_NFH_NACK

Logical Name

CS_QUAL_UL_3_4_NFH_NACK

Definition

Threshold used in the link adaptation algorithms to change the


Coding Scheme from CS3 to CS4 in the uplink direction when the
RLC mode is unacknowledged and the TBF is established on a
non-hopping TRX.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

843 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.59 (CS_SIR_DL_3_4_FH_ACK) - (CS_SIR_DL_3_4_FH_ACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_SIR_DL_3_4_FH_ACK

Logical Name

CS_SIR_DL_3_4_FH_ACK

Definition

Signal to Interference Ratio threshold used in the link adaptation


algorithms to change the Coding Scheme from CS3 to CS4 in the
downlink direction when the RLC mode is acknowledged and the
TBF is established on a hopping TRX.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

14

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

844 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.60 (CS_SIR_DL_3_4_FH_NACK) - (CS_SIR_DL_3_4_FH_NACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_SIR_DL_3_4_FH_NACK

Logical Name

CS_SIR_DL_3_4_FH_NACK

Definition

Signal to Interference Ratio threshold used in the link adaptation


algorithms to change the Coding Scheme from CS3 to CS4 in the
downlink direction when the RLC mode is unacknowledged and the
TBF is established on a hopping TRX.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

845 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.61 (CS_SIR_DL_3_4_NFH_ACK) - (CS_SIR_DL_3_4_NFH_ACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_SIR_DL_3_4_NFH_ACK

Logical Name

CS_SIR_DL_3_4_NFH_ACK

Definition

Signal to Interference Ratio threshold used in the link adaptation


algorithms to change the Coding Scheme from CS3 to CS4 in the
downlink direction when the RLC mode is acknowledged and the
TBF is established on a non-hopping TRX.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

13

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

846 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.62 (CS_SIR_DL_3_4_NFH_NACK) - (CS_SIR_DL_3_4_NFH_NACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_SIR_DL_3_4_NFH_NACK

Logical Name

CS_SIR_DL_3_4_NFH_NACK

Definition

Signal to Interference Ratio threshold used in the link adaptation


algorithms to change the Coding Scheme from CS3 to CS4 in the
downlink direction when the RLC mode is unacknowledged and the
TBF is established on a non-hopping TRX.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

847 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.63 (CS_SIR_HST_DL) - (CS_SIR_HST_DL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CS_SIR_HST_DL

Logical Name

CS_SIR_HST_DL

Definition

Signal to Interference Ratio hysteresis used in the link adaptation


algorithms to change the Coding Scheme from CS4 to CS3 in the
downlink direction.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

848 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.64 (Data Link Connection Identifier) - (DLCI)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Data Link Connection Identifier

Logical Name

DLCI

Definition

Data Link Connection Identifier, corresponds to a PVC identifier, see


Q.922 Annex A, Table 1.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

PVC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

16

991

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: MFS RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Create NS-VC

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

849 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.65 (DRX_TIMER_MAX) - (DRX_TIMER_MAX (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

DRX_TIMER_MAX

Logical Name

DRX_TIMER_MAX (BSC)

Definition

Maximum value allowed for the MS to request for non-DRX mode


after packet transfer mode.

Coding rules

Radio coding :Possible values : 0, 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64 respectively


binary coded as 000, 001, , 111ONLY THE VALUES 0, 1, 2 AND 4
ARE POSSIBLE in ALCATEL BSS.

Mandatory rules

Equal to DRX_TIMER_MAX (MFS)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

850 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.66 (DRX_TIMER_MAX) - (DRX_TIMER_MAX (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

DRX_TIMER_MAX

Logical Name

DRX_TIMER_MAX (MFS)

Definition

Maximum value allowed for the MS to request for non-DRX mode


after packet transfer mode.

Coding rules

Radio coding :Possible values : 0, 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64 respectively


binary coded as 000, 001, , 111ONLY THE VALUES 0, 1, 2 AND 4
ARE POSSIBLE in ALCATEL BSS.

Mandatory rules

Equal to DRX_TIMER_MAX (BSC)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

851 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.67 (EN_CS_ADAPTATION_ACK) - (EN_CS_ADAPTATION_ACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_CS_ADAPTATION_ACK

Logical Name

EN_CS_ADAPTATION_ACK

Definition

Enables / disables the link adaptation in RLC acknowledged mode.

Coding rules

0: Disable; 1: Enable

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

If EN_STREAMING = 1 then it is recommended to set


EN_CS_ADAPTATION_ACK to "TRUE" in order to activate the link
adaptation mechanism so that the (M)CS can reach a suitable level
regarding the level of the configured Rmin_(E)GPRS. Otherwise,
the streaming PFCs can be downgraded to the Default Best Effort
ABQP because the negotiated GBR cannot be reached on the radio
interface.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Cnct Ctrl 1/2

External Comment

This parameter applies to both GPRS and EGPRS TBFs.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

852 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.68 (EN_CS_ADAPTATION_NACK) - (EN_CS_ADAPTATION_NACK)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_CS_ADAPTATION_NACK

Logical Name

EN_CS_ADAPTATION_NACK

Definition

Enables / disables the link adaptation in RLC unacknowledged

Coding rules

0: Disable; 1: Enable

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Cnct Ctrl 1/2

External Comment

This parameter applies to both GPRS and EGPRS TBFs.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

853 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.69 (EN_DL_LLC_PDU_REROUTING) (EN_DL_LLC_PDU_REROUTING)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_DL_LLC_PDU_REROUTING

Logical Name

EN_DL_LLC_PDU_REROUTING

Definition

This flag enables / disables rerouting of DL LLC PDUs.

Coding rules

0 : disabled, 1 : enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

This parameter locks only the rerouting part of the feature. It has
no effect on the securisation part. This parameter applies to both,
intra-NSE and inter-NSE cell change.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

854 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.70 (EN_EGPRS) - (EN_EGPRS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_EGPRS

Logical Name

EN_EGPRS

Definition

Enables/Disables EGPRS traffic in the cell.

Coding rules

0: Disable, 1: Enable

Mandatory rules

EN_EGPRS = enable only if MAX_PDCH > 0.

Recommended rules

If EN_EGPRS is set to enable, Alcatel recommend to set the


parameter PS_PREF_BCCH_TRX to 0.In case of extended cell,
Alcatel recommend to set the same value in both, inner and outer,
cells.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / General groups

External Comment

From system point of view, when EN_EGPRS = Enable, the highest


MCS allowed on the TRX is defined by the current size of the
M-EGCH link of the TRX and by the MAX_EGPRS_MCS value.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

855 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.71 (EN_EXTENDED_UL_TBF) - (EN_EXTENDED_UL_TBF)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_EXTENDED_UL_TBF

Logical Name

EN_EXTENDED_UL_TBF

Definition

Flag to disable/enable the extended TBF mode feature on the uplink


(without or with allowing the MS not to answer to a USF received
while in Extended UL TBF mode).

Coding rules

0: Extended UL TBF mode (EUTM) is not used1: EUTM is used2:


I-EUTM is used (improved EUTM mode)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

-It is recommended not to activate simultaneously extended UL TBF


feature (EN_EXTENDED_UL_TBF) and the DL PDU rerouting feature
(EN_AUTONOMOUS_REROUTING)- if EN_EXTENDED_UL_TBF is
enabled and if RA capability update is supported by SGSN, then the
parameter EN_RA_CAP_UPDATE must be enabled.The Extended
UL TBF mode feature is completely effective only if the parameter
EN_RA_CAP_UPDATE is set to enabled.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

I-EUTM (improved EUTM) allow MS in EUTM mode to not answer to


a USF

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

856 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.72 (EN_FAST_INITIAL_GPRS_ACCESS) (EN_FAST_INITIAL_GPRS_ACCESS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_FAST_INITIAL_GPRS_ACCESS

Logical Name

EN_FAST_INITIAL_GPRS_ACCESS

Definition

This flag indicates whether or not one Slave PDCH is available for
(E)GPRS traffic in the cell (fast initial PS access feature).- In a Non
Evolium BTS, that corresponds to an established PDCH being able
to support incoming (E)GPRS traffic. - In an Evolium BTS, that
corresponds to a PDCH being able to support incoming (E)GPRS
traffic, that PDCH being located on an established TRX (i.e. the TRX
owns an M-EGCH link)

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

MIN_PDCH > NB_TS_MPDCH if


EN_FAST_INITIAL_GPRS_ACCESS = enabled; MIN_PDCH >=
NB_TS_MPDCH if EN_FAST_INITIAL_GPRS_ACCESS = disabled.

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Radio Res. Ctrl

External Comment

Better performances for service access time will be obtained when


this parameter is set to enabled, but one PDCH will always be
established in the cell. A compromise has to be made by the operator
between performance gain and the cost of radio and terrestrial
resources. This compromise becomes of higher importance in
case of a cell connected through a satellite link due to the higher
GPRS access time with satellite links, but also the higher cost of
transmission links.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

857 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.73 (EN_FAST_USF_UL_EXTENDED) (EN_FAST_USF_UL_EXTENDED)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_FAST_USF_UL_EXTENDED

Logical Name

EN_FAST_USF_UL_EXTENDED

Definition

Flag to disable/enable the fast scheduling mode for the uplink TBFs.

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

The parameter is significant only if EN_EXTENDED_UL_TBF


is enabled.The fast scheduling policy is controlled by the
T_EXTENDED_UL_TBF_FAST_POL parameter.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

858 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.74 (EN_FULL_IR_DL) - (EN_FULL_IR_DL_per_cell)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_FULL_IR_DL

Logical Name

EN_FULL_IR_DL_per_cell

Definition

Enables/Disables the resegmentation for the downlink TBF in the cell.

Coding rules

0: Disable the "full" IR, so : Incremental Redundancy with


resegmentation allowed in DL, 1: Enable the "full" IR, so, Incremental
Redundancy without resegmentation in DL

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

To allow the best throughput in DL, it is strongly recommended to set


this parameter to 0 i.e. to not forbid the resegmentation.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

859 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.75 (EN_MULTISLOT_CLASS_30_33) (EN_MULTISLOT_CLASS_30_33)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_MULTISLOT_CLASS_30_33

Logical Name

EN_MULTISLOT_CLASS_30_33

Definition

Enables the support of (E)GPRS multislot class 30-33.

Coding rules

0 : disabled, 1 : enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Support of DTM (E)GPRS multislot classes 31 to 33 is possible only


if EN_DTM = 1 and EN_MULTISLOT_CLASS_30_33 = 1. Support
of configurations requiring EDA is possible only if EN_EDA = 1 (and
ALLOW_DTM_EDA_COMBINATION = 1 in case of DTM).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

860 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.76 (EN_NACC) - (EN_NACC)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_NACC

Logical Name

EN_NACC

Definition

Enables the Network Assisted Cell Change feature.

Coding rules

0: disabled; 1:enabled

Mandatory rules

Can be enabled only if round_trip_delay < 500 msecWhen cell_type


= "extended inner" or "extended outer", then EN_NACC = 0

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

861 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.77 (EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIR) - (EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIR

Logical Name

EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIR

Definition

Indicates whether or not outgoing GPRS redirections are


systematically triggered from the serving cell.

Coding rules

0: Outgoing GPRS redirections are not triggered1: Outgoing GPRS


redirections are systematically triggered

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

In cells where outgoing GPRS redirections are systematically


triggered (i.e. EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIR = Enable), it is up to
the operator to ensure that at least one NC cell reselection cause
is always triggered upon receipt of the first Packet Measurement
Report message. For instance, NC cell reselection Cause PT1 can
be always activated by setting NC_DL_RXLEV_THR to -47 dBm
(Always).

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: ?

Parameter Access

???

External Comment

An outgoing GPRS redirection is a NC cell reselection which is


triggered when the MS enters the packet transfer mode in the serving
cell even if the radio link is good. The intention of GPRS redirections
is to redirect the MS towards a target cell more appropriate to carry
PS traffic (for instance a macro cell).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

862 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.78 (EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIR(n)) (EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIR(n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIR(n)

Logical Name

EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIR(n)

Definition

Indicates whether or not outgoing GPRS redirections are


systematically triggered from the serving cell.

Coding rules

0: Disable Outgoing GPRS redirections are not triggered1: Enable


Outgoing GPRS redirections are systematically triggered

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

In cells where outgoing GPRS redirections are systematically


triggered (i.e. EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIR = Enable), it is up to
the operator to ensure that at least one NC cell reselection cause
is always triggered upon receipt of the first Packet Measurement
Report message. For instance, NC cell reselection Cause PT1 can
be always activated by setting NC_DL_RXLEV_THR to -47 dBm
(Always).

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: ?

Parameter Access

???

External Comment

An outgoing GPRS redirection is a NC cell reselection which is


triggered when the MS enters the packet transfer mode in the serving
cell even if the radio link is good. The intention of GPRS redirections
is to redirect the MS towards a target cell more appropriate to carry
PS traffic (for instance a macro cell).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

863 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.79 (EN_PFC_FEATURE) - (EN_PFC_FEATURE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_PFC_FEATURE

Logical Name

EN_PFC_FEATURE

Definition

Enables/disables the support of the PFC negotiation feature.

Coding rules

1 => PFC feature is supported, 0 => PFC feature is not supported

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Any modification of the parameter leads the MFS to reset


autonomously all the GPUs connected to this BSS.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

864 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.80 (EN_PSI_STATUS) - (EN_PSI_STATUS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_PSI_STATUS

Logical Name

EN_PSI_STATUS

Definition

Enables the Packet SI Status feature in cells w/o PBCCH or the


Packet PSI Status feature in cells with a PBCCH.

Coding rules

0: disabled; 1:enabled

Mandatory rules

Can be enabled only if round_trip_delay < 500 msecWhen cell_type


= "extended inner" or "extended outer", then EN_PSI_STATUS = 0

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

865 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.81 (EN_RA_CAP_UPDATE) - (EN_RA_CAP_UPDATE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_RA_CAP_UPDATE

Logical Name

EN_RA_CAP_UPDATE

Definition

Flag to enable/disable the Radio Acces Capability update on Gb

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

This parameter must be enabled if RA capability update is


supported by SGSN and if it exists, at least, one cell where
EN_EXTENDED_UL_TBF is enabled.The Extended UL TBF
mode feature is completely effective only if the parameter
EN_RA_CAP_UPDATE is set to enabled.If EN_STREAMING is set
to 1 then EN_RA_CAP_UPDATE must also be set to 1 (enabled).
Otherwise the BSS will not be able to handle streaming flow. If
this rule is not respected then all PFC creation requests related to
a streaming flow will be downgraded to the default best effort flow
by the BSS.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

866 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.82 (EN_STREAMING) - (EN_STREAMING)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_STREAMING

Logical Name

EN_STREAMING

Definition

Enables/disables the support of the STREAMING flows.

Coding rules

1 => the cell supports the streaming flows in addition to the non real
time flows (best effort, interactive, background) if EN_PFC_FEATURE
= 1 and if the PFC feature negotiation with the SGSN is successful0
=> the cell supports the non real time flows (best effort, interactive,
background) if EN_PFC_FEATURE = 1 and if the PFC feature
negotiation with the SGSN is successful

Mandatory rules

- Can be enabled only if the BTS Generation = Evolium- If


EN_STREAMING = 1 then MAX_PDCH_HIGH_LOAD > 0When cell_type = "extended inner" or "extended outer", then
EN_STREAMING = 0

Recommended rules

1) If this parameter is set to 1 then the parameter


EN_RA_CAP_UPDATE must also be set to 1 (enabled). Otherwise
the BSS will not be able to handle streaming flow. If this rule is not
respected then all PFC creation requests related to a streaming flow
will be downgraded to the default best effort flow by the BSS.2) the
parameter EN_CS_ADAPTATION_ACK must also set to "TRUE" in
order to activate the link adaptation mechanism so that the (M)CS
can reach a suitable level regarding the level of the configured
Rmin_(E)GPRS. Otherwise, the streaming PFCs can be downgraded
to the Default Best Effort ABQP because the negotiated GBR cannot
be reached on the radio interface.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

867 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.83 (Excess Burst Size) - (EBS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Excess Burst Size

Logical Name

EBS

Definition

Excess Burst Size.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

CIR=0 <=> CBS=0 => EBS > 0CIR <= NIR <= CIR x (1 + EBS/CBS)
<= ACCESS_RATE_BC

Recommended rules

EBS=FR_CAPACITY(expressed in kbit/s) / 8, if CIR=0

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

PVC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

kbyte

248

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: MFS RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Create NS-VC

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

868 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.84 (GAMMA_TNx) - (GAMMA_TNx)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

GAMMA_TNx

Logical Name

GAMMA_TNx

Definition

Binary representation of the "gamma ch" for MS output power control.

Coding rules

Coded on 5 bits, step size=2dB, with 00000 == 0 dB, 00001 == 2


dB, ... 11111 == 62 dB.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

62

30

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Power Ctrl

External Comment

In the context of a concentric cell, the parameter applies to the outer


zone.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

869 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.85 (Gb_Configuration_Type) - (Gb_Configuration_type)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Gb_Configuration_Type

Logical Name

Gb_Configuration_type

Definition

Configuration type used with Gb over IP

Coding rules

0 : Static configuration 1: Dynamic configurationdefault value : 0

Mandatory rules

In a BSS in multi-GP/GPU configuration where Gb_Transport_Mode


is IP, all the NSEs, having children IPendpoint(s), must have the
same Gb_Configuration_Type.

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

NSE

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Gb_Configuration type is significant only when Gb_Transport mode


is IP.Parameter change: before any parameter modification, the
operator has to delete the children SGSN IP endpoints.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

870 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.86 (Gb_Transport_Mode) - (Gb_Transport_Mode)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Gb_Transport_Mode

Logical Name

Gb_Transport_Mode

Definition

Mode of the transport for Gb interface: FR or IP.

Coding rules

0: FR mode1: IP mode

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

When the NSE is not associated to a BSS, the


Gb_Transport_Mode_perNSE defines the transport mode
of the NSE.When the NSE is associated to a BSS, the transport
mode of the BSS defines the transport mode of all NSEs of the BSS
(the Gb_Transport_Mode - of the BSS - overrides the transport mode
defined in the NSE instance).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

871 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.87 (Gb_Transport_Mode_per_NSE) - (Gb_Transport_Mode_per_NSE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Gb_Transport_Mode_per_NSE

Logical Name

Gb_Transport_Mode_per_NSE

Definition

Mode of the transport for Gb interface (per NSE): FR or IP.

Coding rules

0: FR mode1: IP mode

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

NSE

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

When the NSE is not associated to a BSS, the


Gb_Transport_Mode_perNSE defines the transport mode
of the NSE.When the NSE is associated to a BSS, the transport
mode of the BSS defines the transport mode of all NSEs of the BSS
(the Gb_Transport_Mode - of the BSS - overrides the transport mode
defined in the NSE instance).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

872 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.88 (GCH_RED_FACTOR_HiAter) (GCH_RED_FACTOR_High_Ater_Usage)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

GCH_RED_FACTOR_HiAter

Logical Name

GCH_RED_FACTOR_High_Ater_Usage

Definition

Reduction factor of the number of GCHs targeted per PDCH, when


the Ater usage is "high".

Coding rules

step size = 0.01

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

A low value of GCH_RED_Factor_High_Ater_Usage can be


coherent with a high value of Ater_Usage_Threshold (it will avoid
reaching the saturation point of 100% of the Ater resources used
at the same moment in the GPU).Reciprocally, a high value of
GCH_RED_Factor_High_Ater_Usage can be coherent with a low
value of Ater_Usage_Threshold (it will limit the risks of wasting, i.e.
of not using, Ater resources in the GPU).

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.1

0.75

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

The GCH reduction factor applies to the new PDCHs which are
used when the Ater usage is "high" (see the Ater_Usage_Threshold
parameter). This parameter can be reduced in order to avoid Ater
shortage situations.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

873 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.89 (GPRS_CELL_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS) (GPRS_CELL_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

GPRS_CELL_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS

Logical Name

GPRS_CELL_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS

Definition

Additional hysteresis which applies in Ready state for cells in same


RA.

Coding rules

step size = 2dB; coded on 3 bits. 000=0 dB, 001= 2 dB, 111=14 dB

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

14

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 2/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

874 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.90 (GPRS_MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH) - (GPRS_MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

GPRS_MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH

Logical Name

GPRS_MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH

Definition

Maximum TX power level an MS may use when accessing the


system.

Coding rules

Coded on 5 bits from 0 to 31The coding depends on the BCCH


frequency band:P-GSM/G1 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 43 dBm,
..., 19: 5 dBm.GSM 850 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 39 dBm, 1: 39
dBm, 2: 39 dBm, 3: 37 dBm, 4: 35 dBm,..., 19: 5 dBm.DCS 1800
coding:step size = 2 dBm; 0: 30 dBm, ..., 15: 0 dBm.DCS 1900
coding: range 0 to 15, 30, 31; 30: 33 dBm, 31: 32 dBm, 0: 30 dBm,
1: 28 dBm, ..., 15: 0 dBm.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

43

43

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 1/2

External Comment

The default value depends on the BCCH frequency band:Default


value for P-GSM/G1: 43 dBmDefault value for GSM850: 39
dBmDefault value for DCS1800: 30 dBmDefault value for DCS1900:
30 dBm

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

875 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.91 (GPRS_MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH) (GPRS_MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH(n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

GPRS_MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH

Logical Name

GPRS_MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH(n)

Definition

Maximum TX power level an MS may use when accessing the


system.

Coding rules

Coded on 5 bits from 0 to 31The coding depends on the BCCH


frequency band:P-GSM/G1 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 43 dBm,
..., 19: 5 dBm.GSM 850 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 39 dBm, 1:
39 dBm, 2: 39 dBm, 3: 37 dBm, 4: 35 dBm, 19: 5 dBm.DCS 1800
coding:step size = 2 dBm; 0: 30 dBm, ..., 15: 0 dBm.DCS 1900
coding: range 0 to 15, 30, 31; 30: 33 dBm, 31: 32 dBm, 0: 30 dBm,
1: 28 dBm, ..., 15: 0 dBm.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

43

43

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit External Cell / Packet

External Comment

The default value depends on the BCCH frequency band:Default


value for P-GSM/G1: 43 dBmDefault value for GSM850: 39
dBmDefault value for DCS1800: 30 dBmDefault value for DCS1900:
30 dBm

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

876 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.92 (GPRS_MULTISLOT_CLASS_DEF_VALUE) (GPRS_MULTISLOT_CLASS_DEF_VALUE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

GPRS_MULTISLOT_CLASS_DEF_VALUE

Logical Name

GPRS_MULTISLOT_CLASS_DEF_VALUE

Definition

Default value of the (E)GPRS multislot class assumed at TBF


establishment when the actual MS (E)GPRS multislot class is
unknown.- In an Evolium BTS : The default MS class is used as an
input of the best candidate TBF allocation computation process
when the MS class is not known on UL TBF establishment- In a Non
Evolium BTS : The default MS class is used as an input of the best
candidate TBF allocation computation process when the MS class
is not known on UL TBF establishment.In the PDCH anticipation
process on UL TBF establishment : the default MS class is used to
determine how many PDCHs are established in advance to anticipate
the concurrent DL TBF establishment.

Coding rules

Only the following GPRS multislot class defined in 3GPP TS 05.02


annex B are allowed: 1: GPRS multislot class 1 (1+1 MS);2: GPRS
multislot class 2 (2+1 MS);4: GPRS multislot class 4 (3+1 MS);8:
GPRS multislot class 8 (4+1 MS).30: GPRS multislot class 30 (5+1
MS).

Mandatory rules

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

877 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

Recommended rules

The recommendations to set this parameter are the following:1)


Case where there are only Evolium BTSs in the BSS:1.1) In
case the PS traffic is mainly signalling (e.g. there is a great
proportion of RA Updates among the UL TBF establishment
requests), GPRS_MULTISLOT_CLASS_DEF_VALUE shall be
set to 1 (optimization of the number of T2 TBF reallocations
and of PPC / DSP CPU). 1.2) In case the PS traffic is mainly
data (high proportion of UL TBF establishment requests for data
traffic), GPRS_MULTISLOT_CLASS_DEF_VALUE should be set
to the most common multislot class which can be found among
the mobile stations within the BSS (in order to limit the number
of T2 TBF reallocations and of PPC / DSP CPU, triggered with
the establishment of the concurrent DL TBF). In case of multislot
class 30, this additionally requires that the multislot class 30-33
feature is widely activated in the BSS.2) Case where there are
some DRFU BTSs in the BSS (together with some Evolium BTSs
or not):2.1) In DRFU BTSs, the impacts of this parameter value on
T2 TBF reallocations are the same as in Evolium BTSs, so 1.1)
and 1.2) recommendations are applicable in order to avoid useless
/ to limit the number of T2 TBF reallocations .2.2) On the other
hand, in DRFU BTSs, in case the PS traffic is mainly signalling
(e.g. there is a great proportion of RA Updates among the UL TBF
establishment requests) and in case of low number of Ater resources
(risk of Ater congestion in some GPUs), it is recommended to
set GPRS_MULTISLOT_CLASS_DEF_VALUE to 1. Indeed, an
Ater congestion may be encountered because some transmission
resources (PDCHs) are established in advance by RRM based on
the value of GPRS_MULTISLOT_CLASS_DEF_VALUE (PDCH
anticipation process). Once the traffic type is confirmed signalling,
these resources (PDCHs) are released, but at T_GCH_Inactivity
timer expiry. As a consequence, the transmission resources (PDCHs)
can be established even if they are not used during several seconds,
which can generate an Ater congestion in some GPUs.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

30

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / General

878 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

External Comment

The entered value is assumed by default at uplink TBF establishment


when the actual MS multislot class is unknown (e.g. RACH
one phase access on CCCH) . Otherwise, the multislot class
received in the request for uplink TBF establishment is taken
into account.In case the traffic is mainly signalling (majority of
RA Updates), Ater congestion may be encountered because the
transmission resources are allocated in advance, based on the value
of GPRS_MULTISLOT_CLASS_DEF_VALUE parameter. Indeed,
once the traffic type is confirmed signalling, these resources are
de-allocated, but only at T_PDCH_Inactivity timer expiry. As a
consequence, in this case, the transmission resources are allocated
even if they are not used during several seconds. Therefore it is
advised to reduce the value of the default multislot class to 1.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

879 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.93 (GPRS_PENALTY_TIME) - (GPRS_PENALTY_TIME(n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

GPRS_PENALTY_TIME

Logical Name

GPRS_PENALTY_TIME(n)

Definition

Time during which GPRS_TEMPORARY_OFFSET is active in


neighbour cells.

Coding rules

step size = 10 sec, coded on 5 bits (00000 = 10 sec, 11111 = 320 sec)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

10

320

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 2/2 (+ Edit External Cell / Packet)

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

880 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.94 (GPRS_RESELECTION_OFFSET) (GPRS_RESELECTION_OFFSET(n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

GPRS_RESELECTION_OFFSET

Logical Name

GPRS_RESELECTION_OFFSET(n)

Definition

Permanent offset for GPRS cell reselection in neighbour cells.

Coding rules

coded on 5 bits (00000 = -52 dB, 11111 = 48 dB)00000= -52; 00001=


-48; 00010= -44; 00011= -40; 00100= -36; 00101= -32; 00110= -28;
00111= -24; 01000= -20; 01001= -16; 01010= -12; 01011= -10;
01100= - 8; 01101= - 6; 01110= - 4; 01111= - 2; 10000= 0; 10001= 2;
10010= 4; 10011= 6; 10100= 8; 10101=10; 10110= 12; 10111= 16;
11000= 20; 11001= 24; 11010= 28; 11011= 32; 11100= 36; 11101=
40; 11110= 44; 11111= 48

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-52

48

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 2/2 (+ Edit External Cell / Packet)

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

881 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.95 (GPRS_RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN) - (GPRS_RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

GPRS_RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN

Logical Name

GPRS_RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN

Definition

Minimum received level at the MS required for access to the system.

Coding rules

step size = 1 dBm, coded on 6 bits (000000 = -110 dBm, 111111


= -47 dBm)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 1/2 (+ Edit Cell / GPRS / Master
Channel 2/2)

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

882 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.96 (GPRS_RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN) - (GPRS_RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN(n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

GPRS_RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN

Logical Name

GPRS_RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN(n)

Definition

Minimum received level at the MS required for access to the system


in neighbour cells.

Coding rules

coded on 6 bits, 0=-110 dBm, 63=-47 dBm, step size=1dBm

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Adjacencies

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

883 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.97 (GPRS_TEMPORARY_OFFSET) (GPRS_TEMPORARY_OFFSET(n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

GPRS_TEMPORARY_OFFSET

Logical Name

GPRS_TEMPORARY_OFFSET(n)

Definition

Negative offset used for MS cell reselection process in neighbour


cells.

Coding rules

Possible values : 0, 10, 20, 30, 40, 50, 60, infinity respectively binary
coded as 000, 001, , 111

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

infinity

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 2/2 (+ Edit External Cell / Packet)

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

884 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.98 (GPU_Gb_Base_IP) - (GPU_Gb_Base_IP)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

GPU_Gb_Base_IP

Logical Name

GPU_Gb_Base_IP

Definition

Base address of the local IP address used to define the


Gb_IP_Address of each GPU.

Coding rules

coded on 32 bitscoded as follow in 4 groups of 8bits:


255.255.255.000The last group is set to 000 (base address)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

4294967295

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Base address used to define the GPU_Local_IP_Endpoint

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

885 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.99 (GPU_Gb_Base_UDP) - (GPU_Gb_Base_UDP)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

GPU_Gb_Base_UDP

Logical Name

GPU_Gb_Base_UDP

Definition

UDP port number of the GPU board for Gb over IP interface.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

63488

64512

64512

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

used to define the UDP port of each GPU boards

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

886 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.100 (GPU_Gb_IP_Address) - (GPU_Gb_IP_Address)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

GPU_Gb_IP_Address

Logical Name

GPU_Gb_IP_Address

Definition

Allows to display the IP address used by a GPU board in a NSE


instance (used for Gb over IP)

Coding rules

coded on 32 bitsOMC must display the value of each octet following


the format: www.xxx.yyy.zzzdefault value : 0.0.0.0

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

GPU

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

4294967295

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Calculated by the MFS from the GPU_Gb_Base_IP value.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

887 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.101 (GPU_Gb_UDP_Port) - (GPU_Gb_UDP_Port)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

GPU_Gb_UDP_Port

Logical Name

GPU_Gb_UDP_Port

Definition

UDP port number of the GPU board in the NSE instance (used for
Gb over IP).

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

GPU

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

63488

64512

64512

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

equal to GPU_Gb_base_UDP.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

888 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.102 (HCS_THR) - (GPRS_HCS_THR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

HCS_THR

Logical Name

GPRS_HCS_THR

Definition

HCS signal strength.

Coding rules

Coded on 5 bits. 00000=-110 dBm, 00001=-108 dBm, 11111=-48


dBm

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-48

-84

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 2/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

889 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.103 (HCS_THR) - (GPRS_HCS_THR(n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

HCS_THR

Logical Name

GPRS_HCS_THR(n)

Definition

HCS signal strength.

Coding rules

Coded on 5 bits. 00000=-110 dBm, 00001=-108 dBm, 11111=-48


dBm

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-48

-84

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 2/2 (+ Edit External Cell / Packet)

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

890 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.104 (HIGH_PRECEDENCE_BACKGROUND_PRIORITY) (HIGH_PRECEDENCE_BACKGROUND_PRIORITY)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

HIGH_PRECEDENCE_BACKGROUND_PRIORITY

Logical Name

HIGH_PRECEDENCE_BACKGROUND_PRIORITY

Definition

Defines the relative priority used for Background Packet Flow


Context, with precedence parameter set to high

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

891 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.105 (HIGH_PRECEDENCE_THP1_PRIORITY) (HIGH_PRECEDENCE_THP1_PRIORITY)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

HIGH_PRECEDENCE_THP1_PRIORITY

Logical Name

HIGH_PRECEDENCE_THP1_PRIORITY

Definition

Defines the relative priority used for Interactive THP1 Packet Flow
Context, with precedence parameter set to high

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

892 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.106 (HIGH_PRECEDENCE_THP2_PRIORITY) (HIGH_PRECEDENCE_THP2_PRIORITY)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

HIGH_PRECEDENCE_THP2_PRIORITY

Logical Name

HIGH_PRECEDENCE_THP2_PRIORITY

Definition

Defines the relative priority used for Interactive THP2 Packet Flow
Context, with precedence parameter set to high

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

893 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.107 (HIGH_PRECEDENCE_THP3_PRIORITY) (HIGH_PRECEDENCE_THP3_PRIORITY)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

HIGH_PRECEDENCE_THP3_PRIORITY

Logical Name

HIGH_PRECEDENCE_THP3_PRIORITY

Definition

Defines the relative priority used for Interactive THP3 Packet Flow
Context, with precedence parameter set to high

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

12

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

894 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.108 (HIGH_TRAFFIC_LOAD_GPRS) - (HIGH_TRAFFIC_LOAD_GPRS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

HIGH_TRAFFIC_LOAD_GPRS

Logical Name

HIGH_TRAFFIC_LOAD_GPRS

Definition

Load threshold used to determine a certain margin of radio timeslots


reserved for CS traffic between two sending of the BSCGP RR
Allocation Indication messages. The threshold is expressed in
percentage of the radio timeslots available in the cell.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

90

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / General groups

External Comment

The margin of radio timeslots reserved for CS traffic can be computed


as follows:(100 - HIGH_TRAFFIC_LOAD_GPRS)/100*NB_TSwhere
NB_TS is the number of radio timeslots available in the cell.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent
t01

t02

t03

t04

t05

t06

t07

t08

t09

t010

t011

t012

70

70

70

80

80

80

80

80

80

80

80

80

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

895 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.109 (IP_Address) - (SGSN_IP_Address)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

IP_Address

Logical Name

SGSN_IP_Address

Definition

IP address of the SGSN IP endpoint used for Gb over IP

Coding rules

coded on 32 bitsOMC must display the value of each octet following


the format:www.xxx.yyy.zzzdefault value is 0.0.0.0

Mandatory rules

Each SGSN IP EndPoint (SGSN_IP_Address, SGSN_UDP_Port)


must be unique per NSE

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

SGSN-IPEndPoint

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

4294967295

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

896 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.110 (IPGB_SUBNET_MASK_MFS) - (IPGB_SUBNET_MASK_MFS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

IPGB_SUBNET_MASK_MFS

Logical Name

IPGB_SUBNET_MASK_MFS

Definition

Mask of the subnet where is allocated the range of MFS addresses


used forGb telecom protocols

Coding rules

coded on 32 bitscoded as follow in 4 groups of 8bits:


255.255.255.255default value : 0.0.0.0

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

4294967295

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

897 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.111 (LAC) - (LAC (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

LAC

Logical Name

LAC (MFS)

Definition

Location Area Code.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

LAC and CI can not be equal to 65535 at the same timeEqual to LAC
(BSC)A couple of mate extended cells (Extended inner + extended
outer) shall have the same LAC

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

65535

65535

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description ( + Edit External cell


/ circuit1/2)

External Comment

Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated here


is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

898 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.112 (LAC) - (LAC(n)(MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

LAC

Logical Name

LAC(n)(MFS)

Definition

Location Area Code.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

LAC and CI can not be equal to 65535 at the same time.Equal to


LAC(n)(BSC)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

65535

65535

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Adjacencies

External Comment

Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated here


is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

899 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.113 (Level 1 down) - (PVC_Level1_down)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Level 1 down

Logical Name

PVC_Level1_down

Definition

This parameter gives the low level of threshold for congestion.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

PVC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

40

Modifiable

OMC Changes: MFS RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

MFSUSM / GB Configuration / Create NSVC

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

900 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.114 (Level 1 Factor) - (PVC_Level1_Factor)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Level 1 Factor

Logical Name

PVC_Level1_Factor

Definition

This parameter is used to calculate the amount of data used for


buffering.

Coding rules

step size = 0.01

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

amount of memory needed : PVC_Level1_factor * 10 * (CBS+EBS)


for a PVC

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

PVC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.05

12.75

Modifiable

OMC Changes: MFS RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

MFSUSM / GB Configuration / Create NSVC

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

901 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.115 (Level 1 up) - (PVC_Level1_up)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Level 1 up

Logical Name

PVC_Level1_up

Definition

This parameter gives the high level of threshold for congestion.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

PVC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

70

Modifiable

OMC Changes: MFS RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

MFSUSM / GB Configuration / Create NSVC

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

902 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.116 (LOAD_EV_PERIOD_GPRS) - (LOAD_EV_PERIOD_GPRS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

LOAD_EV_PERIOD_GPRS

Logical Name

LOAD_EV_PERIOD_GPRS

Definition

Number of load samples (calculated every TCH_INFO_PERIOD


seconds) used to compute the maximum number of slave PDCHs
that the BSC can allocate to the MFS.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

30

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Radio Resource Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

903 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.117 (LOW_PRECEDENCE_BACKGROUND_PRIORITY) (LOW_PRECEDENCE_BACKGROUND_PRIORITY)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

LOW_PRECEDENCE_BACKGROUND_PRIORITY

Logical Name

LOW_PRECEDENCE_BACKGROUND_PRIORITY

Definition

Defines the relative priority used for Background Packet Flow


Context, with precedence parameter set to low

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

904 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.118 (LOW_PRECEDENCE_THP1_PRIORITY) (LOW_PRECEDENCE_THP1_PRIORITY)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

LOW_PRECEDENCE_THP1_PRIORITY

Logical Name

LOW_PRECEDENCE_THP1_PRIORITY

Definition

Defines the relative priority used for Interactive THP1 Packet Flow
Context, with precedence parameter set to low

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

905 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.119 (LOW_PRECEDENCE_THP2_PRIORITY) (LOW_PRECEDENCE_THP2_PRIORITY)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

LOW_PRECEDENCE_THP2_PRIORITY

Logical Name

LOW_PRECEDENCE_THP2_PRIORITY

Definition

Defines the relative priority used for Interactive THP2 Packet Flow
Context, with precedence parameter set to low

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

906 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.120 (LOW_PRECEDENCE_THP3_PRIORITY) (LOW_PRECEDENCE_THP3_PRIORITY)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

LOW_PRECEDENCE_THP3_PRIORITY

Logical Name

LOW_PRECEDENCE_THP3_PRIORITY

Definition

Defines the relative priority used for Interactive THP3 Packet Flow
Context, with precedence parameter set to low

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

12

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

907 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.121 (MAX_DL_TBF_SPDCH) - (MAX_DL_TBF_SPDCH)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MAX_DL_TBF_SPDCH

Logical Name

MAX_DL_TBF_SPDCH

Definition

Indicative value of the maximum number of DownLink (E)GPRS


TBFs per Slave PDCH.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

When allocating a DL GPRS TBF: MAX_DL_TBF_SPDCH is


the maximum number of GPRS + EGPRS TBFs allowed in
DL on each Slave PDCH. When allocating a DL EGPRS TBF:
MAX_DL_TBF_SPDCH is the maximum number of EGPRS TBFs
allowed in DL on each Slave PDCH (regardless of the current number
of DL GPRS TBFs).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

908 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.122 (MAX_EGPRS_MCS) - (MAX_EGPRS_MCS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MAX_EGPRS_MCS

Logical Name

MAX_EGPRS_MCS

Definition

Maximum Modulation and Coding Scheme used for EGPRS traffic


in the cell.

Coding rules

0: MCS-1; 1: MCS-2; 2: MCS-3; 3: MCS-4;4: MCS-5; 5: MCS-6;6:


MCS-7; 7: MCS-8;8: MCS-9;

Mandatory rules

MAX_EGPRS_MCS >= TBF_DL_INIT_MCSMAX_EGPRS_MCS


>= TBF_UL_INIT_MCSWhen cell_type = "extended outer", then
MAX_EGPRS_MCS <= MCS-4

Recommended rules

R_AVERAGE_EGPRS shall not be set to a bitrate higher than


the useful bitrate corresponding to MAX_EGPRS_MCS (e.g. if
MAX_EGPRS_MCS = MCS9 => R_AVERAGE_EGPRS shall
not be higher than 59,2kbps).R_MIN_EGPRS shall not be
set to a bitrate higher than the useful bitrate corresponding to
Max_EGPRS_MCS. If the above recommended rule is not fulfilled,
then some RT PFCs can be accepted by the BSS whereas it
will not be possible to handle their associated GBR. This may
result in RT PFC downgrades to Best Effort.It is advised to set
MAX_EGPRS_MCS to a value different from MCS-2 to cope
with MEGCH control message granularity in an optimal way.For
consistency reasons, MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_DL and
MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_UL shall NOT be higher than
any of the MAX_EGPRS_MCS values defined in the cells of the MFS.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: ?

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

909 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.123 (MAX_GPRS_CS) - (MAX_GPRS_CS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MAX_GPRS_CS

Logical Name

MAX_GPRS_CS

Definition

Maximum coding scheme used for GPRS traffic in the cell.

Coding rules

1 : CS-2; 2 : CS-3; 3 : CS-4

Mandatory rules

MAX_GPRS_CS >= TBF_DL_INIT_CSMAX_GPRS_CS >=


TBF_UL_INIT_CSIf Max_PDCH = 0 then MAX_GPRS_CS =
CS-2.The aim of this last rule is to prevent the BSC to trigger
uselessly the algorithms of adjust ranking and transmission pool set
up (lead time and outage) for CS3 and CS4, in case Max_PDCH
= 0 (i.e. GPRS is not allowed)

Recommended rules

R_AVERAGE_GPRS shall not be set to a bitrate higher than


the useful bitrate corresponding to MAX_GPRS_CS (e.g. if
MAX_GPRS_CS = CS2 => R_AVERAGE_GPRS shall not be higher
than 12kbps)R_MIN_GPRS shall not be set to a bitrate higher than
the useful bitrate corresponding to Max_GPRS_CS. If the above
recommended rule is not fulfilled, then some RT PFCs can be
accepted by the BSS whereas it will not be possible to handle their
associated GBR. This may result in RT PFC downgrades to Best
Effort.For consistency reasons, MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_DL
and MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_UL shall NOT be higher than
any of the MAX_GPRS_CS values defined in the cells of the MFS.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / General groups

External Comment

CS-3 and CS-4 are supported on Evolium BTS only.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

910 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.124 (MAX_PAGING_QUEUE) - (MAX_PAGING_QUEUE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MAX_PAGING_QUEUE

Logical Name

MAX_PAGING_QUEUE

Definition

Maximum number of CS+PS paging messages stored in GPU.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Paging Rate = 100 paging/s AND Queueing Time = 5s

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

50

1000

500

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / General

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

911 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.125 (MAX_PDCH) - (MAX_PDCH (MFS))


Management of
Enable_GPRS Flag (Cell
Parameter)

Creation of a BSC

DLS Restore When the


Flag is Not In Lline With
Max_PDCH

This flag exists in the BSC and is managed by the OMC-R but it is not visible
to the operator. It is derived by the OMC-R from the value of Max_PDCH.
When the Enable_GPRS flag is set to true, it means that the BSC can accept
MFS requests for a certain cell. In some circumstances, there can be some
inconsistencies, but these might not have any impact:
When the BSS is discovered by the OMC-R, the MFS parameters are set to
their default value by the OMC-R. Max_PDCH is set to 0. (There may be
inconsistency at system level, but no impact.) Later, if the operator installs
GPRS, he has to download the radio configuration to the MFS. Through this
operation, the flag Enable_GPRS is recomputed for the cells concerned by
the PRC, and therefore downloaded to the BSC. All data is then in line for
the cells concerned by the PRC. It can occur that some cells remain with
Enable_GPRS set to true and Max_PDCH set to 0 but this does no harm at all
(no impact on the traffic, and not visible by the operator).
Any DLS restore must be followed by the following procedure to line-up the
EN_GPRS of the cells handled by this BSC with the Max_PDCH of these
cells currently stored in the OMC-R:
1. Copy the SC into the PRC
2. Activate this PRC
Until the synchronization is achieved, the cell cannot be set into service for
GPRS by the telecom application (there is no impact if the cell is already
started for GPRS).

Parameter Name

HMI Name

MAX_PDCH

Logical Name

MAX_PDCH (MFS)

Definition

Maximum number of slave and master PDCHs that can be allocated


to the MFS in the cell.

Coding rules

912 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

Mandatory rules

Max_PDCH >= MAX_PDCH_HIGH_LOAD;If MAX_PDCH > 0


then EN_GPRS = TRUE ; If MAX_PDCH = 0 then EN_GPRS =
FALSE;If MAX_PDCH = 0 then EN_EGPRS = FALSE;If EN_VGCS=
enabled, then "(MAX_VGCS_TS + MAX_PDCH) < Total number
of TCHs of the cell"If Max_PDCH = 0 then MAX_GPRS_CS =
CS-2.The aim of this rule is to prevent the BSC to trigger uselessly
the algorithms of adjust ranking and transmission pool set up
(lead time and outage) for CS3 and CS4, in case Max_PDCH =
0 (i.e. GPRS is not allowed)MAX_PDCH shall be set so that at
least one slave PDCH can be allocated to the MFS to serve DL
or UL TBFs. This means that MAX_PDCH > NB_TS_MPDCH if
EN_GPRS = TRUE.When Max_PDCH > 0 and cell_type = "extended
inner" or "extended outer", then MAX_PDCH shall be an even
number.The following conditions are verified by the OMC-R in order
to check the upper limit of MAX_PDCH:i) MAX_PDCH <= 8*(nb
of TRXs with TRX_PREF_MARK = 0) - 1 if TRX_PREF_MARK
= 0 on BCCH TRX and CCCH_CONF = "1: CCCH combined"ii)
MAX_PDCH <= 8*(nb of TRXs with TRX_PREF_MARK = 0) - 2
if TRX_PREF_MARK = 0 on BCCH TRX and CCCH_CONF =
"0: CCCH not combined"iii) MAX_PDCH <= NB_TS_MPDCH +
8*(nb of TRXs with TRX_PREF_MARK = 0) if TRX_PREF_MARK
<> 0 on BCCH TRXiv) MAX_PDCH <= 8*(nb of TRXs with
TRX_PREF_MARK=0) - 3 if TRX_PREF_MARK = 0 on BCCH TRX
and CCCH_CONF = 2

Recommended rules

In a micro cell, the operator may be interested to force the


MS to reselect a macro cell by a correct setting of the cell
reselection parameters broadcast on PBCCH (without using NC cell
reselections, i.e. when EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIR is set to
0 and NETWORK_CONTROL_ORDER is set to NC0 in the micro
cell). In this case, the following configuration is recommended:
NB_TS_MPDCH = 1, MAX_PDCH = 2, MAX_PDCH_HIGH_LOAD =
1, MIN_PDCH = 1.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

127

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Radio Resource Control

External Comment

127 is a theoretical value : 16 TRX * 8 PDCH - BCCH.To support


LCS in a cell, it is mandatory to have Max_PDCH > 0

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

913 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.126 (MAX_PDCH_HIGH_LOAD) - (MAX_PDCH_HIGH_LOAD (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MAX_PDCH_HIGH_LOAD

Logical Name

MAX_PDCH_HIGH_LOAD (MFS)

Definition

Maximum number of slave and master PDCHs that can be allocated


to the MFS when the CS traffic is high.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

- MAX_PDCH >= MAX_PDCH_HIGH_LOADMAX_PDCH_HIGH_LOAD >= MIN_PDCH- If EN_DTM = 1 then


MAX_PDCH_HIGH_LOAD > 1

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

127

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Radio Resource Control

External Comment

127 is a theoretical value: 16 TRX * 8 PDCH - BCCH.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

914 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.127 (MAX_PDCH_PER_TBF) - (MAX_PDCH_PER_TBF)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MAX_PDCH_PER_TBF

Logical Name

MAX_PDCH_PER_TBF

Definition

Maximum number of PDCHs allocated to a single (E)GPRS


connection.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Radio Resource Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

915 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.128 (MAX_RETRANS) - (Max_retrans (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MAX_RETRANS

Logical Name

Max_retrans (MFS)

Definition

Maximum number of CHANNEL REQUEST retransmissions by


the MS on the RACH, broadcast on the PBCCH for CS service
establishment.

Coding rules

Possible values are:1, 2 ,4 and 7 respectively binary coded:00, 01,


10 and 11

Mandatory rules

Max_retrans (BSC) = Max_retrans (MFS) for a given cell

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

External Comment

The bigger this parameter is, the lesser the MS power consumption
is.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

916 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.129 (MAX_RETRANS_1) - (MAX_RETRANS_1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MAX_RETRANS_1

Logical Name

MAX_RETRANS_1

Definition

Maximum number of PACKET CHANNEL REQUEST retransmissions


by the MS on the PRACH with priority level 1.

Coding rules

Possible values are : 1, 2, 4, 7 respectively binary coded : 00, 01,


10, 11

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Master channel 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

917 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.130 (MAX_RETRANS_2) - (MAX_RETRANS_2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MAX_RETRANS_2

Logical Name

MAX_RETRANS_2

Definition

Maximum number of PACKET CHANNEL REQUEST retransmissions


by the MS on the PRACH with priority level 2.

Coding rules

Possible values are : 1, 2, 4, 7 respectively binary coded : 00, 01,


10, 11

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Master channel 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

918 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.131 (MAX_RETRANS_3) - (MAX_RETRANS_3)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MAX_RETRANS_3

Logical Name

MAX_RETRANS_3

Definition

Maximum number of PACKET CHANNEL REQUEST retransmissions


by the MS on the PRACH with priority level 3.

Coding rules

Possible values are : 1, 2, 4, 7 respectively binary coded : 00, 01,


10, 11

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Master channel 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

919 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.132 (MAX_RETRANS_4) - (MAX_RETRANS_4)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MAX_RETRANS_4

Logical Name

MAX_RETRANS_4

Definition

Maximum number of PACKET CHANNEL REQUEST retransmissions


by the MS on the PRACH with priority level 4.

Coding rules

Possible values are : 1, 2, 4, 7 respectively binary coded : 00, 01,


10, 11

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Master channel 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

920 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.133 (MAX_UL_TBF_SPDCH) - (MAX_UL_TBF_SPDCH)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MAX_UL_TBF_SPDCH

Logical Name

MAX_UL_TBF_SPDCH

Definition

Indicative value of maximum number of UpLink (E)GPRS TBFs per


slave PDCH.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

When allocating an UL GPRS TBF: MAX_UL_TBF_SPDCH is


the maximum number of GPRS + EGPRS TBFs allowed in UL
on each Slave PDCH. When allocating an UL EGPRS TBF:
MAX_UL_TBF_SPDCH is the maximum number of EGPRS TBFs
allowed in UL on each Slave PDCH (regardless of the current number
of UL GPRS TBFs).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

921 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.134 (MIN_PDCH) - (MIN_PDCH (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MIN_PDCH

Logical Name

MIN_PDCH (MFS)

Definition

Minimum number of master and slave PDCHs that are always


allocated to the MFS.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

-MAX_PDCH_HIGH_LOAD >= MIN_PDCH;-MIN_PDCH


> NB_TS_MPDCH if EN_FAST_INITIAL_GPRS_ACCESS
= enabled;-MIN_PDCH >= NB_TS_MPDCH if
EN_FAST_INITIAL_GPRS_ACCESS = disabled.-When
MIN_PDCH > 0 and cell_type = "extended inner" or "extended outer",
then MIN_PDCH shall be an even number

Recommended rules

It is recommended to set this parameter to a value smaller than the


maximum number of PDCHs that may be allocated in the cell, in
order to avoid congestion on the MFS-BSC interface.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

127

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Radio Resource Control

External Comment

127 is a theoretical value : 16 TRX * 8 PDCH - BCCH.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

922 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.135 (Mobile Country Code (MCC)) - (MCC (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Mobile Country Code (MCC)

Logical Name

MCC (MFS)

Definition

Mobile Country Code of the own PLMN.

Coding rules

3 digits BCD

Mandatory rules

The OMC-R shall ensure that the following rules are always fulfilled:MCC (BSC) = MCC (MFS).- The cells belonging to the same BSC
shall have the same (MCC,MNC) couple.- The (MCC,MNC) couple
of cells internal to the OMC-R shall be selected from the set of own
PLMNs.- The (MCC,MNC) couple of cells external to the OMC-R can
be selected from the set of own or foreign PLMNs.

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

999

999

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Customer BUL file

External Comment

The value depends on the configuration. The default value indicated


here is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

923 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.136 (Mobile Network Code (MNC)) - (MNC (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Mobile Network Code (MNC)

Logical Name

MNC (MFS)

Definition

Mobile Network Code of the own PLMN.

Coding rules

3 digits BCD

Mandatory rules

The OMC-R shall ensure that the following rules are always fulfilled:MNC (BSC) = MNC (MFS).- The cells belonging to the same BSC
shall have the same (MCC,MNC) couple.- The (MCC,MNC) couple
of cells internal to the OMC-R shall be selected from the set of own
PLMNs.- The (MCC,MNC) couple of cells external to the OMC-R can
be selected from the set of own or foreign PLMNs.

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

999

999

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Customer BUL file

External Comment

The value depends on configuration. The default value indicated


here is for implementation purposes.The operator is allowed to
enter 2 or 3 digits MNC.MNC such as yz or Fyz correspond to a 2
digits MNC (y, z = 0..9). (F binary coded 1111)MNC such as xyz
correspond to a 3 digits MNC (x = 0..9).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

924 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.137 (MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH) - (MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH

Logical Name

MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH (MFS)

Definition

Maximum transmission power an MS is allowed to use when


accessing the cell until otherwise commanded, broadcast on PBCCH
for CS service establishment.

Coding rules

P-GSM/G1 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 43 dBm, ..., 19: 5


dBm.GSM 850 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 39 dBm, 1: 39 dBm, 2:
39 dBm, 3: 37 dBm, 4: 35 dBm,..., 19: 5 dBm.DCS 1800 coding:step
size = 2 dBm; 0: 30 dBm, ..., 15: 0 dBm.DCS 1900 coding: range
0 to 15, 30, 31; 30: 33 dBm, 31: 32 dBm, 0: 30 dBm, 1: 28 dBm,
..., 15: 0 dBm.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

43

43

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: HPC

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Selection

External Comment

The default value depends on the BCCH frequency band:Default


value for P-GSM/G1: 43 dBmDefault value for GSM850: 39
dBmDefault value for DCS1800: 30 dBmDefault value for DCS1900:
30 dBm

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

925 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.138 (MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH) - (MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH(n)(MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH

Logical Name

MS_TXPWR_MAX_CCH(n)(MFS)

Definition

Maximum transmission power an MS is allowed to use when


accessing the cell until otherwise commanded, broadcast on PBCCH
for CS service establishment.

Coding rules

P-GSM/G1 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 43 dBm, ..., 19: 5


dBm.GSM 850 coding: step size = 2 dBm; 0: 39 dBm, 1: 39 dBm, 2:
39 dBm, 3: 37 dBm, 4: 35 dBm,..., 19: 5 dBm.DCS 1800 coding:step
size = 2 dBm; 0: 30 dBm, ..., 15: 0 dBm.DCS 1900 coding: range
0 to 15, 30, 31; 30: 33 dBm, 31: 32 dBm, 0: 30 dBm, 1: 28 dBm,
..., 15: 0 dBm.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

43

43

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit External Cell/ Packet2/2

External Comment

The default value depends on the BCCH frequency band:Default


value for P-GSM/G1: 43 dBmDefault value for GSM850: 39
dBmDefault value for DCS1800: 30 dBmDefault value for DCS1900:
30 dBm

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

926 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.139 (N_AVG_I (BSC)) - (N_AVG_I (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

N_AVG_I (BSC)

Logical Name

N_AVG_I (BSC)

Definition

N_AVG_I (BSC) value is broadcast to the (E)GPRS MS in the SI13.


The (E)GPRS MS uses it for filtering the interference signal level
measurements that it shall perform during the packet transfer mode.
These measurements are used by the (E)GPRS MS for output power
control, but also reported to the network and used for performing
downlink link adaptation.

Coding rules

coded on 4 bits

Mandatory rules

Equal to N_AVG_I (MFS)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

927 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.140 (N_AVG_I (MFS)) - (N_AVG_I (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

N_AVG_I (MFS)

Logical Name

N_AVG_I (MFS)

Definition

N_AVG_I (MFS) value is broadcast to the (E)GPRS MS in the PSI


13 and PSI1. The (E)GPRS MS uses it for filtering the interference
signal level measurements that it shall perform during the packet
transfer mode. These measurements are used by the (E)GPRS MS
for output power control, but also reported to the network and used
for performing downlink link adaptation.

Coding rules

coded on 4 bits

Mandatory rules

Equal to N_AVG_I (BSC)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Ch. 1/2.

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

928 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.141 (N3101_LIMIT) - (N3101_LIMIT)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

N3101_LIMIT

Logical Name

N3101_LIMIT

Definition

In an UL TBF tranfer procedure, maximum of consecutive times


(before releasing abnormally the UL TBF) when the network receives
no valid UL RLC data block or nothing from the MS on its allocated
PDCH.To note that the counter N3101 can be incremented more
than one time per block period.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

10

64

64

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

929 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.142 (N3101_POLLING_THR) - (N3101_POLLING_THR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

N3101_POLLING_THR

Logical Name

N3101_POLLING_THR

Definition

Threshold on the counter N3101 above which the RLC layer shall
start sending polling request to a MS for an UL TBF in EUTM mode
when EN_EXTENDED_UL_TBF is set ot 2 (IEUTM enabled).

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

This parameter should be equal to N3101_LIMIT / 4.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

16

16

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

930 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.143 (N3103_LIMIT) - (N3103_LIMIT)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

N3103_LIMIT

Logical Name

N3103_LIMIT

Definition

In an UL TBF releasing procedure, maximum of consecutive times


(before releasing abnormally the UL TBF) when the network does not
receive a Packet Control Acknowledgement from the MS in response
of its Packet UL ACK/NACK which specifies the end of the TBF.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

N3103_Limit: maximum number of retransmissions to release an


UL TBFMax_Retrans_DL: maximum number of retransmissions to
establish a DL TBFIn case of simultaneous UL TBF Release and
DL TBF establishment with loss of the Packet Control Ack which
acknowledges the final Packet UL Ack/Nack, the UL TBF has to be
released, at least before the last attempt to establish the DL TBF,
in order to avoid the emission of a Radio Status.Consequently the
following rule has to be followed:(N3103_Limit + 1) x (RTD + 60) <
Max_Retrans_DL x (RTD + 60)N3103_Limit + 1: total number of
attempts to send the final Packet UL Ack/NackRTD: Round Trip
Delay60 (msec): for the Packet UL Ack/Nack acknowledgement:
RRBP + 3 is usedMax_Retrans_DL: total number of attempts minus
one to send the Packet DL Assignment60 (msec): for the Packet
DL Assignment acknowledgement: RRBP + 3 is usedN3103_Limit
< (Max_Retrans_DL x (RTD + 60) / (RTD + 60)) - 1N3103_Limit
< [Max_Retrans_DL] - 1Example:With Max_Retrans_DL = 3:
N3103_Limit < 2 that is N3103_Limit = 1

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

16

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

931 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.144 (N3105_LIMIT) - (N3105_LIMIT)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

N3105_LIMIT

Logical Name

N3105_LIMIT

Definition

For a DL GPRS TBF, if the EGPRS traffic is carried through Abis


terrestrial link and Ater terrestrial link, this parameter defines the
maximum number of expected Packet Downlink ACK/NACK or Packet
Control Acknowledgement messages consecutively lost on the radio
interface, before triggering an abnormal release of the DL TBF. This
parameter is used in conjunction with the MIN_RLF_TIME_DL delay
to decide if the DL TBF shall be released.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

64

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

If N3105_LIMIT < TBF_CS_DL then the loss of consecutive packet


DL ACK/NACK will not trigger link adaptation but TBF release.
N3105_Limit has to be set in order not to release a DL TBF in case
of transient bad radio conditions. The polling frequency depends on
GPRS_DL_Ack_Period, T_DL_GPRS_MeasReport, MS multislot
class and on the number of TBFs per PDCH.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

932 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.145 (N3105_LIMIT_SATELLITE) - (N3105_LIMIT_SATELLITE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

N3105_LIMIT_SATELLITE

Logical Name

N3105_LIMIT_SATELLITE

Definition

For a DL GPRS TBF, if the EGPRS traffic is carried through Abis


satellite link or Ater satellite link, this parameter defines the maximum
number of expected Packet Downlink ACK/NACK or Packet Control
Acknowledgement messages consecutively lost on the radio
interface, before triggering an abnormal release of the DL TBF. This
parameter is used in conjunction with the MIN_RLF_TIME_DL delay
to decide if the DL TBF shall be released.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

64

24

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

If N3105_LIMIT_SATELLITE < TBF_CS_DL then the loss of


consecutive packet DL ACK/NACK will not trigger link adaptation
but TBF release. N3105_LIMIT_SATELLITE has to be set in order
not to release a DL TBF in case of transient bad radio conditions.
The polling frequency depends on GPRS_DL_Ack_Period_Satellite,
T_DL_GPRS_MeasReport, MS multislot class and on the number
of TBFs per PDCH.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

933 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.146 (NB_TS_MPDCH) - (NB_TS_MPDCH (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NB_TS_MPDCH

Logical Name

NB_TS_MPDCH (BSC)

Definition

Number of radio timeslots reserved for the primary and secondary


master PDCHs defined in the cell.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

1) MIN_PDCH > NB_TS_MPDCH if


EN_FAST_INITIAL_GPRS_ACCESS = enabled; MIN_PDCH
>= NB_TS_MPDCH if EN_FAST_INITIAL_GPRS_ACCESS =
disabled.2) if the network_operation_mode (BSC) parameter is set
to 2 (NMO II) then all cells of the BSS must have NB_TS_MPDCH
= 03)The following conditions are verified by the OMC-R in order
to check the upper limit of MAX_PDCH:i) MAX_PDCH <= 8*(nb
of TRXs with TRX_PREF_MARK = 0) - 1 if TRX_PREF_MARK
= 0 on BCCH TRX and CCCH_CONF = "1: CCCH combined"ii)
MAX_PDCH <= 8*(nb of TRXs with TRX_PREF_MARK = 0) - 2 if
TRX_PREF_MARK = 0 on BCCH TRX and CCCH_CONF = "0:
CCCH not combined"iii) MAX_PDCH <= NB_TS_MPDCH + 8*(nb
of TRXs with TRX_PREF_MARK = 0) if TRX_PREF_MARK <> 0
on BCCH TRX.4) When cell_type = "extended inner" or "extended
outer", then NB_TS_MPDCH = 0

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Ch 1/2

934 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

External Comment

The Master PDCH requires the establishment of a GCH (Abis


and Ater) which does not carry traffic. In case of Abis or Ater
through satellite link, the usage of the MPDCH must consider the
following criteria:* higher cost of transmission resources through the
satellite link;* limited throughput of the RSL in case of Abis through
satellite to about 6 kbit/s (because of round trip delay effect on
acknowledged protocol with limited LAP-D window size). In case of
important CS signalling load, the RSL may not be able to transport
the additional signalling load due toTBF establishments when no
MPDCH is established.Hence the recommendation in the GPRS
through satellite case is:* for a cell connected with Abis through
satellite and with non negligible signalling load (CS+PS), MPDCH
is recommended;* for a cell connected with Ater through satellite,
MPDCH is not recommended.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

935 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.147 (NB_TS_MPDCH) - (NB_TS_MPDCH (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NB_TS_MPDCH

Logical Name

NB_TS_MPDCH (MFS)

Definition

Number of radio timeslots reserved for the primary and secondary


master PDCHs defined in the cell.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

1) MIN_PDCH > NB_TS_MPDCH if


EN_FAST_INITIAL_GPRS_ACCESS = enabled;MIN_PDCH
>= NB_TS_MPDCH if EN_FAST_INITIAL_GPRS_ACCESS =
disabled.2) if the network_operation_mode (MFS) parameter is set
to 2 (NMO II) then all cells of the BSS must have NB_TS_MPDCH
= 0.3)The following conditions are verified by the OMC-R in order
to check the upper limit of MAX_PDCH:i) MAX_PDCH <= 8*(nb
of TRXs with TRX_PREF_MARK = 0) - 1 if TRX_PREF_MARK
= 0 on BCCH TRX and CCCH_CONF = "1: CCCH combined"ii)
MAX_PDCH <= 8*(nb of TRXs with TRX_PREF_MARK = 0) - 2 if
TRX_PREF_MARK = 0 on BCCH TRX and CCCH_CONF = "0:
CCCH not combined"iii) MAX_PDCH <= NB_TS_MPDCH + 8*(nb
of TRXs with TRX_PREF_MARK = 0) if TRX_PREF_MARK <> 0
on BCCH TRX.4) When cell_type = "extended inner" or "extended
outer", then NB_TS_MPDCH = 0

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Ch 1/2

936 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

External Comment

The Master PDCH requires the establishment of a GCH (Abis


and Ater) which does not carry traffic. In case of Abis or Ater
through satellite link, the usage of the MPDCH must consider the
following criteria:* higher cost of transmission resources through the
satellite link;* limited throughput of the RSL in case of Abis through
satellite to about 6 kbit/s (because of round trip delay effect on
acknowledged protocol with limited LAP-D window size). In case of
important CS signalling load, the RSL may not be able to transport
the additional signalling load due toTBF establishments when no
MPDCH is established.Hence the recommendation in the GPRS
through satellite case is:* for a cell connected with Abis through
satellite and with non negligible signalling load (CS+PS), MPDCH
is recommended;* for a cell connected with Ater through satellite,
MPDCH is not recommended.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

937 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.148 (NC_DL_RXLEV_LIMIT_THR) - (NC_DL_RXLEV_LIMIT_THR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NC_DL_RXLEV_LIMIT_THR

Logical Name

NC_DL_RXLEV_LIMIT_THR

Definition

Threshold below which a NC cell reselection Cause PT2 can be


triggered due to the detection of a better neighbour cell.

Coding rules

0: "-110 dBm (Never)", 1:" -109 dBm", ...,63: "-47 dBm (Always)"
(step size = 1 dB)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

In cells where outgoing GPRS redirections are systematically


triggered (i.e. EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIR = Enable), it is
recommended to deactivate NC cell reselection Cause PT2 (i.e.
set NC_DL_RXLEV_LIMIT_THR to -110 dBm (Never). The aim of
this recommended rule is to limit the conditions triggering a GPRS
redirection.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-47

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Resel.

External Comment

1) The specific value of "-110 dBm (Never)" deactivates the NC cell


reselections Cause PT2.2) The specific value of "-47 dBm (Always)"
systematically allows the triggering of NC cell reselections Cause
PT2

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

938 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.149 (NC_DL_RXLEV_THR) - (NC_DL_RXLEV_THR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NC_DL_RXLEV_THR

Logical Name

NC_DL_RXLEV_THR

Definition

Threshold below which a NC cell reselection Cause PT1 is triggered


due to a too bad RXLEV in the downlink direction (while the MS is
in packet transfer mode).

Coding rules

0: "-110 dBm (Never)", 1:" -109 dBm", ...,63: "-47 dBm" (step size
= 1 dB)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

In cells where outgoing GPRS redirections are systematically


triggered (i.e. EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIR = Enable), it is
recommended to activate NC cell reselection Cause PT1 (i.e. set
NC_DL_RXLEV_THR to -47 dBm (Always).

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-96

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Resel.

External Comment

The specific value of "-110 dBm (Never)" deactivates the NC cell


reselection Cause PT1.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

939 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.150 (NC_DL_RXQUAL_THR) - (NC_DL_RXQUAL_THR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NC_DL_RXQUAL_THR

Logical Name

NC_DL_RXQUAL_THR

Definition

Threshold above which a NC cell reselection Cause PT3 is triggered


due to a too bad RXQUAL in downlink direction (while the MS is
in packet transfer mode).

Coding rules

step size = 0.1. At the OMC-R, the following values are displayed:
"0", "0.1", "0.2", , "6.9", "7 (Never)".

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

In cells where outgoing GPRS redirections are systematically


triggered (i.e. EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIR = Enable), it is
recommended to deactivate NC cell reselection Cause PT3 (i.e. set
NC_UL_RXQUAL_THR to 7 (Never). The aim of this recommended
rule is to limit the conditions triggering a GPRS redirection.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Resel.

External Comment

The specific value of "7 (Never)" deactivates the NC cell reselection


Cause PT3.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

940 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.151 (NC_PING_PONG_OFFSET) - (NC_PING_PONG_OFFSET)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NC_PING_PONG_OFFSET

Logical Name

NC_PING_PONG_OFFSET

Definition

NC ping-pong offset which is applied to the C2 or C32 criterion to


disfavour the neighbour cells during T_NC_PING_PONG_OFFSET.

Coding rules

step size = 1 dB

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

63

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Resel.

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

941 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.152 (NC_REPORTING_PERIOD_T) - (NC_REPORTING_PERIOD_T)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NC_REPORTING_PERIOD_T

Logical Name

NC_REPORTING_PERIOD_T

Definition

Reporting period of NC measurements reported by the MS while


in packet transfer mode.

Coding rules

coded from 0 to 7 (0 0 0 : 0.48 sec , 0 0 1: 0.96 sec , 0 1 0 : 1.92


sec , 0 1 1: 3.84 sec, 1 0 0 : 7.68 sec , 1 0 1 : 15.36 sec , 1 1 0:
30.72 sec , 1 1 1: 61.44 sec) .

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.48

61.44

0.96

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit cell / Gprs / Reselection

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

942 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.153 (NC_REPORTING_PERIOD_T(n)) (NC_REPORTING_PERIOD_T(n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NC_REPORTING_PERIOD_T(n)

Logical Name

NC_REPORTING_PERIOD_T(n)

Definition

Reporting period of NC measurements reported by the MS while


in packet transfer mode.

Coding rules

coded from 0 to 7 (0 0 0 : 0.48 sec , 0 0 1: 0.96 sec , 0 1 0 : 1.92


sec , 0 1 1: 3.84 sec, 1 0 0 : 7.68 sec , 1 0 1 : 15.36 sec , 1 1 0:
30.72 sec , 1 1 1: 61.44 sec) .

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.48

61.44

0.96

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit External cell / Packet 2/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

943 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.154 (NC_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS) (NC_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS(0,n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NC_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS

Logical Name

NC_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS(0,n)

Definition

NC cell reselection offset used for triggering power budget causes.

Coding rules

0: -127 dB (Always), 1: -126 dB, , 254: 127 dB, 255: 128 dB (Never)
(step size = 1 dB)

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-127

128

128

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit adjacency / Adjacency parameters View / outgoing

External Comment

1) The specific value of "128 dB (Never)" deactivates the NC cell


reselection Cause PT2 towards the target cell n.2) The specific value
of "-127 dB" (Always)" systematically triggers the NC cell reselection
Cause PT2 towards the target cell n.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

944 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.155 (NC_RXLEV_FORGETTING_FACTOR) (NC_RXLEV_FORGETTING_FACTOR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NC_RXLEV_FORGETTING_FACTOR

Logical Name

NC_RXLEV_FORGETTING_FACTOR

Definition

Forgetting factor of the filter used to average the NC measurements


reported in the Packet Measurement Report messages.

Coding rules

step size = 0.001

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.13

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Resel.

External Comment

This parameter applies to the serving cell and the neighbour cells.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

945 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.156 (NC_RXQUAL_AVG_PERIOD) - (NC_RXQUAL_AVG_PERIOD)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NC_RXQUAL_AVG_PERIOD

Logical Name

NC_RXQUAL_AVG_PERIOD

Definition

Period after which a weight of 0.9 s is applied to the current UL or


DL RXQUAL samples in the averaging filter.

Coding rules

step size = 20 ms

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

20

10000

4000

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Resel.

External Comment

This parameter applies to the serving cell.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

946 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.157 (NC_UL_RXQUAL_THR) - (NC_UL_RXQUAL_THR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NC_UL_RXQUAL_THR

Logical Name

NC_UL_RXQUAL_THR

Definition

Threshold above which a NC cell reselection Cause PT4 is triggered


due to a too bad RXQUAL in uplink direction (while the MS is in
packet transfer mode).

Coding rules

step size = 0.1. At the OMC-R, the following values are displayed:
"0", "0.1", "0.2", , "6.9", "7 (Never)"

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

In cells where outgoing GPRS redirections are systematically


triggered (i.e. EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIR = Enable), it is
recommended to deactivate NC cell reselection Cause PT4 (i.e. set
NC_UL_RXQUAL_THR to 7 (Never). The aim of this recommended
rule is to limit the conditions triggering a GPRS redirection.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Resel.

External Comment

The specific value of "7 (Never)" deactivates the NC cell reselection


Cause PT4.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

947 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.158 (NC2_DEACTIVATION_MODE) - (NC2_DEACTIVATION_MODE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NC2_DEACTIVATION_MODE

Logical Name

NC2_DEACTIVATION_MODE

Definition

NC2 deactivation mode. This parameter defines whether or not the


Packet Measurement Order message with a Reset Command is sent
at the end of a packet transfer.

Coding rules

0: "NC2 deactivation at the end of the packet transfer". A Packet


Measurement Order message is sent to deactivate the NC2 mode at
the end of the packet transfer.1: "NC2 deactivation at the expiry of
the GMM Ready timer". No Packet Measurement Order message is
sent to deactivate the NC2 mode.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

In cells where outgoing GPRS redirections are not triggered


systematically (i.e. EN_OUTGOING_GPRS_REDIR = Disable), the
presence of the PBCCH is not mandatory. However, the following
recommendations apply, depending on the presence of the PBCCH:If PBCCH is present, the NC2_DEACTIVATION_MODE can be set to
any value (at the end of the packet transfer mode or at the expiry of
the GMM Ready timer) if the setting of the C32 parameters ensures
that GPRS mobile stations do not camp in cells where outgoing
GPRS redirections are systematically triggered.- If PBCCH is not
present or PBCCH is present but C32 parameters are not correctly
set, the NC2_DEACTIVATION_MODE should be set to "at the expiry
of the GMM Ready timer" to prevent the GPRS mobile stations from
reselecting a cell where outgoing GPRS redirections are triggered
systematically (at least while the MS is in packet idle mode and the
GMM Ready timer is running).

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Resel.

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

948 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.159 (NETWORK_CONTROL_ORDER) (NETWORK_CONTROL_ORDER)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NETWORK_CONTROL_ORDER

Logical Name

NETWORK_CONTROL_ORDER

Definition

This parameter defines whether the MS or the BSS controls the cell
reselections.

Coding rules

0: NC0 mode of operation for all MS. All MS controls their cell
reselections an no MS reports packet measurements to the BSS.1:
NC1 mode of operation for all MS. All MS controls their cell
reselections but all the MS reports packet measurements to the BSS.
(Not supported)2: NC2 mode of operation for R99 onwards MS.
The BSS controls the cell reselections of R99 onwards MS when in
packet transfer mode or of R99 onwards MS when in GMM Ready
state (depending on the selected NC2 deactivation mode). While the
NC2 mode is activated for the concerned MS, the MS reports packet
measurements to the BSS.3: NC2 mode of operation for all MS. The
BSS controls the cell reselections of all MS when in packet transfer
mode or of all MS when in GMM Ready state (depending on the
selected NC2 deactivation mode). While the NC2 mode is activated
for the concerned MS, the MS reports packet measurements to the
BSS.4: NC2 mode of operation for Rel.4 onwards MS. The BSS
controls the cell reselections of Rel.4 onwards MS when in packet
transfer mode or of Rel.4 onwards MS when in GMM Ready state
(depending on the selected NC2 deactivation mode). While the NC2
mode is activated for the concerned MS, the MS reports packet
measurements to the BSS.

Mandatory rules

- The OMC-R only shows the values 0, 2, 3 and 4 to the operator.When cell_type = "extended inner" or "extended outer", then
NETWORK_CONTROL_ORDER = NC0 mode of operation for all MS

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

949 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

External Comment

If the NETWORK_CONTROL_ORDER is set to "NC2 mode of


operation for R99 onwards MS" or "NC2 mode of operation for all
MS" or "NC2 mode of operation for Rel.4 onwards MS", then the 3G
search is systematically deactivated when activating the NC2 mode
(activation performed through the Packet Measurement Order [NC2]
message). If EN_2G_TO_3G_CELL_RESELECTION = "Enabled
with 3G search activated while the UE/MS is in GMM ready state,
even if Network_Control_Order > 1", then the 3G search is activated
even when activating the NC2 mode (the Packet Measurement Order
[NC2] message will not be sent.)

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

950 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.160 (NETWORK_CONTROL_ORDER) (NETWORK_CONTROL_ORDER(n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NETWORK_CONTROL_ORDER

Logical Name

NETWORK_CONTROL_ORDER(n)

Definition

This parameter defines whether the MS or the BSS controls the cell
reselections.

Coding rules

0: NC0 mode of operation for all MS. All MS controls their cell
reselections an no MS reports packet measurements to the BSS.1:
NC1 mode of operation for all MS. All MS controls their cell
reselections but all the MS reports packet measurements to the BSS.
(Not supported)2: NC2 mode of operation for R99 onwards MS.
The BSS controls the cell reselections of R99 onwards MS when in
packet transfer mode or of R99 onwards MS when in GMM Ready
state (depending on the selected NC2 deactivation mode). While the
NC2 mode is activated for the concerned MS, the MS reports packet
measurements to the BSS.3: NC2 mode of operation for all MS. The
BSS controls the cell reselections of all MS when in packet transfer
mode or of all MS when in GMM Ready state (depending on the
selected NC2 deactivation mode). While the NC2 mode is activated
for the concerned MS, the MS reports packet measurements to the
BSS.4: NC2 mode of operation for Rel.4 onwards MS. The BSS
controls the cell reselections of Rel.4 onwards MS when in packet
transfer mode or of Rel.4 onwards MS when in GMM Ready state
(depending on the selected NC2 deactivation mode). While the NC2
mode is activated for the concerned MS, the MS reports packet
measurements to the BSS.

Mandatory rules

- The OMC-R only shows the values 0, 2, 3 and 4 to the operator.When cell_type = "extended inner" or "extended outer", then
NETWORK_CONTROL_ORDER = NC0 mode of operation for all MS

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit External Cell / Packet 2/2

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

951 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

External Comment

If the NETWORK_CONTROL_ORDER is set to "NC2 mode of


operation for R99 onwards MS" or "NC2 mode of operation for all MS"
or "NC2 mode of operation for Rel.4 onwards MS", the 3G search is
systematically deactivated when activating the NC2 mode (activation
performed through the Packet Measurement Order [NC2] message).
This 3G search deactivation is then performed independently of the
value of the EN_2G_TO_3G_CELL_RESELECTION parameter.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

952 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.161 (Network_mode_of_operation) - (network_operation_mode


(BSC))
Parameter Name

HMI Name

Network_mode_of_operation

Logical Name

network_operation_mode (BSC)

Definition

This parameter defines the CS-PS co-ordination for paging.

Coding rules

3 possible values : 1, 2, 3; 1 == Network operation mode I ; 2 ==


Network operation mode II ; 3 == Network operation mode III.

Mandatory rules

If the network_operation_mode (BSC) parameter is set to NMO II


then all cells of the BSS must have NB_TS_MPDCH = 0 Equal to
network_operation_mode (MFS).

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS

External Comment

Any change will trigger a data reset of the GPUs. Stop and restart
of (E)GPRS traffic in all the cells of the BSS. NMO I requires a Gs
interface.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

953 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.162 (Network_mode_of_operation) - (network_operation_mode


(MFS))
Parameter Name

HMI Name

Network_mode_of_operation

Logical Name

network_operation_mode (MFS)

Definition

This parameter defines the CS-PS co-ordination for paging.

Coding rules

3 possible values : 1, 2, 3; 1 == Network operation mode I ; 2 ==


Network operation mode II ; 3 == Network operation mode III

Mandatory rules

If the network_operation_mode (MFS) parameter is set to NMO II


then all cells of the BSS must have NB_TS_MPDCH = 0. Equal to
network_operation_mode (BSC).

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS

External Comment

Any change will trigger a data reset of the GPUs. Stop and restart
of (E)GPRS traffic in all the cells of the BSS. NMO I requires a Gs
interface.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

954 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.163 (Normal Information Rate) - (NIR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Normal Information Rate

Logical Name

NIR

Definition

Normal Information Rate.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

CIR <= NIR <= CIR x (1 + EBS/CBS) <= ACCESS_RATE_BC

Recommended rules

NIR=0 when direct access is used

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

PVC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

kbit/s

1984

Modifiable

OMC Changes: MFS RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

MFSUSM / GB Configuration / NSVC Creation

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

955 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.164 (NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_BACKGROUND_PRIORITY) (NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_BACKGROUND_PRIORITY)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_BACKGROUND_PRIORITY

Logical Name

NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_BACKGROUND_PRIORITY

Definition

Defines the relative priority used for Background Packet Flow Context, with
precedence parameter set to normal

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

956 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.165 (NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_THP1_PRIORITY) (NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_THP1_PRIORITY)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_THP1_PRIORITY

Logical Name

NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_THP1_PRIORITY

Definition

Defines the relative priority used for Interactive THP1 Packet Flow
Context, with precedence parameter set to normal

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

957 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.166 (NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_THP2_PRIORITY) (NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_THP2_PRIORITY)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_THP2_PRIORITY

Logical Name

NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_THP2_PRIORITY

Definition

Defines the relative priority used for Interactive THP2 Packet Flow
Context, with precedence parameter set to normal

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

958 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.167 (NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_THP3_PRIORITY) (NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_THP3_PRIORITY)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_THP3_PRIORITY

Logical Name

NORMAL_PRECEDENCE_THP3_PRIORITY

Definition

Defines the relative priority used for Interactive THP3 Packet Flow
Context, with precedence parameter set to normal

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

12

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

959 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.168 (NS Priority) - (NS_Priority)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NS Priority

Logical Name

NS_Priority

Definition

Priority of the NSVC, is used by the load sharing.

Coding rules

1: lowest priority, 255:highest priority

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

NSVC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: MFS RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

MFSUSM / GB Configuration / NSVC Creation

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

960 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.169 (NSEI) - (NSEI)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NSEI

Logical Name

NSEI

Definition

NSE Identifier.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

The NSEI shall be unique per MFS

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

NSE

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

65535

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: MFS RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

MFSUSM / GB Configuration / NSE Creation

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

961 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.170 (NstagnatingWindowDL_LIMIT) (N_stagnating_Window_DL_LIMIT)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NstagnatingWindowDL_LIMIT

Logical Name

N_stagnating_Window_DL_LIMIT

Definition

This parameter defines the maximum number of consecutive Packet


Downlink ACK/NACK or EGPRS Packet Downlink ACK/NACK
messages reporting the failure of progress of the RLC window during
the active phase of a downlink TBF, before triggering an abnormal
release of the DL TBF. This parameter is used in conjunction with the
MIN_RLF_TIME_DL delay to decide if the DL TBF shall be released.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

256

32

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

962 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.171 (NstagnatingWindowUL_LIMIT) (N_stagnating_Window_UL_LIMIT)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NstagnatingWindowUL_LIMIT

Logical Name

N_stagnating_Window_UL_LIMIT

Definition

NstagnatingWindow limit above which a mono-slot uplink TBF alone


on its PDCH shall be released: the counter is incremented each time
a Packet UL Ack/Nack fails in making the RLC window progress.
For a multi-slot TBF or a TBF which shares its PDCH, the limit is
proportional to the allocated bandwidth at the TBF establishment.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

256

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

963 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.172 (NSVC Identifier) - (NSVCI)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

NSVC Identifier

Logical Name

NSVCI

Definition

NSVC identifier.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

NSVC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

65535

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: set by create(MFS) RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

MFSUSM / GB Configuration / NSVC Creation

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

964 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.173 (PAN_DEC) - (PAN_DEC (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PAN_DEC

Logical Name

PAN_DEC (BSC)

Definition

Value decremented from MS N3102 counter when PACKET UL


ACK/NACK is not received before MS timer T3182.

Coding rules

Binary coded on 3 bits

Mandatory rules

Equal to PAN_DEC (MFS)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / General groups

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

965 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.174 (PAN_DEC) - (PAN_DEC (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PAN_DEC

Logical Name

PAN_DEC (MFS)

Definition

Value decremented from MS N3102 counter when PACKET UL


ACK/NACK is not received before MS timer T3182.

Coding rules

Binary coded on 3 bits

Mandatory rules

Equal to PAN_DEC (BSC)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / General groups

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

966 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.175 (PAN_INC) - (PAN_INC (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PAN_INC

Logical Name

PAN_INC (BSC)

Definition

Value incremented to MS N3102 counter when PACKET UL


ACK/NACK is received by MS.

Coding rules

Binary coded on 3 bits

Mandatory rules

Equal to PAN_INC (MFS)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / General groups

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

967 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.176 (PAN_INC) - (PAN_INC (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PAN_INC

Logical Name

PAN_INC (MFS)

Definition

Value incremented to MS N3102 counter when PACKET UL


ACK/NACK is received by MS.

Coding rules

Binary coded on 3 bits

Mandatory rules

Equal to PAN_INC (BSC)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / General groups

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

968 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.177 (PAN_MAX) - (PAN_MAX (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PAN_MAX

Logical Name

PAN_MAX (BSC)

Definition

Maximum value for counter N3102. cell reselection is done by MS


when N3102 <= 0.

Coding rules

Possible values : 4, 8, 12., 32 respectively binary coded 000, 001, ,


111

Mandatory rules

Equal to PAN_MAX (MFS)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

32

32

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / General groups

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

969 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.178 (PAN_MAX) - (PAN_MAX (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PAN_MAX

Logical Name

PAN_MAX (MFS)

Definition

Maximum value for counter N3102. cell reselection is done by MS


when N3102 <= 0.

Coding rules

Possible values : 4, 8, 12,.., 32 respectively binary coded 000, 001,..


, 111

Mandatory rules

Equal to PAN_MAX (BSC)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

32

32

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / General groups

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

970 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.179 (PC_MEAS_CHAN) - (PC_MEAS_CHAN (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PC_MEAS_CHAN

Logical Name

PC_MEAS_CHAN (BSC)

Definition

This parameter determines on which channel the MS shall measure


the received power level on the downlink for the purpose of the uplink
power control.

Coding rules

0 : downlink measurements for power control shall be made on BCCH

Mandatory rules

Equal to PC_MEAS_CHAN (MFS).

Recommended rules

PC_MEAS_CHAN should be forced to PDCH in multiband cells

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Power Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

971 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.180 (PC_MEAS_CHAN) - (PC_MEAS_CHAN (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PC_MEAS_CHAN

Logical Name

PC_MEAS_CHAN (MFS)

Definition

This parameter determines on which channel the MS shall measure


the received power level on the downlink for the purpose of the uplink
power control.

Coding rules

0 : downlink measurements for power control shall be made on


BCCH, 1 : downlink measurements for power control shall be made
on PDCH

Mandatory rules

Equal to PC_MEAS_CHAN (BSC).

Recommended rules

PC_MEAS_CHAN should be forced to PDCH in multiband cells

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Power Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

972 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.181 (PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_1) (PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_1

Logical Name

PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_1

Definition

Upper limit of the 1st band, lower limit of the 2nd band for DL PDCH
unit allocation distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules

PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_1<
PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_2

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.1

4.9

0.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

973 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.182 (PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_2) (PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_2

Logical Name

PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_2

Definition

Upper limit of the 2nd band, lower limit of the 3rd band for DL PDCH
unit allocation distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules

PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_1 <
PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_2<
PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_3

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.1

4.9

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

974 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.183 (PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_3) (PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_3)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_3

Logical Name

PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_3

Definition

Upper limit of the 3rd band, lower limit of the 4th band for DL PDCH
unit allocation distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules

PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_2
< PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_3 <
PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_4

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.1

4.9

1.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

975 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.184 (PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_4) (PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_4)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_4

Logical Name

PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_4

Definition

Upper limit of the 4th band, lower limit of the 5th band for DL PDCH
unit allocation distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules

PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_3
< PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_4 <
PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_5

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.1

4.9

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

976 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.185 (PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_5) (PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_5)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_5

Logical Name

PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_5

Definition

Upper limit of the 5th band, lower limit of the 6th band for DL PDCH
unit allocation distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules

PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_4
< PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_5 <
PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_6

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.1

4.9

2.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

977 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.186 (PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_6) (PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_6)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_6

Logical Name

PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_6

Definition

Upper limit of the 6th band, lower limit of the 7th band for DL PDCH
unit allocation distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules

PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_5
< PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_6 <
PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_7

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.1

4.9

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

978 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.187 (PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_7) (PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_7)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_7

Logical Name

PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_7

Definition

Upper limit of the 7th band, lower limit of the 8th band for DL PDCH
unit allocation distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules

PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_6
< PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_7 <
PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_8

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.1

4.9

3.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

979 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.188 (PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_8) (PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_8)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_8

Logical Name

PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_8

Definition

Upper limit of the 8th band, lower limit of the 9th band for DL PDCH
unit allocation distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules

PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_7
< PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_8 <
PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_9

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.1

4.9

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

980 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.189 (PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_9) (PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_9)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_9

Logical Name

PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_9

Definition

Upper limit of the 9th band, lower limit of the 10th band for DL PDCH
unit allocation distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules

PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_8 <
PD_DL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_9

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.1

4.9

4.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

981 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.190 (PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_1) (PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_1

Logical Name

PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_1

Definition

Upper limit of the first band, lower limit of the second band for DL
TBF duration distribution.

Coding rules

step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules

PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_1 <
PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_2

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.5

16383.5

0.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

982 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.191 (PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_2) (PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_2

Logical Name

PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_2

Definition

Upper limit of the 2nd band, lower limit of the 3rd band for DL TBF
duration distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules

PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_1 <
PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_2 <
PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_3

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.5

16383.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

983 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.192 (PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_3) (PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_3)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_3

Logical Name

PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_3

Definition

Upper limit of the 3rd band, lower limit of the 4th band for DL TBF
duration distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules

PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_2 <
PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_3 <
PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_4

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.5

16383.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

984 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.193 (PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_4) (PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_4)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_4

Logical Name

PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_4

Definition

Upper limit of the 4th band, lower limit of the 5th band for DL TBF
duration distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules

PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_3 <
PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_4 <
PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_5

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.5

16383.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

985 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.194 (PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_5) (PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_5)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_5

Logical Name

PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_5

Definition

Upper limit of the 5th band, lower limit of the 6th band for DL TBF
duration distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules

PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_4 <
PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_5 <
PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_6

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.5

16383.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

986 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.195 (PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_6) (PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_6)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_6

Logical Name

PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_6

Definition

Upper limit of the 6th band, lower limit of the 7th band for DL TBF
duration distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules

PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_5 <
PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_6 <
PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_7

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.5

16383.5

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

987 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.196 (PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_7) (PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_7)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_7

Logical Name

PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_7

Definition

Upper limit of the 7th band, lower limit of the 8th band for DL TBF
duration distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules

PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_6 <
PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_7 <
PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_8

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.5

16383.5

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

988 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.197 (PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_8) (PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_8)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_8

Logical Name

PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_8

Definition

Upper limit of the 8th band, lower limit of the 9th band for DL TBF
duration distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules

PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_7 <
PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_8 <
PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_9

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.5

16383.5

50

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

989 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.198 (PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_9) (PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_9)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_9

Logical Name

PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_9

Definition

Upper limit of the 9th band, lower limit of the 10th band for DL TBF
duration distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules

PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_8 <
PD_DL_TBF_DURATION_THR_9

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.5

16383.5

100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

990 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.199 (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_1) - (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_1

Logical Name

PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_1

Definition

Upper limit of the 1st band, lower limit of the 2nd band for LLC
volume carried by an DL TBF distribution

Coding rules

step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules

PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_1 < PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_2

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

byte

99999999

500

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

991 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.200 (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_2) - (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_2

Logical Name

PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_2

Definition

Upper limit of the 2nd band, lower limit of the 3rd band for LLC
volume carried by an DL TBF distribution

Coding rules

step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules

PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_1 < PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_2 <


PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_3

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

byte

99999999

1000

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

992 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.201 (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_3) - (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_3)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_3

Logical Name

PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_3

Definition

Upper limit of the 3rd band, lower limit of the 4th band for LLC volume
carried by an DL TBF distribution

Coding rules

step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules

PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_2 < PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_3 <


PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_4

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

byte

99999999

2000

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

993 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.202 (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_4) - (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_4)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_4

Logical Name

PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_4

Definition

Upper limit of the 4th band, lower limit of the 5th band for LLC volume
carried by an DL TBF distribution

Coding rules

step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules

PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_3 < PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_4 <


PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_5

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

byte

99999999

3000

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

994 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.203 (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_5) - (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_5)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_5

Logical Name

PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_5

Definition

Upper limit of the 5th band, lower limit of the 6th band for LLC volume
carried by an DL TBF distribution

Coding rules

step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules

PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_4 < PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_5 <


PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_6

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

byte

99999999

5000

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

995 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.204 (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_6) - (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_6)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_6

Logical Name

PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_6

Definition

Upper limit of the 6th band, lower limit of the 7th band for LLC volume
carried by an DL TBF distribution

Coding rules

step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules

PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_5 < PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_6 <


PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_7

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

byte

99999999

10000

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

996 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.205 (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_7) - (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_7)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_7

Logical Name

PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_7

Definition

Upper limit of the 7th band, lower limit of the 8th band for LLC volume
carried by an DL TBF distribution

Coding rules

step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules

PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_6 < PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_7 <


PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_8

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

byte

99999999

20000

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

997 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.206 (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_8) - (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_8)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_8

Logical Name

PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_8

Definition

Upper limit of the 8th band, lower limit of the 9th band for LLC volume
carried by an DL TBF distribution

Coding rules

step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules

PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_7 < PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_8 <


PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_9

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

byte

99999999

50000

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

998 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.207 (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_9) - (PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_9)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_9

Logical Name

PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_9

Definition

Upper limit of the 9th band, lower limit of the 10th band for LLC
volume carried by an DL TBF distribution

Coding rules

step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules

PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_8 < PD_DL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_9

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

byte

99999999

100000

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

999 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.208 (PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_1) (PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_1

Logical Name

PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_1

Definition

Upper limit of the 1st band, lower limit of the 2nd band for UL PDCH
unit allocation distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules

PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_1<
PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_2

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.1

4.9

0.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1000 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.209 (PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_2) (PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_2

Logical Name

PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_2

Definition

Upper limit of the 2nd band, lower limit of the 3rd band for UL PDCH
unit allocation distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules

PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_1 <
PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_2<
PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_3

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.1

4.9

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1001 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.210 (PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_3) (PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_3)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_3

Logical Name

PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_3

Definition

Upper limit of the 3rd band, lower limit of the 4th band for UL PDCH
unit allocation distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules

PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_2
< PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_3 <
PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_4

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.1

4.9

1.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1002 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.211 (PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_4) (PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_4)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_4

Logical Name

PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_4

Definition

Upper limit of the 4th band, lower limit of the 5th band for UL PDCH
unit allocation distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules

PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_3
< PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_4 <
PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_5

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.1

4.9

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1003 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.212 (PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_5) (PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_5)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_5

Logical Name

PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_5

Definition

Upper limit of the 5th band, lower limit of the 6th band for UL PDCH
unit allocation distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules

PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_4
< PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_5 <
PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_6

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.1

4.9

2.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1004 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.213 (PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_6) (PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_6)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_6

Logical Name

PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_6

Definition

Upper limit of the 6th band, lower limit of the 7th band for UL PDCH
unit allocation distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules

PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_5
< PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_6 <
PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_7

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.1

4.9

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1005 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.214 (PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_7) (PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_7)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_7

Logical Name

PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_7

Definition

Upper limit of the 7th band, lower limit of the 8th band for UL PDCH
unit allocation distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules

PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_6
< PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_7 <
PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_8

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.1

4.9

3.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1006 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.215 (PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_8) (PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_8)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_8

Logical Name

PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_8

Definition

Upper limit of the 8th band, lower limit of the 9th band for UL PDCH
unit allocation distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules

PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_7
< PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_8 <
PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_9

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.1

4.9

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1007 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.216 (PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_9) (PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_9)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_9

Logical Name

PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_9

Definition

Upper limit of the 9th band, lower limit of the 10th band for UL PDCH
unit allocation distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 PDCH

Mandatory rules

PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_8 <
PD_UL_PDCH_UNIT_ALLOC_THR_9

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0.1

4.9

4.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1008 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.217 (PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_1) (PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_1

Logical Name

PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_1

Definition

Upper limit of the first band, lower limit of the second band for UL
TBF duration distribution.

Coding rules

step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules

PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_1 <
PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_2

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.5

16383.5

0.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1009 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.218 (PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_2) (PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_2

Logical Name

PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_2

Definition

Upper limit of the 2nd band, lower limit of the 3rd band for UL TBF
duration distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules

PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_1 <
PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_2 <
PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_3

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.5

16383.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1010 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.219 (PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_3) (PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_3)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_3

Logical Name

PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_3

Definition

Upper limit of the 3rd band, lower limit of the 4th band for UL TBF
duration distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules

PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_2 <
PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_3 <
PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_4

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.5

16383.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1011 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.220 (PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_4) (PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_4)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_4

Logical Name

PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_4

Definition

Upper limit of the 4th band, lower limit of the 5th band for UL TBF
duration distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules

PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_3 <
PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_4 <
PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_5

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.5

16383.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1012 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.221 (PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_5) (PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_5)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_5

Logical Name

PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_5

Definition

Upper limit of the 5th band, lower limit of the 6th band for UL TBF
duration distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules

PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_4 <
PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_5 <
PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_6

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.5

16383.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1013 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.222 (PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_6) (PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_6)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_6

Logical Name

PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_6

Definition

Upper limit of the 6th band, lower limit of the 7th band for UL TBF
duration distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules

PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_5 <
PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_6 <
PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_7

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.5

16383.5

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1014 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.223 (PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_7) (PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_7)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_7

Logical Name

PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_7

Definition

Upper limit of the 7th band, lower limit of the 8th band for UL TBF
duration distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules

PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_6 <
PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_7 <
PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_8

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.5

16383.5

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1015 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.224 (PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_8) (PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_8)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_8

Logical Name

PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_8

Definition

Upper limit of the 8th band, lower limit of the 9th band for UL TBF
duration distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules

PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_7 <
PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_8 <
PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_9

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.5

16383.5

50

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1016 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.225 (PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_9) (PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_9)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_9

Logical Name

PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_9

Definition

Upper limit of the 9th band, lower limit of the 10th band for UL TBF
duration distribution

Coding rules

step size = 0.5 sec

Mandatory rules

PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_8 <
PD_UL_TBF_DURATION_THR_9

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.5

16383.5

100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1017 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.226 (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_1) - (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_1

Logical Name

PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_1

Definition

Upper limit of the 1st band, lower limit of the 2nd band for LLC
volume carried by an UL TBF distribution

Coding rules

step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules

PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_1 < PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_2

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

byte

99999999

500

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1018 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.227 (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_2) - (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_2

Logical Name

PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_2

Definition

Upper limit of the 2nd band, lower limit of the 3rd band for LLC
volume carried by an UL TBF distribution

Coding rules

step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules

PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_1 < PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_2 <


PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_3

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

byte

99999999

1000

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1019 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.228 (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_3) - (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_3)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_3

Logical Name

PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_3

Definition

Upper limit of the 3rd band, lower limit of the 4th band for LLC volume
carried by an UL TBF distribution

Coding rules

step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules

PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_2 < PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_3 <


PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_4

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

byte

99999999

2000

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1020 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.229 (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_4) - (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_4)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_4

Logical Name

PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_4

Definition

Upper limit of the 4th band, lower limit of the 5th band for LLC volume
carried by an UL TBF distribution

Coding rules

step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules

PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_3 < PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_4 <


PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_5

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

byte

99999999

3000

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1021 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.230 (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_5) - (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_5)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_5

Logical Name

PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_5

Definition

Upper limit of the 5th band, lower limit of the 6th band for LLC volume
carried by an UL TBF distribution

Coding rules

step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules

PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_4 < PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_5 <


PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_6

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

byte

99999999

5000

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1022 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.231 (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_6) - (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_6)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_6

Logical Name

PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_6

Definition

Upper limit of the 6th band, lower limit of the 7th band for LLC volume
carried by an UL TBF distribution

Coding rules

step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules

PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_5 < PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_6 <


PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_7

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

byte

99999999

10000

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1023 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.232 (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_7) - (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_7)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_7

Logical Name

PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_7

Definition

Upper limit of the 7th band, lower limit of the 8th band for LLC volume
carried by an UL TBF distribution

Coding rules

step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules

PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_6 < PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_7 <


PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_8

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

byte

99999999

20000

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1024 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.233 (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_8) - (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_8)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_8

Logical Name

PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_8

Definition

Upper limit of the 8th band, lower limit of the 9th band for LLC volume
carried by an UL TBF distribution

Coding rules

step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules

PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_7 < PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_8 <


PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_9

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

byte

99999999

50000

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1025 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.234 (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_9) - (PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_9)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_9

Logical Name

PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_9

Definition

Upper limit of the 9th band, lower limit of the 10th band for LLC
volume carried by an UL TBF distribution

Coding rules

step size = 1 byte

Mandatory rules

PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_8 < PD_UL_TBF_VOLUME_THR_9

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

byte

99999999

100000

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1026 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.235 (Peer_NSE_Data_Weight) - (Peer_NSE_Data_Weight)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Peer_NSE_Data_Weight

Logical Name

Peer_NSE_Data_Weight

Definition

GboverIP: Indicates the data weight assigned to the peer NSE.

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

SGSN-IPEndPoint

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Declared by the operator in case of static configuration.Initialized


after the CONFIG procedure in case of dynamic configuration.If
Peer_NSE_Data_Weight=0, the IP endpoint will not be selected as a
data by the load sharing function.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1027 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.236 (Peer_NSE_Signalling_Weight) - (Peer_NSE_Signalling_Weight)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Peer_NSE_Signalling_Weight

Logical Name

Peer_NSE_Signalling_Weight

Definition

GboverIP: Indicates the signalling weight assigned to the peer NSE.

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

SGSN-IPEndPoint

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

255

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Declared by the operator in case of static configuration.Initialized


after the CONFIG procedure in case of dynamic configuration.If
Peer_NSE_Signalling_Weight=0, the IP endpoint will not be selected
as a signalling endpoint.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1028 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.237 (PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_1) - (PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_1)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_1

Logical Name

PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_1

Definition

This parameter indicates the values of the access persistence level


for radio priority 1.

Coding rules

Values : 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 16 coded


on 4 bits0 0 0 0 : persistence level 0, 0 0 0 1: persistence level 1,
0 0 1 0:persistence level 2, 0 0 1 1: persistence level 3, 0 1.0.0 :
persistence level 4. . . . 1 1 1 0 : persistence level 14, 1 1 1 1:
persistence level 16

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

16

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1029 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.238 (PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_2) - (PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_2)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_2

Logical Name

PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_2

Definition

This parameter indicates the values of the access persistence level


for radio priority 2.

Coding rules

Values : 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 16 coded


on 4 bits0 0 0 0 : persistence level 0, 0 0 0 1: persistence level 1,
0 0 1 0:persistence level 2, 0 0 1 1: persistence level 3, 0 1.0.0 :
persistence level 4. . . . 1 1 1 0 : persistence level 14, 1 1 1 1:
persistence level 16

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

16

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1030 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.239 (PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_3) - (PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_3)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_3

Logical Name

PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_3

Definition

This parameter indicates the values of the access persistence level


for radio priority 3.

Coding rules

Values : 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 16 coded


on 4 bits0 0 0 0 : persistence level 0, 0 0 0 1: persistence level 1,
0 0 1 0:persistence level 2, 0 0 1 1: persistence level 3, 0 1.0.0 :
persistence level 4. . . . 1 1 1 0 : persistence level 14, 1 1 1 1:
persistence level 16

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

16

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1031 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.240 (PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_4) - (PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_4)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_4

Logical Name

PERSISTENCE_LEVEL_4

Definition

This parameter indicates the values of the access persistence level


for radio priority 4.

Coding rules

Values : 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 16 coded


on 4 bits0 0 0 0 : persistence level 0, 0 0 0 1: persistence level 1,
0 0 1 0:persistence level 2, 0 0 1 1: persistence level 3, 0 1.0.0 :
persistence level 4. . . . 1 1 1 0 : persistence level 14, 1 1 1 1:
persistence level 16

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

16

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1032 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.241 (PFC_T6) - (PFC_T6)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PFC_T6

Logical Name

PFC_T6

Definition

Timer guarding the Download-BSS-PFC procedure

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.1

10

0.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1033 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.242 (PFC_T8) - (PFC_T8)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PFC_T8

Logical Name

PFC_T8

Definition

Timer guarding the Modify-BSS-PFC procedure

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.1

10

0.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1034 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.243 (Port_Number) - (SGSN_UDP_Port)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Port_Number

Logical Name

SGSN_UDP_Port

Definition

UDP port number of the SGSN IP endpoint used for Gb over IP.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Each SGSN IP EndPoint (SGSN_IP_Address, SGSN_UDP_Port)


must be unique per NSE.

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

SGSN-IPEndPoint

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

1024

65535

49152

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Following IANA.org: "Registered Ports" are in the range 1024-49151


and "Dynamic and/or Private Ports" are those from 49152 through
65535 (ALU BSS ports are taken in the private range, however SGSN
ports taken in the registered ports are accepted by the ALU BSS).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1035 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.244 (PRACH_BUSY_THRES) - (PRACH_BUSY_THRES)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PRACH_BUSY_THRES

Logical Name

PRACH_BUSY_THRES

Definition

Received level above which a PRACH block is deemed busy.

Coding rules

This parameter is encoded with a step size of 4 dB as follows:0:


-110 dBm1: -106 dBm2: -102 dBm3: -98 dBm4: -94 dBm5: -90
dBm6: -86 dBm7: -82 dBm8: -78 dBm9: -74 dBm10: -70 dBm11:
-66 dBm12: -62 dBm13: -58 dBm14: -54 dBm15: -50 dBm

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-50

-106

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / RLC/MAC

External Comment

Parameter used in dynamic allocation of secondary MasterPDCH


algorithm.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1036 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.245 (PRIORITY_CLASS) - (GPRS_PRIORITY_CLASS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PRIORITY_CLASS

Logical Name

GPRS_PRIORITY_CLASS

Definition

HCS priority of the cell, used in NC0.

Coding rules

Coded on 3 bits.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 2/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1037 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.246 (PRIORITY_CLASS) - (GPRS_PRIORITY_CLASS(n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PRIORITY_CLASS

Logical Name

GPRS_PRIORITY_CLASS(n)

Definition

HCS priority of the adjacent cell, used in NC0.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 2/2 (+ Edit External Cell / Packet)

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1038 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.247 (PS_PREF_BCCH_TRX) - (PS_PREF_BCCH_TRX)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

PS_PREF_BCCH_TRX

Logical Name

PS_PREF_BCCH_TRX

Definition

Indicates whether or not the PS requests shall be preferentially


served with PDCH(s) of the BCCH TRX

Coding rules

0: No preference. The TRX ranking algorithm handles the BCCH


TRX as a non-BCCH TRX.1: PS requests preferentially served on
BCCH TRX. The TRX ranking algorithm ensures that the BCCH TRX
has the highest preference to carry PS traffic (provided that the
BCCH TRX can carry PS traffic, i.e. TRX_PREF_MARK = 0 on that
TRX).2 : PS requests served on BCCH TRX with lowest priority. The
TRX ranking algorithm ensures that the BCCH TRX has the lowest
preference to carry PS traffic (provided that the BCCH TRX can carry
PS traffic, i.e. TRX_PREF_MARK = 0 on that TRX).

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

If EGPRS is activated in a non-hopping or a non-hopping /


radio-hopping cell, Alcatel recommend to set this parameter to 0
in order to reduce the likelihood of having to reduce the GMSK
output power (see external comment).If EGPRS is activated in a
base-band hopping cell, setting this parameter to 0 does not reduce
the likelihood of having to reduce the GMSK output power since PS
capable TRXs will hop on the BCCH carrier.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / General groups

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1039 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

External Comment

When set to 1 or 2, this parameter is only relevant if the BCCH TRX


supports PS traffic (i.e. if TRX_PREF_MARK = 0 on the BCCH
TRX).If EGPRS is activated in a non-hopping or a non-hopping /
radio-hopping cell, if the BCCH TRX can carry PS traffic and if the
BCCH TRX is associated to a TRE hardware allowing the usage of
8-PSK, the operator shall ensure that the difference in the mean
output powers between GSMK and 8-PSK signals is less than 2 dB
in order to be compliant with 3GPP TS 45.005 and 3GPP TS 45.008
requirements (or 4 dB if an SDCCH timeslot is defined on timeslot
number 7 of the BCCH TRX).If EGPRS is activated in a base-band
hopping cell, the operator shall ensure that the difference in the
mean output powers between GMSK and 8-PSK signals is less than
2 dB in order to be compliant with 3GPP TS 45.005 and 3GPP TS
45.008 requirements (or 4 dB if timeslot number 7 is not part of the
PDCH groups).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1040 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.248 (QOS_SAFETY_MARGIN) - (QOS_SAFETY_MARGIN)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

QOS_SAFETY_MARGIN

Logical Name

QOS_SAFETY_MARGIN

Definition

Additional capacity (in terms of radio bandwidth and in terms of


transmission resources) which is reserved for a streaming TBF (RT
PFC) to correctly fulfill its AGBR contract and to possibly convey other
multiplexed NRT PFC(s) of the same TBF. The part of this margin
that is not used by the streaming TBF may be used by other TBF(s).

Coding rules

step size = 10%

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Setting QOS_SAFETY_MARGIN to 0% is not recommended (the


GBR of some RT PFCs may turn out to be impossible to guarantee in
this case).

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1041 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.249 (R_AVERAGE_EGPRS) - (R_AVERAGE_EGPRS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

R_AVERAGE_EGPRS

Logical Name

R_AVERAGE_EGPRS

Definition

Average bitrate per PDCH for Edge capable terminals in this cell

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

RMIN_EGPRS <= R_AVERAGE_EGPRS

Recommended rules

R_AVERAGE_EGPRS shall not be set to a bitrate higher than


the useful bitrate corresponding to MAX_EGPRS_MCS (e.g. if
MAX_EGPRS_MCS = MCS9 => R_AVERAGE_EGPRS shall not
be higher than 59,2kbps).

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

bit/s

59200

30000

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

This parameter represents the average bit rate that is targeted,


per PDCH, in the cell with respect to the cell radio planning. It
is recommended not to set this bit rate higher than the average
measured bit rate in the cell.The default value corresponds to
MCS-6.The max value corresponds to MCS-9.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1042 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.250 (R_AVERAGE_GPRS) - (R_AVERAGE_GPRS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

R_AVERAGE_GPRS

Logical Name

R_AVERAGE_GPRS

Definition

Average bitrate per PDCH for non-Edge capable terminals in this cell

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

RMIN_GPRS <= R_AVERAGE_GPRS

Recommended rules

R_AVERAGE_GPRS shall not be set to a bitrate higher than


the useful bitrate corresponding to MAX_GPRS_CS (e.g. if
MAX_GPRS_CS = CS2 => R_AVERAGE_GPRS shall not be higher
than 12kbps).

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

bit/s

20000

12000

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

This parameter represents the average bit rate that is targeted,


per PDCH, in the cell with respect to the cell radio planning. It
is recommended not to set this bit rate higher than the average
measured bit rate in the cell.The default value corresponds to
CS-2.The max value corresponds to CS-4.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1043 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.251 (RA_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS) - (RA_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

RA_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS

Logical Name

RA_RESELECT_HYSTERESIS

Definition

This parameter indicates in both STANDBY and READY state the


additional hysteresis which applies when selecting a cell in a new
Routing Area.

Coding rules

step size = 2 dB, Coded on 3 bits. 000=0 dB, 001=2 dB, ...111=14 dB

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

14

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 2/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1044 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.252 (RACH/PRACH_TA_FILTER) - (RACH_TA_FILTER (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

RACH/PRACH_TA_FILTER

Logical Name

RACH_TA_FILTER (MFS)

Definition

Timing Advance threshold for CHANNEL REQUIRED and PACKET


CHANNEL REQUEST filtering.

Coding rules

64: no filtering

Mandatory rules

Equal to RACH_TA_FILTER (BSC)

Recommended rules

Disable the filtering for extended cells.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

bper

64

64

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Ctrl Channel

External Comment

One unit corresponds to a distance of about 550m. CHANNEL


REQUIRED or PACKET CHANNEL REQUEST messages with
Timing Advance greater or equal to RACH_TA_FILTER are
discarded.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1045 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.253 (RMIN_EGPRS) - (RMIN_EGPRS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

RMIN_EGPRS

Logical Name

RMIN_EGPRS

Definition

Minimal bitrate per PDCH for Edge capable terminals in this cell (at
95 % or 90% confidence level or less %, depending on tolerable risk)

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

RMIN_EGPRS <= R_AVERAGE_EGPRS

Recommended rules

If EN_STREAMING = 1 and EN_CS_ADAPTATION_ACK = False


then the following condition must be respected: RMIN_EGPRS
<= useful bitrate corresponding to min (TBF_UL_INIT_MCS,
TBF_DL_INIT_MCS). Otherwise the streaming PFC can be
downgraded to the Defaut Best Effort ABQP.R_MIN_EGPRS shall
not be set to a bitrate higher than the useful bitrate corresponding to
Max_EGPRS_MCS. If the above recommended rule is not fulfilled,
then some RT PFCs can be accepted by the BSS whereas it will not
be possible to handle their associated GBR. This may result in RT
PFC downgrades to Best Effort.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

bit/s

59200

20800

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

This parameter is used to provide a guaranted Bit rate of streaming


PFC for Edge capable MS, in the worst case radio condition. It should
be set appropriately with respect to the cell radio planning.The default
value corresponds to a bitrate between MCS-4 and MCS-5.The max
value corresponds to MCS-9.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1046 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.254 (RMIN_GPRS) - (RMIN_GPRS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

RMIN_GPRS

Logical Name

RMIN_GPRS

Definition

Minimal bitrate per PDCH for non-Edge capable terminals in this


cell cell (at 95 % or 90% confidence level or less, depending on
tolerable risk)

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

RMIN_GPRS <= R_AVERAGE_GPRS

Recommended rules

If EN_STREAMING = 1 and EN_CS_ADAPTATION_ACK = False


then the following condition must be respected: RMIN_GPRS
<= useful bitrate corresponding to min (TBF_UL_INIT_CS,
TBF_DL_INIT_CS). Otherwise the streaming PFC can be
downgraded to the Defaut Best Effort ABQP.R_MIN_GPRS shall
not be set to a bitrate higher than the useful bitrate corresponding
to Max_GPRS_CS. If the above recommended rule is not fulfilled,
then some RT PFCs can be accepted by the BSS whereas it will not
be possible to handle their associated GBR. This may result in RT
PFC downgrades to Best Effort.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

bit/s

20000

8000

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

This parameter is used to provide a guaranted Bit rate of streaming


PFC for Non Edge capable MS, in the worst case radio condition. It
should be set appropriately with respect to the cell radio planning.The
default value corresponds to CS-1.The max value corresponds to
CS-4.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1047 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.255 (Round trip delay MFS-MS) - (round_trip_delay)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Round trip delay MFS-MS

Logical Name

round_trip_delay

Definition

Round trip delay between the MFS and a MS.

Coding rules

step size=10 ms

Mandatory rules

T3192 + T_MAX_EXTENDED_UL + round_trip_delay < 5 sec

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

80

940

160

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Connection Control 2/2

External Comment

The round-trip delay is used by the RRM, RLC and MAC layers. The
OMC-R and the MFS also use this parameter to determine whether
or not GPRS traffic is carried through Abis or Ater satellite links as
follows:- If round_trip_delay < 500 ms, the OMC-R and the MFS
consider that GPRS traffic is carried through Abis and Ater terrestrial
links,- If round_trip_delay >= 500 ms, the OMC-R and the MFS
consider that GPRS traffic is carried either through Abis satellite links
or Ater satellite links.When the GPRS traffic is carried through Abis
or Ater satellite links in the serving cell, it is recommended to set the
round_trip_delay parameter to [Delay due to satellite (540 ms) +
Delay due to MFS-MS link (160 ms)] = 700 ms.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1048 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.256 (Routing Area Code for GPRS) - (RA_CODE (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Routing Area Code for GPRS

Logical Name

RA_CODE (BSC)

Definition

Routing Area Code for GPRS.

Coding rules

The initial special value -1 means that the RA code has still not been
set by the operator.

Mandatory rules

- Equal to RA_CODE (MFS)- A couple of mate extended cells


(Extended inner + extended outer) shall have the same RA_CODE
when they are PS capable

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

-1

255

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / General groups

External Comment

The value depends on configuration. The default value indicated


here is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1049 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.257 (Routing Area Code for GPRS) - (RA_CODE (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Routing Area Code for GPRS

Logical Name

RA_CODE (MFS)

Definition

Routing Area Code.

Coding rules

0...255 (significant value: 3GPP TS 04.60)other values: external


or unknown cell

Mandatory rules

- Equal to RA_CODE (BSC)- A couple of mate extended cells


(Extended inner + extended outer) shall have the same RA_CODE
when they are PS capable

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

-1

255

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / General groups

External Comment

The value depends on configuration. The default value indicated


here is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1050 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.258 (Routing Area Code for GPRS) - (RA_CODE(n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Routing Area Code for GPRS

Logical Name

RA_CODE(n)

Definition

Routing Area Code of neighbour cells.

Coding rules

0...255 (significant value: 3GPP TS 04.60);other values: external or


unknown cell.The special value of "-1" means that the RA code has
still not been valued by the network provider or that the MFS shall set
the SAME_RA_AS_SERVING_CELL field to 0.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

If i) the target and serving cells belong to different PLMNs and ii) the
RAC and LAC of the target cell are equal to the RAC and LAC of the
serving cell, and iii) there is a PBCCH established in the serving
cell, and iv) a cell reselection adjacency link is defined between the
serving cell and the target cell, then it is recommended to set the
RA_CODE to -1. Otherwise, the MFS considers that the serving cell
and the target cell belong to the same routing area when setting
the SAME_RA_AS_SERVING_CELL field in the 04.60 PACKET
SYSTEM INFORMATION TYPE 3/3bis messages.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

-1

255

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Adjacencies

External Comment

The special value of -1 means that the RA code has still not been
valued by the operator or that the routing area of the serving cell is
different from the routing area of the target cell.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1051 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.259 (Routing Area Colour for GPRS) - (RA_COLOUR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Routing Area Colour for GPRS

Logical Name

RA_COLOUR

Definition

Routing Area Colour for GPRS.

Coding rules

Coded over 3 bits. the initial special value -1 means that the RA
codecolour has not yet been valued by the network provider.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / General groups

External Comment

Default value depends on the configuration. The value indicated here


is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1052 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.260 (RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN) - (RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN

Logical Name

RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN (MFS)

Definition

Minimum received level at the MS required for initial access to the


cell.

Coding rules

Coded on 6 bits, 0=-110 dBm, 63=-47 dBm, step size=1dBm.

Mandatory rules

RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN (MFS) = RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN (BSC)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1053 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.261 (RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN) - (RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN(n)(MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN

Logical Name

RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN(n)(MFS)

Definition

Minimum received level at the MS required for initial access to the


cell.

Coding rules

Coded on 6 bits, 0=-110 dBm, 63=-47 dBm, step size=1dBm.

Mandatory rules

RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN(n)(MFS) = RXLEV_ACCESS_MIN(n)(BSC)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

adj

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-110

-47

-100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC only RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit External Cell/ Packet2/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1054 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.262 (S) - (S)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Logical Name

Definition

Number of slots between 2 successive PACKET CHANNEL


REQUEST.

Coding rules

Possible values are : 12, 15, 20, 30, 41, 55, 76, 109, 163, 217
respectively binary coded : 0000, 0001, 0010,... ,1001

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

When the GPRS traffic is carried through Abis or Ater terrestrial


links, it is recommended to set S so that the time between two
successive Packet Channel Request messages is longer than 900
ms.When the GPRS traffic is carried through Abis or Ater satellite
links, it is recommended to set S so that the time between two
successive Packet Channel Request messages is longer than 1400
ms.The number of slots belonging to the MSs PRACH between 2
successive Packet Channel Request messages is a random value
drawn randomly for each new retransmission with uniform distribution
in the set (S, S+1, ...,S+T-1) with T = Tx_INT. The time in seconds
between two Packet Channel Request messages is determined as
a function of S, TX_INT and of the BS_PRACH_BLKS parameter.
BS_PRACH_BLKS defines the number of blocks statically allocated
to the PRACH per 52 multiframe on each PCCCH.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

12

217

30

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Master channel 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1055 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.263 (SGSNR) - (SGSNR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

SGSNR

Logical Name

SGSNR

Definition

Year corresponding to the version of ETSI/3GPP recommendations


used to implement SGSN software.

Coding rules

0 = SGSN is release 98 or older; 1 = SGSN is release 99 onwards

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / Internetworking SGSN Internetworking

External Comment

Any modification of the parameter leads the MFS to reset


autonomously all the GPUs connected to this BSS.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1056 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.264 (SMS_PRIORITY) - (SMS_PRIORITY)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

SMS_PRIORITY

Logical Name

SMS_PRIORITY

Definition

Defines the relative priority used for the pre-defined "SMS" PFC.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1057 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.265 (T stop frame relay emission) - (T_STOP_FR_EMISSION)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T stop frame relay emission

Logical Name

T_STOP_FR_EMISSION

Definition

Timer used to trigger restart of emission on a PVC (Frame Relay).

Coding rules

step size = 1 ms

Mandatory rules

Not changeable after MFS system initialization.

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

PVC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

10

5000

100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: MFS RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

MFSUSM / GB Configuration / NSVC Creation

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1058 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.266 (T_AVG_T) - (T_AVG_T (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_AVG_T

Logical Name

T_AVG_T (BSC)

Definition

Signal strength filter period for power control in packet transfer mode.

Coding rules

binary coded on 5 bits

Mandatory rules

Equal to T_AVG_T (MFS)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

25

12

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Power Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1059 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.267 (T_AVG_T) - (T_AVG_T (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_AVG_T

Logical Name

T_AVG_T (MFS)

Definition

Signal strength filter period for power control in packet transfer mode.

Coding rules

binary coded on 5 bits

Mandatory rules

Equal to T_AVG_T (BSC)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

25

12

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Power Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1060 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.268 (T_AVG_W) - (T_AVG_W (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_AVG_W

Logical Name

T_AVG_W (BSC)

Definition

Signal strength filter period for power control in packet idle mode.

Coding rules

binary coded on 5 bits

Mandatory rules

Equal to T_AVG_W (MFS)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

25

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Power Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1061 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.269 (T_AVG_W) - (T_AVG_W (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_AVG_W

Logical Name

T_AVG_W (MFS)

Definition

Signal strength filter period for power control in packet idle mode.

Coding rules

binary coded on 5 bits

Mandatory rules

Equal to T_AVG_W (BSC)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

25

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Power Control

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1062 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.270 (T_DELAYED_FINAL_PUAN) - (T_DELAYED_FINAL_PUAN)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_DELAYED_FINAL_PUAN

Logical Name

T_DELAYED_FINAL_PUAN

Definition

This timer defines the duration of the delay introduced by the BSS
to send the final Packet UL Ack/Nack message when releasing an
UL TBF.

Coding rules

step size : 100 ms ; 0 = 0 msec, 1 = 100 msec, 2 = 200 msec, etc

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

2000

400

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

The feature "delayed emission of the final Packet UL Ack/Nack"


can be inhibited by setting the value 0 to the parameter
T_DELAYED_FINAL_PUAN. When the feature is enabled, the timer
duration should be long enough to let the server send its response
to the uplink PDUs received from the MS, while remaining short
enough in order not to jeopardise the sending of further uplink PDUs
by the MS.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1063 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.271 (T_DL_GPRS_MeasReport) - (T_DL_GPRS_MeasReport)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_DL_GPRS_MeasReport

Logical Name

T_DL_GPRS_MeasReport

Definition

Time period to request for a Packet Downlink Ack/Nack with


measurements.

Coding rules

step size = 20 ms

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

60

3000

400

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / RLC/MAC

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1064 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.272 (T_FLOW_CTRL_CELL) - (T_flow_ctrl_cell)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_FLOW_CTRL_CELL

Logical Name

T_flow_ctrl_cell

Definition

Periodicity of emission of NM- FLOW-CONTROL-BVC message to


SGSN.

Coding rules

step size=1sec, 0 means infinite timer

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1065 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.273 (T_FLOW_CTRL_MS) - (T_flow_ctrl_ms)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_FLOW_CTRL_MS

Logical Name

T_flow_ctrl_ms

Definition

Periodicity of emission of NM- FLOW-CONTROL-MS message


towards the SGSN for GPRS and EGPRS Mobile Stations.

Coding rules

step size=1sec, 0 means infinite timer

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

250

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS

External Comment

1) if T_Flow_Ctrl_MS is set to "0", then the MS flow control


mechanism is inhibited;2) if T_Flow_Ctrl_MS has a non-null value,
then "C< T_flow_ctrl_ms < Th". The parameters C and Th are
defined in the 3GPP TS 08.18.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1066 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.274 (T_GCH_CORR) - (Tcorr)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_GCH_CORR

Logical Name

Tcorr

Definition

Timer to supervise clock drift correction loop for 16k channel.

Coding rules

step size=100ms

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Tcorr > Trelease+240ms and Tcorr > Testab+240mswhere 240 ms


represents the maximum delay in MAC layer between the notification
for a DBN correction and the application of this DBN correction.It is
recommended to set this parameter as follows depending whether or
not GPRS traffic is carried through Abis or Ater satellite links:- Tcorr
= 0.8 s if GPRS traffic is carried through Abis and Ater terrestrial
links in the serving cell,- Tcorr = 1.4 s if GPRS traffic is carried either
through Abis satellite links or Ater satellite links in the serving cell.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.5

0.8

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / General groups

External Comment

HMI name changed to precise that this timer is valid for GCH
channels. Former HMI name Tcorr.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1067 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.275 (T_GCH_ESTAB) - (Testab)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_GCH_ESTAB

Logical Name

Testab

Definition

Supervision of loss of GCH link establishment for 16k channels.

Coding rules

step size= 100 ms

Mandatory rules

Treq_pending > Testab

Recommended rules

It is recommended to set this parameter as follows depending


whether or not GPRS traffic is carried through Abis or Ater satellite
links:- Testab = 0.4 s if GPRS traffic is carried through Abis and
Ater terrestrial links in the serving cell,- Testab = 1 s if GPRS traffic
is carried either through Abis satellite links or Ater satellite links in
the serving cell.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.1

0.4

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / General groups

External Comment

HMI name changed to precise that this timer is valid for GCH
channels. Former HMI name Testab.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1068 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.276 (T_GCH_INACTIVITY) - (T_GCH_INACTIVITY)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_GCH_INACTIVITY

Logical Name

T_GCH_INACTIVITY

Definition

- For Non Evolium BTS : Timer to postpone the release of one slave
PDCH, when it does not support any (E)GPRS traffic.- For Evolium
BTS : Timer to postpone the release of the "unused" GCHs of the
M-EGCH link of a TRX (the condition for some GCHs of the M-EGCH
link of a TRX to become "unused" is that some TBFs established on
that TRX were released).

Coding rules

step size = 1sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

T_GCH_INACTIVITY > T_CANDIDATE_TBF_REALLOC in all the


cells of the BSS.This constraints avoids as much as possible that
some GCHs are released and reestablished again some moments
later. This way, the T3 and T4 TBF reallocations can benefit from the
GCHs which are currently unused, but still established.If it is seen
as an important goal to save Ater resources in the GPU, a value of
Ater_Usage_Threshold_Short_Data < 100% is coherent with a low
value of the T_GCH_INACTIVITY and T_GCH_INACTIVITY_LAST
timers.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

The setting of the T_GCH_INACTIVITY timer comes to make


a trade-off between the GCH resource usage and the Telecom
performance:- The higher is the T_GCH_INACTIVITY timer, the
higher is the GCH resource usage on the Ater interface.- The higher
is the T_GCH_INACTIVITY timer, the lower is the average duration
of TBF establishments on (P)CCCH, especially if the GPRS traffic is
carried through satellite.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1069 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.277 (T_GCH_INACTIVITY_LAST) - (T_GCH_INACTIVITY_LAST)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_GCH_INACTIVITY_LAST

Logical Name

T_GCH_INACTIVITY_LAST

Definition

- Evolium BTS : Timer to postpone the release of the last


N_GCH_FAST_PS_ACCESS GCHs established in a cell, when
the last TBF has been released in the cell. There is no more
(E)GPRS traffic in the cell, but keeping some GCHs established will
be useful in case of (E)GPRS traffic resumption in the cell (e.g.
WAP, WEB).- Non Evolium BTS : Timer to postpone the release of
the last established slave PDCH of a cell, when it does not support
GPRS traffic anymore. There is no more GPRS traffic in the cell, but
keeping a PDCH established will be useful in case of GPRS traffic
resumption in the cell.

Coding rules

step size = 1 sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

If it is seen as an important goal to save Ater resources in the


GPU, a value of Ater_Usage_Threshold_Short_Data < 100%
is coherent with a low value of the T_GCH_INACTIVITY and
T_GCH_INACTIVITY_LAST timers.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

200

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

That timer is relevant only if EN_FAST_INITIAL_GPRS_ACCESS


is disabled.The setting of the T_GCH_INACTIVITY_LAST timer
comes to make a trade-off between the GCH resource usage and the
Telecom performance:- The higher is the T_GCH_INACTIVITY_LAST
timer, the higher is the GCH resource usage on the Ater interface.The higher is the T_GCH_INACTIVITY_LAST timer, the lower is the
average duration of TBF establishments on (P)CCCH, especially
if the GPRS traffic is carried through satellite links.This parameter
may also be used to ensure that the BSS reserves at least one
GCH resource in the serving cell while the MS is engaged in a Web
browsing session.

1070 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1071 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.278 (T_MAX_EXTENDED_UL) - (T_MAX_EXTENDED_UL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_MAX_EXTENDED_UL

Logical Name

T_MAX_EXTENDED_UL

Definition

Maximum duration of the extended uplink TBF phase

Coding rules

step size = 100 ms

Mandatory rules

T3192 + T_MAX_EXTENDED_UL + round_trip_delay < 5 sec

Recommended rules

It is recommended to set this parameter as follows depending


whether or not GPRS traffic is carried through Abis or Ater satellite
links:- between 1 sec and 2 sec if GPRS traffic is carried through Abis
and Ater terrestrial links,- between 1.5 sec and 2.5 sec if GPRS traffic
is carried either through Abis satellite links or Ater satellite links.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

100

4000

2000

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1072 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.279 (T_MAX_STREAMING_BUFFERING) (T_MAX_STREAMING_BUFFERING)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_MAX_STREAMING_BUFFERING

Logical Name

T_MAX_STREAMING_BUFFERING

Definition

Time which multiplied by the GBR defines a buffer level above which
we may consider the BSS failed to provide the GBR

Coding rules

step size = 1 sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

100

30

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1073 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.280 (T_NC_PING_PONG) - (T_NC_PING_PONG)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_NC_PING_PONG

Logical Name

T_NC_PING_PONG

Definition

Time during which the ping-pong offset is applied.

Coding rules

step size = 100 ms

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

20000

5000

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Resel.

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1074 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.281 (T_NC_REJ_CELL) - (T_NC_REJ_CELL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_NC_REJ_CELL

Logical Name

T_NC_REJ_CELL

Definition

Time during which a NC cell reselection is inhibited towards that cell


due to a previous NC cell reselection failure on that cell.

Coding rules

step size = 100 ms

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

20000

5000

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Resel. 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1075 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.282 (T_NETWORK_RESPONSE_TIME) (T_NETWORK_RESPONSE_TIME)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_NETWORK_RESPONSE_TIME

Logical Name

T_NETWORK_RESPONSE_TIME

Definition

Maximum expected response time of a network server as seen from


the MFS.

Coding rules

step size: 100 ms

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

100

5000

1600

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / General

External Comment

1) The response time corresponds to T1 T2 where T2 corresponds


to the time at which a command is sent to the SGSN and T1 the time
at which the response is received on the MFS side. This command
/ response is e.g. the LLC PDU containing an FTP GET and the
first LLC PDU starting the file transfer. It can also be the LLC PDU
containing an HTTP GET and the first LLC PDU starting the page
download.2) The value of this timer defines the duration of the
Delayed DL TBF Release procedure. In case the servers to which
the GGSN serving the MFS is connected are not located at the same
place, then the maximum server response time should be entered.
However, note that the higher this timer is, the longer TBF releases
will be delayed and therefore the more resources are used up.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1076 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.283 (T_PAG_PS) - (T_PAG_PS (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_PAG_PS

Logical Name

T_PAG_PS (BSC)

Definition

This timer indicates the maximum time a PS PAGING message can


remain in a Paging Group Queue. It includes the round-trip delay
on Gb and A-bis interface.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Equal to T_PAG_PS (MFS)

Recommended rules

T_PAG_PS < T3313 (SGSN timer)

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

25.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / RLC/MAC

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1077 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.284 (T_PAG_PS) - (T_PAG_PS (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_PAG_PS

Logical Name

T_PAG_PS (MFS)

Definition

This timer indicates the maximum time a PS PAGING message can


remain in a Paging Group Queue. It includes the round-trip delay
on Gb and A-bis interface.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1sec

Mandatory rules

Equal to T_PAG_PS (BSC)

Recommended rules

T_PAG_PS < T3313 (SGSN timer)

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

25.5

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / RLC/MAC

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1078 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.285 (T_PSI_PACCH) - (T_PSI_PACCH)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_PSI_PACCH

Logical Name

T_PSI_PACCH

Definition

Scheduling period of PSI1, PSI13 or PSI14 on PACCH.

Coding rules

step size =1sec, 00000 == Deactivated PSI scheduling on PACCH,


00001 == 1s, 11110 == T_PSI_PACCH = 30 sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

30

14

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit BSS / GPRS / General

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1079 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.286 (T_RESEL) - (T_RESEL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_RESEL

Logical Name

T_RESEL

Definition

Timer whose expiry allows a MS, which has performed an abnormal


release with cell reselection, to reselect the previous cell.

Coding rules

coded on 3 bits, 000= 5 sec, 001= 10 sec, 010 = 15 sec, 011 = 20


sec, 100= 30 sec, 101 = 60 sec, 110 = 120 sec, 111 = 300 sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

300

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Master Channel 2/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1080 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.287 (T_ul_assign_PCCCH) - (T_ul_assign_pccch)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_ul_assign_PCCCH

Logical Name

T_ul_assign_pccch

Definition

The duration between the reception of the (EGPRS) Packet Channel


Request message and one uplink radio block allocated to the MS.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

It is recommended to set this parameter as follows depending


whether or not GPRS traffic is carried through Abis or Ater satellite
links:- T_ul_asssign_pccch = 0.4 s if GPRS traffic is carried through
Abis and Ater terrestrial links in the serving cell,- T_ul_assign_pccch
= 0.7 s if GPRS traffic is carried either through Abis satellite links or
Ater satellite links in the serving cell.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

0.1

0.7

0.4

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Connection Control 2/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1081 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.288 (T_UL_RLS_EUTM) - (T_UL_RLS_EUTM)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_UL_RLS_EUTM

Logical Name

T_UL_RLS_EUTM

Definition

Waiting time between two successive polling request sent to a MS


for an UL TBF in EUTM mode when EN_EXTENDED_UL_TBF is
set ot 2 (IEUTM enabled).

Coding rules

step size = 20ms

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

100

300

100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

RLS = Radio Link Supervision

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1082 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.289 (T3168) - (T3168 (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T3168

Logical Name

T3168 (BSC)

Definition

This timer defines the maximum time the MS waits for a packet
UL assignment, after sending a Packet Resource Request (case
of two-phase UL TBF establishment) or after including a Channel
Request Description Information Element in a Packet Downlink
Ack/Nack (case of UL TBF establishment on a concurrent DL TBF).
Broadcast in SI13 within the GPRS Cell Options IE.

Coding rules

Coded on 3 bits as follows:001: 1000 ms010: 1500 ms011: 2000


ms100: 2500 ms101: 3000 ms110: 3500 ms111: 4000 ms.

Mandatory rules

Equal to T3168 (MFS)

Recommended rules

It is recommended to set this parameter as follows depending


whether or not GPRS traffic is carried through Ater satellite links:T3168 = 1 s if GPRS traffic is carried through Ater terrestrial links in
the serving cell,- T3168 = 1.5 s if GPRS traffic is carried through Ater
satellite links in the serving cell.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Connection Control 2/2

External Comment

The setting of T3168 should leave sufficient time to the MFS for
granting PDCHs for serving the UL TBF request, plus also cover
the round trip time and the possible queuing delay within the MFS
before the Packet Uplink Assignment can be sent to the Mobile
Station. Therefore a value of 500 ms is not allowed in this release
of the Alcatel BSS.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1083 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.290 (T3168) - (T3168 (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T3168

Logical Name

T3168 (MFS)

Definition

This timer defines the maximum time the MS waits for a packet
UL assignment, after sending a Packet Resource Request (case
of two-phase UL TBF establishment) or after including a Channel
Request Description Information Element in a Packet Downlink
Ack/Nack (case of UL TBF establishment on a concurrent DL TBF).
Broadcast in PSI1 within the GPRS Cell Options IE.

Coding rules

Coded on 3 bits as follows:001: 1000 ms010: 1500 ms011: 2000


ms100: 2500 ms101: 3000 ms110: 3500 ms111: 4000 ms.

Mandatory rules

Equal to T3168 (BSC)

Recommended rules

It is recommended to set this parameter as follows depending


whether or not GPRS traffic is carried through Ater satellite links:T3168 = 1 s if GPRS traffic is carried through Ater terrestrial links,T3168 = 1.5 s if GPRS traffic is carried through Ater satellite links.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Connection Control 2/2

External Comment

The setting of T3168 should leave sufficient time to the MFS for
granting PDCHs for serving the UL TBF request, plus also cover
the round trip time and the possible queuing delay within the MFS
before the Packet Uplink Assignment can be sent to the Mobile
Station. Therefore a value of 500 ms is not allowed in this release
of the Alcatel BSS.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1084 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.291 (T3192) - (T3192 (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T3192

Logical Name

T3192 (BSC)

Definition

Wait for release of the downlink TBF on MS side after reception of


the final block by the MS.

Coding rules

Coded on 3 bits as follows: 0 0 0: 500 msec0 0 1: 1000 msec0 1


0: 1500 msec1 1 1: 200 msec

Mandatory rules

Equal to T3192 (MFS)T3192 + T_MAX_EXTENDED_UL +


round_trip_delay < 5 sec

Recommended rules

T3192>MS-BSS roundtrip delay + RRBP maximum duration (60


ms)It is recommended to set this parameter as follows depending
whether or not GPRS traffic is carried through Abis or Ater
satellite links:==> Case GPRS traffic is carried through Abis and
Ater terrestrial links in the serving cell:i) T3192 = 1000 ms if the
non-DRX mode is not activated and the delayed DL TBF release
mode is not activated in the cell (i.e. if DRX_TIMER_MAX =
0 and EN_DELAYED_DL_TBF_REL = 0)ii) T3192 = 500 ms if
the non-DRX mode is activated or the delayed DL TBF release
mode is activated in the cell (i.e. if DRX_TIMER_MAX > 0 or
EN_DELAYED_DL_TBF_REL = 1)iii) however, if T3192 is finally set
to 200 msec, then :- some abnormal DL TBF release may occur
during the delayed phase, and - the MS may not receive the NC2
deactivation order from the BSS, which may lead the MS to send
useless PMR before leaving its ready state.==> Case GPRS traffic is
carried either through Abis satellite links or Ater satellite links in the
serving cell:i) T3192 = 1500 ms if the non-DRX mode is not activated
and the delayed DL TBF release mode is not activated in the cell (i.e.
if DRX_TIMER_MAX = 0 and EN_DELAYED_DL_TBF_REL = 0)ii)
T3192 = 1000 ms if the non-DRX mode is activated or the delayed DL
TBF release mode is activated in the cell (i.e. if DRX_TIMER_MAX >
0 or EN_DELAYED_DL_TBF_REL = 1)

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

200

1500

500

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Connection Control 2/2

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1085 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

External Comment

The following values ofT3192 defined in the 3GPP TS 04.60 are not
supported in this release of the Alcatel BSS:0 1 1: 0 msec1 0 0: 80
msec1 0 1: 120 msec1 1 0: 160 msec

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1086 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.292 (T3192) - (T3192 (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T3192

Logical Name

T3192 (MFS)

Definition

Wait for release of the downlink TBF on MS side after reception of


the final block by the MS.

Coding rules

Coded on 3 bits as follows: 0 0 0: 500 msec0 0 1: 1000 msec0 1


0: 1500 msec1 1 1: 200 msec

Mandatory rules

Equal to T3192 (BSC)T3192 + T_MAX_EXTENDED_UL +


round_trip_delay < 5 sec

Recommended rules

T3192>MS-BSS roundtrip delay + RRBP maximum duration (60


ms)It is recommended to set this parameter as follows depending
whether or not GPRS traffic is carried through Abis or Ater
satellite links:==> Case GPRS traffic is carried through Abis and
Ater terrestrial links in the serving cell:i) T3192 = 1000 ms if the
non-DRX mode is not activated and the delayed DL TBF release
mode is not activated in the cell (i.e. if DRX_TIMER_MAX =
0 and EN_DELAYED_DL_TBF_REL = 0)ii) T3192 = 500 ms if
the non-DRX mode is activated or the delayed DL TBF release
mode is activated in the cell (i.e. if DRX_TIMER_MAX > 0 or
EN_DELAYED_DL_TBF_REL = 1)iii) however, if T3192 is finally set
to 200 msec, then :- some abnormal DL TBF release may occur
during the delayed phase, and - the MS may not receive the NC2
deactivation order from the BSS, which may lead the MS to send
useless PMR before leaving its ready state.==> Case GPRS traffic is
carried either through Abis satellite links or Ater satellite links in the
serving cell:i) T3192 = 1500 ms if the non-DRX mode is not activated
and the delayed DL TBF release mode is not activated in the cell (i.e.
if DRX_TIMER_MAX = 0 and EN_DELAYED_DL_TBF_REL = 0)ii)
T3192 = 1000 ms if the non-DRX mode is activated or the delayed DL
TBF release mode is activated in the cell (i.e. if DRX_TIMER_MAX >
0 or EN_DELAYED_DL_TBF_REL = 1)

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

200

1500

500

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Connection Control 2/2

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1087 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

External Comment

The following values ofT3192 defined in the 3GPP TS 04.60 are not
supported in this release of the Alcatel BSS:0 1 1: 0 msec1 0 0: 80
msec1 0 1: 120 msec1 1 0: 160 msec

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1088 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.293 (T3212) - (T3212 (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T3212

Logical Name

T3212 (MFS)

Definition

This timer indicates to the MS the delay between two consecutive


Periodic Location Update procedures.

Coding rules

0: no periodic location update, coded on 8 bits

Mandatory rules

Equal to T3212 (BSC)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

6 mn

255

30

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1089 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.294 (TBF_CS_DL) - (TBF_CS_DL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TBF_CS_DL

Logical Name

TBF_CS_DL

Definition

Threshold defining the number of consecutive PACKET DOWNLINK


ACK/NACK not received above which the Coding Scheme of a DL
acknowledged or unacknowledged DL TBF is changed to CS-1.

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 2/2

External Comment

If the GPRS traffic is carried through Abis terrestrial link and


Ater terrestrial link, in case where N3105_LIMIT < TBF_CS_DL
then the loss of consecutive packet DL ACK/NACK will not
trigger link adaptation but TBF release.If the GPRS traffic is
carried through Abis satellitel link or Ater satellite link, in case
where N3105_LIMIT_SATELLITE < TBF_CS_DL then the loss of
consecutive packet DL ACK/NACK will not trigger link adaptation
but TBF release.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1090 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.295 (TBF_CS_UL) - (TBF_CS_UL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TBF_CS_UL

Logical Name

TBF_CS_UL

Definition

Threshold defining the maximum number of consecutive times the


network receives an invalid UL RLC data block or nothing from
the MS having a monoslot GPRS TBF before changing the coding
scheme to CS1. For a multislot GPRS TBF, TBF_CS_UL_limit :=
TBF_CS_UL x n_allocated

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

64

32

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / CS3/CS4 2/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1091 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.296 (TBF_CS3_BLER_PERIOD) - (TBF_CS3_BLER_PERIOD)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TBF_CS3_BLER_PERIOD

Logical Name

TBF_CS3_BLER_PERIOD

Definition

Defines the window size required to estimate the CS3 BLER. The
window size is expressed as a number of DL RLC data blocks.

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

512

32

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1092 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.297 (TBF_CS4_BLER_PERIOD) - (TBF_CS4_BLER_PERIOD)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TBF_CS4_BLER_PERIOD

Logical Name

TBF_CS4_BLER_PERIOD

Definition

Defines the window size required to estimate the CS4 BLER. The
window size is expressed as a number of DL RLC data blocks.

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

512

32

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1093 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.298 (TBF_DL_INIT_CS) - (TBF_DL_INIT_CS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TBF_DL_INIT_CS

Logical Name

TBF_DL_INIT_CS

Definition

Value of the downlink coding scheme when the link adaptation


algorithm is disabled or initial value (i.e. at TBF start or in case of TBF
resumption with CS_MAX_IDLE_PERIOD expiry) of the downlink
coding scheme when the link adaptation algorithm is enabled.

Coding rules

0 : CS1, 1 : CS2, 2 : CS3, 3 : CS4

Mandatory rules

TBF_DL_INIT_CS <= MAX_GPRS_CS

Recommended rules

In order to avoid establishing too many GCHs during


the "short data" MS transfer phases, it is recommended
that MAX [MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_DL,
MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_UL] <= MIN [TBF_DL_INIT_CS,
TBF_UL_INIT_CS] in all the cells of the MFS. This rule also tends
to reduce the TBF blocking rate in the MFS (by recommending low
values for MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_DL/UL) and to simplify
the MFS configuration.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / RLC/MAC

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1094 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.299 (TBF_MCS_DL) - (TBF_MCS_DL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TBF_MCS_DL

Logical Name

TBF_MCS_DL

Definition

Threshold defining the number of consecutive EGPRS PACKET


DOWNLINK ACK/NACK not received above which the MCS of a DL
acknowledged or unacknowledged DL TBF is changed to MCS-1.

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

12

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / E-GPRS

External Comment

If the EGPRS traffic is carried through Abis terrestrial link and Ater
terrestrial link, in case where EGPRS_N3105_LIMIT < TBF_MCS_DL
then the loss of consecutive EGPRS Packet DL ACK/NACK will
not trigger link adaptation but TBF release.If the EGPRS traffic is
carried through Abis satellitel link or Ater satellite link, in case where
EGPRS_N3105_LIMIT_SATELLITE < TBF_MCS_DL then the loss
of consecutive EGPRS Packet DL ACK/NACK will not trigger link
adaptation but TBF release.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1095 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.300 (TBF_MCS_UL) - (TBF_MCS_UL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TBF_MCS_UL

Logical Name

TBF_MCS_UL

Definition

Threshold defining the maximum number of consecutive times the


network receives an invalid UL RLC data block or nothing from the
MS having a monoslot EGPRS TBF before changing the coding
scheme to MCS1. For a multislot EGPRS TBF, TBF_MCS_UL_limit
:= TBF_MCS_UL x n_allocated_timeslots.

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

192

32

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / E-GPRS

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1096 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.301 (TBF_UL_INIT_CS) - (TBF_UL_INIT_CS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TBF_UL_INIT_CS

Logical Name

TBF_UL_INIT_CS

Definition

Value of the uplink coding scheme when the link adaptation algorithm
is disabled or initial value (i.e. at TBF start or in case of TBF
resumption with CS_MAX_IDLE_PERIOD expiry) of the uplink
coding scheme when the link adaptation algorithm is enabled.

Coding rules

0 : CS1, 1 : CS2, 2 : CS3, 3 : CS4

Mandatory rules

TBF_UL_INIT_CS <= MAX_GPRS_CS

Recommended rules

In order to avoid establishing too many GCHs during


the "short data" MS transfer phases, it is recommended
that MAX [MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_DL,
MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_UL] <= MIN [TBF_DL_INIT_CS,
TBF_UL_INIT_CS] in all the cells of the MFS. This rule also tends
to reduce the TBF blocking rate in the MFS (by recommending low
values for MAX_GPRS_CS_SHORT_DATA_DL/UL) and to simplify
the MFS configuration.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / RLC/MAC

External Comment

Exception cases apply for uplink TBF establishment on PACCH when


link adaptation is enabled.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1097 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.302 (THR_NC2_LOAD_RANKING) - (THR_NC2_LOAD_RANKING)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THR_NC2_LOAD_RANKING

Logical Name

THR_NC2_LOAD_RANKING

Definition

Threshold above which the load of the serving cell is considered in a


high load situation in the NC2 cell ranking process

Coding rules

Step size of 10%0 : 0%; 1: 10%; . 10 : 100%

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

This parameter is only relevant if the parameter


NETWORK_CONTROL_ORDER is set to "2: NC2 mode
of operation for R99 onwards MS" or "3: NC2 mode of operation
for all MS".The serving cell is considered in a low load situation
when THR_NC2_LOAD_RANKING = 0 %. The value of 0 %
deactivates the load evaluation in the serving cell.The load situation
of external cells is unknown in the serving cell. The BSS then
computes the NC2 load of those cells as follows:- If the threshold
THR_NC2_LOAD_RANKING is set to a value lower than 100 %,
then the cell is considered in a low load situation.- If the threshold
THR_NC2_LOAD_RANKING is set to 100 %, then the cell is
considered in an high load situation

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1098 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.303 (TOM8_PRIORITY) - (TOM8_PRIORITY)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TOM8_PRIORITY

Logical Name

TOM8_PRIORITY

Definition

Defines the relative priority used for the pre-defined TOM8 Packet
Flow Context

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1099 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.304 (TX_EFFICIENCY_ACK_THR) - (TX_EFFICIENCY_ACK_THR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TX_EFFICIENCY_ACK_THR

Logical Name

TX_EFFICIENCY_ACK_THR

Definition

Threshold below which the TBF is released because of a bad


transmission efficiency in acknowledged mode.

Coding rules

step size = 1%

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Reselection 2/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1100 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.305 (TX_EFFICIENCY_NACK_THR) - (TX_EFFICIENCY_NACK_THR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TX_EFFICIENCY_NACK_THR

Logical Name

TX_EFFICIENCY_NACK_THR

Definition

Threshold below which the TBF is released because of a bad


transmission efficiency in unacknowledged mode.

Coding rules

step size = 1%

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Reselection 2/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1101 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.306 (TX_EFFICIENCY_PERIOD) - (TX_EFFICIENCY_PERIOD)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TX_EFFICIENCY_PERIOD

Logical Name

TX_EFFICIENCY_PERIOD

Definition

Number of received RLC data blocks for GPRS TBF after which
TX_EFFICIENCY is computed.

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

500

200

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Reselection 2/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1102 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.307 (TX_INT) - (TX_INT)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TX_INT

Logical Name

TX_INT

Definition

Number of PRACH timeslots to spread transmission of PACKET


CHANNEL REQUEST.

Coding rules

Possible values are : 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20, 25,


32, 50, coded from 0000 to 1111

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

It is recommended to set TX_INT so that the corresponding


spreading time is about 240 ms.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

50

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Master channel 1/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1103 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.308 (TX_INTEGER) - (Tx_integer (MFS))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TX_INTEGER

Logical Name

Tx_integer (MFS)

Definition

Number of RACH timeslots that spread transmission of CHANNEL


REQUEST.

Coding rules

Possible values are:3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 14, 16, 20, 25, 32,
50 respectively binary coded from 0000 to 1111

Mandatory rules

Equal to Tx_Integer (BSC)

Recommended rules

When the GPRS is supported through Abis or Ater terrestrial


links, it is recommended to set:TX_INTEGER = 32 if the CCCH
is not combined, i.e. CCCH_CONF = 0TX_INTEGER = 12 if the
CCCH is combined, i.e. CCCH_CONF = 1.When the GPRS is
supported through Abis or Ater satellite links, it is recommended to
set:TX_INTEGER = 32 whatever the configuration of the CCCH.The
number of slots belonging to the MSs RACH between 2 successive
Channel Request messages is a random value drawn randomly
for each new retransmission with uniform distribution in the set
(S, S+1, ...,S+T-1). With T = Tx_Integer and S depending on the
CCCH configuration as shown below:1) for non combined CCCH:Tx_Integer = 3, 8, 14, 50 > S = 55 RACH frames (i.e. 253.8
ms)- Tx_Integer = 4, 9, 16 > S = 76 RACH frames (i.e. 349.6
ms)- Tx_Integer = 5, 10, 20 > S = 109 RACH frames (i.e. 501.4
ms)- Tx_Integer = 6, 11, 25 > S = 163 RACH frames (i.e. 749.8
ms)Tx_Integer = 7, 12, 32 > S = 217 RACH frames (i.e. 998.2 ms)2)
for combined CCCH:- Tx_Integer = 3, 8, 14, 50 > S = 41 RACH
frames (i.e. 357.5 ms)- Tx_Integer = 4, 9, 16 > S = 52 RACH frames
(i.e. 453.4 ms)- Tx_Integer = 5, 10, 20 > S = 58 RACH frames (i.e.
505.7 ms)- Tx_Integer = 6, 11, 25 > S = 86 RACH frames (i.e.
749.9 ms)- Tx_Integer = 7, 12, 32 > S = 115 RACH frames (i.e.
1002.8 ms)Note: - In the non-combined CCCH configuration, there
are 51 RACH frames per 51-multiframe- In the combined CCCH
configuration, there are 27 RACH frames per 51-multiframe.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

50

32

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: PAG

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / RACH Ctrl

1104 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

External Comment

When EN_GPRS=1, it is recommended to set: TX_INTEGER = 32 if


the CCCH is not combined, i.e. CCCH_CONF = 0TX_INTEGER =
12 if the CCCH is combined, i.e. CCCH_CONF = 1

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1105 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.309 (Wait Indication for Packet Access Reject) - (WI_PR)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Wait Indication for Packet Access Reject

Logical Name

WI_PR

Definition

Wait indication used in IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT REJECT or


PACKET ACCESS REJECT, when not in PMU CPU overload
situation.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

WI_PR <= WI_PR_CPU_OVERLOAD.

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

255

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: GPR

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / Connection Control 2/2

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1106 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.310 (Wait Indication for Packet Access Reject when CPU overload)
- (WI_PR_CPU_OVERLOAD)
Parameter Name

HMI Name

Wait Indication for Packet Access Reject when


CPU overload

Logical Name

WI_PR_CPU_OVERLOAD

Definition

Wait indication used in IMMEDIATE ASSIGNMENT REJECT or


PACKET ACCESS REJECT, when in PMU CPU overload situation.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

WI_PR <= WI_PR_CPU_OVERLOAD.

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

255

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1107 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.311 (Weight_P10) - (Weight_P10)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Weight_P10

Logical Name

Weight_P10

Definition

Weight to be used for a TBF/PFC of priority 10

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

weight_Px >= weight_Py if x<y

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1108 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.312 (Weight_P11) - (Weight_P11)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Weight_P11

Logical Name

Weight_P11

Definition

Weight to be used for a TBF/PFC of priority 11

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

weight_Px >= weight_Py if x<y

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1109 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.313 (Weight_P12) - (Weight_P12)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Weight_P12

Logical Name

Weight_P12

Definition

Weight to be used for a TBF/PFC of priority 12

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

weight_Px >= weight_Py if x<y

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1110 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.314 (Weight_P13) - (Weight_P13)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Weight_P13

Logical Name

Weight_P13

Definition

Weight to be used for a TBF/PFC of priority 13

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

weight_Px >= weight_Py if x<y

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1111 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.315 (Weight_P14) - (Weight_P14)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Weight_P14

Logical Name

Weight_P14

Definition

Weight to be used for a TBF/PFC of priority 14

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

weight_Px >= weight_Py if x<y

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1112 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.316 (Weight_P15) - (Weight_P15)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Weight_P15

Logical Name

Weight_P15

Definition

Weight to be used for a TBF/PFC of priority 15

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

weight_Px >= weight_Py if x<y

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1113 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.317 (Weight_P4) - (Weight_P4)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Weight_P4

Logical Name

Weight_P4

Definition

Weight to be used for a TBF/PFC of priority 4

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

weight_Px >= weight_Py if x<y

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

12

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1114 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.318 (Weight_P5) - (Weight_P5)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Weight_P5

Logical Name

Weight_P5

Definition

Weight to be used for a TBF/PFC of priority 5

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

weight_Px >= weight_Py if x<y

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

11

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1115 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.319 (Weight_P6) - (Weight_P6)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Weight_P6

Logical Name

Weight_P6

Definition

Weight to be used for a TBF/PFC of priority 6

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

weight_Px >= weight_Py if x<y

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1116 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.320 (Weight_P7) - (Weight_P7)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Weight_P7

Logical Name

Weight_P7

Definition

Weight to be used for a TBF/PFC of priority 7

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

weight_Px >= weight_Py if x<y

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1117 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.321 (Weight_P8) - (Weight_P8)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Weight_P8

Logical Name

Weight_P8

Definition

Weight to be used for a TBF/PFC of priority 8

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

weight_Px >= weight_Py if x<y

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1118 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

5.2.322 (Weight_P9) - (Weight_P9)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Weight_P9

Logical Name

Weight_P9

Definition

Weight to be used for a TBF/PFC of priority 9

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

weight_Px >= weight_Py if x<y

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1119 / 1182

5 GPRS Telecom Parameters

1120 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1121 / 1182

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.1 Network (CDE)


6.1.1 (EN_DL_RETRANS_BTS) - (EN_DL_RETRANS_BTS)
Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_DL_RETRANS_BTS

Logical Name

EN_DL_RETRANS_BTS

Definition

This flag enables / disables downlink retransmission in the BTS.

Coding rules

0 : disabled, 1 : enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

DL retransmission in the BTS will be disabled by the MFS in the


cells mapped to non Evolium BTSs or in cells having an Abis or an
Ater satellite link (whatever the TRE type G3 or G4). In a cell with
terrestrial Abis and Ater links, this feature is disabled for G3 TREs
only.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1122 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.1.2 (MIN_THROUGHPUT_GAIN) - (MIN_THROUGHPUT_GAIN)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MIN_THROUGHPUT_GAIN

Logical Name

MIN_THROUGHPUT_GAIN

Definition

Minimum throughput gain required to be provided to the MS when


performing a T2 or T3 TBF reallocation.

Coding rules

step size = 0,1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

0,1

0,3

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Increasing the value of this parameter above 0,3 might block some
reallocations for mobiles having a high multislot class (multislot class
>= 30).

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1123 / 1182

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.1.3 (N_GCH_FAST_PS_ACCESS) - (N_GCH_FAST_PS_ACCESS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

N_GCH_FAST_PS_ACCESS

Logical Name

N_GCH_FAST_PS_ACCESS

Definition

Two definitions are possible : - If EN_FAST_INITIAL_GPRS_ACCESS


= "enabled" : number of GCHs required to be
established due to the "Fast Initial PS Access" feature, - If
EN_FAST_INITIAL_GPRS_ACCESS = "disabled" : number of GCHs
to keep established when there is no more (E)GPRS traffic in a cell
(while the T_GCH_INACTIVITY_LAST timer is running). Those
GCHs will be useful in case of (E)GPRS traffic resumption in the cell.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

MFS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

This parameter is significant only for Evolium BTSs

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1124 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.2 Site (CAE)


6.2.1 (ALLOW_DTM_EDA_COMBINATION) (ALLOW_DTM_EDA_COMBINATION)
Parameter Name

HMI Name

ALLOW_DTM_EDA_COMBINATION

Logical Name

ALLOW_DTM_EDA_COMBINATION

Definition

Allows EDA operations for mobile stations in DTM mode.

Coding rules

0: the usage of EDA for mobile stations in DTM mode is not allowed,1:
the usage of EDA for mobile stations in DTM mode is allowed.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

This flag is relevant only if DTM and EDA are both activated.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1125 / 1182

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.2.2 (BEP_PERIOD) - (BEP_PERIOD)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

BEP_PERIOD

Logical Name

BEP_PERIOD

Definition

Filter constant for EGPRS channel quality measurements.

Coding rules

coded on 4 bits as follows:0: 11: 22: 33: 44: 55: 76: 107: 128: 159:
2010: 2511: Reserved for future use12: Reserved for future use13:
Reserved for future use14: Reserved for future use15: Reserved for
future use

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

25

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: ?

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / Cell Information / Cell Description

External Comment

The BEP_PERIOD parameter defines the forgetting factor used in


the MEAN_BEP and CV_BEP averaging at the MS side.In case of
cell without frequency hopping and without "fast" mobiles (i.e. not
motorway or TGV coverage), it is advised to set a higher value (e.g.
25) in order to avoid spurious MCS changes causing higher BLER
and throughput loss.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1126 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.2.3 (E_TX_EFFICIENCY_PERIOD) - (E_TX_EFFICIENCY_PERIOD)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

E_TX_EFFICIENCY_PERIOD

Logical Name

E_TX_EFFICIENCY_PERIOD

Definition

Number of received radio blocks for an EGPRS TBF after which


E_TX_EFFICIENCY is computed.

Coding rules

step size = 1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

500

200

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: ?

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / GPRS / E-GPRS

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1127 / 1182

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.2.4 (EDA_MS_ACTIVATION_LEVEL) - (EDA_MS_ACTIVATION_LEVEL)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EDA_MS_ACTIVATION_LEVEL

Logical Name

EDA_MS_ACTIVATION_LEVEL

Definition

Activation level of Extended Dynamic Allocation (EDA).

Coding rules

0: EDA activated for all mobile stations (supporting the feature),1:


EDA activated for R99-onwards mobile stations (supporting the
feature),2: EDA activated for Rel-4-onwards mobile stations
(supporting the feature).

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

-This parameter is relevant only if EDA is activated (EN_EDA


parameter).-The activation level may provide an artificial mean to
limit the inter-operability risks due to mobile stations with uncorrect
EDA implementation (EDA is a R97 feature but has been completely
clarified in Rel-6). R99 is detected through the Revision Level
Indicator. A mobile station is considered Rel-4onwards compliant if
it indicates the field "GERAN Feature Package 1" in its MS Radio
Access Capability.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1128 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.2.5 (EGPRS_N3105_LIMIT) - (EGPRS_N3105_LIMIT)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EGPRS_N3105_LIMIT

Logical Name

EGPRS_N3105_LIMIT

Definition

For a DL EGPRS TBF, if the EGPRS traffic is carried through Abis


terrestrial link and Ater terrestrial link, this parameter defines the
maximum number of expected Packet Downlink ACK/NACK or Packet
Control Acknowledgement messages consecutively lost on the radio
interface, before triggering an abnormal release of the DL TBF. This
parameter is used in conjunction with the MIN_RLF_TIME_DL delay
to decide if the DL TBF shall be released.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

32

20

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

If EGPRS_N3105_LIMIT < TBF_MCS_DL then the loss of


consecutive packet DL ACK/NACK will not trigger link adaptation but
TBF release. EGPRS_N3105_Limit has to be set in order not to
release a DL TBF in case of transient bad radio conditions.The polling
frequency depends on Ack_factor, T_DL_EGPRS_MeasReport, MS
multislot class and on the number of TBFs per PDCH.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1129 / 1182

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.2.6 (EGPRS_N3105_LIMIT_SATELLITE) (EGPRS_N3105_LIMIT_SATELLITE)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EGPRS_N3105_LIMIT_SATELLITE

Logical Name

EGPRS_N3105_LIMIT_SATELLITE

Definition

For a DL EGPRS TBF, if the EGPRS traffic is carried through Abis


satellite link or Ater satellite link, this parameter defines the maximum
number of expected Packet Downlink ACK/NACK or Packet Control
Acknowledgement messages consecutively lost on the radio
interface, before triggering an abnormal release of the DL TBF. This
parameter is used in conjunction with the MIN_RLF_TIME_DL delay
to decide if the DL TBF shall be released.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

32

24

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

External Comment

If EGPRS_N3105_LIMIT_SATELLITE < TBF_MCS_DL then the


loss of consecutive packet DL ACK/NACK will not trigger link
adaptation but TBF release. EGPRS_N3105_Limit_Satellite has
to be set in order not to release a DL TBF in case of transient bad
radio conditions.The polling frequency depends on Ack_factor,
T_DL_EGPRS_MeasReport, MS multislot class and on the number
of TBFs per PDCH.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1130 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.2.7 (EN_EDA) - (EN_EDA)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_EDA

Logical Name

EN_EDA

Definition

Enables Extended Dynamic Allocation (EDA).

Coding rules

0: EDA not activated,1: EDA activated

Mandatory rules

EN_EDA = 0 in case of not Evolium BTSEN_EDA = 0 in case of


extended cell

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

When EDA is activated, its activation domain is


given by the EDA_MS_ACTIVATION_LEVEL and
ALLOW_DTM_EDA_COMBINATION parameters.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1131 / 1182

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.2.8 (EN_IR_UL) - (EN_IR_UL_per_cell)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_IR_UL

Logical Name

EN_IR_UL_per_cell

Definition

Enables/Disables Incremental redundancy for the uplink TBF in the


BSS.

Coding rules

0: Disable, 1: Enable

Mandatory rules

Can be enabled only if BTS Generation = G4

Recommended rules

Among the features Incremental Redundancy in uplink (EN_IR_UL)


and RLC resegmentation in uplink (EN_RESEGMENTATION_UL),
Alcatel recommends to enable first the Incremental Redundancy in
Uplink. The activation of both at the same time may reduce the gain
of the Incremental Redundancy

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

The Incremental Redundancy for the uplink TBF feature is supported


only on G4 BTSs.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1132 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.2.9 (EN_MCS1_in_CRP) - (EN_MCS1_in_CRP)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_MCS1_in_CRP

Logical Name

EN_MCS1_in_CRP

Definition

Enables the forced usage of MCS-1 for uplink EGPRS TBF in


contention resolution phase at one-phase access to make this phase
more robust.

Coding rules

0: the BSS does not force uplink EGPRS TBF to use MCS-1 during
the contention resolution phase at one-phase access.1: the BSS
forces uplink EGPRS TBF to use MCS-1 during the contention
resolution phase at one-phase access.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

The forced usage of MCS-1 for uplink EGPRS TBF in contention


resolution phase at one-phase access corresponds to the behaviour
in B9.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1133 / 1182

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.2.10 (EN_RESEGMENTATION_UL) (EN_RESEGMENTATION_UL_per_cell)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_RESEGMENTATION_UL

Logical Name

EN_RESEGMENTATION_UL_per_cell

Definition

Enables/Disables the resegmentation for the uplink TBF in the cell, in


case of RLC in acknowledged mode.

Coding rules

0: Disabled, 1: Enabled

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Among the features Incremental Redundancy in uplink (EN_IR_UL)


and RLC resegmentation in uplink (EN_RESEGMENTATION_UL),
Alcatel recommends to enable first the Incremental Redundancy in
Uplink. The activation of both at the same time may reduce the gain
of the Incremental Redundancy

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1134 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.2.11 (N_ATER_TS_MARGIN_GPU) - (N_ATER_TS_MARGIN_GPU)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

N_ATER_TS_MARGIN_GPU

Logical Name

N_ATER_TS_MARGIN_GPU

Definition

Number of free 64k Ater TSs that are kept "in reserve" in order to be
able to serve some prioritary requests in cells managed by the GPU.
The prioritary requests are the GCH establishment requests launched
when the first TBF has to be established in a cell (useful to guarantee
that MM traffic will be supported in any cell at any time).Note : In
case of non-Evolium BTS, those are PDCHs that will be established
instead of GCHs.In case N_ATER_TS_MARGIN_GPU = 0, then no
Ater margin is managed.In case N_ATER_TS_MARGIN_GPU > 0,
RRM will ensure that N_ATER_TS_MARGIN_GPU 64k Ater TSs are
always free (i.e. not used by a GCH in the GPU). From then on, only
prioritary requests will be allowed to establish some GCHs (Evolium
BTS) / PDCHs (non-Evolium BTS) with those Ater resources.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

10

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

- Increasing the value of N_ATER_TS_MARGIN_GPU will make


the average number of unused Ater nibbles in the GPU increase.
That corresponds to a loss of Ater resources on the field, as the
on-going TBF traffic will never "benefit from the margin of Ater
resources". But, on the other hand, the likelihood of not serving a
prioritary request in the GPU will be become very low.- Decreasing
the value of N_ATER_TS_MARGIN_GPU (to a non null value) will
make it possible that prioritary requests cannot be served in case
several such requests have to be served in a short period of time
(i.e. before having had the time to "fill the Ater margin" up again),
especially if the requests have to be served on several different
DSPs (one 64k Ater TS will be consumed by each DSP).- Setting
N_ATER_TS_MARGIN_GPU to 0 will make it possible the cases
where prioritary requests cannot be served at all.

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1135 / 1182

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1136 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.2.12 (N_UL_BIAS_FOR_EDA) - (N_UL_BIAS_FOR_EDA)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

N_UL_BIAS_FOR_EDA

Logical Name

N_UL_BIAS_FOR_EDA

Definition

Minimum number of significantly consecutive uplink biases observed


during a transfer to allow a mobile station to use Extended Dynamic
Allocation.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

64

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

This parameter can allow using EDA only in case of big UL transfers

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1137 / 1182

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.2.13 (T_DL_EGPRS_MeasReport) - (T_DL_EGPRS_MeasReport)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T_DL_EGPRS_MeasReport

Logical Name

T_DL_EGPRS_MeasReport

Definition

Time period to request for an EGPRS Packet Downlink Ack/Nack


with measurements.

Coding rules

step size = 20 ms

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

ms

60

3000

200

Modifiable

OMC Changes: None RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

???

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1138 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.2.14 (TBF_DL_INIT_MCS) - (TBF_DL_INIT_MCS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TBF_DL_INIT_MCS

Logical Name

TBF_DL_INIT_MCS

Definition

Value of the downlink modulation and coding scheme when the link
adaptation algorithm is disabled or initial value (i.e. at TBF start or in
case of TBF resumption with CS_MAX_IDLE_PERIOD expiry) of the
downlink modulation and coding scheme when the link adaptation
algorithm is enabled.

Coding rules

0 : MCS-1 1 : MCS-2 2 : MCS-3 3 : MCS-4 4 : MCS-5 5 : MCS-6 6


: MCS-7 7 : MCS-8 8 : MCS-9

Mandatory rules

TBF_DL_INIT_MCS <= MAX_EGPRS_MCS

Recommended rules

In order to avoid establishing too many GCHs during


the "short data" MS transfer phases, it is recommended
that MAX [MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_DL,
MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_UL] <= MIN
[TBF_DL_INIT_MCS, TBF_UL_INIT_MCS] in all the cells
of the MFS. This rule also tends to reduce the TBF
blocking rate in the MFS (by recommending low values for
MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_DL/UL) and to simplify the MFS
configuration.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / RLC/MAC

External Comment

The parameter is significant only if EN_EGPRS is enabled

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1139 / 1182

6 E-GPRS Telecom Parameters

6.2.15 (TBF_UL_INIT_MCS) - (TBF_UL_INIT_MCS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TBF_UL_INIT_MCS

Logical Name

TBF_UL_INIT_MCS

Definition

Value of the uplink modulation and coding scheme when the link
adaptation algorithm is disabled or initial value (i.e. at TBF start or
in case of TBF resumption with CS_MAX_IDLE_PERIOD expiry) of
the uplink modulation and coding scheme when the link adaptation
algorithm is enabled.

Coding rules

0 : MCS-1 1 : MCS-2 2 : MCS-3 3 : MCS-44 : MCS-55 : MCS-66 :


MCS-77 : MCS-88 : MCS-9

Mandatory rules

TBF_UL_INIT_MCS <= MAX_EGPRS_MCS

Recommended rules

In order to avoid establishing too many GCHs during


the "short data" MS transfer phases, it is recommended
that MAX [MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_DL,
MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_UL] <= MIN
[TBF_DL_INIT_MCS, TBF_UL_INIT_MCS] in all the cells
of the MFS. This rule also tends to reduce the TBF
blocking rate in the MFS (by recommending low values for
MAX_EGPRS_MCS_SHORT_DATA_DL/UL) and to simplify the MFS
configuration.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: No

Parameter Access

Edit Cell / GPRS / RLC/MAC

External Comment

The parameter is significant only if EN_EGPRS is enabled. Exception


cases apply for uplink TBF establishment on PACCH when link
adaptation is enabled.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1140 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

7 DTM Telecom Parameters

7 DTM Telecom Parameters

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1141 / 1182

7 DTM Telecom Parameters

7.1 Site (CAE)


7.1.1 (EN_DTM) - (EN_DTM)
Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_DTM

Logical Name

EN_DTM

Definition

Enables/disables the support of dual transfer mode

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

EN_DTM may be set to 1 only if :-The cell is mapped on an Evolium


BTS-CELL_RANGE = 0-MAX_PDCH_HIGH_LOAD > 1

Recommended rules

To get full benefit of DTM feature, a Gs interface shall be present,


and Network_Operation_Mode shall be set to 1 (NMO 1). However,
DTM is still possible with NMO2 or NMO3.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

((E)GPRS is mandatory for DTM operation, and at least 2 PDCHs


are required in the PS zone for allocation of DTM resources to (at
least) one DTM call, therefore, MAX_PDCH_HIGH_LOAD shall at
least be equal to 2.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1142 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

7 DTM Telecom Parameters

7.1.2 (MAX_LAPDM) - (MAX_LAPDM)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

MAX_LAPDM

Logical Name

MAX_LAPDM

Definition

Maximum number of LAPDm frames on which a layer 3 can be


segmented into and be sent on the main DCCH.

Coding rules

Coded on 3 bits:000 : 5001 : 6.111 : 12

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

12

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1143 / 1182

7 DTM Telecom Parameters

1144 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1145 / 1182

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.1 Network (CDE)


8.1.1 (CGI_3G_REQUIRED) - (CGI_3G_REQD)
Parameter Name

HMI Name

CGI_3G_REQUIRED

Logical Name

CGI_3G_REQD

Definition

Controls format of 3G cell identifications sent to the MSC.

Coding rules

0: CGI not used, 1: CGI used

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Alcatel recommend to set the CGI_3G_REQD parameter to 1


provided that the MSC supports the CGI format. The CGI_3G_REQD
parameter shall be set to 1 if the operator wants to allow inter-PLMN
2G to 2G handovers. If this parameter needs to be changed, it is
recommended to change it during a migration phase to avoid any
additional Telecom outage.

Category

Network (CDE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Depends on MSC Type. The value indicated here is for


implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1146 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2 Site (CAE)


8.2.1 (A_ECNO_HO) - (A_ECNO_HO)
Parameter Name

HMI Name

A_ECNO_HO

Logical Name

A_ECNO_HO

Definition

Window size for Ec/No level averages for 2G to 3G handover

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

Samfr

31

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

Single

Umbrella

Concentric

Concentric Umbrella

Microcell

Minicell

Extended inner cell

Extended outer cell

Nb of TRX Dependent

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

No

1147 / 1182

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.2 (Cell Capacity Class) - (CELL_CAPACITY_CLASS)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Cell Capacity Class

Logical Name

CELL_CAPACITY_CLASS

Definition

Capacity class of the cell, measured on a linear scale, ranging from 1


to 100.

Coding rules

binary value on 8 bits

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

the Cell Capacity Class shall follow the recommended rule: "In order
to fulfill the 3GPP requirement of having a linear scale in the capacity
class, ranging from 1 to 100:Cell Capacity Class is a linear function
of the Cell capacity: value 1 shall indicate the minimum capacity
class, and 100 shall indicate the maximum capacity class. Capacity
class should be measured on a linear scale.The default value of Cell
Capacity Class should depend on the number of available TCHs in
the cell and since there may be up to 126 TCH channels in one GSM
cell:Cell_Capacity_Class = int{[(99/125) x (NTCH - 1)] + 1}where
NTCH is the number of all TCH channels in the Cell."

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1148 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.3 (CI_3G(n)) - (CI_3G(n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

CI_3G(n)

Logical Name

CI_3G(n)

Definition

This parameter indicates the Cell Identifier of a 3G cell as defined


in 3GPP TS 25.401

Coding rules

Binary value on 16 bitsThe value of "-1" indicates that no cell


identifier is provided by the operator (the default value, indicated
here, is for implementation purposes).

Mandatory rules

MCC_3G(n), MNC_3G(n), RNC_ID(n) and CI_3G(n) shall together


uniquely identify a 3G cellCI_3G(n) is a mandatory parameter (must
be different from "-1")

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

3G cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

65535

-1

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

The default value indicated here is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1149 / 1182

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.4 (EN_2G_3G_HO_NO_SERVICE_HO) (EN_2G_3G_HO_NO_SERVICE_HO)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_2G_3G_HO_NO_SERVICE_HO

Logical Name

EN_2G_3G_HO_NO_SERVICE_HO

Definition

Allows handovers towards 3G cells for a given MS when I.E. Service


Handover is missing and the load in the serving cell is high (see
THR_CELL_LOAD_3G_REQ

Coding rules

0 : disable, 1 : enable

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1150 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.5 (EN_2G_TO_3G_CELL_RESELECTION) (EN_2G_TO_3G_CELL_RESELECTION)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_2G_TO_3G_CELL_RESELECTION

Logical Name

EN_2G_TO_3G_CELL_RESELECTION

Definition

Enables/Disables the GSM to UTRAN FDD cell reselections and


defines the 3G search activation mode for MS in GMM Ready state.

Coding rules

0: Disabled1: Enabled with 3G search activated while the UE/MS


is in GMM ready state,2: Enabled with 3G search deactivated
while the UE/MS is in GMM ready state.3: Enabled with 3G
search activated while the UE/MS is in GMM ready state, even if
Network_Control_Order > 1

Mandatory rules

EN_2G_3G_CELL_RESELECTION and
EN_2G_3GTDD_CELL_RESELECTION shall not be
<>0 at the same time.1) for Non Evolium serving cell
: The cell neighborhood for reselection is controlled
by EN_2G_TO_3G_CELL_RESELECTION value and
FDD_ARFCN_LIST content.- if the neighborhood of the serving
cell for reselection is 2G only, then there can be up to 32 different
BCCH 2G frequencies for the set of all the target cells.- if the
neighborhood of the serving cell for reselection is mixed 2G/3G,
and if all 2G frequencies can be encoded in the SI2 or SI2bis
message, and if the SI2ter message is used to encode only
3G frequencies, then there shall be no more than 31 different
BCCH 2G frequencies for the set of all the target cells.2) For
Evolium serving cell : The cell neighborhood for reselection is
controlled by EN_2G_TO_3G_CELL_RESELECTION value and
FDD_ARFCN_LIST content.- if the neighborhood of the serving
cell for reselection is 2G only, or mixed 2G/3G, then there can be
up to 32 different

Recommended rules

The support of extended BCCH (parameter BCCH_EXT) is HIGHLY


recommended in cells having adjacent cells in several frequency
bands and at least 18 adjacent frequencies within the same
band.Value 3 should be used only in case of good 3G FDD coverage.

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1151 / 1182

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

External Comment

If the NETWORK_CONTROL_ORDER is set to "NC2 mode of


operation for R99 onwards MS" or "NC2 mode of operation for
all MS", then the 3G search is systematically deactivated when
activating the NC2 mode through the Packet Measurement Order
[NC2] message. If EN_2G_TO_3G_CELL_RESELECTION =
"Enabled with 3G search activated while the UE/MS is in GMM
ready state, even if Network_Control_Order > 1", then the 3G
search is activated even when activating the NC2 mode (the Packet
Measurement Order [NC2] message will not be sent.)

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1152 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.6 (EN_2G_TO_3GTDD_CELL_RESELECTION) (EN_2G_TO_3GTDD_CELL_RESELECTION)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_2G_TO_3GTDD_CELL_RESELECTION

Logical Name

EN_2G_TO_3GTDD_CELL_RESELECTION

Definition

Enables/Disables the GSM to UTRAN TD-SCDMA cell reselections


and defines the 3G search activation mode for MS in GMM Ready
state.

Coding rules

0: Disabled1: Enabled with 3G search activated while the UE/MS


is in GMM ready state,2: Enabled with 3G search deactivated
while the UE/MS is in GMM ready state.3: Enabled with 3G
search activated while the UE/MS is in GMM ready state, even if
Network_Control_Order > 1

Mandatory rules

In front of non-Evolium cells, the parameter value shall


be forced to 0.EN_2G_3G_CELL_RESELECTION and
EN_2G_3GTDD_CELL_RESELECTION shall not be <>0 at the
same time.

Recommended rules

The support of extended BCCH (parameter BCCH_EXT) is HIGHLY


recommended in cells

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

If EN_2G_3GTDD_CELL_RESELECTION < 3, and If the


NETWORK_CONTROL_ORDER is set to "NC2 mode of operation
for R99 onwards MS" or "NC2 mode of operation for Rel4 onwards
MS" or "NC2 mode of operation for all MS", the 3G search is
systematically deactivated when activating the NC2 mode through
the Packet Measurement Order [NC2] message. This 3G search
deactivation is then performed independently of the value of the
EN_2G_TO_3GTDD_CELL_RESELECTION parameter.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1153 / 1182

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.7 (EN_3G_DIVERSITY(n)) - (EN_3G_DIVERSITY(n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_3G_DIVERSITY(n)

Logical Name

EN_3G_DIVERSITY(n)

Definition

This parameter indicates if diversity is applied for the cell

Coding rules

1 bit: 0 diversity is not applied, 1 diversity is applied

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

3G cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1154 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.8 (EN_3G_HO) - (EN_3G_HO)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_3G_HO

Logical Name

EN_3G_HO

Definition

This flag enables/disables the 2G-3G handover

Coding rules

0: disabled, 1: enabled

Mandatory rules

1) For Non Evolium serving cell:The cell neighborhood for handover


is controlled by EN_3G_HO and FDD_ARFCN values.- since the
neighborhood of the serving cell for handover is 2G only, then there
can be up to 32 different

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

2G-3G Handover will be disabled by the BSS in cells mapped to


non Evolium BTSs

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1155 / 1182

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.9 (EN_COMPRESSED_INTER_RAT_INFO) (EN_COMPRESSED_INTER_RAT_INFO)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_COMPRESSED_INTER_RAT_INFO

Logical Name

EN_COMPRESSED_INTER_RAT_INFO

Definition

Allows sending by the MS of Compressed Inter-RAT HO information

Coding rules

0 : disable, 1 : enable

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Shall be set to 1 only if all RNCs neighbour to this BSS support the
feature.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1156 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.10 (EN_CPICH_2G_3G_RESELECTION) (EN_CPICH_2G_3G_RESELECTION)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_CPICH_2G_3G_RESELECTION

Logical Name

EN_CPICH_2G_3G_RESELECTION

Definition

Defines the CPICH measurements used in the 2G to 3G cell


reselection

Coding rules

0: Only 1 CPICH measurement is used1: CPICH Ec/No and RSCP


measurements must be used

Mandatory rules

This parameter can be set on 1 only if EN_2G_TO_3G_CELL_


RESELECTION <>0

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1157 / 1182

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.11 (EN_FAST_3G_RESELECTION) - (EN_FAST_3G_RESELECTION)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

EN_FAST_3G_RESELECTION

Logical Name

EN_FAST_3G_RESELECTION

Definition

Enables a fast 3G cell reselection at 2G CS call release.

Coding rules

0:fast 3G cell reselection at 2G CS call release is not used1:fast 3G


cell reselection at 2G CS call release is used

Mandatory rules

This parameter can be set to 1 only if EN_2G_TO_3G_CELL_


RESELECTION <>0.EN_FAST_3G_RESELECTION shall not be set
to 1 when EN_2G_TO_3GTDD_CELL_ RESELECTION is <>0.

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Flag

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1158 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.12 (FDD_ARFCN) - (FDD_ARFCN(n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

FDD_ARFCN

Logical Name

FDD_ARFCN(n)

Definition

Downlink FDD UTRAN Absolute Radio Frequency Numbers


(UARFCN)

Coding rules

The value of "-1" indicates that no UARFCNis provided by the


operator (the default value, indicated here, is for implementation
purposes).

Mandatory rules

For a given 2G cell, the maximum number of different FDD_ARFCN(n)


among all 2G to 3G adjacencies for handover is 3 FDD_ARFCN(n) is
a mandatory parameter (must be different from "-1")Only the following
downlink UARFCN ranges are standardized: I) 10562-10838 and II)
9662-9938 and III) 1162-1513 and IV) 1537-1738 andV) 4357-4458
andVI) 4387-4413 andVII) 2237- 2563 andVIII) 2937-3088 andIX)
9237-9387

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

3G cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

16383

-1

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

The default value indicated here is for implementation purposes.The


FDD UTRAN frequencies are coded as the UTRAN Absolute Radio
Frequency Numbers (UARFCN) on the Air interface.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1159 / 1182

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.13 (FDD_ARFCN_LIST) - (FDD_ARFCN_LIST(BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

FDD_ARFCN_LIST

Logical Name

FDD_ARFCN_LIST(BSC)

Definition

List of neighbour Downlink FDD UTRAN Absolute Radio Frequency


Numbers (UARFCN)

Coding rules

The value of "-1" indicates that no UARFCN is provided.

Mandatory rules

The defined frequencies (i.e. not set to -1) in the set shall be different.
Only the following downlink UARFCN ranges are standardized:
I) 10562-10838 and II) 9662-9938 and III) 1162-1513 and IV)
1537-1738 andV) 4357-4458 andVI) 4387-4413 andVII) 2237- 2563
andVIII) 2937-3088 andIX) 9237-9387

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

List of numbers

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

16383

-1

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: BSS

Parameter Access

Edit BSC / UMTS

External Comment

The FDD UTRAN frequencies are coded as the UTRAN Absolute


Radio Frequency Numbers (UARFCN) on the Air interface.The FDD
UARFCN of the 3G neighbour cells are broadcast on BCCH and on
PBCCH if there is a PBCCH allocated in the serving cell.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1160 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.14 (FDD_GPRS_Qoffset) - (FDD_GPRS_Qoffset)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

FDD_GPRS_Qoffset

Logical Name

FDD_GPRS_Qoffset

Definition

Offset added to the received level average of the serving cell and of
the neighbour GSM cells for UTRAN FDD cell re-selection in GPRS

Coding rules

Coded value (binary): Value (dB): Text displayed at the OMC0: -32:
Always select a 3G cell if possible1: -28: -28 dB2: -24: -24 dB3:
-20: -20 dB4: -16: -16 dB5: -12: -12 dB6: -8: -8 dB7: -4: -4 dB8:
0: 0 dB9: 4: 4 dB10: 8: 8 dB11: 12: 12 dB12: 16: 16 dB13: 20: 20
dB14: 24: 24 dB15: 28: 28 dB

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-32

28

-32

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

This parameter is broadcast on PBCCH if there is a PBCCH allocated


in the serving cell.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1161 / 1182

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.15 (FDD_MULTIRAT_REPORTING) - (FDD_MULTIRAT_REPORTING)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

FDD_MULTIRAT_REPORTING

Logical Name

FDD_MULTIRAT_REPORTING

Definition

Number of the strongest 3G cells to be reported by the MS in the


measurement report message

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

This parameter is broadcast on BCCH and on PBCCH if there is a


PBCCH allocated in the serving cell.This parameter is meaningful
only if EN_3G_HO is set to enabled. If disabled, this parameter is
considered as equal to zero (the MS shall report only 2G cells).This
parameter is also broadcast on SACCH.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1162 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.16 (FDD_Qmin) - (FDD_Qmin(BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

FDD_Qmin

Logical Name

FDD_Qmin(BSC)

Definition

Minimum threshold for Ec/Io for UTRAN FDD cell re-selection.

Coding rules

0 = -20 dB1 = -6 dB2 = -18 dB3 = -8dB4 = -16dB5 = -10dB6 =


-14dB7 = -12dB

Mandatory rules

Equal to FDD_Qmin(MFS)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-20

-6

-12

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit cell / UMTS

External Comment

This parameter is broadcast on BCCH and on PBCCH if there is a


PBCCH allocated in the serving cell.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1163 / 1182

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.17 (FDD_Qmin_Offset) - (FDD_Qmin_Offset)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

FDD_Qmin_Offset

Logical Name

FDD_Qmin_Offset

Definition

Applies an offset to FDD_Qmin value

Coding rules

coded on 3 bits:0 = 0 dB, 1 = 2 dB, 2 = 4 dB, 3 = 6 dB, 4 = 8 dB, 5


= 10 dB, 6 = 12 dB, 7 = 14 dB.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

14

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Available only if EN_CPICH_2G_3G_Reselection = 1

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1164 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.18 (FDD_Qoffset) - (FDD_Qoffset (BSC))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

FDD_Qoffset

Logical Name

FDD_Qoffset (BSC)

Definition

Offset added to the received level average of the serving cell and of
the neighbour GSM cells for UTRAN FDD cell re-selection.

Coding rules

Coded value (binary): Value (dB): Text displayed at the OMC0: -32:
Always select a 3G cell if possible1: -28: -28 dB2: -24: -24 dB3:
-20: -20 dB4: -16: -16 dB5: -12: -12 dB6: -8: -8 dB7: -4: -4 dB8:
0: 0 dB9: 4: 4 dB10: 8: 8 dB11: 12: 12 dB12: 16: 16 dB13: 20: 20
dB14: 24: 24 dB15: 28: 28 dB

Mandatory rules

Equal to FDD_Qoffset(MFS)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-32

28

-32

Modifiable

OMC Changes: PRC & SC RNO Changes: SEL

Parameter Access

Edit cell / UMTS

External Comment

This parameter is broadcast on BCCH and on PBCCH if there is a


PBCCH allocated in the serving cell.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1165 / 1182

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.19 (FDD_RSCPmin) - (FDD_RSCPmin)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

FDD_RSCPmin

Logical Name

FDD_RSCPmin

Definition

Minimum threshold of RSCP for UTRAN FDD cell re-selection.

Coding rules

coded on 4bits:0 = -114 dBm, 1 = -112 dBm, 2 = -110 dBm, 3 = -108


dBm, 4 = -106 dBm, 5 = -104 dBm, 6 = -102 dBm, 7 = -100 dBm, 8 =
-98 dBm, 9 = -96 dBm, 10 = -94 dBm, 11 = -92 dBm, 12 = -90 dBm,
13 = -88 dBm, 14 = -86 dBm, 15 = -84 dBm.

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-114

-84

-102

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Available only if EN_CPICH_2G_3G_Reselection=1

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1166 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.20 (LAC_3G(n)) - (LAC_3G(n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

LAC_3G(n)

Logical Name

LAC_3G(n)

Definition

This parameter indicates the Location Area Code as defined in 3GPP


TS 24.008. It is used in the HANDOVER COMMAND message

Coding rules

binary value on 16 bitsThe value of "-1" indicates that no LAC is


provided by the operator (the default value, indicated here, is for
implementation purposes).

Mandatory rules

LAC_3G(n) is a mandatory parameter (must be different from "-1")

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

3G cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

65535

-1

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

The default value indicated here is for implementation purposes

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1167 / 1182

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.21 (Qsearch_C) - (Qsearch_C)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Qsearch_C

Logical Name

Qsearch_C

Definition

Threshold for searching for 3G cells in dedicated mode depending


whether the received signal level of the serving cell is below or above
the threshold.

Coding rules

Coded value (binary): Value (dBm): Text displayed at the OMC0:


-98: -98 dBm (below)1: -94: -94 dBm (below)2: -90: -90dBm
(below)3: -86: -86dBm (below)4: -82: -82 dBm (below)5: -78: -78
dBm (below)6: -74: -74 dBm (below)7: -70: Always search for 3G
neighbour cells8: -78: -78 dBm (above)9: -74: -74 dBm (above)10:
-70: -70 dBm (above)11: -66: -66 dBm (above)12: -62: -62 dBm
(above)13: -58: -58 dBm (above)14: -54: -54 dBm (above)15: -50:
Never search for 3G neighbour cells

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

In a cell where at least one 2G to 3G adjacency has been defined,


Qsearch_C =-70, i.e. always search for 3G neighbour cells

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-98

-50

-70

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

This threshold is used to search for 3G cells if the received signal


level is below (-98 dBm to "always search for 3G neighbour cells")
or above (-78 dBm to "never search for neighbour cells") the
threshold.This parameter is broadcast on SACCH

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1168 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.22 (Qsearch_I) - (Qsearch_I)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Qsearch_I

Logical Name

Qsearch_I

Definition

Threshold for searching for 3G cells depending whether the received


level average of the serving cell is below or above the threshold.

Coding rules

Coded value (binary): Value (dBm): Text displayed at the OMC0:


-98: -98 dBm (below)1: -94: -94 dBm (below)2: -90: -90dBm
(below)3: -86: -86dBm (below)4: -82: -82 dBm (below)5: -78: -78
dBm (below)6: -74: -74 dBm (below)7: -70: Always search for 3G
neighbour cells8: -78: -78 dBm (above)9: -74: -74 dBm (above)10:
-70: -70 dBm (above)11: -66: -66 dBm (above)12: -62: -62 dBm
(above)13: -58: -58 dBm (above)14: -54: -54 dBm (above)15: -50:
Never search for 3G neighbour cells

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

In a cell with FDD_ARFCN_list not empty, Qsearch_I =-70, i.e.


always search for 3G neighbour cells

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-98

-50

-50

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

This threshold is used to search for 3G cells if the received signal


level is below (-98 dBm to "always search for 3G neighbour cells")
or above (-78 dBm to "never search for neighbour cells") the
threshold.This parameter is broadcast on BCCH

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1169 / 1182

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.23 (Qsearch_P) - (Qsearch_P)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Qsearch_P

Logical Name

Qsearch_P

Definition

Threshold for searching for 3G cells in GPRS depending whether


the received level average of the serving cell is below or above the
threshold

Coding rules

Coded value (binary): Value (dBm): Text displayed at the OMC0:


-98: -98 dBm (below)1: -94: -94 dBm (below)2: -90: -90dBm
(below)3: -86: -86dBm (below)4: -82: -82 dBm (below)5: -78: -78
dBm (below)6: -74: -74 dBm (below)7: -70: Always search for 3G
neighbour cells8: -78: -78 dBm (above)9: -74: -74 dBm (above)10:
-70: -70 dBm (above)11: -66: -66 dBm (above)12: -62: -62 dBm
(above)13: -58: -58 dBm (above)14: -54: -54 dBm (above)15: -50:
Never search for 3G neighbour cells

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

In a cell with FDD_ARFCN_list not empty, Qsearch_P =-70, i.e.


always search for 3G neighbour cells

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-98

-50

-50

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

This threshold is used to search for 3G cells if the received signal


level is below (-98 dBm to "always search for 3G neighbour cells") or
above (-78 dBm to "never search for neighbour cells") the threshold
in GPRS.This parameter is broadcast on BCCH and on PBCCH if
there is a PBCCH allocated in the serving cell.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1170 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.24 (Qsearch_P_PTM) - (Qsearch_P_PTM)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

Qsearch_P_PTM

Logical Name

Qsearch_P_PTM

Definition

Threshold for searching for 3G cells in GPRS packet transfer mode


depending whether the received level average of the serving cell
is below or above the threshold

Coding rules

Coded value (binary): Value (dBm): Text displayed at the OMC0:


-98: -98 dBm (below)1: -94: -94 dBm (below)2: -90: -90dBm
(below)3: -86: -86dBm (below)4: -82: -82 dBm (below)5: -78: -78
dBm (below)6: -74: -74 dBm (below)7: -70: Always search for 3G
neighbour cells8: -78: -78 dBm (above)9: -74: -74 dBm (above)10:
-70: -70 dBm (above)11: -66: -66 dBm (above)12: -62: -62 dBm
(above)13: -58: -58 dBm (above)14: -54: -54 dBm (above)15: -50:
Never search for 3G neighbour cells

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

MFS

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dBm

-98

-50

-50

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

This threshold is used to search for 3G cells if the received signal


level is below (-98 dBm to "always search for 3G neighbour cells") or
above (-78 dBm to "never search for neighbour cells") the threshold
in GPRS packet transfer mode.This parameter is sent in Packet
Measurement Order on PACCH.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1171 / 1182

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.25 (RNC_ID(n)) - (RNC_ID(n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

RNC_ID(n)

Logical Name

RNC_ID(n)

Definition

This parameter indicates the RNC Identifier as defined in 3GPP TS


25.401. It is used in HO Required message sent to the MSC.

Coding rules

binary value on 12 bits.The value of "-1" indicates that no RNCid is


provided by the operator (the default value, indicated here, is for
implementation purposes).

Mandatory rules

MCC_3G(n), MNC_3G(n), RNC_ID(n) and CI_3G(n) shall together


uniquely identify a 3G cellRNC_ID(n) is a mandatory parameter
(must be different from "-1")

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

3G cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

4095

-1

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

The default value indicated here is for implementation purposes

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1172 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.26 (SCRAMBLING_CODE_3G(n)) - (SCRAMBLING_CODE_3G(n))


Parameter Name

HMI Name

SCRAMBLING_CODE_3G(n)

Logical Name

SCRAMBLING_CODE_3G(n)

Definition

This parameter indicates the Primary Scrambling Code as defined


in 3GPP TS 25.213

Coding rules

binary value on 9 bits.The value of "-1" indicates that no scrambling


code is provided by the operator (the default value, indicated here,
is for implementation purposes).

Mandatory rules

EN_3G_DIVERSITY(n) can be True only if


SCRAMBLING_CODE_3G(n) <> "-1"SCRAMBLING_CODE_3G(n)
is a mandatory parameter (must be different from "-1")In any serving
cell there shall be only one 3G target cell defined with the couple
FDD_ARFCN(n) SCRAMBLING_CODE_3G(n)

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

3G cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

511

-1

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

The default value indicated here is for implementation purposes

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1173 / 1182

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.27 (T3121) - (T3121)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

T3121

Logical Name

T3121

Definition

This timer is started by sending an INTER SYSTEM TO UTRAN


HANDOVER message to the MS and is normally stopped when the
MS has correctly seized the UTRAN channel(s). Its purpose is to
keep the old channels sufficiently long for the MS to be able to return
to the old channels, and to release the channels if the MS is lost.

Coding rules

step size = 0.1 sec

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Timer

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSC

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

sec

25.5

14

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1174 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.28 (TDD_FREQUENCY_LIST) - (TDD_ARFCN_LIST)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TDD_FREQUENCY_LIST

Logical Name

TDD_ARFCN_LIST

Definition

List of neighbour TDD UTRAN frequencies (TD-SCDMA)

Coding rules

0 = 0.0 MHz, 1 = 0.2 MHz, ... , 16383 = 3276.6 MHz. The value of
"-1" indicates that no UTRAN TDD frequency is provided.

Mandatory rules

The defined frequencies (i.e. not set to -1) in the set shall be
different.Only following frequency bands are standardised : a) 1900
1920 MHz (UL/DL), 2010 2025 MHz (UL/DL) b) 1850 1910 MHz
(UL/DL), 1930 1990 MHz (UL/DL) c) 1910 1930 MHz (UL/DL).
Bands b) and c) are defined only for ITU region 2 (Americas).

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

List of numbers

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

BSS

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

MHz

16383

-1

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

The TDD UTRAN frequencies are coded as the UTRAN Absolute


Radio Frequency Numbers (ARFCN) on the Air interface.The TDD
UTRAN frequencies of the 3G neighbour cells are broadcast on
BCCH.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1175 / 1182

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.29 (TDD_Qoffset) - (TDD_Qoffset)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

TDD_Qoffset

Logical Name

TDD_Qoffset

Definition

Offset added to the received level average of the serving cell and of
the neighbour GSM cells for UTRAN TDD cell re-selection.

Coding rules

Coded value (binary): Value (dB): Text displayed at the OMC0: -32:
Always select a 3G cell if possible1: -28: -28 dB2: -24: -24 dB3:
-20: -20 dB4: -16: -16 dB5: -12: -12 dB6: -8: -8 dB7: -4: -4 dB8:
0: 0 dB9: 4: 4 dB10: 8: 8 dB11: 12: 12 dB12: 16: 16 dB13: 20: 20
dB14: 24: 24 dB15: 28: 28 dB

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-32

28

-32

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

This parameter is broadcast on BCCH.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1176 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.30 (THR_CELL_LOAD_3G_REJECT) (THR_CELL_LOAD_3G_REJECT)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THR_CELL_LOAD_3G_REJECT

Logical Name

THR_CELL_LOAD_3G_REJECT

Definition

Load threshold determining whether a 3G to 2G handover request


shall be rejected in load situation; the feature is deactivated by setting
THR_CELL_LOAD_3G_REJECT to its maximum value 100%.

Coding rules

binary value on 8 bits

Mandatory rules

THR_CELL_LOAD_3G_REJECT shall be lower than the 2G load


thresholds HIGH_TRAFFIC_LOAD or equal to 100%.

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Number

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1177 / 1182

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.31 (THR_CELL_LOAD_3G_REQ) - (THR_CELL_LOAD_3G_REQ)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THR_CELL_LOAD_3G_REQ

Logical Name

THR_CELL_LOAD_3G_REQ

Definition

Load threshold on the serving cell below which handovers towards


3G cells are forbidden when I.E. Service Handover is missing
(whatever EN_2G_3G_HO_NO_SERVICE_HO value)

Coding rules

Step size = 1

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

100

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Value 0 disables the feature.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1178 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

8.2.32 (THR_ECNO_HO) - (THR_ECNO_HO)


Parameter Name

HMI Name

THR_ECNO_HO

Logical Name

THR_ECNO_HO

Definition

Ec/No threshold above which a handover to UTRAN may be triggered

Coding rules

step size = 0.5 dB, coded over 6 bits0: "HO to 3G attempted whatever
the Ec/No", 1: -24.0,2: -23.5,3: -23, ...,48: -0.5,49: 0.0

Mandatory rules

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Threshold

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

dB

-24.5

-15

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1179 / 1182

8 2G-3G Telecom Parameters

1180 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

9 Telecom Parameters

9 Telecom Parameters

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

1181 / 1182

9 Telecom Parameters

9.1 Site (CAE)


9.1.1 (LAC) - (LAC(n)(BSC))
Parameter Name

HMI Name

LAC

Logical Name

LAC(n)(BSC)

Definition

Location Area Code of adjacent cell.

Coding rules

Mandatory rules

LAC and CI can not be equal to 65535 at the same timeEqual to


LAC(n)(MFS)A couple of mate extended cells (Extended inner +
extended outer) shall have the same

Recommended rules

Category

Site (CAE)

Type

Reference

SubSystem

BSC

Instance

cell

Value

Unit

Minimum

Maximum

Default

None

65535

65535

Modifiable

OMC Changes: RNO Changes:

Parameter Access

External Comment

Default value depends on configuration. The value indicated here


is for implementation purposes.

Cell Type Dependent

No

Nb of TRX Dependent

No

1182 / 1182

3BK 21224 AAAA PCZZA Ed.10

You might also like